Quarterlytics / Real Estate / Real Estate - Development / Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI

lre · LSE Real Estate
Claim this profile
Ticker lre
Exchange LSE
Sector Real Estate
Industry Real Estate - Development
Employees 201-500
← All annual reports
FY2022 Annual Report · Lar España Real Estate SOCIMI
Sign in to download
Loading PDF…
Holdings Limited

Lancashire Holdings Limited 
Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Strong
momentum

forward

Strategic report
Overview
2
3
4

Our business
KPIs
Business model
Our vision
Chair’s statement
Group Chief Executive’s review

8
10

Performance

Our market environment
Financial review
Underwriting review
Business review

Our approach to risk management
Enterprise risk management
Principal risks

14
16
20

Risk

26
30

Environmental, Social  
and Governance Report

Our commitment to sustainability
Chair’s introduction

40

Sustainability
43
44

ESG strategy
Stakeholder engagement and  
Section 172 responsibilities
Lancashire Foundation
People and culture
Sustainable insurance
Responsible investment

47
51
56
57
58 Operating responsibly
61

TCFD report

Governance

Our governance practice
Board of Directors
Corporate governance report
Committee reports

72
76
80
96 Directors’ Remuneration Report
118 Directors’ report
121

Statement of Directors’ responsibilities

Financial statements
122 Independent auditor’s report
132 Consolidated primary statements
136 Accounting policies
144 Risk disclosures
164 Notes to the accounts

Additional information
189 Shareholder information
191 Glossary
197 Alternative Performance Measures
199 Contact information

Lancashire and its people are guided by our values

Our values underpin everything we do and we challenge 
ourselves to keep them at the core of our culture. These  
values give us the framework to conduct our business in the 
right way for our people, our customers, wider society, and  
our stakeholders, as we continue to grow and move forward.

Leadership

Aspirational

Nimble

Exhibiting passion and commitment in all  
aspects of Lancashire life and inspiring others  
to do the same, we are…

aspiring to deliver a superior service for our 
clients, ourselves and our business partners,  
we are…

in our decisions, actions and business processes, 
and considerate of our environment and wider 
society, we are…

Collaborative

valuing teamwork and a diversity of skills  
and experience and sharing in our success,  
and we are…

Straightforward

in conducting our business in an accountable, 
open, honest and sustainable way.

A better
balance

for growth

1,652.3

810.2

1,225.3

664.2

1,500

1,000

814.1

526.6

842.1

706.7

454.2

638.5

392.9

561.0

500

Lancashire made significant 
progress in 2022 in realising the 
benefits of our work to diversify, 
fortify and grow our strong 
product portfolio.

We will always be driven by the 
underwriting opportunity and our 
disciplined approach to managing 
risk as we push forward.

We have the momentum to  
take advantage of an exciting 
market opportunity.

Gross premiums written

245.6

252.5

287.5

Key

Reinsurance

Insurance

2018

2019

2020

2021

2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

0

1

Our business

Demonstrating
resilience

A business focused on growth

We are a provider of global specialty 
insurance and reinsurance products offering 
risk transfer solutions to brokers and clients.
We always strive for long-term and mutually 
beneficial relationships with our customers 
and stakeholders.

We want to be the best and we are building on our strengths

Empowering people
Our sector 

A growing and responsible franchise
2

47%

plays a role in giving people and businesses confidence to operate, 
recover and thrive through our products

segments with 8 core  
product classes 

Our people 

are united by our ambition and we work hard to build strong teams

A supportive employer
100+

$149,000 

senior managers 
attended Group 
strategy sessions 
during 2022

donated to charities 
nominated by staff  
in 2022 from a total 
Foundation donation 
of $0.6m.

11.2%

Staff turnover

A helpful employer

One-off cost-of-living payment to lower paid employees

2

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

$1.7bn 

Robust capital base

Our footprint
3

offices in London, 
Bermuda and Australia

women in senior  
management roles

100%

calculated GHG emissions  
from own operations offset

338

experienced and  
talented colleagues

Strongly rated
A

A-

A3

(Excellent) 
A.M. Best Company

S&P  
Global Ratings 

Moody’s Investors 
Service

Key performance indicators

Change in FCBVS  

Combined ratio

Total investment return

1
.
4
1

.

2
0
1

4
2

.

)
8
5
(

.

.

)
7
6
(

-6.7%

.

2
2
99
0
8

.

8
7.
0
1

3
7.
0
1

7
7.
9

.

9
4

9
3

.

.

8
0

1
.
0

.

)
5
3
(

97.7%

-3.5%

18

19

20

21

22

18

19

20

21

22

18

19

20

21

22

The negative change in FCBVS is primarily due to the 
upwards trend in U.S. interest rates which resulted  
in $93.2 million of unrealised losses on our fixed 
maturity investment portfolio.

For the 2023 accounting year we will rename 
‘Change in FCBVS’ to ‘Change in Diluted Book  
Value Per Share’. This has no impact on the 
underlying calculation, given the Group has  
no warrants in issuance.

Net premiums earned have grown to $988.4 million 
compared to $696.5 million in the prior year. The 
profitable growth of our non-catastrophe lines of 
business has enabled Lancashire to mitigate the 
impact of the 2022 natural catastrophe loss events, 
such as hurricane Ian and the Australian floods.  
The combined ratio of 97.7% demonstrates how 
our recent disciplined growth helps deliver more 
balanced returns over the longer term and improves 
our ability to return an underwriting profit even in  
a year of significant losses.

Lancashire reported a total net investment return  
of negative 3.5% for the year ended 31 December 
2022. This was primarily driven by unrealised losses 
on our fixed maturity portfolio as a result of 
significant interest rate hikes by the U.S. Federal 
Reserve. Given the short duration of our investment 
portfolio we should benefit from the higher interest 
rate environment going forward.

Total Shareholder return

.

3
4
3

7
.
1
1

.

)
7
2
1
(

)
4
.
1
(

.

)
8
5
2
(

Comprehensive income  
returned to shareholders
284.2%

Gross premiums written  
under management

.

2
0
7

N/A

.

5
9
5

N/A

.

3
3
4

20.7%

132.9%

.

2
0
3

.

3
2
3

11.7%

1
.
2
4
8

.

8
4
3
9

1
7.
6
0
,
1

$59.5m 

.

7
0
5
8
,
1

.

4
3
0
5
,
1

$1.9b

18

19

20

21

22

18

19

20

21*

22*

18

19

20

21

22

In 2022 there has been an overall stock market 
decline driven by the ongoing conflict in Ukraine, 
supply chain and inflationary pressures, a rapidly 
changing interest rate environment, exchange rate 
volatility and general economic uncertainty. This 
weighed on our total shareholder return for much of 
the year with a recovery in Q4 2022. We see further 
opportunities for profitable underwriting growth into 
2023 and will continue to deliver on our strategy and 
manage the cycle.

Ordinary / special dividends and shares repurchased ($)
Comprehensive income returned to shareholders

%

* Due to 2022 and 2021 being N/A the five year %                  

average is not calculated.

The Group has made a comprehensive loss of 
$92.6 million in 2022 primarily driven by unrealised 
investment losses of $93.2 million on our fixed 
maturity available for sale investment portfolio.  
We remain strongly capitalised to deliver on  
our long-term strategy and continued to deploy 
excess capital into the business to fund growth 
opportunities. We paid ordinary dividends of 
$36.2 million and repurchased shares of 
$23.3 million. 

The Group continues to expand and diversify its 
underwriting portfolio taking advantage of a period 
of sustained rate increases across a number of lines 
of business. The Group’s corporate member has also 
acquired additional syndicate participation rights in 
Syndicate 2010, which takes the Group’s share of  
the 2023 year of account to 69.3%.

Key

KPI linked to Executive  
Directors’ remuneration.  
For more information see pages 96 to 117.

Alternative Performance Measures (APMs) 
refer to page 197.

Five-year average

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

3

OverviewBusiness model and strategy

A model to

move us forward

Our strengths

Our strategy

Customer focus
•  Our relationships with clients and brokers are 

long-standing and we aim to enable our clients  
to return to their pre-loss condition as soon  
as practicable

Expert people and  
specialised products 
•  Experienced management team and skilled 
operational teams with proven ability 

•  A lean business operation allows us to  

make decisions efficiently 

•  Highly-specialised multi-class products with  
market barriers to entry in terms of data and 
modelling expertise 

Disciplined risk and  
capital management
•  Rigorous systems for risk monitoring  

and management 

•  Strong track record of capital management 

•  Proven ability to manage volatility by optimising 
capital and the underwriting portfolio through 
market cycles 

A diverse offering
•  Three established platforms: Lancashire 

Insurance companies; Lancashire Syndicates;  
and Lancashire Capital Management 

•  Access to multiple markets providing clients  
with versatile solutions and ourselves with 
underwriting opportunities 

•  A stable core book of business and  

disciplined underwriting

Underwriting
comes first

Profitable growth 

Exploring opportunities for growth in markets where  
we believe the right long-term opportunities exist, and 
rigorously monitoring and managing our risk exposures.

Balance risk
and return through the cycle

Maximise risk-adjusted returns

Our speed and agility in the way we manage volatility 
help us underwrite our core portfolio profitably through 
the challenges of the cycle, yet seize opportunities when 
they present themselves.

Insurance market
employer of choice
Positive culture enables sustainability

Maintaining our positive culture and the ability to retain 
and attract the best talent is key for success, coupled  
with a strong focus on profitability and risk selection.

4

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Our purpose is to...

Deliver bespoke risk solutions  
that protect our clients and 
support economies, businesses  
and communities in the face  
of uncertain loss events.

Manage our risk exposures  
and capital resources to generate 
returns for our investors.

Support our people and work  
with our stakeholders, fostering  
a positive, sustainable and  
open business culture to the  
benefit of society.

Priorities

Growth in existing and new classes where favourable and improving market  
conditions exist. 

Focus on maintaining a diversified portfolio structure and our core clients.

Use the principle of peer review throughout the Group.

Achievements

We continue to add new expertise to the Group and diversify our underwriting  
portfolio. Gross premiums written increased to $1.7 billion in 2022. This growth  
came from both newer and more established classes.

Priorities

Explore opportunities for top-line growth in markets where we believe the right 
long-term opportunities exist and rigorously monitor and manage our risk exposures.

Use our speed and agility to manage volatility and underwrite our core portfolio 
profitably through the challenges of the cycle.

Deploy capital quickly when it is needed and having the discipline to return it when  
it is not.

Achievements

We have increased our underwriting footprint and optimised our portfolio in areas 
where rating has improved, whilst adding new complementary classes of business.

Priorities

Foster entrepreneurial, collaborative culture through the Lancashire values.

Improve operational efficiency and data capabilities through business  
transformation activities.

Develop the Group’s ESG principles to ensure we operate responsibly as a business.

Achievements

Employee headcount increased to 338 in 2022 with new talent attracted by 
Lancashire’s positive corporate culture.

More than $149,000 donated to charitable organisations nominated by employees  
in 2022.

The value we create

Our people

85%

overall participation rate for 2022  
employee ‘Pulse’ survey

Our policyholders

$412.7m 

gross losses paid in 2022

Our shareholders

16.5%

compound annual change  
in FCBVS since inception 

Society

$0.6m 

donated through the  
Lancashire Foundation in 2022 

The environment

15% 

per FTE carbon footprint reduction target  
from own operations by 2030

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

5

OverviewOur Vision

At Lancashire, our vision is to be  
the leading underwriter of specialty 
insurance and reinsurance products.

6

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

I am pleased with our performance in 2022 
and that the decisions we have made in the 
past few years to better balance the portfolio 
mean we have produced an underwriting 
profit in a challenging year. 

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

7

Chair’s statement

A stronger

and more  
 resilient business

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chair

Overall, the Board is satisfied that the business has demonstrated 
discipline and resilience in a challenging year. 

The Group’s negative change in FCBVS of 6.7%, based on the 
comprehensive loss of $92.6 million, was mainly driven by rising  
U.S. interest rates and general volatility in investment markets. These 
have impacted our investment returns at negative 3.5% and resulted  
in unrealised losses on our investment portfolio during the year, which 
we expect to unwind for the most part as our predominantly shorter 
duration assets reach maturity. 

Elevated natural catastrophe insured losses also contributed, with 
estimated industry-wide losses in 2022 of around $120bn, exceeding  
the 10-year average by 40%. 

Natural catastrophe risk business, particularly property catastrophe  
risks, is an important part of Lancashire’s product offering to its clients, 
offering confidence to vulnerable communities that they can return to 
normal post a loss event. 

As a result, we can expect our underwriting results to be impacted  
by catastrophe losses such as hurricane Ian. Nevertheless, Lancashire 
delivered a combined ratio of 97.7%, which demonstrates the benefits  
of the current growth and greater risk diversification in enabling us to 
produce an underwriting profit even in a year of heightened losses. 

For Lancashire, 2022 was the year where  
we continued to implement our long-term 
strategy of building a more diverse and 
robust business. We deployed our capital 
according to the opportunity in an 
improving pricing environment.

The year started with a challenging macroeconomic environment,  
which was further amplified by the conflict in Ukraine. In addition,  
the insurance industry had to deal with the large natural catastrophe  
loss of hurricane Ian and other loss events. 

However, I am very pleased that we maintained our strong forward 
momentum – with an increase in gross premiums written of 34.9%  
– despite the various challenges. 

This is the second year of strong premium growth since we raised new 
equity capital in 2020, and we now have a more diversified and balanced 
underwriting portfolio. 

The Board is pleased with this continued growth in both existing and new 
classes including longer tail casualty lines, and the Group’s position going 
into a strong market for many of our product lines in 2023. 

8

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

A stronger

“ This is the second year of strong premium growth since we 
raised new equity capital in 2020, and we now have a 
more diversified and balanced underwriting portfolio.”

This is testament to the delivery of our strategy to grow our footprint 
when the market opportunity allows, and to rigorously monitor and 
manage our risk exposures through the cycle. 

The Group’s philosophy on reserving has been conservative and is well 
established. Management engaged proactively with the Board during 
2022 in explaining the reserving exercises which were conducted, in 
particular with regard to the conflict in Ukraine and hurricane Ian. This 
gives us the confidence in our overall capital position and Natalie talks 
more about this in her review. 

Importantly, maintaining our positive culture as we grow is at the heart 
of Lancashire’s strategy, as outlined by Alex in his review. The Board is 
fully supportive of management’s efforts to ensure we continue to retain 
and attract a talented and diverse group of colleagues. 

During 2022, we also continued to have an active dialogue on issues  
of climate change, sustainability and governance. We were pleased  
to join the ClimateWise organisation during the year and we have  
again reported against the recommendations of TCFD and outlined  
our activities in measuring and actively monitoring climate change 
effects on the Group. 

Through the Lancashire Foundation we have always sought to support 
charities that have a positive impact on the communities they serve. The 
cost-of-living crisis has made that need even more acute. I am pleased 
that during 2022, the Foundation’s focus on social causes has been 
increasingly valuable and effective. The Foundation’s support for 
homeless charities is particularly apt and the organisations we have 
funded include in their ethos a long-term goal of helping people back  
on their feet. 

During the course of 2022, we have acknowledged and discussed the 
impact that the increased cost-of-living can have on some employees. 
We have ensured that our focus with regards to remuneration and 
assistance has been targeted to benefit those who are likely to require 
additional support the most. To that end, the Board approved a one-off 
cost-of-living payment for employees whose salary was below a specific 
level. You can read more about our work on Environmental, Social and 
Governance matters in our sustainability section starting on page 40. 

As in previous years, we have not changed our dividend strategy.  
Subject to a shareholder vote at the 2023 AGM, we propose to pay a 
final ordinary dividend of $0.10 per common share, unchanged on prior 
years. Further information can be found on page 119. Our dividend policy 
is set out on page 118. 

Q: How have employees assisted in navigating a challenging year? 
A: Lancashire employs some of the best people in our industry. Our underwriters have market-leading expertise and all our support functions 
effectively aid our overall goal to deliver on our strategy. 

In a challenging year, acting as one team with one driver for success is incredibly important. I am reminded constantly in my conversations with people 
from around the business of the strength of pride that they feel in working at Lancashire. 

On behalf of the Board, I would like to thank Alex, the wider management team and all our colleagues for their hard work and commitment. 

We believe the outlook for 2023 and beyond is extremely exciting and that we have the right teams across the Group to deliver our strategy and grow 
when there are opportunities. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

9

OverviewGroup Chief Executive’s review

Driving forward
a more diverse 
 and robust business

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

This year our focus remained firmly on 
delivering our long-term strategy and 
actively managing the cycle. 

I’m very pleased to report that Lancashire 
continued its strong growth trajectory, 
increasing gross premiums written  
year-on-year by 34.9% to $1.7 billion  
and delivering a combined ratio of 97.7%. 

Our robust underwriting performance came against a backdrop  
of high industry losses and a volatile macroeconomic environment. 

In line with our ‘underwriting comes first’ principle, we have continued  
to expand our footprint and take full advantage of the organic growth 
opportunities and rate increases being seen across the majority of our 
product lines. 

This growth has come from those lines where we have longer-term 
strength and expertise and from those we have added over the past  
few years as part of our actions to diversify and fortify our portfolio. 

Although there have been years in the past when we have had to be 
patient, we are now starting to see the benefits of the expansion we 
started in 2018 coming through. 

Traditionally, Lancashire has been seen as an established writer of natural 
catastrophe risk business meaning that when such events occur it is 
expected to impact our performance. However, during 2022 we have 
demonstrated that the growth and diversification of recent years now 
allows us to absorb significant catastrophe losses, such as hurricane Ian. 
While this event is estimated to be the second most costly hurricane  
on record, we have still produced a net underwriting profit. 

This is a notable positive step-change for the business and testament  
to the clear long-term strategy we have set out. 

Catastrophe and weather related losses for the year, excluding the 
impacts of reinstatement premiums, were $218.4 million. This includes 
the impact of hurricane Ian, which was within our expectations for these 
types of events and at the lower end of the $160 million to $190 million 
range provided at Q3.

10

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

“ Everything we do is driven by the underwriting opportunity. 
It is why we are here and why we do what we do.”

We previously set aside $22 million for direct claims emanating from  
the conflict in Ukraine. In Q4, we subsequently revised this to include an 
additional management margin for any potential indirect claims related 
to the conflict across a number of classes. Our potential claims related  
to the conflict now total $65.8 million. Given the nature of the conflict, 
the ultimate claims relating to the event are subject to a high level 
of uncertainty.

On investments, the volatility in the global financial markets and higher 
interest rates have understandably affected our 2022 investment result, 
which was negative 3.5% including mark-to-market losses. These losses 
are largely unrealised and were the most significant driver of the 
negative change in FCBVS of 6.7% for the year. Going forward, we 
expect to see higher investment income as a result of the higher 
interest rate environment.

From a capital perspective, we held a very strong position throughout 
the year and we have the necessary headroom to continue to write 
profitable business, and deliver returns, during what we expect to  
be a harder market in 2023. 

Overall, I am pleased with our performance in 2022, and that the 
decisions we have made in the past few years to better balance  
the portfolio mean we have returned an underwriting profit in a  
challenging year. 

During 2022, we have continued to strengthen our underwriting teams 
and our organisational infrastructure through key internal promotions 
and external hires. 

Lancashire aims to retain and attract the best people in our industry. Our 
underwriters have market-leading expertise and our support functions 
are vitally important in the overall delivery of our growth strategy. 

We made a number of senior appointments from within our existing 
underwriting teams during the year. This is testament to the strength  
of talent, knowledge and experience that we have at Lancashire, in 
underwriting and across the wider business. 

Our long-term investment in developing our people means that we are 
able to reward and promote colleagues across the Group when suitable 
opportunities arise. 

We are also enhancing and expanding our capabilities in a range of areas, 
including business development, human resources, procurement, change 
and vendor management, and sustainability.

We have always recruited on merit which has given us the benefits of a 
diverse employee community and we continue to look at how we can 
bring more people into the industry from a range of backgrounds. 

Q: How have the business’s strategic 
objectives and vision changed in 2022? 
A: Each year the Board reviews the Group strategy, and in 
2022 we made some changes to reflect the size of the business 
and our future aspirations. This includes a new focus on our 
people, operations and sustainability. 

It is important to stress that our number one priority remains 
the same and will not change – underwriting comes first. 

It is this emphasis on disciplined underwriting that underpins 
everything we do. It is also in many cases why people want to 
join Lancashire. 

They know that we have a strong team, in both underwriting 
and support functions, and that we value and reward expertise 
and talent. 

As I said last year, everything we do is driven by the underwriting 
opportunity. It is why we are here, why we do what we do and 
why we play an important role in supporting and protecting 
communities and economies across the world. 

I am pleased that in delivering on our strategy we have the  
full support of our people. We hosted sessions in London and 
Bermuda during 2022 for our people managers, where we had 
an opportunity to discuss how to bring the strategy and vision 
to life – and how we can further improve the work experience 
for employees. 

This spirit of collaboration is incredibly important for us  
at Lancashire. 

Fundamentally we are a people business and we have a high level of 
engagement from all our colleagues. Keeping our positive culture and 
making Lancashire a place that develops, retains and attracts quality 
people is central to our success going forward. 

I very much look forward to the opportunities for further profitable 
growth that the next 12 months may bring, and I’d like to thank all of  
our colleagues for their hard work, and our investors, clients, and brokers 
for their support during the past year.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

11

StrategyOur

market
environment

12

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

At Lancashire, we build when 
market conditions are favourable 
to create sustainable returns.

Our strong balance sheet will 
support our growth ambitions. 

Natalie Kershaw
Group Chief Financial Officer

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

13

Financial review

A balanced 
approach

Natalie Kershaw
Group Chief Financial Officer

We held a very strong capital position throughout the year and we 
have the necessary headroom to write profitable business during what 
promises to be an improving insurance market in 2023. We will always 
use our capital effectively to support the underwriting environment 
and manage our exposures to market conditions.

Financial highlights

Gross premiums written
Net underwriting profit 
(Loss) profit after tax1
Comprehensive (loss) income1
Dividends2
Diluted (loss) earnings per share
Fully converted book value per share
Change in FCBVS
Combined ratio
Accident year loss ratio 
Total investment return

1.  Amounts are attributable to Lancashire and exclude non-controlling interests.
2.  Dividends are included in the financial statement year in which they were recorded.

14

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

2022  
$m
1,652.3
150.8
(3.3)
(92.6)
36.2
($0.01)
$5.24
(6.7%)
97.7%
69.9%
(3.5%)

2021  
$m
1,225.2
69.0
(62.2)
(92.9)
36.4
($0.26)
$5.77
(5.8%)
107.3%
81.0%
0.1%

2020  
$m
814.1
77.0
4.2
24.3
32.3
$0.02
$6.28
10.2%
107.8%
71.4%
3.9%

2019 
$m
706.7
186.5
117.9
145.7
30.2
$0.58
$5.84
14.1%
80.9%
51.3%
4.9%

2018  
$m
638.5
121.7
37.5
24.7
70.2
$0.19
$5.26
2.4%
92.2%
70.0%
0.8%

 
During 2022, we have continued to deliver on our strategy to diversify 
our portfolio.

We have reported a combined ratio of 97.7%% for 2022, a strong 
performance when set against a backdrop of significant loss events, 
including hurricane Ian, and the conflict in Ukraine.

For hurricane Ian we incurred catastrophe losses of $163.3 million, 
excluding the impact of reinstatement premiums, in line with our 
expectations for this type of event.

The work we have done over the past four years has been targeted at 
strategic growth, and we reported gross premiums written for the year  
at $1,652.3 million - an increase of 34.9% on 2021. 

This growth has come both from those lines where we are traditionally 
strong, and from the newer classes of business that we have begun to 
write with new talented underwriting teams joining us. 

Lancashire has always had a well-established approach to reserving, and 
we have a consistent approach to these newer lines. Our philosophy is to 
be conservative and comfortable with how these classes are performing 
during the first years of writing this business. 

When catastrophe loss events occur, such as hurricane Ian, the size of 
our business and our strong collaborative culture mean that we have  
a clear line of sight in assessing the likelihood of claims arising. We use  
a combination of sophisticated modelling techniques, historical loss 
experience analysis, and our team’s expert judgement to estimate 
ultimate losses. These loss estimates are developed on a contract-by-
contract basis rather than a percentage of a wider expected industry loss.

We previously set aside $22 million for direct claims emanating from  
the conflict in Ukraine. In Q4, we subsequently revised this to include an 
additional management margin for any potential indirect claims related 
to the conflict across a number of classes. Our potential claims related  
to the conflict now total $65.8 million. Given the nature of the conflict, 
the ultimate claims relating to the event are subject to a high level  
of uncertainty.

The volatility in the global financial markets and steeper interest rates 
have inevitably affected our investment performance. Our investment 
result for 2022 was a negative return of 3.5% including mark-to-market 
losses. These losses are largely unrealised and are the main contributing 
factor to the comprehensive loss of $92.6 million.

The short duration of our portfolio means that we will see the  
benefit of the higher interest rate environment going forward  
in 2023. These additional returns will complement the growth  
in our underwriting portfolio.

In the medium term, we do not expect to make material changes to  
our investment strategy, with a focus on a short duration portfolio. 

Clearly, global commerce across sectors will also be impacted by higher 
inflation. For Lancashire we have experience managing inflationary 
pressures – in both directions – through a number of our product lines. 

Looking forward, our strategy has always been to manage the 
underwriting cycle and we are pleased that the decisions we have made 
in the past few years have put us in a strong position to take advantage 
of the market opportunities we will see in 2023. 

From a capital perspective, we held a very strong capital position 
throughout the year, and we have the necessary headroom to write 
profitable business during what promises to be an improving insurance 
market in 2023. This includes our catastrophe products, where we are 
happy with our position in the market and share of risk.

We will always use our capital effectively to support the underwriting 
environment and manage our exposures to market conditions.

Maximising returns for the capital deployed is what we are here to do, 
providing the best opportunity for returns for our shareholders. As we 
move forward into 2023, and beyond, our strategy for growth will 
continue to focus on less capital-intensive lines of business while matching 
the underwriting of more volatile classes with the market opportunity. 

Our strong capital position brings optionality, which is always beneficial 
in a fast-moving market. During 2022, we undertook a share repurchase 
programme to buy 4,589,592 common shares totalling $23.3 million to 
fund future exercises of awards under our RSS.

2022 was my second full year of serving as Group CFO. I am constantly 
impressed by the commitment of our teams across the business and 
their sharp focus on delivering on our strategic priorities. 

I am extremely confident that Lancashire is in a strong position to further 
grow in a disciplined way as the pricing environment continues to move 
in a positive direction. The events of 2022 will only accelerate that 
change and we are well placed to optimise those opportunities.

Q: What preparations for the IFRS 17 changes has the business made in 2022?
A: During 2022, we have spent a considerable amount of time fine-tuning our preparations for the transition to IFRS 17. As the biggest 
insurance accounting change for more than a generation, it has been many years in the making. 

As we move into implementation in 2023, we are confident that our preparations have been robust.

IFRS 17 allows businesses to make a number of judgments on how they will report. We have continued to work through these and to make 
the appropriate decisions to reflect the nature of our operations and our established focus on transparency. 

At our Investor Day in November we outlined our approach to IFRS 17 to aid early understanding of the impact. With such a substantial 
change it is important to stress test our assumptions and processes, and we have carried out a number of ‘parallel runs’ internally, ready  
for final implementation in 2023.

In ensuring our systems, data, processes and people are ready we have seen a strong collaborative effort across a number of teams.  
While the overall preparations have been time-consuming, we have taken the opportunity to refine our wider processes and make positive 
enhancements. This includes improving our collation and use of data across the business, which will have the long-term benefit of making 
Lancashire more efficient and reducing operating costs in some areas.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

15

PerformanceUnderwriting review

Gaining

momentum

Paul Gregory
Group Chief Underwriting Officer 

We delivered a healthy combined ratio of 97.7% in a year characterised 
by a challenging loss environment. Additionally, we saw the impacts  
of political unrest, inflation, sanctions, and economic instability that 
were offset by improved market conditions. 

Against this backdrop, we have continued to strengthen our  
underwriting bench, mainly through internal promotions and  
developing our talented teams. 

During 2022, we once again witnessed a number of loss events that  
both tested our clients and demonstrated the value of the (re)insurance 
products we sell. 

The conflict in Ukraine, and its tragic humanitarian consequences, 
dominated the year. Events such as these have far-reaching economic 
consequences and can create losses to (re)insurance policies that provide 
the relevant coverage. The total cost to the (re)insurance market for the 
conflict is not yet known, and there are a number of ongoing material 
uncertainties, but it is likely to be across both insurance and reinsurance 
classes including marine, energy, aviation, political violence, and political 
risk. These are classes in which we specialise and therefore have exposure 
to; albeit for a loss event of this magnitude, we see our estimated loss as 
very manageable. 

For the past five years we have spoken 
about our desire to grow and diversify  
our underwriting footprint whilst market 
conditions are favourable. The intention of 
this strategy has been to build out a more 
robust portfolio of business that allows us 
to better absorb the inherent volatility of 
the business we underwrite. 2022 is the  
year where we demonstrated the benefit  
of this strategy.

16

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

“ Gross Premiums Written is now at $1.7 billion. This is the 
highest at any point in our history and over $1 billion more 
than at the soft market low in 2017.”

We have also seen significant industry losses from natural catastrophes 
with an estimated $120 billion of insured losses. A variety of events have 
contributed to this total including flooding in areas such as Pakistan, 
South Africa and Australia, hailstorms, drought and extreme heat in 
Europe, plus convective storms, winter storms and hurricanes across 
North America. Of all the natural catastrophe loss events of 2022 by far 
the largest from an insured perspective was hurricane Ian. Hurricane Ian 
impacted the west coast of Florida in late September and is estimated  
to be the second most costly hurricane on record. These events have 
once again tested our underwriting of natural catastrophe risk and,  
given the size of hurricane Ian, our portfolio has proved to be more 
robust than ever. 

Despite these challenges, it has been another year of forward 
momentum in the build out of the underwriting portfolio and team.  
The underwriting environment has continued to be supportive, as 
demonstrated by a portfolio RPI of 108%. Almost every single sub-class 
of business delivered positive year-on-year rate increases, including 
classes that have now delivered cumulative rate rises each year for  
the past five years. 

It is these market conditions, plus the addition of new teams and 
products, that have contributed to premium growth of approximately 
35%, with gross premiums written now at $1.7 billion. This is the highest 
at any point in our history and over $1 billion more than at the soft 
market low in 2017. We anticipate even more favourable market 
conditions in 2023 and it is likely that this record premium level  
will be surpassed during the course of the next 12 months. 

We have consciously been building out our underwriting expertise  
over the past number of years as the business evolves, and the 
underwriting bench has continued to expand through 2022. 

We are pleased to have made a number of internal promotions over the 
past 12 months, demonstrating the strong development and progression 
of our underwriting talent as our footprint broadens. As the business 
grows, we will continue to offer attractive opportunities for those at 
Lancashire to progress their careers. 

Alongside these internal promotions, we continue to hire new talent  
into the business. In 2022, we added new lines of business such as 
construction and engineering, added leadership capabilities in sub-classes 
such as energy liabilities to expand our market presence, and successfully 
launched our new office in Sydney, Australia, to underwrite regional 
property insurance. All of these have contributed to our 2022 premium 
growth and will keep developing over the coming years as they mature. 

The dynamics across all our business segments have varied and we  
cover these more specifically in the analysis that follows. The Group’s 
operating segments for the purpose of reporting were revised during  
the year to reflect an internal management restructuring that occurred  
in the second half. 

Segment
Reinsurance
Insurance
Total

Premium $m

RPI

2022
842.1
810.2

2021
561.0
664.2
1,652.3 1,225.2

Variance
281.1
146.0
427.1

2022

2021 
108% 110%
108% 108%
108% 109%

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

17

PerformanceInsurance 
Our insurance segment includes aviation insurance, casualty insurance, 
energy and marine insurance, property insurance and specialty insurance. 
We have seen another year of growth opportunities across this segment 
with rates across all sub-classes positive. The insurance segment RPI  
for 2022 was 108% with premium growth of approximately 22%. A 
combination of the positive rating environment, inflationary pressure 
increasing values at risk and the continued build out of new teams have 
all contributed to the growth we have seen in 2022. 

It has been an interesting year for aviation insurance as the aviation 
industry continues to rebound strongly post the COVID-19 pandemic. 
Demand for aviation insurance has been relatively resilient despite the 
extreme downturn experienced by the sector during the pandemic years. 
In addition, the rating environment has continued to improve with a RPI 
of 118%, which is the highest across our portfolio. Within this there are 
sub-classes that are broadly stable from a rating perspective, given rates 
have increased steadily over the past five years, whilst the war / 
terrorism exposed products have seen a sharp increase in rating following 
the conflict in Ukraine. This is a class, however, that has seen a negative 
premium impact due to international sanctions on Russia which have 
been a headwind for growth in 2022. We continue to see opportunities 
to further grow our aviation portfolio during 2023, and the expectation  
is that rating will remain favourable to support this development. 

Casualty insurance is a small segment of the business and comprises 
our accident and health insurance sub-class and a small amount of 
professional lines insurance which is adjunct to our casualty reinsurance 
class. Market conditions remain positive with an RPI of 105%. Accident 
and health was a new class of business to the Group in 2020 and has 
grown steadily. We continue to explore opportunities in the broader 
casualty insurance arena, albeit our focus thus far has centred around  
the reinsurance lines. 

35% 

increase in gross premiums written

Group Chief Underwriting Officer continued

Reinsurance 
Our reinsurance segment contains casualty reinsurance, property 
reinsurance and specialty reinsurance. There has been significant 
premium growth in this segment during 2022 of approximately  
50%, with an RPI of 108%. This was expected given the build-out  
of casualty reinsurance and the strong rating environment for property 
and specialty reinsurance. 

Casualty reinsurance comprises casualty, professional and financial 
lines and accident and health reinsurance. The rating environment for  
all these sub-classes has been broadly stable with an RPI of 101%, with 
growth being a result of the continued maturity of the casualty sub-class 
and professional and financial lines sub-classes. An inflationary and 
future recessionary environment can bring challenges to some of these 
longer tail classes. Having entered these classes very recently, we have 
no legacy portfolio, where reserve deterioration can become a negative 
drag on results, and rating levels are at historical highs. Our underwriting 
and reserving approach to these lines will remain prudent as we build out 
this portfolio. 

Property reinsurance comprises our catastrophe exposed reinsurance 
classes as well as our excess of loss risk and other property treaty 
portfolios. As anticipated, rating for the natural catastrophe exposed 
sub-classes was positive as the market continued to harden; this is  
seen in the RPI of 111% for property reinsurance. During 2022, property 
catastrophe product line pricing strengthened during each quarter with 
supply reducing and demand increasing, while inflation saw our clients 
purchase more cover. We stuck to our stated strategy of maintaining 
relatively stable risk levels and taking the increased margin we got 
through rate improvements given we had already grown our footprint 
significantly during 2021. As we look to 2023, we expect to see a true 
hard market, due to the loss environment, the demand and supply 
imbalance and macroeconomic conditions. 

Specialty reinsurance comprises our reinsurance offering for classes 
such as aviation, marine and energy, as well as our property retrocession 
portfolio. The rating environment across all of the sub-classes remained 
positive during 2022, with an RPI of 110%. We continue to build out our 
specialty treaty account in areas such as energy, marine and political 
violence, adding to the already well-established sub-classes of aviation 
reinsurance and property retrocession. Much like our property 
reinsurance class, our risk appetite for the property retrocession  
sub-class was broadly stable as we look to maintain the Group’s natural 
catastrophe footprint. Loss events such as the conflict in Ukraine and 
hurricane Ian impacted these classes during 2022 and provided further 
impetus for continued improvement in both rating and terms and 
conditions as we move into 2023. 

18

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

“ The team have continued their  
drive forward as our bench strength 
grows, delivering on Lancashire’s 
long-term strategy.”

Specialty insurance comprises our terrorism, political violence and 
political and sovereign risks sub-classes. Prior to the conflict in Ukraine, 
rates in terrorism and political violence were starting to soften. As the 
insurance market reappraised its view of risk, this softening reversed and 
we started to see rate rises come through these product lines. The overall 
segment RPI for 2022 was 101%. The broader ramifications, in the form 
of political and economic turmoil that the conflict has produced, have 
undoubtedly influenced these sub-classes. The political and sovereign 
risk portfolio is predominantly non-renewable business and therefore  
is not subject to RPIs but the rating levels remain strong against this 
backdrop. We have delivered strong premium growth in the broader 
segment primarily as a result of new business opportunities. The outlook 
for 2023 is more promising as we anticipate the dislocation from the 
conflict to add more traction to the rating environment. 

Overall, we are extremely proud of what the underwriting team have 
achieved in 2022. 

The team have continued their drive forward as our bench strength 
grows, delivering on Lancashire’s long-term strategy. 2023 will bring 
plenty of opportunity for this momentum to carry on as premiums 
continue to grow and the underwriting portfolio goes from strength  
to strength. 

Energy and marine insurance provides products across the spectrum  
of the marine and energy sectors. The rating environment has remained 
positive with an RPI of 104% for 2022. There has been a variance in 
rating levels across all of the sub-classes with some, such as downstream 
energy, broadly stable and others, such as marine liability, seeing double 
digit rate increases. We have been able to grow premiums ahead of rate 
given the positive environment, inflationary pressures boosting demand, 
and underlying values at risk. Additionally, our investments in newer 
sub-classes such as energy and marine liability have provided new 
business opportunities. This has offset the negative impact of Russian 
sanctions on premiums in some of the energy sub-classes. 

We have continued to invest in our underwriting expertise to support  
the transition within the energy sector. In 2022, we brought in additional 
engineering resource to aid this ongoing development. This allows us to 
offer products and services that cater to the changing risks our clients 
face as their businesses transition. Insurance will continue to be a key risk 
management tool for the industry, supporting global net-zero goals and 
the wider transition. Please see the ESG section starting on page 40 for 
more information. 

Whilst the conflict in Ukraine did create losses in the energy and marine 
sectors, our exposure was modest. Outside of this event there were no 
significant insured losses in the energy and marine sectors, although 
there were a number of mid-sized losses in the downstream energy  
and power generation sectors; some of which we incurred. These loss 
events should help maintain modest rating momentum into 2023. 

Property insurance comprises property direct and facultative insurance 
and construction insurance. Trading conditions have been favourable 
with a 2022 RPI of 108%. Significant premium growth in property 
insurance this year has been driven by the favourable rating 
environment, inflationary pressures increasing demand, and underlying 
values at risk. In addition we have seen the benefits of various 
investments we have made. We opened our office in Australia to 
underwrite property direct and facultative insurance in the region,  
and the team have made a promising start. We also welcomed the 
construction team and market conditions have been better than 
originally anticipated, meaning that our start in this class has been 
strong. Across the broader property direct and facultative class we have 
continued to build out our portfolio on both our Lloyd’s and Lancashire 
UK platforms, benefitting from a number of new business opportunities. 
As a product that provides natural catastrophe protection, property 
direct and facultative was impacted by the various events during 2022, 
and in particular hurricane Ian. Our anticipation is that these positive 
market conditions continue in 2023, providing more opportunity to 
develop our portfolio. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

19

PerformanceBusiness review

Underwriting results

James Irvine
Group Chief Underwriting Officer 
– Reinsurance

James Flude
Group Chief Underwriting Officer 
– Insurance

Gross premiums written
Net premiums earned
Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Expense ratio
Combined ratio

2022

2021

Reinsurance $m

Insurance $m

Total $m

Reinsurance $m

Insurance $m

Total $m

842.1
495.5
71.0%
26.4%
–
97.4%

810.2
492.9
45.5%
26.4%
–
71.9%

1,652.3
988.4
58.3%
26.4%
13.0%
97.7%

561.0
302.1
90.6%
18.6%
–
109.2%

664.2
394.4
49.9%
25.5%
–
75.4%

1,225.2
696.5
67.6%
22.5%
17.2%
107.3%

The Group's operating segments for the purpose of segmental reporting 
have been revised in 2022. This reflects an internal management 
restructuring that occurred in the second half of the year. 

Reinsurance gross premiums written
The significant increase in premiums in the reinsurance segment is 
primarily due to new business in the casualty reinsurance class as we 
continue our successful build out of the new product lines within this 
class. This class also benefited from significant written premium being 
recognised from new policies bound in 2021.

Strong growth was also seen in property reinsurance. Rates continued  
to harden with RPIs of 111%. Aside from rate rises there was limited 
exposure growth in this class as the Group maintained relatively stable 
risk levels, taking the increased margin through rate improvements,  
given we had already grown our footprint significantly during 2021.

In specialty reinsurance, all lines of business saw small increases in gross 
premiums written driven by new business growth. We continued to build 
out our specialty treaty account in areas such as energy, marine and 
political violence, adding to the already well-established sub-classes  
of aviation reinsurance and property retrocession.

Overall, for the reinsurance segment, reinstatement premiums were 
$45.1 million in 2022 compared to $42.8 million in the prior year.

Insurance gross premiums written
There was increased premium in the majority of insurance classes during 
the year. A combination of the positive rating environment, inflationary 
pressure increasing values at risk and the continued build out of new 
teams all contributed to the growth in 2022.

The most significant increases in this segment were in the property 
insurance class where the Group has continued to expand its property 
direct and facultative offering across all its underwriting platforms, 
including the newly established Australian platform. The Group also 
added a new property construction line of business. 

The energy and marine insurance classes grew through the addition  
of new underwriting teams and product expansion, particularly in  
the marine liability and cargo and specie lines of business.

Outwards reinsurance premiums
Although in dollar terms the spend increased by $55.2 million or 13.5% 
compared to 2021, the proportion of outwards reinsurance premiums  
to gross premiums written has decreased year-on-year. The increase  
in reinsurance spend is primarily driven by the growth of the inwards 
portfolio and, to a lesser degree, by an increase in outwards 
reinstatement premium.

20

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Net acquisition costs
Net acquisition costs were $261.2 million in 2022 compared to 
$157.0 million in 2021, and the Group’s net acquisition costs ratio for  
the year ended 31 December 2022 was 26.4% compared to 22.5% in 
2021. The increase is primarily driven by the reinsurance segment where 
a change in business mix has seen more premium growth in proportional 
lines of business, which incur higher commission costs.

Net insurance losses
The Group’s net loss ratio for 2022 was 58.3% compared to 67.6%  
in 2021. The accident year loss ratio for 2022, including the impact of 
foreign exchange revaluations, was 69.9% compared to 81.0% in 2021. 

During 2022, we experienced net losses from catastrophe, weather  
and large loss events of $308.8 million, excluding the impacts of 
reinstatement premiums. Within this, catastrophe and weather  
related losses for the year ended 31 December 2022, excluding the 
impacts of reinstatement premiums, were $218.4 million. This includes 
$163.3 million from hurricane Ian. 

Prior year loss development
Prior year favourable development for 2022 was $100.5 million, 
compared to $86.5 million of favourable development in 2021. The 
favourable development in 2022 was primarily due to general IBNR 
releases on the 2021 and 2020 accident years and across most lines of 
business, due to a lack of reported claims. There was also favourable 
development on natural catastrophe loss events from the 2019 and 2018 
accident years as well as beneficial claims settlements on risk losses in 
the 2017 accident year. 

The favourable development in 2021 was primarily driven by general 
IBNR releases on the 2020 accident year across most lines of business 
due to a lack of reported claims. 2021 also included favourable 
development on the 2017 accident year, mainly from reserve releases  
on natural catastrophe loss events, as well as some beneficial claims 
settlements from earlier accident years. 

The table below provides further detail of the prior years’ loss development 
by class, excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations.

Our provision for large risk events for the year amounted to 
$90.4 million and include $65.8 million related to the ongoing conflict  
in Ukraine and $24.6 million from an accumulation of four large losses  
in the energy upstream and power generation lines of business.

Reinsurance 
Insurance
Total

2022  
$m
45.3
55.2
100.5

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

The table below provides further detail of the prior years’ loss 
development by accident year, excluding the impact of foreign  
exchange revaluations.

Ultimate loss development by accident year

2017 accident year and prior
2018 accident year
2019 accident year
2020 accident year
2021 accident year
Total

Note: Positive numbers denote favourable development.

2022  
$m
19.9
13.6
13.7
27.5
25.8
100.5

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, the table below 
shows the impact of the current year loss events on the Group’s net loss 
ratio for the year ended 31 December 2022:

Reported at 31 December 2022
Absent catastrophe and weather 
events 
Absent large losses 
Absent catastrophe, weather and 
large loss events

Losses  
$m
576.4

358.0
486.0

267.6

Loss ratio  
%
58.3

35.7
48.8

26.3

Note: The table does not sum to a total due to the impact of reinstatement premium.

During 2021, our total net catastrophe, weather and large losses, 
excluding the impact of reinstatement premiums, were $306.4 million. 

Excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, the table below 
shows the impact of prior year loss events on the Group’s net loss ratio 
for the year ended 31 December 2021.

Reported at 31 December 2021
Absent catastrophe and weather 
events 
Absent large losses 
Absent catastrophe, weather and 
large loss events

Losses  
$m
470.5

232.9
401.7

164.1

Loss ratio  
%
67.6

33.2
57.7

23.4

Note: The table does not sum to a total due to the impact of reinstatement premium.

2021  
$m
22.2
64.3
86.5

2021  
$m
36.1
7.1
8.8
34.5
–
86.5

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

21

PerformanceBusiness review continued

Investment results

Denise O’Donoghue
Group Chief Investment Officer

Investments and liquidity
Since inception, the primary objectives for our 
investment portfolio have been capital preservation 
and liquidity, and we position our portfolio to limit 
down-side risk in the event of market shocks. Those 
objectives remain unchanged and are more important 
than ever in today’s volatile markets. 2022 was the 
story of one of the most significant U.S. Federal 
Reserve rate increases in history as a tool to fight 
inflation. While it resulted in negative returns for 
2022, 2023 has a more positive outlook, starting  
the year with much higher yields in the investment 
portfolio. With the significant rate hikes, continued 
inflation and an inverted yield curve, there is a risk  
of recession. However, given the level of current 
market yields, our portfolio can weather this, 
particularly with a high credit quality portfolio.  
With an inverted yield, we do not see any reason  
to increase duration significantly. We will continue  
to maintain a short, high credit quality portfolio with 
some portfolio diversification to balance the overall 
risk adjusted return. 

Our portfolio mix illustrates our conservative 
philosophy, as shown in the chart below. 

Investment performance
Net investment income, excluding realised and 
unrealised gains and losses, was $43.7 million for 
2022, an increase of 90.0% compared to 2021. Total 
investment return, including net investment income, 
net other investment income, net realised gains and 
losses, impairments and net change in unrealised 
gains and losses, was a loss of $76.7 million in 2022 
compared to a gain of $1.3 million for 2021.

In a year of significant volatility, the investment 
portfolio generated a negative return of 3.5%. The 
returns were driven primarily from interest rate 
increases and the widening of credit spreads, resulting 
in losses in all asset classes. The majority of the losses 
were unrealised. It is expected that the majority of 
the unrealised losses will reverse over the next couple 
of years, given the short duration of the portfolio. 

In 2021, the investment portfolio generated a small 
positive return of 0.1%. While the portfolio had been 
hit in 2021 by rising rates, the losses were somewhat 
mitigated by the strong returns in the majority of the 
risk assets, notably the bank loans, hedge funds and 
the private investment funds.

Conservative portfolio structure – quality

Asset allocation 
Total investment portfolio and managed cash

Credit quality 
Fixed maturities and managed cash

Other government bonds 
and agency debt: 3%

Private investment funds: 4%

Hedge Funds: 4%

Index Linked Securities: 1%

BB or below: 6%

AAA: 19%

BBB: 13%

U.S. government 
bonds and agency 
debt: 30%

Duration 
1.7 years

Corporate and 
Bank Loans: 37%

Average credit 
rating of AA-

A: 21%

Managed cash and short 
term securities: 11%

Non-agency structured 
products: 8%

Agency structured products: 2%

22

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

AA: 41%

Other financial information

Hayley Johnston
Chief Executive Officer, 
Lancashire Insurance Company 
Limited and Reinsurance Manager

John Cadman
Group General Counsel  
and Chief Executive Officer, 
Lancashire Insurance Company 
(UK) Limited

John Spence
Chief Executive Officer, 
Lancashire Syndicates Limited

Share repurchases
During the year ended 31 December 2022, Lancashire repurchased 
4,589,592 of its common shares (out of an overall, maximum Board-
approved limit of 9,000,000 common shares, conducted via three 
separate share repurchase programs). These repurchases totalled 
$23.3 million and were made pursuant to and in accordance with  
the general authority granted by shareholders at Lancashire's Annual 
General Meeting held on 27 April 2022, and will be used to satisfy a 
number of future exercises of awards under the Company’s Restricted 
Share Scheme.

Dividends
Lancashire announces that its Board of Directors has declared a final 
dividend of $0.10 (approximately £0.08) per common share, subject to  
a shareholder vote of approval at the AGM to be held on 26 April 2023, 
which will result in an aggregate payment of approximately 
$23.8 million. On the basis that the final dividend is approved by 
shareholders at the AGM, the dividend will be paid in Pounds Sterling  
on 2 June 2023 (the “Dividend Payment Date”) to shareholders of record 
on 5 May 2023 (the “Record Date”) using the £ / $ spot market exchange 
rate at 12 noon London time on the Record Date. 

Shareholders interested in participating in the dividend reinvestment plan 
(DRIP), or other services including international payment, are encouraged 
to contact the Group’s registrars, Link Group, for more details.

Third-party capital management
The total contribution from third party capital activities consisted of the 
following items:

LCM underwriting fees
LCM profit commission
LSL fees & profit commission
Total other income
Share of loss of associate
Total third-party capital 
management income

2022 
 $m
3.1
0.9
2.5
6.5
(6.5)

–

2021  
$m
10.6
5.2
2.4
18.2
(3.9)

14.3

 The amount of Lancashire Capital Management profit commission 
recognised is driven by the timing of loss experience, settlement of 
claims, and collateral release, and therefore varies year on year. The 
share of loss of associate reflects Lancashire’s equity interest in the 
Lancashire Capital Management managed vehicle. 

Other operating expenses
Other operating expenses were $128.7 million in 2022 compared to 
$119.6 million in 2021. A growth in headcount has resulted in higher 
underlying employee remuneration costs compared to the prior year 
alongside an increase in audit fees, travel costs and fees and 
subscriptions. The weakening Sterling/U.S. Dollar exchange rate relative 
to the prior year partly offset these increases in the underlying cost base.

Capital
As at 31 December 2022, total capital available to Lancashire was 
approximately $1.7 billion, comprising shareholders’ equity of $1.3 billion 
and $0.4 billion of long-term debt. Tangible capital was $1.5 billion. 
Leverage was 26.0% on total capital and 28.9% on total tangible capital. 
Total capital and total tangible capital as at 31 December 2021 were 
$1.9 billion and $1.7 billion respectively.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

23

PerformanceOur approach to

risk management

24

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

At Lancashire, our corporate 
infrastructure has been developed 
to manage risk and support 
disciplined, sustainable growth.

We pride ourselves on a strong and 
collaborative risk culture that promotes  
risk awareness and discipline across all  
the Group’s activities.

Louise Wells
Group Chief Risk Officer

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

25

Enterprise risk management

A culture

of risk
challenge

Louise Wells
Group Chief Risk Officer

At Lancashire, our corporate infrastructure has been developed to 
manage risk and support disciplined, sustainable growth. Our ERM 
framework sits at the heart of this, underpinned by a strong risk culture 
and governance framework. As the Group continues its strong forward 
momentum and maximises the opportunities available, the risk function 
is focussed on providing appropriate second line oversight and challenge 
to mitigate the risks involved. 

Inflation and geopolitical risk are two areas that have had a lot of focus 
this year. The impact of inflation on the principal risk of reserving is 
discussed in more detail on page 34.

The events of the last couple of years have demonstrated just how 
quickly a risk can change and the importance of monitoring a wide  
range of risks, including those that are harder to quantify. As a result, 
 the focus of the risk function has been on balancing the rear-view, what 
happened and why did it happen, and the cockpit view of uncertainty, 
what will happen and how can we make it happen to both preserve and 
create value for the Group. The risk function cannot operate successfully 
in isolation and we pride ourselves on a strong and collaborative risk 
culture that promotes risk awareness and discipline across all the  
Group’s activities.

Lancashire’s values remain instrumental in maintaining a strong and 
straightforward risk culture within the business. Leadership is a key 
element of this, with the accessibility to, and visibility of, Lancashire’s 
senior management actively promoting, and adhering to, the risk 
framework driving the collaboration throughout the business. 

26

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

During 2022, we have expanded the risk function, recruiting additional 
staff with complementary skill sets to better enable us to provide 
effective challenge of the changing risk landscape and stress test the 
assumptions made by the business in relation to these risks. As the 
Group continues with its growth plans, resource levels will be revisited to 
help ensure the function continues to be able to manage the challenges 
associated with our growth as well as address emerging and climate risks 
and legal and regulatory changes.

With respect to climate change, Lancashire became a member of 
ClimateWise during the first half of 2022. ClimateWise is part of the 
Centre for Sustainable Finance at Cambridge University and represents  
a growing global network of leading insurance industry organisations. 
ClimateWise helps to align its members’ expertise to directly support 
society as it responds to the risks and opportunities of climate change. 
ClimateWise members are required to annually disclose their firm’s 
response to climate change through the ClimateWise Principles 
Framework; as a new member Lancashire was not obliged to participate 
but opted to do so. The seven ClimateWise Principles are aligned  
with the requirements of the Taskforce on Climate Related Financial 
Disclosures (TCFD); our TCFD reporting can be found in the sustainability 
section starting on page 61. 

ERM & ORSA
Key activities

Strategy review & challenge
•  Review of business strategy with  

challenge from the Board

•  Annual approval of a business  
strategy paper by the Board

•  Development of ESG strategy and framework

Risk identification & assessment
•  Quarterly risk and control affirmations

•  Quarterly emerging risk working group

•  Quarterly internal audit reports to the Audit 
Committee providing an update on work 
performed and analysis of root causes of  
audit findings

•  External audit reports to the Audit Committee

•  Audit Committee annual review of 

the effectiveness of financial controls

•  Monthly CCWG

•  Monthly ESG Committee

Risk appetite & tolerances
•  Review of risk strategy and ‘attitude to risk’

•  Review and measurement of risk  

appetite and limits

•  Review of Group risk tolerances

•  Management, Board and subsidiary board 
approval and monitoring of risk appetite 
and tolerances

Strategy review  
& challenge

Risk 
solvency &  
assessment

Capital 
management

C u l ture &

Board

RRC

Govern a n c

e

Risk 
identification  
& assessment

Risk appetite &  
tolerances

Risk & business  
management

Business  
planning

Risk & business management

Capital management

•  Review of risk management policies

•  Capital and liquidity management frameworks

•  Assessment of risk management 

•  Review of internal model policies, capital and 

framework maturity

solvency appetites

• 

Integrated assurance assessment

•  Full/proxy capital assessments

•  Emerging risk assessment

•  Rating agency capital assessments

•  ESG framework and strategy

•  Stress and scenario testing

•  Review and approval of business  

•  Board quarterly review of capital needs, 

plan by the Board

headroom and actions

Business planning
•  Stress and scenario testing (business plan)

Risk solvency & assessment
•  Group CRO reports to Board and Group  

•  Assessment of management actions

•  Group CRO review of business plan

•  Board business performance review

•  Board consideration of 

stakeholder engagement

Executive Committee

•  Production of quarterly ORSA report for 

review and approval by the Board

Key elements of ORSA

Board sign off and embedding

Business strategy

Risks

Capital and solvency

Stress and scenario testing

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

27

RiskEnterprise risk management continued

Risk management strategy
Our risk management strategy remains aligned to the business and 
capital strategy to ensure the capital resources held are matched to the 
risk profile of the Group and that the balance between risk and return is 
considered as part of all key business decisions.

The Group’s financial performance is exposed to risks from several 
sources. These include insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, credit risk, 
operational risk and strategic risk, which are all discussed further in the 
risk disclosures on page 144, as well as Group risk and regulatory and 
legal risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk, which can be 
subdivided into the core risk of underwriting and the non-core risk of 
reserving and includes the Group’s risk exposures to natural 
catastrophes, including wind storms, wildfires and other loss events 
linked to climate change trends, and risks related to other natural 
phenomena. This risk is discussed in more detail in the Principal Risks 
section starting on page 30.

The Board of Directors retains responsibility for all risk within the Group 
and is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite 
and tolerances, whereas the individual entity boards of directors are 
responsible for setting and monitoring entity-level risk tolerances. Risk 
tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, generally on a 
modelled basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to 
certain risks. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary marginally from time 
to time to reflect the potential risks and returns that present themselves. 
However, protecting the Group’s capital and maximising risk-adjusted 
returns for investors over the long term are constants. All risk tolerances 
are subject to at least an annual review and consideration by the 
respective boards of directors. The Board and individual entity boards  
of directors review actual risk levels versus tolerances, emerging risks, 
loss event and near miss reporting, key risk indicators, and an overview  
of the control environment (driven by key control testing and control 
affirmations and supported by internal audit findings) at least quarterly. 
In addition, on at least a monthly basis, management assesses our 
modelled potential losses against risk tolerances to ensure that risk  
levels are managed in accordance with them.

The focus on ERM and governance is consistent across the cycle with  
full engagement from the Board down. Roles and responsibilities with 
respect to the identification, assessment, mitigation and monitoring of 
risks are clearly defined. The risk management framework drives risk 
culture from the bottom up, through risk and control ownership by 
management and staff across the Group.

28

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Risk management framework
The Group takes an enterprise-wide approach to managing risk with  
a Group risk management framework. The framework sets out our 
approach to identifying, assessing, mitigating and monitoring the 
principal risks the Group faces. Lancashire subscribes to a ‘three lines  
of defence’ model, the front-line being risk ownership by business 
managers. Responsibility for the management of individual risks has been 
assigned to, and forms part of, the performance objectives of the risk and 
control owners within the business. Risk owners ensure that these risks 
and the controls that mitigate against them are consistent with their 
day-to-day processes and the entries made in the respective risk 
registers, which are a direct input into the subsidiary capital models. The 
second line comprises the risk management team, which is responsible 
for risk oversight, the emerging risk forum, the CCWG and the RRC. 
Within this, the Group CRO provides regular reports to the business 
outlining the status of the Group’s ERM activities and strategy, as well  
as formal reports to the Board and the boards of the individual operating 
entities. The Group CRO ultimately has the right to report directly to  
the Group and entity regulators if they feel that management is not 
appropriately addressing areas of concern regarding the Group as a 
whole or any of the individual operating entities. LSL’s CRO provides 
formal reports to the LSL Board and its RCCC. The third line of defence  
is the internal audit function, whose work complements that of risk 
management by independently assessing the operating effectiveness  
of controls and also appraising the culture.

We continue to perform a quarterly risk and control affirmation process 
whereby the operation of all key controls is affirmed by the control 
operators and then reviewed and approved by the risk owners. In 
addition, the risk owners are required to affirm that their risks remain 
appropriately documented and scored. The risks are scored on both a 
gross basis (i.e. inherent risk pre-controls) and a net basis (i.e., residual 
risk post the application of controls). The output from this process is 
reported to the RRC and the Group and operating subsidiary audit  
and risk committees or boards of directors as appropriate.

As at 31 December 2022, all Group entities were operating within their 
Board-approved risk tolerances.

The quarterly ORSA reports prepared by the Group CRO to the Group 
and subsidiary boards provide a timely analysis of current and potential 
or emerging risks, compared against risk tolerances, along with their 
associated capital requirements.

The 2023 annual ORSA report will be presented to the Board for review, 
challenge and approval at the Q1 2023 Board meeting. The equivalent 
reports for the operating subsidiaries will also be presented to their 
boards for review, challenge and approval during Q1 2023. As a Lloyd’s 
managing agent, LSL falls within the Society of Lloyd’s for Solvency II 
reporting, preparing ORSA reports for each syndicate. LSL has its own 
ERM framework to ensure adherence to Lloyd’s minimum standards.

The diagram on the previous page illustrates how we balance our ERM 
and ORSA activities, all of which are underpinned by our risk culture and 
governance. Our collaborative risk culture is driven from the ‘top down’ 

“ We aim to promote informed risk taking that considers the 
risk and reward equation in all major decisions in order to 
optimize growth.”

via the Board and executive management to the business, with the RRC 
central to these processes. Risk culture is also driven from the ‘bottom 
up’ through the risk and control affirmation process. The primary role  
of the Group CRO is to facilitate the effective operation of ERM and the 
ORSA processes throughout the Group at all levels. 

The role includes, but is not limited to, the following responsibilities:

•  overall management of the risk management system;

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

to drive ERM culture, ownership and execution on three levels:  
Board, executive management and operational within the business;

to facilitate the identification, assessment, evaluation and 
management of existing and emerging risks by management and the 
Board, including the articulation of risk preferences and the adoption 
of formal risk tolerances;

to facilitate the identification, assessment, evaluation and 
management of climate-related risks and opportunities by 
management and the Board and report the financial impacts thereof;

to ensure that these risks are given due consideration and are 
embedded within management’s and the Board’s oversight and 
decision-making process;

to be consulted, and opine, on policy in areas such as, but not limited 
to, underwriting, claims, investments, operations and capital 
management; and

to provide timely, accurate, reliable, factual, objective and  
accessible information and analysis to guide, coach and support 
decision making.

During 2022, the risk management framework was enhanced with 
regards to evidencing risk management challenge, with a focus on  
the areas of strategic decision making and change management. The 
quarterly ORSA report was used to report this oversight and challenge  
to the Board.

The internal audit function considers both existing risks to the business 
and emerging risks which may impact the Group in designing its 
programme of work. The Group’s risk and control registers and emerging 
risk radar are key sources of information for internal audit who provide 
the Audit Committee with mapping between the proposed audit plan 
and key risks of the Group as well as coverage of emerging risks within 
the internal audit plan. The Group CRO has input to all internal audit 
terms of reference and receives copies of all internal audit reports 
enabling the risk function to assess all recommendations and include  
in the risk register as appropriate.

RRC
The RRC, chaired by the Group CEO, is the key management tool for 
monitoring and challenging the assessment of risk on a regular basis. It 
seeks to optimise risk-adjusted returns and facilitate the appropriate use 
of the Group’s internal models, including considering their effectiveness. 
It ensures that all key areas of risk are discussed according to a schedule 
that covers fortnightly, monthly, quarterly, semi-annual and annual 
reviews. The RRC meets fortnightly and is responsible for coordinating 

and overseeing ERM activities within the risk profile, appetites and 
tolerances set by the Group and individual entity boards of directors.  
The RRC includes the Group CEO, members from the finance, actuarial, 
modelling, operations, treasury and underwriting functions, and both the 
Group CRO and LSL CRO. The Group CRO reports on the RRC’s activities 
to the Group and individual entity boards of directors and via the LSL 
CRO to the RCCC of LSL. Through the Group CRO the RRC considers 
recommendations to the Board and its committees with regard to the 
adoption of formal risk tolerances. Examples of specific items considered 
by the RRC during 2022 include: the Group strategy and business plan, 
risk appetite statements, capital and solvency appetite, ERM framework, 
stress and scenario tests, the results of thematic reviews (for example a 
review on the impact of inflation on our portfolio and associated model 
assumptions) and the results of the quarterly affirmation process and 
related controls testing.

Emerging risk
The identification and assessment of emerging risk occurs throughout 
the Group from individual departments to management and executive 
committees, to the boards of directors and sub-committees of the 
boards. The risk function runs the emerging risk forum and maintains  
an emerging risk radar, which is provided to the executive committees, 
Board and entity boards of directors each quarter, and is therefore 
subject to an iterative process of review and oversight. 

Emerging risks, by their nature, are difficult to quantify, however our 
emerging risk radar was designed to clearly illustrate the risks and 
expected time horizon, magnitude and likelihood. Examples of key 
emerging risks monitored include operational strain (driven by growth), 
geopolitical disruption, economic risks including inflation and recession, 
and regulatory risk, for example in relation to new climate related 
standards or legislation.

Whilst no longer an emerging risk, climate change risk remains at  
the top of many political agendas internationally and is an area of  
risk monitoring and management for us at both management and  
Board level. 

The threat which catastrophic weather events pose to individuals, 
communities and businesses illustrates the social and economic value 
which our risk management products generate. This is therefore a key 
area of strategic opportunity for our business and one of the key drivers 
of our underwriting risk exposure management. In particular, 
management and the Board set tolerances for, and monitor, the Group’s 
probable maximum losses for major catastrophe events and in particular 
weather-related exposures. Please see page 146 for a list of the Group’s 
current PML risk exposures. 

Climate change risk also informs the way we manage our investment 
portfolio and associated risk. During 2022, the Group once again 
participated in the CDP, which is aligned with the recommendations of 
the TCFD, which are promoted by the Financial Stability Board and the 
Bank of England. See also our 2022 TCFD Report starting on page 61 for 
more information.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

29

RiskPrincipal risks

Understanding the key risks to the Group

Our classification of risks as Intrinsic Core 
and Intrinsic Non-core, Operational and 
Other helps us to focus on our management 
and mitigation of those risks.

Within the capital models, insurance risk accounts for the majority of  
the allocated risk capital, so this is clearly the principal area where we 
stringently apply controls and reviews. For example, we place a large 
number of controls around monitoring risk levels across the business. 
However, we understand that even risks that do not generate a capital 
charge under an economic capital model can pose serious threats to the 
execution of the business plan and strategy, and therefore need to be 
monitored and tested. We continue to believe in the market cycle and 
the dynamics of supply and demand and therefore spend time looking at 
the implications of new capital entering the market and the evolution of 
the market cycle. In addition, the Group continues to consider and adapt 
to the risks and opportunities arising from climate change through the 
analysis of the associated physical, transitional and liability risks. As part 
of our overall risk mitigation strategy, we perform detailed stress and 
scenario testing to stress the financial stability of the Group. This process 
is aligned to our business planning, ORSA processes and strategic and 
business plan time horizons. The selected tests are aligned to our key  
risk areas of capital (rating agency and regulatory), underwriting and 
investment-related stress tests, at a minimum. 

From a capital perspective we show the losses we could absorb and still 
meet our rating agency and regulatory capital requirements. Our climate 
change scenario incorporates underwriting and investment risks as we 
consider transition risk and physical risk. For this scenario we stress our 
premium income, our catastrophe loss ratios to reflect the assumed 
increased frequency and severity and inflationary impact on associated 
claims, our litigation costs, and our investment return. We also run 
various other tests based on discussions with the RRC and the Group 
Executive Committee that identify pertinent potential stresses and 
scenarios given market or social conditions prevailing at the time.

Risk universe

We continue to classify risks in three broad classes: (a) Intrinsic risk: risk 
that stems from the inherent randomness and uncertainty that exists in 
the universe in which we operate and that is therefore fundamental to 
how we manage our business. This can be core (represents the potential 
to generate a return as well as a loss) or non-core (offers no direct 
potential for return); (b) Operational risk: which can be independent or 
correlated; and (c) Other risk: the non-financial category of risks which 
cannot necessarily be mitigated by holding capital since such risks may 
not have direct balance sheet implications.

The Board evaluated the risks disclosed, alongside other factors, in the 
assessment of the Group’s viability and prospects as set out in the going 
concern and viability statement in the Directors’ report at page 118.

Intrinsic (core)

Underwriting, Investment

Intrinsic risks representing the potential to generate a return as well  
as a loss.

In these areas, the Group promotes informed risk taking that considers 
the risk and return equation in all major decisions, with the intention of 
maximising risk-adjusted returns.

We recognise that by insuring fortuitous events we can suffer losses, and 
that within our investment portfolio we can see the value of investments 
fall. We cannot avoid these risks, so we focus on the correlated 
operational risks and seek to mitigate them. For example, we know that 
by insuring the risk of natural perils we are exposed to the risk that losses 
exceed our plan. We model our portfolio using stochastic modelling to 
review actual and planned exposures to ensure they remain within 
tolerances. The correlated risks are that we might fail to design or 
maintain effective tolerances and limits, and fail to maintain exposures 
within such limits; or that we fail to keep accurate and timely records of 
our exposures. We then devise systems and processes to mitigate these 
risks, such as PML reconciliations and RDS sign offs, with review by the 
RRC and regular ORSA reports to the Board, which also considers and 
approves formal risk tolerances.

30

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Intrinsic (non-core)

Current assessment of principal risks

Reserving, (Re)insurance Counterparty, Liquidity

Intrinsic risks to which we are inevitably exposed as a result of 
conducting our day-to-day business operations, yet offer no direct 
potential for return.

They are quantified insofar as practicable for the purposes of  
capital and risk management and avoided or minimised insofar  
as is economically justifiable.

Operational

These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal 
processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events.

They have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of 
intrinsic risks, for example increased reinsurer default losses arising 
through the use of non-approved counterparties; or to crystallise 
separately in their own right, for example losses arising through the 
imposition of fines as a result of a regulatory breach, so unrelated to  
our core functions.

Other

Strategic, Group, Emerging, Climate

These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for 
which a structured approach is still required to ensure that their potential 
impact is considered and mitigated insofar as is practicable. These are 
included within the risk register and are assessed and mitigated through 
scenario and stress testing.

Given the broad reach of climate change and the risks associated with it, 
we concluded these risks are most appropriately managed by including 
their impact through existing principle risks, rather than a separate 
climate change principal risk. The impact of climate change is therefore 
covered in the following principal risks: underwriting, investment, 
operational and strategic.

i

n
a
t
r
e
C
t
s
o
m
A

l

1

2

6

5

3

4

7

d
o
o
h

i
l
e
k
i
l
g
n
i
s
a
e
r
c
n

I

y
l
e
k
i
L

e
l
b
i
s
s
o
P

y
l
e
k
i
l

n
U

e
r
a
R

Very Low

Low

Moderate

High

Very High

Increasing financial and non-financial consequences

Key

Principal risk

1

2

3

4

Underwriting 

Investment 

Reserving

(Re)insurance counterparty

5

Liquidity

6 Operational

7

Strategic 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

31

Risk 
 
Principal risks continued

Intrinsic risk: Core – Underwriting

1

As a (re)insurance group our business is in assuming risk. The problem arises where there is a mismatch between the risk we are being paid for and the 
risk we are assuming. If we are mispricing our business, we are at increased risk of having insufficient premium to cover any losses arising. If we are 
taking on more exposure than we realise, then we are at an increased risk of having much larger losses than we expect in a particular scenario. Losses  
in our classes are hard to predict, in particular as to the specifics of timing and quantum of catastrophe loss events. Additionally, we underwrite lines  
of business that are subject to accumulations, including accumulations of individual risk losses arising from a single event such as several property 
catastrophe excess of loss programmes being affected by a windstorm or earthquake, and accumulations between business lines such as a 9/11 type 
event impacting both the terrorism and AV52 portfolios. Losses can also exceed expectations in terms of both frequency and severity. We recognise 
that through climate change trends, and other influencing factors, weather-related incidences or other actual catastrophe loss events may increase 
losses in frequency, severity and clustering, so, although we model losses, using third party stochastic models, we know that these projections can  
and will be wrong in many instances.

Opportunities
As market dynamics change so too do the opportunities available to the 
Group. We remain creative and responsive in the provision of tailored 
insurance and reinsurance products and solutions to our core clients 
across the different platforms of our business. The management team 
regularly considers new business opportunities and provides updates on 
these to the Board. We continue to focus on the opportunities to support 
our clients as they transition from the current carbon intense 
environment to a lower-carbon one.

Mitigation

Modelling: We apply loads to, and stress test, stochastic models and 
develop alternative views of losses using exposure damage ratios. We 
review our assumptions periodically to ensure they remain appropriate. 
We also backtest our portfolio against historic events to assess potential 
losses. PMLs for natural catastrophe perils are updated monthly, and 
RDSs for non-elemental perils are updated quarterly. Both are provided 
to the RRC for review.

RRC: The RRC considers accumulations, clashes and parameterisation of 
losses and models. 

Governance: Board and capital management: We set our internal capital 
requirements at a level that allows for buffers above accumulations of 
extreme events and, further to recommendations, the Board approves 
risk tolerances at least annually and considers capital requirements on  
at least a quarterly basis.

Underwriting guidelines: Underwriting risk appetite is incorporated into 
underwriters’ individual underwriting authorities; compliance with these 
authority levels is part of the daily underwriting procedures. Climate 
related insurance underwriting guidelines have been introduced to guide 
underwriters during this period of transition in energy markets.

Reinsurance: We buy reinsurance to manage our exposure and protect 
our balance sheet. The structure of our programme is reviewed each year 
to ensure it remains aligned to our strategy and risk profile.

How the Board reviews this risk
Unsurprisingly, the Board views underwriting as the Group’s key risk.  
As such, the Board continues to focus on underwriting expertise and 
discipline to effectively balance the equation of risk and return through 
the cycle. The Board is actively engaged in the development and 
implementation of the Group’s underwriting strategy, including 
consideration of potential risks to the strategy such as climate-related 
physical, transition and litigation risks. The Board is also involved in the 
articulation of, and adherence to, formal underwriting risk tolerances. 
Quarterly risk data on this, including all movements in the Group’s 
principal modelled PMLs and RDSs, is both received and reviewed by  
the Board’s UURC to ensure that good risk selection and disciplined 
underwriting remain at the core of the Group’s underwriting strategy. 
The Board customarily reviews the capital requirements and adequacy  
of the business within the context of underwriting risk exposures on  
a quarterly basis. The UURC and Board also review and approve the 
structure of the Group’s outwards reinsurance programme. 

Key

Strategy

Risk trend

Impact trend

Appetite trend

1

2

3

32

Underwriting comes first

Increased

High

Acceptable

Effectively balance risk and return

Stable

Moderate

Reassess

Insurance market employer of choice

Decreased

Low

Unacceptable

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Intrinsic risk: Core – Investment

2

We need to hold sufficient assets in readiness to pay claims, but the markets and products in which we invest can suffer volatility and losses.  
As a predominantly short-tail insurer, we are able to hold the majority of assets in low-duration securities such as fixed maturities. We model  
our investment portfolios and use various stress scenarios to manage the extent and source of losses we could expect under a range of outcomes 
associated with credit, interest rate and liquidity risks. The Investment Committee adopts a strategy designed to have a low exposure to the effects  
of climate change transitional risk over the various asset classes.

How the Board reviews this risk
The Investment Committee receives and reviews investment strategies, 
guidelines and policies, risk appetite and associated risk tolerances, and 
makes recommendations to the Board in this regard. The Committee 
also monitors performance of the investment strategies within the risk 
framework and compliance with investment operating guidelines, as well 
as performance against the climate-related metrics that have been 
implemented, including carbon intensity scores and a climate value at 
risk measure. In addition, the quarterly ORSA report from the Group 
CRO includes statements regarding performance against investment risk 
tolerances. As noted within the mitigation section, the Board approved 
the recommendations arising from the biannual strategic asset allocation 
study which was performed during the year and will be implemented in 
2023, unless there are unforeseen circumstances in the market that 
change the outlook of certain asset classes.

Opportunities
The primary objectives for our investment portfolio remain capital 
preservation and liquidity. Our conservative approach limits our 
downside risk but means we are unlikely to equal the returns of  
peers taking on more investment risk.

Mitigation

Governance: Board and investment strategy: Our strategy is that 
investment income is not expected to be the principal driver of  
our returns. However, we do seek out non-correlated investment 
opportunities to add yield where appropriate and as we build our 
casualty portfolio, we will look to match casualty reserves with longer 
duration assets. Our primary focus remains on underwriting as the 
engine of profits. Investment strategy, including investment risk 
tolerances, is approved annually and monitored on a quarterly basis  
by the Investment Committee and Board. Our biannual strategic asset 
allocation study was performed during 2022, the recommendations from 
which were approved by the Board on the recommendation of the 
Investment Committee in Q3 and will be implemented during 2023.

IRRC: The IRRC forms an integral part of our risk management 
framework, meeting at least quarterly and reporting to the RRC  
and the Investment Committee via the CRO.

External advisers: Lancashire’s Board and management recognise that 
the Group’s principal expertise lies in underwriting so we use the services 
of internationally recognised investment managers who are experts in 
their fields. The Group’s principal investment managers are signatories  
to the UN Principles for Responsible Investment.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

33

RiskPrincipal risks continued

Intrinsic risk: Non-core – Reserving

2

Because we do not know the quantum of losses, if any, to be incurred at the outset of a contract, we have to make estimates of the reserves we need 
to hold to pay claims. Lancashire has a consistent reserving methodology; however, there is a risk that the reserves established based on our estimates 
are insufficient. If these reserves are inadequate and claims exceed them, this may have an impact on earnings, or indeed capital. Independent reserve 
reviews by external actuaries evaluate the overall levels of expected losses, including individual large events and benchmarking analyses, to provide 
assurance over the level of reserves booked.

Recently, there have been several loss events which, due to their ongoing nature and impact across multiple product lines, are exceptionally difficult to 
reserve for with inherently uncertain ultimate losses. In 2020 the pandemic led us to change the trend for this risk to increased, from stable. In 2021, 
we retained the elevated status due to the social inflation risk within claims. This year, with inflation across the U.S. and Europe reaching its highest 
level for many years, we have performed a detailed analysis on the impact of inflation rates to ultimate losses and reserve levels. However, there 
remains considerable uncertainty and we have therefore again shown the risk as trending upwards.

Whilst our longer tail lines, such as casualty, remain a small proportion of the overall book, these lines, due to their very nature, are more difficult  
to reserve for and will, over time, increase the inherent risk within this principal risk.

Opportunities
As an intrinsic non-core risk, i.e. one to which we are exposed as a result 
of our day-to-day business but does not offer a direct potential for 
return, there are no opportunities as such to speak of.

Whilst our focus is predominantly on short-tail lines of business, 
uncertainty still exists on the eventual ultimate losses as loss information 
can take some time to obtain. As additional information emerges, the 
Group’s actual ultimate loss may vary, perhaps materially, from those 
initially reported. This may result in reserve releases or a required 
strengthening of reserves.

Mitigation

Governance: Reserves are reviewed and approved by the Reserve 
Committee whose members include representation from finance, 
actuarial and claims; there are additional attendees from finance, 
actuarial, underwriting, legal and risk. A reserving update is presented  
to and reviewed by the Audit Committee on a quarterly basis.

External review: Insurers typically facilitate an independent review by 
external actuaries of their loss reserves. Lancashire retains the services  
of one of the leading industry experts and our appetite is defined so  
as to set reserves within a range of reasonable estimates based on  
both internal and external review. The Audit Committee receives and 
considers reports on reserve adequacy from the external actuary on a  
six monthly basis.

Short-tail business: Lancashire’s focus is predominantly on short-tail 
lines of business where losses are usually known within, or shortly after, 
the policy period with a reasonable degree of certainty. When entering 
any new line of business, Lancashire adopts a conservative reserving 
approach as it becomes established.

Experience data: We have access to significant amounts of data, both 
internal and from the industry as a whole, relating to losses and loss 
trends. Actuarial and statistical data are used to set estimates of future 
losses, and these are reviewed by underwriters, claims staff and actuaries 
to ensure that they reflect the actual experience of the business.

How the Board reviews this risk
The Board reviews this risk in detail on a quarterly basis through the 
Audit Committee, which focuses on the appropriateness of the overall 
reserve levels, informed by management’s quarterly update, the external 
actuary’s independent review of reserve adequacy performed at half-year 
and year-end and the work performed by the external auditor; and 
through the UURC, which receives quarterly updates from management 
on individual large losses. The review includes detailed analysis on major 
losses including climate-related and other natural catastrophe losses and 
pandemic losses.

34

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Intrinsic risk: Non-core – (Re)Insurance and intermediary counterparty

2

Almost all the insurance policies which we underwrite are brought to us by brokers, who act as intermediaries between us and our clients, and handle 
the transaction of payments of claims and premiums on our behalf. This exposes us to the risk of mishandling by, or failure of, the broker concerned.  
In order to make our portfolio as efficient as possible, we buy reinsurance to protect against severity, frequency and accumulation of losses. Again, this 
exposes us to the risk that our counterparties may have the inability or unwillingness to pay us in the event of a loss.

Opportunities
As both a purchaser and seller of reinsurance, opportunities exist 
throughout the insurance cycle. While rates were suppressed, the 
quantum of reinsurance coverage purchased increased and therefore  
so did counterparty exposure. This is mitigated through established 
governance processes to manage the aggregate exposure and credit 
control processes to help ensure monies due are received. As always, it  
is the case of balancing the risk we are taking with the expected return; 
reinsurance purchasing is one way of balancing this. As market conditions 
change, we may choose to retain more risk or may be unable to purchase 
the same level of reinsurance as in previous years, resulting in a reduction 
in counterparty exposure.

Mitigation

Counterparty credit limits: The Broker Vetting Committee is 
responsible for the broker vetting approval process and monitoring  
credit risk in relation to brokers. In addition, the Group conducts broker 
business using non-risk transfer TOBAs. This mitigates the risk due to 
non-payment by brokers and intermediaries as monies are held in 
separated client money accounts. 

We use counterparty credit limits, seek to deal with reputable reinsurers 
that meet our minimum rating standards, and use collateral agreements 
where appropriate. The operating entities of the Group that contract for 
reinsurance separately maintain and report their own counterparty credit 
limits at the entity level. The RSC is responsible for approving 
counterparties and monitoring first loss and aggregate limits.

How the Board reviews this risk
The quarterly ORSA report to the Board includes the top five reinsurance 
counterparty exposures versus the Board-agreed tolerances. These 
tolerances are reviewed and approved on an annual basis by the Board 
and considered as part of the annual strategy review. Amounts owed to 
intermediary counterparties are included in the underwriting information 
provided to the UURC on a quarterly basis.

Intrinsic risk: Non-core – Liquidity

2

In order to satisfy claims payments, we need to ensure that sufficient assets are held in a readily realisable form. This includes holding liquid assets for 
the modelled payout of loss reserves, as well as ensuring that we can meet claims payments in relatively extreme events.

How the Board reviews this risk
Liquidity risk is reviewed by the Investment Committee which regularly 
receives and reviews reports detailing asset allocation and compliance 
with pre-defined guidelines and tolerances.

Opportunities
As previously noted, liquidity is a primary objective of our investment 
portfolio. It is important we balance the need for liquidity and being able 
to pay our clients’ claims on a timely basis with the opportunity for 
return from our investments. We do this through different investment 
portfolio categories.

Mitigation

Portfolio management: The Group maintains liquidity in excess of the 
Board-agreed tolerances. This is achieved through the maintenance of  
a highly liquid portfolio with short duration and high creditworthiness. 
We monitor this through the use of stress tests and mitigate risks 
through the quality of the investments themselves.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

35

RiskPrincipal risks continued

Intrinsic risk: Operational

2

3

These are risks arising as a result of inadequate or failed internal processes, personnel, systems or (non-insurance) external events. The Group is also 
subject to regulatory supervision and oversight, as well as legislation and tax requirements across a number of jurisdictions (see page 151 for more 
information). Operational risks have the potential either to magnify the adverse impacts of intrinsic risks or crystallise separately in their own right. 
This can encompass IT availability, where the failure of an IT system, such as our underwriting system, could impact our ability to maintain accurate 
and up-to-date records of our exposures. If correlated with an insurance loss this could cause us to breach insurance risk tolerances. It could also 
encompass IT integrity, where an unauthorised intruder could alter data in our systems, or introduce a bug that would corrupt the system. 
Furthermore, unauthorised access to IT systems as a result of a breach or failure could result in data loss, including personal data, which may have 
regulatory and/or reputational risk implications. With flexible working conditions now the norm we have invested heavily in our information security 
capabilities, monitoring and staff training to mitigate the risk associated with the change in working environment.

Although the Group holds limited personal data, it has a suite of policies 
and processes, including penetration testing procedures, around data 
protection which facilitate compliance with the GDPR, the UK Data 
Protection Act and the Bermudian equivalent of the GDPR, the PIPA.

How the Board reviews this risk
The Audit Committee receives quarterly reports from the Group CRO 
summarising the results from the quarterly risk and control affirmation 
process and detailed control testing, along with the Group CRO’s opinion 
on the overall control environment. The Audit Committee reviews this 
alongside the quarterly updates from the internal audit team regarding 
their programme of work and opinion on the effectiveness of controls. In 
addition, the quarterly ORSA report from the Group CRO to the Board 
includes details of a suite of KRIs, any risk events and near misses, 
changes to the risk register, and the drivers for such change. The Board 
reviews the culture aspect of operational risk through the Audit 
Committee, which receives an update in each internal audit report as 
well as through internal audit’s analysis of the root causes of the audit 
findings. The Board is provided with regular updates on the change 
management portfolio of work. 

Opportunities
A risk-based approach is followed to determine which areas require 
strongly controlled processes and procedures (i.e. the key risk areas)  
and those areas where a more proportionate approach is appropriate 
(those areas assessed as low risk).

Mitigation

Capacity: We mitigate IT availability risk by adding redundancy to the 
capacity we need and using backups of data, including off-site storage 
that we test regularly. Additionally, the Group has both disaster recovery 
and BCPs in place that are tested annually and which are designed, in 
particular, to help minimise the risk posed by Bermuda hurricane events 
or disruptive political or terrorism events in London. The business follows 
strict tax and regulatory operating guidelines, which are periodically 
reviewed and approved by the Board. 

Testing and access: We mitigate the integrity risk by using independent 
external penetration tests, and by restricting access to key systems to 
only those people who are qualified and need to use them. We also have 
a Cyber Incident Response Plan to guide management should a third 
party be discovered to have gained access to our systems. This plan is 
tested on an annual basis in the form of a table-top exercise facilitated 
by a third party specialist.

Personnel: We mitigate the risks associated with staff recruitment and 
retention and key-man risk through a combination of resource planning 
processes and controls. Examples include targeted retention packages, 
documented position descriptions and employment contracts, resource 
monitoring and the provision of appropriate compensation and training 
schemes. In addition, the Group has core values, to which all employees 
subscribe and which reflect the strong and positive corporate culture 
described in the People and culture section starting on page 51. The 
Board regularly reviews succession planning arrangements and 
remuneration structures.

36

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Intrinsic risk: Other

1

2

3

These are risks for which quantitative assessment is difficult but for which a structured approach is still required to ensure that their potential impact  
is considered and mitigated insofar as practicable. They include categories such as strategic, group, regulatory, emerging and climate change risks.

Whilst we view climate change as a factor relevant principally to our underwriting and investment risks (see previous), the Board and business continue 
to monitor the effects of climate change risk and its perception as a driver of global economic, political, legal and regulatory change. For more detail 
on this and our governance, strategy, risk management and metrics and targets associated with climate change risks please see the TCFD report 
starting on page 61.

Of the other risks, the success of the Group is most dependent on its strategy and the successful execution thereof. Strategic risk is not limited to  
but can be increased by any or all of the following: inappropriate strategic objectives, not adapting to market conditions, poor decision making, poor 
communication of the strategy and/or the business plan in place to deliver it, and inappropriate or insufficient personnel.

Opportunities
Having a clear vision, and a strategy that is well communicated internally 
allows the whole Group to understand their role and contribution to  
the whole.

Mitigation

Review and challenge: The risk of inappropriate strategic objectives and 
not adapting the strategy / business plan for the market conditions are 
mitigated by the governance over the Group’s strategic planning process 
and the annual review and challenge by the Group Executive and Board 
of the strategy document. 

Communication: Following the Board’s approval of the strategy, events 
were held in London and Bermuda to communicate the strategy to the 
wider management team, who then communicated it to their teams 
prior to town hall events where there was the opportunity to ask 
questions of executive management.

Performance and appraisal process: There is the risk that poor 
performance by senior management has a detrimental impact on  
the Group’s performance. This is mitigated by the performance and 
appraisal process run by the HR department, and the monitoring of 
senior management’s performance by the CEO, overseen by the 
Remuneration Committee of the Board. The performance and  
appraisal process is also a mitigant against inappropriate conduct  
by, or inadequate skills of, personnel.

Succession planning: Being aware of the strength in depth, or lack of, 
and documenting within a succession plan that is regularly reviewed, 
mitigates the risk of both inappropriate and insufficient personnel.

How the Board reviews this risk
An annual strategy day is held with the Board and members of the Group 
Executive, following which management prepares the strategy for review 
and challenge by both the Group Executive and the Board. The Board 
then receives quarterly updates on the Group’s performance against  
plan in its execution of the strategy.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

37

RiskOur

commitment

to sustainability

At Lancashire, we’re committed to 
evolving as a business on matters  
of sustainability and governance.

38

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Our ESG approach is relatively simple.  
We actively review and consider the wide 
range of developing requirements and focus 
on those areas where we can make a tangible 
impact in the short-term. We also consider the 
longer-term impact of factors, such as climate 
change, on our business and our clients.

Peter Clarke 
Non-Executive Chair of the Board

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

39

Sustainability and governance

Chair’s introduction

Embedding
a sustainable 
    approach

In last year’s Annual Report and Accounts we presented our Group ESG 
strategy which had the full backing of the Board for implementation by 
the business.

The strategy was reviewed again in November 2022 and the Board  
was pleased with the progress we had made against our core priorities 
focussing on the Lancashire Foundation, people and culture, sustainable 
insurance, operating responsibly and responsible investment. 

Additionally, we have also included a new pillar within our Group 
strategy which includes as an objective further developing the Group’s 
ESG principles to ensure we continue to operate responsibly. Aligned  
to this is also fostering an entrepreneurial collaborative culture via the 
Lancashire values.

Issues of sustainability and governance, and good corporate citizenship, 
are now at the forefront of business thinking globally. There are few 
sectors where the impact of a company’s activities is not considered. 

Our ESG approach is relatively simple. We actively review and consider 
the wide range of developing ESG requirements and focus on those areas 
– such as our people and the Lancashire Foundation – where we can 
make a tangible impact in the short-term. We also consider the 
longer-term impact of ESG factors, such as climate change, on our 
business and our clients.

Our efforts are led by the senior management team who receive regular 
reports from the Group’s ESG Committee. In turn the Board monitors 
and implements the overarching governance arrangements for the 
Group and receives, as part of its quarterly meetings, reports on all key 
strategic and ESG developments and business activity, and discusses 
material issues.

40

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chair of the Board

All members of the ESG Committee have operational roles, which 
ensures our thinking is embedded deep within the business, which means 
we receive strong buy-in at the outset. Initiatives are truly driven by the 
business with a realistic lens on how the Company operates. 

Much of the focus on ESG is rightly on environmental matters. We have 
long taken account of the potential impact of climate change on our 
business. The Board has set clear PML tolerances which identify the 
amount of our balance sheet we are willing to expose to climate risk. 
Additionally, we are also a valued partner to our clients, who are taking 
their own actions as part of the global energy transition. We will 
continue to work with them and our industry peers through our 
membership of the ClimateWise organisation. 

The global energy transition is part of an ongoing debate. As we have 
seen during 2022, fossil fuel based forms of energy remain a key 
component of global energy security while alternative lower carbon 
energy infrastructure is in a state of further development. While we do 
not have all the answers, we understand the importance of the global 
energy transition away from carbon based energy. We welcome the 
opportunity to work with our clients, and aim to be a constructive 
participant in these important discussions and the process of transition. 

While we are in no doubt that the expectations on businesses in all 
sectors have grown, and will continue to grow, the Board remains 
committed to transparency in our reporting.

We continue to report against the United Nations’ Environment 
Programme Finance Initiative’s Principles for Sustainable Insurance and 
the recommendations of the TCFD, which are also aligned with the 
principles set out in the 2015 Paris Agreement. The Group’s UNEP FI 

Principles for Sustainable Insurance’s report can be found on our website. 
As in previous years, our progress in the area of climate change 
management of risk and opportunity is outlined in our TCFD Report 
starting on page 61.

As the business has grown, ensuring that the Board continues to engage 
with employees is crucial.

While Alex Maloney and Natalie Kershaw, as Executive Directors, lead 
that day-to-day engagement, our Non-Executive Directors also welcome 
the opportunity to meet employees and gain valuable insights. These 
opportunities are both formal and informal and include representation at 
the quarterly Town Hall events which are led by Alex Maloney. The 
Board also receives quarterly updates from the business on employee-
related topics. We were pleased to approve a targeted cost-of-living 
payment and a tiered approach to salary increases to benefit those  
most impacted by inflationary pressures, alongside a number of changes 
to policies focused on work/life balance at our meetings in 2022. 

The Board’s various committees also received presentations from  
around the Group on a range of matters including specific underwriting 
opportunities within product classes, ongoing business transformation 
projects, and the feedback from employee surveys. 

During the year, there have been a number of changes within the Board.

Samantha Hoe-Richardson completed nine years of service in early 2022 
and accordingly did not stand for re-election at our 2022 AGM. On 
behalf of the Board, I would like to wish Sam the very best with her 
future endeavours and to thank her for her service. Sally Williams 
succeeded Sam as Chair of the Audit Committee.

Irene McDermott Brown was appointed Chair of the Remuneration 
Committee in April, succeeding Simon Fraser. She has since initiated a 
review of our Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors and consulted 
with Lancashire’s shareholders. Please see the Remuneration Committee 
report starting on page 94 for more information.

Additionally, Simon Fraser stepped down from the role of Senior 
Independent Director which he has held since April 2014. Simon has 
recently completed nine years of service as a Non-Executive Director  
and will not stand for re-election at the AGM in 2023. We were pleased 
that, following a selection process, Robert Lusardi was appointed Senior 
Independent Director in November. Robert has been an independent 
Non-Executive Director since July 2016. He is the Chair of the 
Investment Committee and is also a member of both the Audit  
and Remuneration Committees.

The Board offers its grateful thanks to Simon for his long tenure and also 
wishes him the best for the future.

In July we were delighted to welcome Jack Gressier as a Non-Executive 
Director. Jack has over thirty years’ experience in the insurance industry 
and will bring additional expertise to the Board. 

During the year, the Nomination, Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee reviewed the composition of the Board to 
ensure that it had the correct balance of skills, knowledge, independence, 
experience and diversity to be appropriate for the Group to meet its 
strategic objectives. 

The Board is committed to meeting the Parker Review target for 
minority ethnic representation by December 2024. We are actively 
progressing recruitment in order to meet this target.

As a premium-listed company on the LSE, Lancashire measures its 
corporate governance compliance against the requirements of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code published by the UK FRC. This requires each 
company with a premium listing to disclose how it has complied with 
Code provisions or, if the Code provisions have not been complied with, 
provide an explanation for the non-compliance. The Board’s Nomination, 
Corporate Governance and Sustainability Committee monitors the 
Group’s code compliance quarterly and more information can be found 
in the report starting on page 86. In addition, the Company also 
monitors compliance with applicable corporate governance requirements 
under Bermuda law and regulations. The Company is subject to group 
supervision by the BMA, which also regulates LICL, the Group’s 
Bermuda-incorporated (re)insurance entity. The Group’s UK insurance 
entities are regulated by the PRA and the FCA, and Lloyd’s in the case  
of LSL and Syndicates 2010 and 3010.

The Board has continued to focus on proactive and constructive 
stakeholder engagement aligned to the Section 172 responsibilities of 
boards under the UK Companies Act 2006. While not formally subject  
to Section 172 as a matter of law, due to the Company’s incorporation  
in Bermuda, we believe that, as a responsible business, complying with 
those responsibilities is a matter of importance and that they provide 
practical working tools by which we can monitor our engagement. The 
Board’s statement regarding matters covered by Section 172 can be 
found on page 44 which outlines examples of how the Board and the 
business have factored in the needs of our stakeholders in their 
discussions and decision making. 

I am pleased to say that, in the judgement of the Board, the Company 
has complied with the principles and provisions as set out in the Code 
throughout the year ended 31 December 2022, and has appropriately 
considered those duties set out in Section 172. 

During the year the Board conducted a review of the Company’s 
Bye-laws. The Board is recommending certain changes to the Bye-laws, 
which are of a technical nature, for consideration and approval by 
shareholders at the 2023 AGM. Details of the proposal will be set out in 
the AGM notice and on the Company’s website.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

41

SustainabilitySustainability continued

Evolving our ESG philosophy

“ Sustainability is a core part of  
our strategy, demonstrated by the 
products we sell and in supporting 
the energy transition.”

Jelena Bjelanovic
Chair of the ESG Committee and Head of Investor Relations

Q: How does Lancashire think about sustainability? 
A: Since its inception, Lancashire has operated as a responsible 
business. Our ESG strategy is to continue to build and embed a 
culture of sustainability further within the business. We do this in a 
number of ways. In our own operations, we have been measuring and 
offsetting our carbon footprint for a number of years. In 2021, we 
introduced a target to reduce this footprint by 15% per FTE by 2030, 
through a number of initiatives, like minimising the use of single use 
plastics and reducing paper wastage through on-demand printing, to 
name just two. I’m pleased to say we are progressing well on that 
target. In 2022, we also surveyed our employees so we can better 
understand the emissions impact of their commute to the office.

Q: How are you embedding a culture of sustainability at 
Lancashire?
A: Within our underwriting operations, we continue to monitor and 
report on compliance with our ESG insurance underwriting guidelines 
to the Board and have completed a pilot project to monitor the 
carbon footprint of parts of our underwriting portfolio. This is in 
addition to the regular and active engagement our underwriters have 
with their clients on ESG matters, which we are also in the process of 
documenting. Likewise, our investment team continues to apply and 
report on our ESG investment guidelines, as well as evaluating 

different measures for our financed emissions. We had already 
introduced a Climate VaR risk appetite statement in 2021 and are 
evaluating potential sustainability fund investments that may be 
appropriate for our overall strategic asset allocation. 

Q: How are employees helping with these efforts?
A: It goes without saying that people are the biggest asset we have 
at Lancashire. To that end, we have recently reinvigorated our DE&I 
working group and launched an employee network, to provide 
further support to all colleagues through additional educational, 
mentoring and networking opportunities. In our communities we  
are all extremely proud of the work of the Lancashire Foundation.

Q: What role does the ESG Committee play?
A: All of these activities are overseen by the ESG Committee, which 
is fully integrated into the business and reports to the Group 
Executive Committee and the Board on a quarterly basis. Particularly 
in the second half of 2022, the Committee spent time developing 
additional metrics and targets, which will form part of our quarterly 
Board reporting for 2023. Most importantly for me, sustainability is a 
core part of our strategy, demonstrated by the products we sell and 
in actively supporting the energy transition.

42

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

S
u
s
t
a
n
a
b

i

i
l
i
t
y

ESG strategy and progress

The Board challenges the business on matters of sustainability, people 
and governance and works collaboratively with the management team. 

During 2022, the Board reviewed and approved the Group’s ESG 
strategy and priorities. Progress against these is noted below.

1.People and culture
Giving our people the environment, tools,  
skills and support they need to thrive in an  
open, honest and diverse culture.

Progress
•  High level of diversity maintained (Senior 

management positions 53% male/47% female; 
Group executive 57% male/43% female).

•  Accredited living wage employer, for our business 

and our supply chain.

•  Hiring practices seek to remove bias through 

anonymisation of CVs and gender neutral language 
for role adverts.

•  Training on diversity matters included in employee 
induction programme and unconscious bias training 
across the Group.

4. Operating responsibly
Running our business as a good corporate citizen,  
a responsible preserver of resources, and holding  
our supply chain to the high standards we apply  
to ourselves. 

Supporting wider society through our corporate and 
charitable activities including the Lancashire Foundation. 

Meet and comply with legal, regulatory and investor 
obligations on ESG.

Progress
• 

In the five years from 2015 up until the pandemic  
hit early in 2020, the Group’s emissions reduced by  
16% per FTE.

•  Fully offset calculated 2022 GHG market-based 

emissions by purchasing verified credits.

•  More than $22.3 million donated to charitable 

organisations since 2007.

•  The Group continues to operate in line with all 
 relevant regulatory and legal requirements.

2.Sustainable insurance
Ensuring our business considers climate  
change and other ESG issues in our underwriting 
decision making.

Progress
•  ESG insurance underwriting guidelines 

implemented by reference to Lloyd’s ESG 
underwriting guidelines.

•  We underwrite renewable energy covers, where 
appropriate, and continue to monitor our energy 
clients’ transition plans.

•  2022 peer benchmarking exercise. ESG 

framework reviewed annually.

•  Our CCWG articulates underwriting related risks 
and opportunities relating to physical, transition 
and liability risks and investment-related risks 
and opportunities. 

• 

Joined ClimateWise in 2022.

3.Responsible investment
Demonstrating our commitment to ESG,  
including responsibility for our environment,  
through the management of our investments.

Progress
•  93.9% of the Group’s principal investment 

managers are signatories to the UN Principles  
for Responsible Investment.

•  Our ESG investment guidelines embedded in 
external investment managers’ guidelines for 
2022.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

43

Section 172

A responsible business culture

The very foundations of our 
strategy and success as a 
business are the solid pillars of 
engagement that we have built 
with our people, our stakeholders 
and society, and the creation of  
a healthy and sustainable 
corporate culture. Since its 
foundation in 2005, the Group 
has focused on fostering 
relations with a broad  
range of stakeholders.

Our universe of stakeholders

Lancashire
Foundation

Brokers

Society 
and the 
environment

Our  
policyholders

Communities

Board 
engagement  
and decision 
making

Government  
and regulators

Our 
shareholders

Our 
people

Rating 
agencies

Service 
providers

Our people
We believe the talents of our people and our distinctive culture continue 
to set us apart from our competitors.

Our employees are the lifeblood of the organisation and the Group 
therefore strives to attract and retain excellent individuals who share  
our drive and appetite to outperform.

SEE PAGES 51 TO 55 FOR FURTHER DETAILS.

Our policyholders
We place the highest value on the relationships we have built over the 
years with our existing policyholders and work hard at creating effective 
partnerships with new ones.

Policyholders are central to our business, so understanding and serving 
their commercial requirements is at the forefront of everything we do. 
Through our range of underwriting platforms, we strive to offer clear, 
fairly priced and useful products.

SEE PAGE 57 FOR FURTHER DETAILS.

Our shareholders
Lancashire values the views of all of its shareholders and maintains open 
and transparent communication channels with them.

As a premium-listed company on the LSE, LHL understands the 
importance of its obligations to shareholders. We work hard to foster 
good investor relations and pride ourselves on having an active 
programme of engagement with our diverse shareholder community.

Lenders

Society and the environment
The Group is committed to measuring and offsetting carbon emissions 
for its own operations (see page 59) and to creating the governance 
structure, risk management and metrics for managing the effects of 
climate change on business strategy and aligning this with the global 
economy as it transitions to ‘net zero’ (see our 2022 TCFD report starting 
on page 61).

Through the Lancashire Foundation, we utilise the talent and energy  
of our staff in helping others, positively impacting society and creating  
a more sustainable environment.

Our insurance products deliver social benefits in helping businesses and 
communities manage and mitigate the risks they face. Lancashire is 
strongly committed to giving back to the communities within which it 
operates and also further afield. The business seeks to help those who 
are in distress or at a disadvantage, through continued support of local 
initiatives and activities, volunteering days, mentoring opportunities and 
fundraising events.

SEE PAGE 57 FOR FURTHER DETAILS.

SEE PAGES 47 TO 50 FOR FURTHER DETAILS.

44

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Responsible Board decision making 
The Code requires formal disclosure around the interests of and engagement with stakeholders, and the duties falling upon boards under Section 172 
of the UK Companies Act 2006. Although the Company is incorporated in Bermuda and is therefore not subject to the UK Companies Act 
requirements, the Board continues to pay close attention to developments in English law and governance best practice.

In this 2022 Annual Report and Accounts, we give an overview of how both the Board and the business have factored in the needs of our stakeholders 
in their discussions and decision making in all areas of performance review, strategy, risk and capital management. To that end, this sustainability 
segment should be considered together with the rest of this report as the Company’s comprehensive account of its Directors’ compliance with their 
Section 172 duties.

Section 172 responsibilities in focus

Operation of the  
Lancashire Foundation

Loss events during 2022 
(Hurricane Ian and the conflict in Ukraine)

Workforce reward and  
cost-of-living support

Criteria considered (See table overleaf)

Criteria considered (See table overleaf)

Criteria considered (See table overleaf)

Relevant stakeholders
Customers
Our people
Brokers
Communities

The Lancashire Foundation has been a 
UK-registered charity since September 2012.

The Board approves a funding pool  
each year which is linked to the Group’s 
financial performance in the last accounting 
year. 

The Board receives regular reports from, and 
meets with, the Foundation’s trustees.

During 2022, the Foundation focused  
on supporting causes that benefit wider 
society, including support for two homeless 
charities. The Foundation  
also continued to make donations to 
organisations nominated by employees and 
to match funds raised. 

Relevant stakeholders
Customers
Our people
Brokers
Government and regulators
Our shareholders

Lancashire expects its insurance 
and reinsurance products to respond 
to catastrophe and exceptional 
insured losses. 

The Board convened ad hoc information 
calls with management to discuss the 
impacts upon the Group’s underwriting 
portfolio and the reserving exercise in 
relation to major loss events. The Board 
formally discussed the development of 
claims and the establishment of reserves, 
the impact of international sanctions and 
measures taken to comply. The Board also 
discussed the wider impacts of these events 
across all operations, including the 
investment portfolio. Reserving for such 
events influences the Board’s discussion  
of capital requirements to deliver on  
the strategy and the business plan. 
Consideration is also given to the 
expectations of investors, regulators  
and rating agencies.

Relevant stakeholders
Our people
Communities

The Nomination, Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee and Board 
discussed the outcome of a staff survey 
focussed on staff perception and 
appreciation of reward structures and 
benefits. In light of the survey feedback, and 
in view of the inflationary and cost  
of living crisis, management introduced a 
targeted package of financial support for 
lower paid employees and extended the 
Group’s subsidised lunch scheme.

The Board discussed the importance of job 
satisfaction and reward. It noted that the 
Group has a high-performance culture 
which helps in the recruitment and retention 
of the right people for the business and 
mitigates significant business planning risk.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

45

SustainabilitySection 172 continued

Section 172(1):

Duty to promote the success of 
the company, with regard to:

For further details, see:

The likely consequences of  
any decision in the long term;

The Group’s statement of purpose – page 5

The Group’s business model – page 4

The Group’s strategic goal and three priorities: that Underwriting comes first; balancing  
risk and return through the cycle; operating as an insurance market employer of choice –  
pages 4 and 5

Positive culture enables sustainability – page 51

The Board’s assessment of the Group’s viability and prospects as set out in the going  
concern and viability statement – page 120

The interests of the  
company’s employees;

The importance of our people, and the business’s focus on Lancashire’s values, culture, 
diversity & inclusion, training and development and workforce engagement – page 51

The need to foster the company’s 
business relationships with suppliers, 
customers and others;

Our business depends upon the strong business relationships that we build and maintain with 
our core and broader stakeholders. All Board members attend the quarterly UURC and, during 
2022, gave close consideration to business development opportunities as summarised in the 
Committee’s report – pages 92 to 93

The impact of the company’s 
operations on the community and 
the environment;

Society and the environment form part of our ‘core’ set of stakeholders. 2022 saw the further 
embedding of our ESG strategy within the business – page 43. The Board is engaged with the 
impact of the Company’s operations through its oversight of the Lancashire Foundation, the 
Group’s submission to the CDP, the annual offsetting of our own operations’ GHG emissions, 
and our commitments to report against the UNEP FI Principles for Sustainable Insurance (see 
our website for details) and address the requirements of the TCFD – page 61

The desirability of the company 
maintaining a reputation for high 
standards of business conduct; and

Through its compliance with the Code, the Company strives to operate in line with high 
standards of governance expectation and business conduct. A healthy and sustainable 
corporate culture is embedded throughout the business, which is assessed by the Board 
through various channels – page 88

The need to act fairly  
as between members  
of the company.

The Audit Committee oversees the Group’s implementation of whistleblowing arrangements, 
and other systems and controls for the prevention of fraud, bribery and money laundering 
– page 84

The Board is committed to treating the Company’s shareholders fairly, and engaging with them 
through a broad programme of investor relations activities, meetings (including the AGM), and 
targeted consultations; be that with our substantial shareholders, the Company’s own 
employees, private individuals, or via shareholder advisory groups – see in this regard ‘Section 172 
responsibilities in focus’, as well as page 23 Capital management/actions and dividend policy – in 
particular, the Board’s consideration of the balance between underwriting opportunities and the 
payment of dividends – pages 8 and 9, page 23 and page 118

46

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Sustainability

The Lancashire Foundation 

The Lancashire Foundation is at the centre of the Group’s charitable 
activities and has made donations totalling more than $22.3 million 
since 2007.

The Foundation supports a range of causes each year and, in 2022, had  
a particular focus on organisations working to resolve societal issues such 
as homelessness, access to quality education, and assisting the elderly in 
our communities.

In February 2022, the Foundation also made donations to UNICEF  
and the Red Cross to aid their work with people in Ukraine, in addition  
to matching donations from employees.

It is important to the Foundation that our employees are involved  
in nominating charities for support through smaller donations  
alongside larger donations to longer-standing charitable partners. 

During 2022, a total of more than $0.6 million was donated to 
organisations nominated by employees – including a number of 
matched-funding donations for colleagues who have fundraised 
themselves through sponsorship of activities such as marathons, 
triathlons and other activities.

We are proud of our employees’ support for a wide range of causes. 
Many are close to them through personal experience and others  
are organisations they put forward for funding from the Lancashire 
Foundation because they believe in the good that helping those less 
fortunate can do for wider society. Donations to staff-nominated 
charities are a minimum of £2,000. These donations have an incredible 
impact, particularly for smaller charities for whom the funding can mean 
they can continue their work.

The Foundation has been a UK-registered charity since September 2012. 
It is funded by the business through a donation pool which is linked  
to the Group’s financial performance meaning all employees are  
aware that strong business performance will assist in supporting  
the wider community.

The Foundation receives 0.75% of Group profits with a minimum 
threshold of $250,000 to a maximum of $750,000. 

The Board receives regular reports from and meets with the 
Foundation’s trustees.

Just some of the 
charities nominated 
by employees for 
funding from the 
Foundation during 
2022.

Hospice UK
A senior underwriter nominated 
the charity following the death of 
a family member who themselves 
was raising funds for the 
organisation’s work offering 
hospice and palliative care.

Roots
The Foundation supported this 
charity helping the homeless in 
Bristol which is run by a friend  
of an employee.

Spinal Cure Australia
A colleague in our Australia  
office nominated this  
organisation which carries  
out vital spinal cord research.

Bermuda Education Network
The Foundation Donations 
Committee gave their backing  
to the network which aims to 
address the achievement gap 
between public and private  
school systems in Bermuda.

Mercy Ships
One of our senior marine 
underwriters nominated Mercy 
Ships to support their hospital 
vessels which take healthcare 
around the world.

Meals on Wheels
The Bermuda charity prepares and 
delivers up to 220 freshly cooked 
meals four times a week to those 
who are incapacitated or are 
unable to prepare a meal on  
their own.

Family in Trust
Two staff members put forward 
Family in Trust to help cover the 
costs of supporting children in an 
adoption home.

H-ABC Foundation UK
A colleague nominated  
the research charity after a 
neighbour’s son was diagnosed 
with the rare genetic disorder 
H-ABC.

Children’s Hospital Pyjamas
An employee requested support 
for this organisation which 
supplies pyjamas to hospitals, 
hospices and women’s refuges.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

47

SustainabilitySustainability continued

Q: Why is the Lancashire Foundation so important?
A: The Foundation has been there since the formation of 
Lancashire and employees are enormously proud of that. It is  
part of who we are as a business and the support we get from  
people within the business is phenomenal.

Charitable giving is a huge talking point now due to the increased 
focus on ESG but Lancashire was fully committed to giving back  
to the community before it was seen as something businesses 
should do.

The $22.3 million we have given over the past 16 years has made  
a huge impact and we are so pleased that we have been able to  
do that.

Q: What is the role of the Foundation’s trustees and the 
donations committee?
A: Importantly, the donations committee is made up of employees 
from across the organisation who meet quarterly to review 
submissions from staff and make recommendations for donations. 
Additionally, the trustees add an enhanced level of governance to 
approve the recommendations from that committee before 
donation payments are made.

Q: How do staff get involved in the Foundation?
A: The trustees and committee members are all employees,  
except for one external trustee. For the past couple of years we have 
asked staff to submit applications for assistance for a charity that  
is important to them. This ensures that we align our giving with 
charities that are supported by a wide range of staff, not just the 
committee members. In 2022 alone we donated $149,000 to 
charities nominated by our colleagues. The Foundation also  
provides matching donations for fundraising endeavours such  
as marathons, triathlons, and other activities by staff.

Q: What has been the focus for 2022?
A: This year we decided to focus on the ‘Social’ in ESG and we 
were pleased to be able to allocate £150,000 to this initiative. We 
also started the year with donations in support of people affected  
by the conflict in Ukraine with donations of £30,000 to both 
UNICEF and the Red Cross. We also matched staff donations  
of another £13,000.

We continued to maintain relationships with our core, long-term 
charities such as the Family Centre, International Care Ministries,  
St Giles Trust, Tomorrow’s Voices and Cancer Research UK.

Q: What is the focus going to be in 2023?
A: We plan to focus on the ‘Environmental’ in ESG and,  
while still supporting social organisations, we will look at  
more environmental charities.

We’ll continue to allocate a pot of funds for staff-nominated 
donations and also hope to do more volunteering.

“ Charitable giving is a huge 
talking point due to the 
increased focus on ESG but 
Lancashire was fully committed 
to giving back to the community 
before it was seen as something 
businesses should do.”

Jennifer Wilson 
Chair of the Lancashire Foundation Donations Committee and LICL CFO

48

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Giving back through volunteering
Giving back to our communities through volunteering has always been 
part of Lancashire’s way of making a difference to those less fortunate. 

Following the COVID-19 pandemic, when it was not possible for 
employees to give their time to volunteering, we were pleased that  
in 2022 we were able to again support a number of causes in this way.

To encourage our employees to use their skills and expertise to help 
others, all staff have the opportunity to attend at least one paid  
Charity Day per year. Employees use this time to support organisations 
across a diverse range of activities. 

In Bermuda, employees supported the Keep Bermuda Beautiful 
organisation which aims to keep the island clear of litter and to protect 
the island’s species and wildlife. They participated in a number of 
activities including maintaining the Bermuda railway trail.

In London, during 2022, we launched a partnership with onHand,  
an award-winning app that puts employees in control of how, when  
and where they spend their volunteering time. 

Using the app, people can see opportunities to help those who need  
a hand and can accepted ‘missions’ on an ongoing or one-off basis.

Activities can include food shopping for vulnerable people, befriending 
phone calls, dog walking, gardening, environmental activities, youth 
mentoring and lots more. onHand also includes enhanced DBS checks 
and certificates for volunteers. 

Focus on society: Helping the homeless
Helping the homeless in the UK and Bermuda was a focus for 
the Foundation in 2022 as part of the year’s theme of 
supporting social causes. 

In the UK, the Foundation partnered with the Friends of Essex & 
London Homeless (FOELH).

The charity was initially nominated for a small donation by an 
employee but, due to its work and impact, the Foundation 
decided to assist further, with funding totalling £40,000 over 
two years. 

FOELH was founded in 2016 and each week volunteers reach 
out to those in need at soup kitchens in the Charing Cross area 
of London and Grays in Essex. 

They also signpost people to other services that can help them 
towards a better future longer-term. 

The Foundation agreed to donate 100 rucksacks, which were 
filled with items supplied by employees in our London office to 
make the winter a little more manageable for the people the 
charity supports.

Charity co-founder Steven Stuart visited the London office to 
thank staff for their support and explain the importance of the 
organisation’s work. Steven said: “We really are lost for words 
with the Foundation believing in us through a two-year 
commitment. It is an incredible donation and will have such a 
huge impact.

“Knowing we have this large amount of guaranteed funds will 
allow us to really start making an even bigger difference to 
those in need, homeless and in poverty.”

Following the visit a number of employees volunteered with  
the charity at its London soup kitchen.

In Bermuda, the Foundation has supported HOME, which is 
working with the Bermuda government and wider local 
community to create a collaborative plan to eradicate 
homelessness on the island by 2027.

The charity says 555 people were identified as experiencing 
homelessness in Bermuda during a study in 2021, a rise of  
300 per cent since 2016.

Our Bermuda staff hosted a Christmas lunch for the 
organisation and the Foundation funded small gifts for the 
guests. Employees also donated toiletries, socks, blankets  
and many other items to be distributed by HOME. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

49

SustainabilitySustainability continued

Since 2007 the Foundation has put a  
strong focus on supporting charities with a 
focus on developing solutions to deal with 
social exclusion and particularly issues that 
affect children and young people.

During 2022, the Foundation continued to support a number of  
charities with which we have established a long-standing relationship  
over a number of years. 

These include ICM (International Care Ministries), St Giles Trust, The 
Family Centre in Bermuda, Tomorrow’s Voices, which have all received 
more than $1 million in total donations since 2007, and Cancer  
Research UK. 

$0.6m 

donated in 2022

$22.3m 

donated since 2007

Long-standing partnerships

The Family Centre in Bermuda
The Family Centre in Bermuda 
was among the very first 
recipients of donations following 
the formation of the Foundation 
in 2007.

Over the years we have continued 
to support its work providing 
support to children suffering from 
emotional, social, behavioural and 
trauma-based challenges. Its 
services are available to any 
Bermuda resident that meets the 
criteria and has the need.

St Giles Trust
The St Giles Trust aims to help 
offenders realise their potential 
and avoid re-offending and 
contribute to a safer and more 
productive society. It assists some 
of society’s more vulnerable 
people who may be struggling 
with issues such as homelessness, 
unemployment, addiction and 
discrimination.

ICM (International Care 
Ministries)
ICM works with the ultra-poor in 
the Philippines where more than 
20 million people live below the 
national poverty line. In previous 
years, employees have had the 
opportunity to travel to the 
Philippines to see the work  
of the charity themselves.

Tomorrow’s Voices
Tomorrow’s Voices is a Bermudian 
Autism early intervention centre. 
It was founded in October 2007. 
It aims to help people diagnosed 
with Autism or on the Autism 
Spectrum, starting at the age  
of two.

50

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

People and culture

Respect, reward and opportunity

Respect, reward and opportunity
During 2022, the Board approved a new strategic focus on our people 
and culture. This emphasis on ensuring Lancashire attracts and retains 
talented employees further builds on the business’s reputation in the 
market as an employer of choice. 

All the Group’s activities are shaped by our values (LANCS – see inside 
front cover) which underpin both the work we do and how we do it. 

Our strong and vibrant culture allows our people to thrive in an 
environment that values development, retention and respect. 

Engagement in a time of growth 
The business has continued to grow during 2022, both in terms of  
gross premiums written and the number of employees. 

This growth includes additional underwriters and those in corporate 
functions who support the underwriting processes and wider corporate 
infrastructure. 

During 2022, we saw our headcount increase from 306 at the end of 
2021 to 338.

Central to Lancashire’s culture is a philosophy of meritocracy and 
openness. Senior executives are available to discuss issues with 
employees on both a formal and ad hoc basis. 

The formalised communications calendar includes quarterly all staff 
‘Town Hall’ events, led by Group Chief Executive Officer, Alex Maloney. 

To ensure a firm link between the work of the Board and the wider 
business, Non-Executive Directors attend these events to discuss their 
role and recent Board discussions, and to invite questions. In addition, 
Alex Maloney regularly communicates with employees on significant 
corporate announcements and activities. 

Staff engagement channels are kept under review to ensure they remain 
appropriate and effective. A new Group-wide intranet will be launched  
in 2023 to further engage with staff and provide news and information.

Employee surveys and acting on feedback
Lancashire is committed to giving people mechanisms for feedback and 
to suggest how enhancements can be made to the employee experience. 

During 2022, a survey was carried out among our London-based staff 
focusing on wellbeing. This followed a Group-wide 2021 Engagement 
Survey and was designed to test the effectiveness of a number of 
initiatives that had been introduced following the wider survey.

A Group-wide reward and benefits survey was also carried out during 
2022 to assess employees’ views on Company benefits and their 
understanding of them. 

Participation in this survey was high at 85% with extremely positive 
feedback. A summary of the results was presented to the LHL Board,  
the Group’s subsidiary boards and Group Executive Committee team  
to assist in identifying areas of positive engagement and those which  
can be further strengthened.

Nearly three quarters of employees said they considered the range  
of workplace benefits at Lancashire to be market competitive with  
a majority saying they would remain working at Lancashire even if  
a comparable role was available elsewhere.

Following the survey the Company enhanced a number of benefits,  
with a particular focus on ‘family friendly’ employment policies. These 
included enhancements to maternity, paternity and adoption leave,  
and a new benefit of paid leave for IVF treatment and pregnancy loss.

As a business we benefit from the experience and expertise of our 
people, many of whom have spent large parts of their career with us.  
To acknowledge this contribution, we also launched a new sabbatical 
benefit for those who have served for 10 years or more. This is our way  
of thanking people for their commitment and dedication.

RSS 
All permanent employees have an enhanced interest in the performance 
and success of the Company through our RSS to ultimately become  
a shareholder in LHL. The 2022 reward and benefit survey found the  
RSS to be among the top five benefits valued most by employees.

Practical support
During 2022, the Company acknowledged the difficulties experienced by 
some employees due to the increased cost-of-living, particularly higher 
energy prices. To assist, a one-off cost of living payment was made to 
lower paid employees in London and Bermuda.

For a number of years the Company has provided free lunches on specific 
days for staff members to encourage them to interact in the office during 
breaks. This benefit was also expanded during 2022. 

We are also an accredited living wage employer, for our business and our 
supply chain. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

51

SustainabilityPeople and culture continued

Supporting our people
Lancashire’s goal is to retain  
and attract people who share our 
values and can bring their talents 
to the benefit of the Group. 

Group employee turnover in  
2022 was 11.2%.

We believe that a mix of new 
talent and supporting and 
developing those who have  
longer service is a differentiator 
relative to our competitors.

During 2022, we continued to 
promote talented employees to 
more senior positions within the 
business when the appropriate 
opportunities arose. 

A significant number of senior 
executives have held previous 
roles with the Group meaning  
we continue to harness their 
experience and expertise.

Total years of service with the Company Selection of roles held in the organisation
Alex Maloney*

LUK CUO

Hayley Johnston*

17yrs

Group CUO

Group CUO and LUK CEO

Current position: Group CEO

Claims and Reinsurance Assistant

16yrs

Specialty Lines and Re-insurance Coordinator

Assistant Underwriter & Reinsurance Coordinator

Deputy Chief Underwriting Officer & Reinsurance Coordinator

LUK CUO and Reinsurance Manager – LUK

Current position: LICL CEO & Reinsurance Manager 

Denise O’Donoghue

Corporate Finance Officer

Paul Gregory*

15yrs

15yrs

Group Head of Investments and Treasury

Current position: Group CIO

Deputy Energy Underwriter/Marketer

LUK CUO

Group CUO

Group CUO & LUK CEO

Current position: Group CUO and LCM CEO

Natalie Kershaw*

Group Financial Controller 

13yrs

Group Financial Controller & LICL CFO 

Ben Readdy

12yrs

Louise Wells*

Group Chief Accounting Officer 

Current position: Group CFO

Actuary

Head of Capital Modelling 

Deputy Chief Actuary 

Current position: Group Chief Actuary 

Group Head of Internal Audit 

11yrs

CRO 

John Cadman*

9yrs

John Spence*

8yrs

Current position: Group CRO & LICL COO

Group General Counsel 

Current position: Group General Counsel and LUK CEO 

Active Underwriter Syndicate 3010

Current position: LSL CEO

 * Member of the Group Executive Committee 

“ We benefit from the experience and expertise of our 
people, many of whom have spent large parts of their 
career with us. To acknowledge this contribution, we 
also launched a new sabbatical benefit for those who 
have served for 10 years or more.”

52

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Training and development
At Lancashire, we believe that training and professional development is  
a continuous career-long process that helps employees make the best  
of their talents and meet their ambitions. It is also good for the business  
as we benefit from the increased knowledge, skills and experience that 
development brings.

During 2022, as part of our on-going enhancements to how we assist  
our people, we launched a new training and professional study policy. 

The policy outlines the support available and includes, in some cases, 
new financial incentives for completing certain programmes. It also has  
a clear process for identifying training needs across the Group, both for 
individuals and for the additional skills we need as a business as we 
continue to grow. 

Regardless of their role, Lancashire also offers all colleagues the 
opportunity to learn new skills through our online ‘LMS - Insurance 
Assess’ e-learning platform which features a wide range of (re)insurance 
specific training courses, as well as compliance, soft skills, management 
and health and wellbeing training. 

The Group’s comprehensive training programme on regulatory and  
other matters is aligned to a clear set of policies and procedures.  
This compulsory training ensures we uphold our high standards and  
is delivered to all new permanent staff, including employees working  
part time, and those on fixed-term contracts.

Topics covered include Tax/Regulatory Operating Guidelines, Disclosure 
(including the requirements of the Market Abuse Regulation 2016), 
Inspections, Financial Crime, ERM, Cyber Security, Communications 
Etiquette/Equality, Diversity & Inclusion, GDPR and Conduct Rules. 

Other training may be held on an ad hoc, one-off or refresher basis 
according to an individual’s requirements. New employees are expected 
to complete this training during the first three months of employment.

Quarterly updates regarding completion of these compulsory training 
sessions are provided to the Board for information purposes.

Additionally, training needs and requirements for employees are 
reviewed at least annually in partnership with the employee and their 
manager as a part of the performance review process.

Diversity, Equity and Inclusion 
We understand that a successful business must have a range of talents 
available and that this comes from having a diverse workforce. 
Lancashire has a number of robust policies in place to ensure that people 
are not discriminated against either during the recruitment process or 
during their time with us. We operate a zero-tolerance approach to 
bullying and harassment. 

The gender split of our employees is 63% male to 37% female. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

53

SustainabilityPeople and culture continued

During 2022, the Group has actively strived to widen its net for 
recruitment and to seek to encourage more diverse applicants for roles. 
A recruitment day was organised for a number of underwriting roles and 
this was advertised on our corporate website and social media channels. 
It was specifically broad in its scope to attract those new to the sector 
and those returning from a career break.

The Group has for a number of years supported the work of the 
Hampton-Alexander and Davies Reviews on gender diversity. The  
FTSE Women Leaders Review, an independent, business-led framework 
supported by the Government, which sets recommendations to improve 
the representation of women on boards and in leadership positions, 
builds on these initiatives. The Group submits data annually to  
the review.

Lancashire employees were also asked to attend training on Unconscious 
Bias and the 2022 programme, aimed to ensure that all staff had the 
skills they need to support our focus on fairness and inclusion, had a  
95% participation rate.

The Chair’s statement on our diversity policy, the representation of 
women on the Board and within executive and senior management,  
and in relation to ethnic diversity, is available on our website.

The Group runs an ‘open door’ policy where employees are encouraged 
to engage with their manager or HR department concerning any matters 
of concern during their career at Lancashire. This is supported by a 
Dispute Resolution Policy in instances where issues cannot be initially 
resolved. Employees are encouraged to use this mechanism without  
fear that they will be penalised in any way. 

Employees are also invited to offer constructive ideas on how we can 
improve our operations, increase efficiency, eliminate waste, and 
improve working conditions. 

As a responsible employer, our people have the reassurance that we 
comply with all relevant requirements with respect to human rights, 
rights of freedom of association, collective bargaining, and working  
time regulations.

We believe every employee, and prospective employee, should be 
treated with dignity, respect and fairness. As an equal opportunity 
employer, we do not discriminate, or tolerate discrimination, on  
grounds of race, age, sex, sexual orientation, marital or civil partnership 
status, gender reassignment, pregnancy or maternity, disability, religion 
and/or beliefs. 

During 2022, the Group Executive Committee approved the Group’s 
Diversity, Equity and Inclusion Policy which is available on the Group 
website. 

All employees have a duty to treat colleagues, visitors, clients, 
customers, suppliers and former staff members with dignity at all times.

Employees who believe they may have been discriminated against  
are encouraged to raise the matter through our Grievance Procedure.
Likewise, any employee who believes they may have been subject to 
harassment are encouraged to raise the matter through our Anti-
Harassment and Bullying Policy. Details of all internal policies are 
available to employees on our intranet site.

All businesses carry the risk of unknowingly harbouring malpractice  
but we believe our culture of openness and accountability is key to 
preventing such issues occurring. 

Number of employees (UK, Bermuda and Australia)
Percentage of female employees
Percentage of women on the LHL Board
Percentage of women on the Group Executive Committee
Percentage of women in senior management positions
Percentage of the workforce composed of third-party contractors
Group employee turnover (annual)
Percentage of permanent employees eligible for RSS awards
Accredited London Living Wage employer

2022 
338 
37.3%
29.0%
43.0%
47.0%
10.3% 
11.2% 
100%
Yes

2021
306
37.0%
44.4%
50.0%
50.0%
7.1%
15.3%
100%
Yes

2020
255
38.8%
37.5%
50.0%
50.0%
6.9%
6.8%
100%
Yes

2019
218
38.5%
37.5%
50.0%
38.1%
8.0%
13.8%
100%
Yes

54

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Whistleblowing 
We provide a simple, transparent and secure environment for staff and 
other stakeholders to raise concerns about any potential wrongdoing 
within the company. We encourage staff to report any activity that may 
constitute a violation of laws, regulation or internal policy, and reporting 
channels are provided to staff for this purpose within a whistleblowing 
policy available on the Group intranet. 

Each Group entity has a designated whistleblowing champion, a 
Non-Executive Director, who can be contacted if employees would 
prefer to raise concerns with them.

The UK Employment Rights Act 1996 as amended by the Public Interest 
Disclosure Act 1998, and the Bermuda Employment Act 2000, govern 
the making of disclosures concerning workplace activities and are 
intended to protect employees who report malpractice from any 
detriment or unfair dismissal.

Data protection and privacy
In order to operate efficiently, the Group must collect and use 
information about its staff and data protection policies are in place  
to ensure that information, however it is collected, recorded and used,  
is handled and dealt with correctly. Overall responsibility for data 
protection and privacy sits with the Audit Committee, which receives  
a quarterly report for review.

To this end the Group fully endorses and adheres to the principles of 
data protection as set out in the relevant UK data protection legislation. 
All employees are expected to familiarise themselves and comply with 
the regulations, which are available on the Group intranet.

Wellbeing and health and safety
Particularly following the COVID-19 pandemic, the focus on  
health and wellbeing for employees, both physical and mental,  
has increased globally. 

Lancashire has a range of policies and procedures in place to ensure 
people are supported. Communications are regularly sent to employees 
to highlight the initiatives and assistance available through our 
third-party corporate healthcare providers. This included the 2022  
World Mental Health Day. 

The Group’s Employee Assistance Programme (EAP) includes immediate 
expert telephone support 24 hours a day, access to a suite of resources 
aimed at supporting home life, work life and physical and emotional 
health, and the opportunity to enrol in Self-Help Programmes. 

The Group’s occupational mental health and well-being policy aims to 
provide a positive and supportive working environment conducive to 
good mental health and to eradicate any stigma or discrimination.

The HR department is responsible for leading on mental health and 
wellbeing for the Group and the initiatives required to achieve its aims.

The Group makes it clear in its recruitment, induction and employee 
training programmes that it takes the promotion of wellbeing and good 
mental health seriously, and offers non-judgemental support for those 
suffering mental health difficulties and ill-health.

Abusive or discriminatory behaviour by a member of staff towards 
another will be seriously and confidentially investigated and will be  
dealt with in accordance with the Group’s disciplinary procedure.

The Group Staff Handbook, distributed to employees on joining and 
available on our internal intranet, is supported by individual supplements 
relevant to our UK and Bermuda operations.

As an office-based business, we are less exposed to major incidents. 
However, the Group consults with and updates staff regularly on health 
and safety issues and provides and maintains risk assessments for tasks 
carried out by employees where potential danger has been identified. 
Business Continuity, Disaster Recovery, and Fire Safety training, is 
mandatory for all staff. 

Our full Health and Safety Policy is communicated to employees on 
joining and is available on the intranet. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

55

SustainabilitySustainable insurance

Supporting the global carbon transition 

Lancashire has developed and implemented a number of internal 
insurance underwriting guidelines focused on assisting with wider global 
efforts to tackle issues of climate change and other environmental, social 
and governance factors. 

These have been articulated by reference to the Lloyd’s market guidance 
and are applicable across all underwriting platforms. These guidelines are 
also linked to the Group’s formal risk appetite statements. 

In addition to these guidelines our long-standing underwriting processes 
and controls include, where possible, peer review to identify any risks 
that are written outside predetermined criteria. Underwriters and 
Lancashire Insurance Companies and senior management also take part 
in a daily UMCC to discuss potential business. When appropriate, these 
discussions include consideration of sustainability factors as part of the 
underwriting process.

Lancashire underwriting teams are a respected risk partner for businesses 
in the energy sector.

This specialist expertise means we are valued for our assistance in 
providing solutions to clients that may assist in delivering safer 
operations and resilience. 

We regularly engage with our trading partners on ESG matters during 
the course of our business discussions and fully support their efforts as 
they transition away from carbon-based forms of energy.

While the process will take some years we believe we are well placed  
to have a positive impact.

Meeting the challenges and opportunities of ESG issues has been 
embedded within the Lancashire business for many years. 

The underwriting of complex risks, particularly those within the property 
catastrophe class, is based on a clear and pragmatic understanding of 
potential perils, their nature and mitigation factors. 

This includes measuring and assessing potential loss exposures due to 
climate factors and setting clear preferences and tolerances for events, 
such as hurricanes and other weather occurrences.

Lancashire underwriters use their expertise which is supplemented by  
a number of sophisticated models.

We believe that the insurance industry has an important role to play  
in assisting clients with their own role in the global carbon transition. 
Lancashire operates within a subscription market in which the ability  
to adapt insurance solutions to address climate-related issues is a  
shared focus.

In May 2022, Lancashire joined ClimateWise, which brings together  
the global insurance industry with a focus on driving action on climate 
change risk.

We look forward to sharing our long-standing expertise and working with 
firms across the sector as we all rise to the shared challenges we face.

The insurance sector plays a crucial role in empowering people. The risk 
management solutions we provide give people confidence that the 
potential effects of catastrophic loss events on business and community 
are mitigated. 

Since 2019, we have been committed to implementing and  
reporting against the UNEP FI Principles for Sustainable Insurance,  
a global framework for the insurance industry to address ESG risks  
and opportunities. 

These UN Principles aim to achieve a better understanding of 
environmental, social and governance risks, with a view to promoting  
the prevention and reduction of harm and enhancing opportunities  
for sustainable and effective risk protection and reporting.

Further information on Lancashire’s reporting against the UNEP  
FI Principles for Sustainable Insurance for 2022 can be found on  
our website.

“ In May 2022, Lancashire joined ClimateWise, which 
brings together the global insurance industry with a 
focus on driving action on climate change risk.”

56

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Our shareholders
Our relationship with our shareholders is led by our Group Head of 
Investor Relations, in collaboration with members of the Board and the 
wider executive team.

Lancashire has an open and transparent communication philosophy.

In November 2022, the Group held our first Investor Day in London 
which included presentations from senior underwriters on their class of 
business and market challenges and opportunities. These presentations 
were followed by a questions and answers session.

In addition, Lancashire carries out a full programme of outreach 
(including meetings, presentations and periodic consultation initiatives) 
to assist shareholders, and potential investors, in understanding our 
strategy, business model and performance.

Our corporate brokers also provide advice and guidance on investor 
priorities, the business’s performance, and perception amongst investors. 
The Board meets our corporate brokers regularly as part of these 
discussions.

Service excellence for policyholders
Our experienced teams include our claims specialists, who have specific 
and detailed knowledge of our diverse product lines.

This expertise aids us in achieving our goal of ensuring a timely and 
equitable claim resolution for our clients.

While acting in accordance with the terms and conditions of the (re)
insurance policy provided to our clients, we aim to adopt an approach to 
the claims handling process which is proactive and efficient, as well as 
transparent and flexible. This approach is specifically designed to enable 
our clients to recover from the impact of loss events as soon as 
practicable.

We have fostered strong relationships with our clients, brokers and 
outside advisors, which we work hard to develop and maintain. 

We manage and investigate any loss our clients may sustain to achieve  
a timely, straightforward and fair resolution.

Brokers
Lancashire has strong relationships with brokers distributing its products. 
This includes large international firms and smaller independent 
intermediaries. We strive to be a trusted partner and add value through 
our expert understanding of risk management and transfer. During 2022, 
a new Business Development team was formed which will further 
strengthen and enhance our relationships.

Responsible  
investment

We continue to monitor ESG and climate change factors on our 
investment portfolio. 

While metrics and the means of measuring these factors are in 
development, they remain imperfect and Lancashire is committed  
to working with its external portfolio managers to further refine  
our analysis. 

Of the Group’s externally managed investment portfolio, 93.9% of 
portfolio managers are signatories to the UN-supported ‘Principles  
for Responsible Investment’. 

Lancashire operates ESG and carbon management investment guidelines, 
implemented by the Group’s investment managers, across the Group’s 
fixed maturity investment portfolios. 

Compliance with the guidelines is monitored on a monthly basis and any 
adjustments are approved by the Investment Committee and the Board.

Lancashire monitors the ESG profile of its fixed maturity portfolio 
through the MSCI ESG rating tool. The current portfolio is designated as 
within the “average” ESG category. 

In addition, 2022 was the second year in which Lancashire measured 
climate sensitivity of corporate bonds, so far as covered by MSCI,  
within its fixed maturity portfolio through a Climate Value at Risk  
metric (Climate VaR) aligned to the Paris Accord 1.5°C goal.

We are also investigating the development of a sustainable fund  
during 2023.

Please see the Investment Committee report starting on page 90  
for further information.

MSCI Overall Rating (%)

40

30

20

10

0

AAA

AA

A

BBB

BB

B

CCC

Lancashire total

MSCI benchmark

Percentages for the MSCI Benchmark data are up-scaled to compare with the Lancashire 
securities that are covered by the MSCI.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

57

SustainabilityOperating responsibly

Understanding the role we play

A culture of responsibility
We understand that successfully operating a modern business comes 
with increased responsibility.

We embed our values across our operations including showing 
appropriate leadership and acting as a good corporate citizen and  
a responsible preserver of resources. 

The Group operates in line with all relevant regulatory and legal 
requirements, giving particular regard to the environmental, social and 
governance regulations of the BMA, PRA, FRC, FCA, Lloyd’s, UNEP-FI, 
TCFD, Mandatory Greenhouse Gas Emissions reporting / Streamlined 
Energy & Carbon Reporting (SECR), and Home Office (Modern Slavery 
Statement Registry).

Our regulators, rating agencies and lenders
The Group has an active programme of engagement with the relevant 
regulatory bodies who provide the Group with supervision and oversight.

This includes meetings, regular reporting or engaging with routine 
regulatory reviews. The Board and management monitors changes  
in regulatory and supervisory requirements closely.

Lancashire and its insurance subsidiaries are assessed for financial 
strength and creditworthiness by three major rating agencies: A.M. Best, 
S&P and Moody’s. We engage with each quarterly to discuss financial 
performance and when significant events occur such as loss events.

We write business successfully in all major global insurance markets and 
comply with reinsurance contracts under which the Group is reinsured, 
as well as our credit facilities which support underwriting obligations.

Additionally, the syndicates benefit from Lloyd’s current ratings, 
resources, brand, and network of global licences.

We help support and fund our underwriting operations, and comply  
with regulatory capital requirements, through a number of long-term 
debt and financing arrangements with lenders. 

The Group requires the flexibility to execute its strategy and react to 
economic conditions and values its strong relationships with its lenders.

Tax authorities
The Group maintains proactive relationships with relevant tax authorities 
in order to comply with all its tax obligations. This requires us to keep 
abreast of developments in tax legislation and to work with the tax 
authorities to manage our tax risk.

Collaboration with third parties 
During the course of our business operations, Lancashire utilises a 
number of third-party suppliers. These providers complement our 
in-house skills and we recognise the importance of these partnerships 
and that success comes through openness and collaboration.

We strive to receive assurance that employers within the ancillary 
services and limited supply chains used by the Group pay a living wage. 

58

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Payments to service providers are made in accordance with the 
individual payment terms agreed. The Group’s UK subsidiary, LUK, 
complies with its statutory reporting duty for payment practices and 
performance in relation to qualifying contracts on a half-yearly basis.

Lancashire has its own responsibilities to those within its limited supply 
chain. Any concerns arising over the ethical practices and human rights 
records of insureds and potential clients would be considered as part of 
the underwriting process.

Anti-slavery and human trafficking 
The Group’s Anti-Slavery and Human Trafficking Statement is available 
on our website. We consider that there is minimal risk that, within either 
the Lancashire Group or the very limited supply chains which support our 
business activities, the Lancashire Group is involved in, supportive of, or 
complicit in slavery and human trafficking.

We are proud of the conditions of employment for all our employees 
throughout the Lancashire Group. 

Environmental impact and offsetting 
The Group is committed to understanding and managing the 
environmental impact of its business and has engaged ClimatePartner  
to calculate its corporate carbon footprint (CCF), for the 2022 reporting 
year. The CCF reflects the total CO₂ emissions released by the company’s 
own business operations, within defined system boundaries and over a 
specified period of time, with the calculations based on the guidelines  
of the Greenhouse Gas Protocol Corporate Accounting and Reporting 
Standard (GHG Protocol). We continue to measure our carbon footprint 
for our own operations annually with a view to minimising its negative 
impact through mitigation strategies and by offsetting at least 100% of 
our calculated GHG emissions, in order to remain carbon neutral. 
Previously, Lancashire has calculated its emissions from 1 January until 
31 December for each calendar year. Due to the publication date of this 
report, this necessitated some estimation for the data in the latter part 
of the year, the particulars of which were detailed alongside the CCF in 
each report. In order to improve the efficacy of the data collection 
process, and to reduce our reliance on data estimations as well as 
increase our use of primary data, we have changed the reporting period 
for our CCF to an annual period measured from 1 July to 30 June. 
Accordingly, for this report we have calculated our emissions from  
1 July 2021 to 30 June 2022 and given their inclusion in this 2022  
annual report, we refer to these as our 2022 emissions. 

Historically, the Group has achieved its carbon neutral status for its own 
operations through the purchase of carbon credits, predominately in 
carbon avoidance programmes, which assist in the creation and/or 
maintenance of systems and technologies that replace the use of carbon 
intensive processes. In order to maintain our own operations’ carbon 
neutral status, despite a change to the CCF reporting period, we have 
calculated and offset our emissions from 1 July 2021 to 30 June 2022. 
The emissions from July 2021 until December 2021 were also offset last 
year, but we have offset this time period twice to ensure that our carbon 
neutral status is not interrupted. In 2021, for the first time, the Group 
offset 15% of its emissions via a carbon sequestration project, which 

“We have procured 100% renewable electricity 
for our London operations.”

aims to actively remove carbon from the atmosphere, with the 
remainder of our carbon credits procured via carbon avoidance projects. 
We have followed the same approach for 2022 and report the emissions 
data for the Group in the table on page 60. 

The Group recognises the challenges posed by climate change and 
considers its environmental impact as part of its wider risk management 
and strategic planning process (please refer to the section on principal 
risks from pages 30 to 37 for further details). The Group CRO and the 
Board oversee the Company’s annual submission to the CDP, which 
includes the information detailed in this CCF. The CDP reporting process 
is aligned with the recommendations of the TCFD and the business,  
led by the Group CRO, has further developed its understanding and 
reporting in line. Please see pages 61 to 69 for more information on  
our TCFD journey. 

As set out above, as a result of a change to our CCF methodology in line 
with our work with ClimatePartner, emissions data was calculated using 
the company’s consumption data as well as emission factors researched 
by ClimatePartner. Wherever possible, primary data was used. If no 
primary data was available, secondary data from highly credible sources 
was used. Emission factors were taken from scientifically recognised 
databases such as ‘Ecoinvent’ and DEFRA. 

Lancashire used an operational control approach, to assess its boundaries 
and identify all the activities and facilities for which it is responsible. 
Subsequently, we have reported 100% of our Scope 1 and 2 CCF, along 
with areas of our Scope 3 CCF with high levels of operational control, as 
detailed below. Calculations performed follow the ISO 14064-1:2018 
standard, giving absolute and intensity factors for the Group’s emissions. 
Where data was not available for the 2022 report, values have been 
either extrapolated by using available data or calculated using industry 
benchmarks. Lancashire does not own company vehicles; thus, business 
travel emissions fall entirely in Scope 3 and vehicle energy is not included 
in the numbers below. 

For the first time, the Group has reported emissions associated with its 
employees’ commuting and home working within its Scope 3 emissions. 
For the third year, Lancashire has also calculated its Scope 2 market-
based emissions, in line with the Greenhouse Gas Protocol’s guidance  

on dual reporting. With operations in London, Bermuda and now 
Australia, and with clients and brokers around the globe, the Lancashire 
Group has typically incurred the bulk of its carbon footprint within Scope 
3 as a result of airline travel. Historically, these emissions were calculated 
based upon all of the flights booked within the reporting period. This 
year, in order to improve the accuracy of our reporting, we have changed 
the methodology to include flights that were taken within the booking 
period. Following the easing of international COVID-related travel 
restrictions, there has been more opportunity for employees to travel 
between our offices, as well as to meet our clients and brokers during 
2022. This has resulted in a significant and expected increase in our 
business travel emissions from the 2021 level of 291.2 tCO2e to 1348.0 
tCO2e for 2022. This change, together with the recent addition of our 
employee commuting emissions, underpins the increase in our overall 
emissions this year. 

We have procured 100% renewable electricity for our London operations 
on a tariff which is backed up by associated Renewable Energy 
Guarantees of Origin (REGOs), with an appropriate residual grid factor 
applied for our operations in Bermuda and Australia. Under the 
market-based methodology, the Group’s Scope 2 emissions are therefore 
265.1 tCO2e. Lancashire did not implement any further energy efficiency 
measures in the business during 2022 due to limited control of its sites. 
However, our London office is already well optimised with 20 Fenchurch 
Street achieving a BREEAM ‘excellent’ environment performance rating, 
and representatives from the Company engaged with the building 
management’s “Green Building” meetings and the property’s energy 
saving initiatives. 

Lancashire uses tCO2e per full time employee (FTEs) as its intensity 
metric in its CCF. FTEs have increased year-on-year, with a period of 
significant recruitment continuing during 2022. The Group has also 
expanded geographically with an office now in Australia and we include 
their emissions for the reporting period in the total below, alongside 
those from our Bermuda and London offices. Given the increase in total 
emissions from 2021, emissions per FTE have also increased. The table  
on page 60 sets out the Group’s CCF for the current and prior reporting 
period, noting both the change in reporting period and the emissions 
broken down by source.

Streamlined Energy & Carbon Reporting disclosure – 1 July 2021 to 30 June 2022 

Emissions from the combustion of fuel or the operation of any facility 
including fugitive emissions from refrigerants use / tCO2e 
Emissions resulting from the purchase of electricity, heat, steam or cooling by 
the company for its own use / tCO2e 
Gross Emissions (Scope 1, 2) / tCO2e 
Energy consumption used to calculate above emissions /kWh 
Total gross emissions (Scope 1, 2, 3)/ tCO2e 
tCO2e per FTE 

Current 2022 reporting year 
(market-based) 

Previous 2021 reporting year 
(location-based) 

(UK & offshore)

UK Only

(UK & offshore)

UK Only

154.1

150.5

106.7

106.7

265.1
419.2
2,004,830

–
150.5
1,366,540

279.9
386.4
1,899,648.9

138.8
245.0
1,233,727.6

2,407.7
7.8

842.1
2.8 

Please note that in previous years the data in this table has been provided according to our location-based emissions. For 2022 onwards, our market-based emissions will be used. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

59

SustainabilityOperating responsibly continued

The Group has fully offset its calculated GHG market-based emissions 
for 1 July 2021 to 30 June 2022 with ClimatePartner, by purchasing 
verified credits in both carbon avoidance and carbon sequestration 
programmes. To ensure that all emissions generated from our own 
operations are offset within the system boundaries, a safety margin  
of 10% was applied to the total carbon footprint incurred. This margin 
compensates for uncertainties in the underlying data that naturally arise 
from the use of database values, assumptions or estimates. We have 
therefore purchased a total of 2,648.49 carbon credits, to support our 
continued carbon neutral status. 85% of the Group’s carbon credits  
have been purchased in a Solar Energy Project in Alt Ougrour, Morocco,  
a VCS carbon avoidance project. The remaining 15% of the Group’s 2022 
carbon credits have been purchased in an afforestation project in Dingxi, 
China, which is categorised as a VCS and CCBS approved carbon 
sequestration programme. These offsetting proposals were discussed  
and agreed with the Group CEO. 

The Board will continue to calculate, monitor and offset the Group’s 
emissions from its own operations, mindful of the Group’s strategic and 
business operational requirements. 

In addition, we encourage the use of public transport, walking and cycling 
by employees travelling to work to assist in reducing the number of car 
journeys. As a result of the employee commuting survey completed 
during Q4 2022, we note that the majority of our employees commute 
to their place of work via public transport. Incentives include a season 
ticket loan scheme and assistance in purchasing bicycles, with designated 
storage for employees’ bicycles at all our offices.

Types of emissions
Scope 1  
Direct emissions from company facilities 
Scope 2  
Purchased electricity for own use
Scope 3

Gross emissions (tCO2e) (market-based)
Gross emissions per FTE (tCO2e/FTE)
Carbon credits
Total net emissions after offset (tCO2e)

Activity
Heat (self-generated) 
Refrigerant leakage 

Electricity (stationary)
Business Travel (flights, hotel nights, vehicles, and rail)
Employee commuting and home office
Fuel- and energy-related activities (upstream emissions for 
electricity and heat)
Purchased good and services (office paper and water)
Waste generated in operations

1 July 2021 – 
30 June 2022 
tCO2e 
135.6
18.5

1 January 2021 – 
31 December 2022 
tCO2e 
106.7
–

265.1
1,348.0
515.8

116.0
7.0
1.7
2,407.7
7.8
2,648.5
–

259.7
291.2
–

153.5
9.7
1.3
822.1
2.8
823.0
–

Please note: all numbers quoted have been rounded to one decimal place. 
Upstream fuel- and energy-related activities include Well-to-Tank and Transmission & Distribution emissions. These are emissions associated with the upstream processes of 
extracting, refining and transporting raw fuel and the emissions associated with the electrical energy lost during transmission to our business. 

Progress against our targets
The following diagram shows the change in the Group’s emissions per FTE from the baseline year of 2015 against our current target of a further 
reduction in emissions per FTE of 15% by 2030.

16

14

12

10

8

6

4

2

0

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

2022

Gross emissions per FTE (tCO2e/FTE)

Target

60

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

TCFD

2022 TCFD Report 

Lancashire supports the aims of the TCFD, and recognises we need to play our part  
in supporting the transition to a more sustainable future. This includes supporting our 
customers and partners with their own transition journeys. The summary below and in 
detail on the following pages details our disclosures consistent with the four 
recommendations and the 11 recommended disclosures.

e
c
n
a
n
r
e
v
o
G

y
g
e
t
a
r
t
S

t
n
e
m
e
g
a
n
a
M
k
s
i
R

s
t
e
g
r
a
t
d
n
a
s
c
i
r
t
e
M

Recommendation
Describe the Board’s oversight of climate-related risks 
and opportunities

TCFD Disclosure status
Disclosed

Reference
See page 62 

Describe management’s role in assessing and managing 
climate-related risks and opportunities

Disclosed

Describe the climate-related risks and opportunities the 
organisation has identified over the short, medium, and 
long term
Describe the impact of climate-related risks and 
opportunities on the organisation’s business, strategy 
and financial planning
Describe the resilience of the organisation’s strategy, 
taking into consideration different climate-related 
scenarios, including a 2°C or lower scenario

Describe the organisation’s processes for identifying  
and assessing climate-related risks

Describe the organisation’s processes for managing 
climate-related risks

Describe how processes for identifying, assessing, and 
managing climate-related risks are integrated into the 
organisation’s overall risk management
Disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess 
climate-related risks and opportunities in line with its 
strategy and risk management processes
Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and if appropriate Scope 3 
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, and the related risks

Describe the targets used by the organisation to manage 
climate-related risks and opportunities and performance 
against targets

Disclosed

Disclosed

Partially disclosed – work continues on the 
development of a range of scenarios at the 
short, medium and long-term milestones. 
We expect to fully disclose in the next year.
Disclosed

Disclosed

Disclosed

Disclosed

Disclosed

Disclosed

See page 63 

See page 64 

See page 65 

See page 66 

See page 67 

See page 67 

See page 67 

See page 68 

See pages 60 and 69 

See page 69 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

61

Sustainability 
 
 
TCFD continued

Governance

Disclose the organisation’s governance around  
climate-related risks and opportunities.

Describe the Board’s oversight of climate-related 
risks and opportunities.

The LHL Board retains ultimate responsibility for climate-related risks 
and opportunities. It oversees the Group’s ERM activities and receives 
regular updates on material risks including ESG-related risks and 
opportunities. This is done through the Nomination, Corporate 
Governance and Sustainability Committee, the Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committee, as well as the Investment Committee. 

The Nomination, Corporate Governance and Sustainability Committee 
monitors issues of sustainability, including developments in climate 
change risk management and reporting.

The Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee and the Investment 
Committee each have responsibility for monitoring the impacts of 
climate change and transition risk, as well as the broader ESG risks,  
and to articulate appropriate appetites and tolerances for the Group.

Overall responsibility for the ESG programme sits with the Group  
CEO. The Board as a whole reviews and approves the Group’s risk 
framework and appetites, which are ordinarily addressed within the 
quarterly ORSA report.

The Board receives a quarterly ORSA report from the Group CRO.  
This covers the full range of risks and controls identified through the 
Group’s risk register and operated by the Group, including climate 
change and ESG risks and controls. Facilitated by the Group CRO,  
the Board discusses, agrees and monitors performance against a range  
of risk appetites. The Board discussions also cover consideration of 
emerging risks.

Examples of Board ESG and climate change oversight in 2022 include:

• 

Its annual review and approval of the Group’s ESG framework

•  Annual review and approval of the Group’s ESG strategy

•  Annual review and approval of the Group’s risk appetite statements, 
including the tolerances for elemental PMLs and non-elemental 
RDSs. More information on this can be found on page 138. These  
risk appetite statements include climate-related statements for  
both the asset and liability side of our business

•  Review and approval of the Group’s ESG insurance underwriting 

guidelines

•  Review and approval of the annual ORSA report

•  Review of the quarterly ORSA reporting which contains information 

on all risk categories highlighting material risk considerations 
including climate-related risk where appropriate

•  Review of the output from stress tests performed as part of both  

the annual business planning exercise and the annual ORSA reporting 
process, including climate-related scenarios.

The actual business underwritten within the Group is monitored  
against both the strategic plan and the Board-approved risk tolerances 
(including those linked to climate-related catastrophe loss events) and  
is reported to the Board quarterly within the Group CRO’s quarterly 
ORSA report. Please see page 27 for more information. In addition,  
the Group CUO and Group CRO regularly review current and emerging 
(re)insurance risks.

The Investment Committee oversees the management and performance 
of the Group’s investment portfolio including investment risk 
parameters, which include specific Board approved climate-related 
investment guidelines applied across the Group’s fixed maturity 
portfolio. In addition, the Investment Committee monitors performance 
against a Climate VaR risk appetite statement as part of the regular 
quarterly reporting process. This includes an agreed preference for the 
financial impact of the Climate VaR on the Group’s actual fixed maturity 
portfolio, covered by MSCI, to have a less detrimental impact than the 
MSCI benchmark model. The Committee also considers investment 
portfolio performance by reference to an MSCI carbon sensitivity tool 
and ESG profile tool. Please see the Investment Committee report 
starting on page 90 for more information.

62

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Describe management’s role in assessing and managing 
climate-related risks and opportunities.

The Group CEO is accountable for the development and execution of the 
Group strategy, including the management of climate-related risks and 
opportunities. The Group CUO is ultimately responsible for the business 
written by the Group, assisted by the subsidiary CUOs and active 
underwriters. Climate-related risks and opportunities as they relate to 
the business written are assessed as part of the underwriting process. 
Each underwriter has their own underwriting authority in which 
climate-related underwriting guidelines have been embedded. 
Management information is available to monitor the business written 
against these guidelines.

as well as the Investment and the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk, 
Audit and Remuneration Committees as appropriate, and ultimately to 
the Board via the Group CRO’s quarterly reporting and periodic reporting 
from the ESG Committee Chair.

The RRC evaluates and monitors the Group’s modelled underwriting  
PML and RDS risk exposures against the Group’s tolerance levels on a 
monthly basis. Lancashire underwrites predominantly short-tail business, 
with loss exposures usually crystallising within a policy period of 
12 months. As a result, with PML levels updated monthly and shared 
internally, we ensure we closely track both market pricing and coverage 
conditions and the Group’s modelled climate-related loss exposures. 
Please see page 146 for more information. 

The Group CRO is responsible for the overall management of the risk 
management framework, which includes facilitating the identification, 
assessment, evaluation and management of existing and emerging risks 
by management and the Board; ensuring these risks are given due 
consideration and are embedded within both management’s and the 
Board’s oversight and decision-making process.

The ESG Committee, established by management in 2021, is tasked with 
the oversight, co-ordination and internal management of the Group’s 
ESG strategy. The ESG Committee reports to the Board on a quarterly 
basis, as well as regular reporting to the Group Executive Committee, 
and is supported by both the Climate Change and Diversity, Equity  
& Inclusion Working Groups. Key developments are reported to the 
Nomination, Corporate Governance and Sustainability Committee  

The IRRC actively monitors the potential impacts of climate change-
related transitional risk on assets within the Group’s investment 
portfolio. The requirement to monitor, develop and implement ESG  
and TCFD principles is included within its terms of reference. Both the 
RRC and the IRRC are supported by the Climate Change Working Group.

The diagram below illustrates the Group Board, Board sub-committee 
and management committee governance structure as it pertains to ESG. 
The role and responsibilities of each of the Board’s sub-Committees is 
explained within the Governance section starting on page 76 and in each 
Committee’s Terms of Reference which can be found on the Group’s 
website. The Group CRO is a member or attendee of all the fora shown 
above and provides a link between each individual forum and the 
management RRC and Group Executive Committee.

Group ESG governance structure

LHL 
Board

Group  
Executive 
Committee

Nomination, Corp 
Governance & 
Sustainability  
Committee

Investment 
Committee

Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk 
Committee 

Remuneration 
Committee

Audit 
Committee

ESG 
Committee

Climate Change  
Working Group

DE&I  
Working Group

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

63

SustainabilityTCFD continued

Strategy

Disclose the actual and potential impacts of climate-related 
risks and opportunities on the organisation’s businesses, 
strategy, and financial planning where such information  
is material.

Describe the climate-related risks and opportunities the 
organisation has identified over the short, medium, and  
long term.

We consider the actual and potential impacts of climate-related risks 
and opportunities on Lancashire’s strategy and financial planning across 
the following timeframes: short-term being up to five years, medium-
term being five to 15 years and long-term being 15 to 30 years from now. 
Lancashire underwrites predominantly short-tail business, and so the 
principal impact of climate-related risks and opportunities is on 
short-term strategy. Such impact is mitigated by our ability to re-
evaluate the portfolio on an annual basis and therefore re-price physical 
risks and reset exposure levels to take into account new data regarding 
the frequency and severity of elemental catastrophe events. During 
2022, we have engaged more actively with our insured clients and seen 
an increase in the level of climate-related information provided as part  
of the underwriting process. We recognise that climate change does  
also impact the longer-term strategy in terms of emerging risk and 
accordingly management works with some of the leading external 
catastrophe model providers to understand the science which underlies 
and informs developments in the short- and long-term climate-related 
assumptions in their stochastic models. These developments are 
included in the Group’s management- and Board-approved annual 
five-year business strategy and the three-year forward-looking business 
plan. More information can be found in the going concern and viability 
statement on page 120 of this report.

The Board also regularly discusses cycles and trends within the  
insurance sector as well as within the natural, commercial and political 
environment to which the Group’s business is subject. We also recognise 
the potential impacts of transitional climate change risk on the Group’s 
underwriting and investment portfolios and associated strategies. Whilst 
detailed strategic planning is based on short-term horizons (over a period 
of three to five years) the Board’s strategic discussions are informed by 
consideration of potential future trends in the medium to longer term 
such as the make-up of global energy demand (which may be influenced 
by climate-related factors), the impact on travel and transportation 
(aviation, shipping, cruise ships) or the potential for political instability 
(for example over a period of five to 30 years). 

Since 2021, significant work has been undertaken to identify and 
articulate the financial impacts of climate-related risks, including 
physical, transitional, regulatory (current and emerging), technological, 
legal, market and reputational risks. As an example, for each physical risk 
identified, the loss amplification factors, time-frame and magnitude were 
considered, as were metrics by which these risks could be monitored and 
reported upon. Examples of short- to medium-term risks identified 
included increased severity of tropical cyclones and heightened storm 
surge resulting from the enhanced strength and duration of storms 
combined with sea level rise; increased intensity of extratropical 
cyclones; increased intense rainfall due to the warming atmosphere thus 
increased risk of flooding; and increased risk of wildfire due to warming 
temperatures combined with shifting precipitation patterns. A longer-
term risk being considered is the emergence of new natural catastrophe 
zones due to the shifting weather patterns. The potential financial 
impact from these risks is included within the metrics and targets section 
on page 68. In addition, the Group’s current catastrophe exposure by 
geographical zone for our peak perils are listed on page 146 along with 
details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks 
insured and by business segment.

The physical risk to our own operations is less material. As a group 
operating out of three physical locations (Bermuda, London and 
Australia) we do not have significant physical assets to be impacted  
by physical risk; with the main impact of physical risk arising from  
our underwriting portfolio in the form of losses arising from elemental 
catastrophic events. We do however have robust BCP processes in place 
across the Group. 

Examples of transitional risks that may be faced by the Group include  
the probability of a declining premium environment in the traditional  
oil and gas sector or transportation classes over time, or the risk of 
exposure to climate change-related litigation. The potential impact  
in terms of premium is thought to range from low to medium for the 
relevant subsidiary writing the business, however the financial impact  
to the Group of these risks ranges from very low to low at this time  
due to the inherent responsiveness in the Group’s nimble underwriting 
strategy. The impact would expect to be felt in both segments of the 
business i.e. insurance and reinsurance.

As a (re)insurer, the Group is in the business of accepting and mitigating 
risk; for every risk identified there is the potential for an opportunity. 
Opportunities come in the form of new products and services, as we 
work closely with existing clients to provide the insurance they need  
as they undertake their own transition; and access to new markets in  
the form of new assets and locations requiring insurance coverage.

64

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Risk radar

Lancashire’s current internal view of the 
physical and transition risks the Group  
may face from climate change include the 
potential time horizon over which they may 
be faced, potential magnitude of financial 
impact, and the geographical region (for 
physical risks).

Physical risks

Time horizon

Long: 2030+
Medium: 2025-2030
Short: now – 2025

Magnitude
High
Medium
Low

Extratropical 
Cyclone – Europe

Emergent Perils

Tropical 
Cyclone – Japan

Tropical Cyclone 
– United States.

Inland Flood 
– Europe

Wildfire 
– United States

Tra

n

sitio

n

al ris

k

Declining 
Transport 
Premium

External 
Factors

Litigation

s

Declining 
Energy 
Premium

Capital

Describe the impact of climate-related risks and 
opportunities on the organisation’s businesses, strategy,  
and financial planning.

Lancashire is exposed to the risk of heightened severity and frequency of 
weather-related losses which may be influenced by climate change. We 
manage this risk by using the stochastic models from third-party vendors 
which have a long history of quality data governance. In addition, we 
adapt these models based upon our views of climate risk, as well as  
our clients’ exposure data, to create aggregate loss scenarios. Further, 
individual risks that are likely to materially utilise the Group’s capital  
are reviewed at the daily UMCC prior to binding. The modelling data and 
the capital deployment are closely monitored by executive management. 
Likewise, the Board monitors this on a quarterly basis as part of strategic 
risk and capital management, with the testing of the models leading to 
changes in risk levels, reinsurance purchasing and structuring strategy  
as required. As part of the financial planning process, the assumptions 
within the underwriting portfolio are reviewed including the expected 
rate adequacy and losses for each class of business. Our assumptions  
are driven by a number of factors, which include climate change-related 
factors such as frequency and severity of elemental events and the 
potential for associated claims inflation. The level and availability of 
capital, as well as capital utilisation by class of business, are also key 
considerations in the financial planning process. The business mix is  
also reviewed, with new products and lines considered where rates  
prove attractive and accretive.

For 2022, we developed insurance underwriting guidelines which were 
embedded within our Underwriting Authority framework, in order to 
effectively monitor and guide underwriting in the more carbon-intensive 
industries and we continue to further develop and enhance how we track 
premium and policies according to their climate profile.

Lancashire’s exposure to physical risk in our own operations is modest. 
As a business with an office in Bermuda we recognise that this is an  
area of the world that is vulnerable to catastrophic windstorm events 
and may be affected by any future climate change trends. All Lancashire 
offices have BCP and disaster recovery plans in place. Specifically,  
the Bermuda management team and Board consider hurricane and 
tsunami risk within the Bermuda office’s BCP. Please see page 36 for 
more information.

Outside of physical risk, Lancashire has been a risk partner of businesses 
operating in the aviation, marine and energy sectors across the world for 
many years. The risk solutions which we provide help deliver the wider 
social benefits of safer operations in a properly regulated environment 
with access to capital resources to quickly repair and remediate damage 
in the event of accidents or catastrophic failure. We will continue to 
support our clients in the journey required to transition away from 
carbon-based forms of energy to a net zero state. Substantial 
investments will be required to both meet global energy demand and  
to reduce carbon emissions and we remain committed to supporting  
our clients across the energy sector as they navigate this transition.

We also recognise the potential impacts of climate-related risks and 
opportunities upon the Group’s investment portfolio, in particular  
the potential impacts of the transition away from a carbon intensive 
economy. We have tools in place to identify, measure and manage these 
risks and opportunities; our findings are reviewed and reported through 
the IRRC, the RRC and the Investment Committee to the Board.

With respect to opportunities arising from climate change, immense 
investment in infrastructure will be required as the world transitions to  
a lower-carbon economy, and such infrastructure will require insurance 
which lies within the Group’s existing classes of business and appetite. 
The demand for environmental insurance products is also expected to 
increase. A summary of the opportunities, their likelihood, timeframe 
and magnitude of impact on comprehensive income, is included on  
the following page.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

65

SustainabilityTCFD continued

Risk Description
Political Risk insurance

Natural Catastrophe  
(re)insurance

Renewables

Carbon Capture: injection of 
CO2 into depleted gas fields

Decommissioning Insurance:  
Oil & Gas assets

Environmental Insurance 
Products

Parametric (weather)  
Insurance Products for  
food & agriculture industry

Market Opportunity
There is currently a strong uptick in ESG related funding from  
our existing client base and this trend is expected to continue. 
Additional limit purchased by insureds and reinsurers at improved 
pricing levels as catastrophe risk increases; both earnings protection 
and capital protection being sought to significantly increase demand.
The share of renewables in global electricity generation jumped to  
an all time high of 29% in 2020 and this trend is fully expected to 
continue. As our clients transition from fossil fuels to renewable 
energy there will be sizeable opportunities in the market to grow  
this part of our portfolio. 
We believe that offshore carbon capture and storage (CCS ) may  
play a major role in global efforts to reduce emissions. 

The pace of the energy transition will accelerate the decommissioning 
of a large number of offshore platforms and complexes. As these assets 
reach the end of their commercial life there will be increased pressure 
to ensure that their decommissioning is done in an environmentally 
friendly way with appropriate risk management solutions. 
Environmental insurance provides coverage for loss or damages 
resulting from unexpected releases of pollutants typically excluded  
in general property and liability policies. 
Industries will look at new ways of managing weather risk where 
parametric triggers are more likely to offer a form of indemnity.

Time-frame
Short to Medium 
Term
Medium Term 

Likelihood Magnitude
High

Low

High

High

Medium Term

High

Medium

Medium to Long 
Term

Medium  Medium

Medium Term

Medium 

Low

Medium to Long 
Term

Low 

Low

Long Term 

Low / 
Medium

Low

Describe the resilience of the organisation’s strategy,  
taking into consideration different climate-related scenarios, 
including a 2°C or lower scenario.

Stress and scenario tests and reverse stress tests are performed as part  
of the business planning process and the annual ORSA reporting process. 
More information on these processes can be found on pages 27 to 29  
of this report. The capital impacts from a range of scenarios, including 
climate-related risks and opportunities, are presented to the RRC and 
Board for review and discussion.

During 2022, stress testing has been performed on the Group’s business 
plans to understand the impact should the recent high catastrophe event 
experience (2017-2022) be more indicative of the average experience 
than that currently predicted by the third party catastrophe models. In 
addition, we have transitioned to a different catastrophe model provider 
to increase the range of secondary perils we are able to model. As part  
of this transition and our annual model review, we have explicitly 
considered the impact of climate change to ensure our hazard selections 
within the model are appropriate for our understanding of the current 
environment and impact with respect to climate change. On a quarterly 
basis we also model historic climate-related loss events for our current 
portfolio to understand the current day impact of their re-occurrence. 
Such events include the Katrina, Rita and Wilma hurricanes of 2005, the 
Florida hurricanes of 2004 (Charley, Frances and Ivan), the San Francisco 
earthquake of 1906, the New Madrid earthquake of 1811 and hurricanes 
Harvey, Maria and Irma of 2017.

One of Lancashire’s key operating principles, which supports the Group’s 
strategy to produce an attractive risk-adjusted total return to 
shareholders over the long term, is to ‘balance risk and return through 
the cycle’. Climate change may influence the severity and frequency  
of losses that impact our policyholders and Lancashire’s quick response 
to such post-loss situations can therefore be seen as a competitive 
advantage. A similarly ‘responsive’ approach to the management  
of climate change transition risk helps inform asset allocation and 
investment portfolio management. As of 31 December 2022, 93.9%  
of our externally managed investment portfolio, excluding internally 
managed cash, is managed by signatories to the United Nation’s 
Principles for Responsible Investment. Analysis of our investment 
portfolio, specifically the fixed maturity portfolio, has shown it is more 
resilient to the impacts of climate change than the relevant benchmark 
which we have linked to a 1.5C future pathway scenario. As part of our 
biennial strategic asset allocation study, we recommended a target 
percentage to be invested in a sustainable fund which we are looking  
to implement in 2023.

Given the Group’s predominately short-tail nature of, and the ability  
to model the geographical and economic impacts of climate risk on,  
the insurance products it sells and its ability to price insurance premiums 
on the basis of a flexible and dynamic risk analysis, the Board and 
management consider that there is some resilience in both the Group’s 
underwriting and investment strategy and its business model to the 
challenges of increased frequency and severity of physical damage  
and the effects of transition risk, as a result of climate change risk.

66

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Risk management

Disclose how the organisation identifies, assesses,  
and manages climate-related risks.

Describe the organisation’s processes for identifying  
and assessing climate-related risks.

The impact of climate-related risks is managed within existing principal 
risks see page 30. 

As a result, climate-related risks are identified and assessed as part of the 
usual risk identification and management process which includes but is  
not limited to: discussions with risk owners and with subject matter 
experts across the Group, along with discussions at the Group’s Emerging 
Risk Working Group, CCWG, and ESG Committee. Climate-related risks 
specific to the (re)insurance portfolios are identified and assessed as part  
of the day-to-day underwriting process by individual underwriters in their 
analysis of specific risk information, and more broadly in the context of the 
wider portfolio during the daily UMCC and the fortnightly RRC meetings. 
This includes, for example, the assets to be insured, their physical location, 
weather-related perils that have impacted that location, historical 
frequency and severity, as well as expected short- and long-term changes. 
The individual entity annual underwriting strategy days and the Group 
annual catastrophe underwriting strategy day also provide a good basis  
for discussion of the climate-related risks of both current and anticipated 
future risks. Examples of such risks include transition risks arising from a 
decline in value of assets to be insured, changing energy costs and liability 
risks that could arise from climate-related litigation. Physical, transition 
and liability risks are considered by business segment and geographical 
location, and the expected impact from the risks identified is considered 
with respect to both magnitude and timescale.

Describe the organisation’s processes for managing  
climate-related risks.

We recognise the potential environmental effects of carbon emissions 
and in a global commercial and political environment which currently 
remains reliant on carbon-based forms of energy production, we will 
work with our clients through a period of global energy transition to  
help manage their operational and catastrophe-exposure risks in a 
controlled and responsible way.

Nonetheless, climate-related risks (and opportunities) are a constituent 
part of the Group’s underwriting and investment risks. As we have 
detailed in this TCFD report, such risks are managed in the same way  
as other risks: they are identified, monitored, mitigated and reported 
upon against tolerance as appropriate. For elemental perils this includes 
monitoring and reporting the PMLs related to the top perils on a monthly 
basis to the RRC and quarterly to the Board. In addition, we monitor our 
PMLs as a percentage of GPW; the chart on the following page shows 
this for our 100 year Gulf of Mexico wind net PML at 31 December.

Opportunities are monitored and taken advantage of where it makes sense 
to do so. More information can be found on pages 26 and 27.

Describe how processes for identifying, assessing,  
and managing climate-related risks are integrated  
into the organisation’s overall risk management.

As noted in the ERM section, the Group subscribes to a ‘three lines of 
defence’ model with respect to the identification, ownership, monitoring 
and mitigation of risk. The management of climate-related risk falls within 
this same framework, which is fully embedded throughout the Group and 
includes fora with climate change at the heart of their agenda such as  
the CCWG and the ESG Committee. The ESG Committee reports to the 
Group Executive Committee via the CRO and the Nomination, Corporate 
Governance and Sustainability Committee through the Chair of the ESG 
Committee. The CRO also provides an ESG update to the LHL Board in her 
Quarterly ORSA report. The RRC considers all aspects of risk for the Group 
at a management level and reports through the Group CRO to the Board. 
The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the 
Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual entity boards 
of directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk 
tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least an annual review  
and consideration by the respective boards of directors.

The Board considers the capital requirements of the business on at least 
a quarterly basis. The Group’s exposures to natural catastrophe risks are 
one of the key drivers of the capital held by the Group to support its 
underwriting activities.

The IRRC is alive to the potential impacts of climate change-related 
transitional risk on the Group’s assets within the Group’s investment 
portfolio and its work is reported to the Board-level Investment 
Committee. We continue to monitor the carbon intensity and  
transition risk of our fixed income portfolio and are working to develop 
our modelling capabilities to also monitor against MSCI Physical Risk. 
During 2022, carbon intensity limits were added to our fixed income 
managers’ guidelines. Updates on these metrics, including the exposure 
of the investment portfolio to climate-related risk, as compared to the 
MSCI Climate VaR, are provided to the Investment Committee on a 
quarterly basis.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

67

SustainabilityTCFD continued

Metrics and targets

Disclose the metrics and targets used to assess and manage 
relevant climate-related risks and opportunities where such 
information is material. 

Disclose the metrics used by the organisation to assess 
climate-related risks and opportunities in line with its 
strategy and risk management process.

Our underwriting strategy is based on a number of factors, including but 
not limited to: market conditions and opportunities, pricing adequacy 
and available capital. We define our risk appetite for underwriting risks  
as a percentage of capital we are willing to lose in a specific event, and 
we set a capital loss tolerance for, and track the Company’s modelled 
PMLs to, weather-related hurricane perils. 

PML as a % of GWP
50

On pages 64 to 66 we described the work undertaken in 2022 to identify 
and articulate the financial impacts of climate-related risks. The table 
below sets out the financial impact of physical risk. 

Our PMLs are derived using stochastic models licensed from third-party 
vendors. These models include perils such as windstorm, convective 
storm, wildfire and flood. Our actuarial team assesses the assumptions 
within the licensed model and, where appropriate, applies loadings to it. 
Model outputs are regularly challenged at both the macro and specific 
account level. Our PMLs, and the actual in-force exposure versus 
tolerance, are reviewed by the RRC on a monthly basis. The loadings 
applied to the model are reviewed by the RRC periodically to assess their 
ongoing appropriateness. Additionally, risk learning can be performed 
following a large catastrophe event to compare the actual loss versus the 
modelled loss to further assess the appropriateness of the assumptions 
and loadings within the model and establish whether further 
adjustments are required. 

40

30

20

10

0

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

2022

Impact of climate-related risk

The table below shows the impact based on our current portfolio, if exposure or experience was to change materially the financial impact could be 
more significant. However, the longer term impact to the Group should be managed by our ability to reprice contracts if needed and develop new 
products. Further detail is also included within insurance risk disclosures on pages 145 to 146, where we have noted the geographical area of risks 
insured and the Group’s exposure to certain peak zone elemental losses by geography as a percentage of tangible capital over a 100 and 250 year 
return period.

Magnitude of 
impact

Potential financial impact Group 
net PML/ % of capital

Mitigation

Timeframe

Physical: acute and chronic
Tropical Cyclone
U.S. Windstorm  
– Gulf of Mexico
U.S. Windstorm 
– Non-Gulf of Mexico
Japan Windstorm
Extratropical Cyclone
European Windstorm Medium 

Medium High

Medium High

$301.2 million / 19.5% •  Positive feedback loop in pricing models that reflect 

heightened risks from climate change

$248.0 million / 16.1%

•  Lancashire adjusts gross risk appetite wherever the risk is 

Medium Medium $144.5 million / 9.4%

viewed as inappropriately priced for the exposure

•  Outwards reinsurance is adapted to reflect the changing 

exposures 

Medium $181.2 million / 11.8%

•  Robust internal controls ensuring PMLs are monitored 

– Long

monthly by the RCC

•  Additional secondary perils now modelled
•  We continue to develop views on other perils

Our PMLs are derived using stochastic models licensed from third-party 
vendors. Our actuarial team assesses the assumptions within the 
licensed model and, where appropriate, applies loadings to it. Model 
outputs are regularly challenged at both the macro and specific account 
level. Our PMLs, and the actual in-force exposure versus tolerance are 
reviewed by the RRC on a monthly basis. The loadings applied to the 
model are reviewed by the RRC periodically to assess their ongoing 
appropriateness. Additionally, risk learning is performed following a  
large catastrophe event to compare the actual loss versus the modelled 
loss to further assess the appropriateness of the assumptions and 
loadings within the model and establish whether further adjustments  
are required. 

68

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Similarly, with respect to our investments, we continue to monitor steps 
taken in 2021 to advance the previous approach for assessing our 
portfolio’s exposure to climate-related risks looking at the carbon 
intensity and transition risk within our fixed maturity portfolio. The 
Climate Value at Risk (VaR) of our fixed maturity portfolio (as covered  
by MSCI) at the 1.5°C global warming goal is monitored and reported  
to the Board and Investment Committee on a quarterly basis. 
Management’s target preference is for the impact of climate change  
to be less detrimental on our portfolio than the relevant benchmark  
at the same level.

Our portfolio at 31 December 2022 consisted of the following:
Fixed maturity securities
Managed cash
Private investment funds
Hedge funds
Index linked securities
Total

79.8%
10.5%
4.4%
4.2%
1.1%
100.0%

As shown in the table above, we have 90.3% allocated to managed cash 
and fixed maturities. The majority of the fixed maturities consist of 
government-related securities: U.S. government treasuries, non-U.S. 
government sovereign debt, U.S. agency debt and U.S. agency mortgage-
backed securities. In addition, we have 30.5% allocated to corporate 
bonds, of which we have a small amount of exposure to climate-related 
risks. The Group itself does not hold any equities (although we have 
exposure to a small number of equities in the hedge fund portfolio).

Disclose Scope 1, Scope 2, and if appropriate Scope 3 
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, and the related risks.

The Group is committed to managing the environmental impact of its 
business. We measure our carbon footprint to minimise its negative 
impact through mitigation strategies and by offsetting 100% of our 
greenhouse gas (GHG) emissions, in order to remain carbon neutral. In 
2022, we instructed ClimatePartner as our new consultant to calculate 
and facilitate the offsetting of our carbon emissions. Please see page 60 
of this Annual Report and Accounts where we report our Scope 1, 2 and 3 
GHG emissions and the changes to the methodology of this reporting 
following ClimatePartner’s appointment. The Group also recognises the 
challenges posed by climate change and considers its impact as part of 
the risk management and strategic planning processes, as discussed 
above. The Group CRO and the Board oversee the Company’s annual 
submission to the CDP and note that the information which is requested 
as part of that reporting process is aligned with the recommendations of 
the TCFD.

With operations in London, Bermuda and Australia, as well as clients and 
brokers around the globe; the Lancashire Group has (with the exception 
of the period of the COVID-19 pandemic) incurred the bulk of its carbon 
footprint as a result of its business travel. We utilise a number of 
technologies to reduce inter-office travel, including full video and 
telephone conferencing facilities in all of our offices and our meeting 
spaces and boardrooms. During 2022, business travel has started its 
trajectory towards a more normal level as restrictions have lifted, 
in-person conferences and events have recommenced and it has been 
considered safe for our employees to travel. 

Describe the targets used by the organisation to manage 
climate-related risks and opportunities and performance 
against targets.

Last year, the Group articulated its path to meeting the UK 
Government’s net-zero target by 2050 with 2015 selected as our 
baseline year on the basis it was the first full year in our London office  
at 20 Fenchurch Street, an energy efficient building with a BREEAM 
Excellent rating. 

The following diagram shows our path to carbon net-zero in 2050, 
illustrating the intended downwards trajectory of our emissions per FTE 
and the intended increase in offsetting projects which remove carbon 
from the atmosphere.

In terms of the Group’s own emissions targets and with reference to  
the Group’s business travel emissions, we have travel policies in place  
to reduce our impact on the environment whilst balancing the needs  
of our staff and Directors. For instance, our policy is to not to ordinarily 
book a business class airline ticket, if the duration of the flight is less than 
five hours long. 

The Group also commits to continue to offset 100% of Scope 1 and 2 
emissions and 100% of the Scope 3 emissions pertaining to our 
operations which we are able to accurately calculate and exercise 
sufficient control over at this time. These include business travel, waste 
generated in operations, our employees’ commuting, and fuel and energy 
related activities not included within Scope 1 or Scope 2. As a small 
financial services company, we consider a number of the emissions 
categories to be either not applicable to our operations, or that we have 
minimal operational control over them. We are working with a specialist 
third party, and alongside others in the industry, to understand how to 
accurately calculate and track emissions within the unreported 
categories where applicable. 

The Group will continue to source and utilise 100% renewable electrical 
energy for its 20 Fenchurch Street London offices. Other targets for  
the Group’s own emissions remain under discussion but areas under 
consideration (outside of those related to business travel) include further 
reducing paper usage, reducing water waste, improving the level of 
recycling, and eliminating the use of single-use plastics. Please see page 
59 for more information.

In relation to the Group’s investments, we have a target of managing the 
impacts of our fixed maturity portfolio by reference to a Climate VaR 
appetite statement. 

For the Group’s underwriting exposure, Lancashire limits its tangible 
capital at risk by reference to a series of PML loss exposure scenarios 
(which include climate-related loss scenarios). PMLs are regularly 
monitored and reported to the Board on a quarterly basis and reflect real 
time changes in the Group’s underwriting portfolio. The Group’s stated 
tolerance is to expose not more than 25% of its tangible capital by 
reference to any one of its principal PMLs. For the reported outcomes  
of this process see page 146 which shows details of the Group’s principal 
PMLs including those related to catastrophic weather loss events linked 
to climate change risk.

Lancashire’s path to carbon net-zero in 2050

-16% CO2  
per FTE

-15%  
CO2 per FTE

s
n
o
i
s
s
i
m
e
2

O
C

2015

2020

2030

2050

Carbon emissions neutralised

Carbon emissions removed from atmosphere

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

69

Sustainability 
Our
practice

Governance

70

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

At Lancashire, we conduct our 
business in an accountable, open, 
honest and sustainable way.

Strong corporate governance is at the heart 
of our culture - the Board and management 
team are focused on creating a diverse and 
vibrant culture which is sustainable over 
the long term.

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chair of the Board

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

71

Board of directors

A focused Board

Peter Clarke
Non-Executive Chair

B

I

N

R

Date of appointment to the Board: 9 June 2014

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Peter Clarke was Group Chief Executive of Man Group plc between April 2007 and February 2013. In 1993, 
Mr Clarke joined Man Group plc, a leading global provider of alternative investment products and solutions 
as well as one of the world’s largest futures brokers. He was appointed to the board in 1997 and served in a 
variety of roles, including Head of Corporate Finance and Corporate Affairs and Group Company Secretary, 
before becoming the Group Finance Director in 2000. During this period, he was responsible for investing  
in and developing one of the leading providers of third-party capital insurance and reinsurance products. In 
November 2005, he was given the additional title of Group Deputy CEO. Mr Clarke has previously served  
as the Chair of the National Teaching Awards Trust. Mr Clarke took a first in Law at Queens’ College, 
Cambridge and is a qualified solicitor, having practised at Slaughter and May, and has experience in the 
investment banking industry, working at Morgan Grenfell and Citibank.

External appointments/Other roles:
Mr Clarke is currently a Non-Executive Director of RWC Partners Limited, RWC Holdco Limited, RWC 
Midco Limited and Lombard Odier Asset Management. 

Alex Maloney
Group Chief Executive Officer

B

U

Date of appointment to the Board: 5 November 2010

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Alex Maloney joined Lancashire in December 2005 and was appointed Group Chief Executive Officer in 
April 2014. On joining, Mr Maloney was responsible for establishing and building the energy underwriting 
team and account and, in May 2009, was appointed Group Chief Underwriting Officer. Since November 
2010, Mr Maloney has served as a member of the Board. Mr Maloney has also been closely involved in the 
development of the Group’s Lloyd’s strategy. Mr Maloney has over 30 years’ underwriting experience and 
has also worked in the New York and Bermuda markets.

Natalie Kershaw
Group Chief Financial Officer

B

I

Date of appointment to the Board: 1 March 2020

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Natalie Kershaw joined Lancashire in December 2009 as the Group Financial Controller and has also  
held the positions of Chief Financial Officer of Lancashire Insurance Company Limited and Group Chief 
Accounting Officer. She has over 20 years’ experience of the insurance/reinsurance sector with previous 
roles at Swiss Re, ALAS (Bermuda) Ltd and PwC. Ms Kershaw graduated from Jesus College, Oxford in 1996 
with a first class degree in Geography and is a Fellow of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England 
and Wales.

72

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Michael Dawson
Non-Executive Director

B

N

R

U

Simon Fraser
Non-Executive Director

B

A

R

Jack Gressier
Non-Executive Director

B

R

U

Date of appointment to the Board: 3 November 2016

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Michael Dawson has more than 40 years’ experience in the insurance industry, having started his career  
at Lloyd’s in 1979. He joined Cox Insurance in 1986 where he was the Chief Executive from 1995 to 2002.  
In 1991, Mr Dawson formed and became the underwriter of Cox’s and subsequently Chaucer’s specialist 
nuclear syndicate 1176, where he remains the active underwriter. Between 2005 and 2008, Mr Dawson was 
appointed Chief Executive of Goshawk Insurance Holdings PLC and its subsidiary Rosemont Re, a Bermuda 
reinsurer. Mr Dawson served on the Council of Lloyd’s from 1998 to 2001 and on the Lloyd’s Market Board 
from 1998 to 2002.

External appointments/Other roles:
Mr Dawson is Deputy Chair of the Management Committee of Nuclear Risk Insurers Limited. He is also a 
director of Knoll Investments Limited, Dawmouse Limited and Glengau Limited, all private family companies.

Date of appointment to the Board: 5 November 2013

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Simon Fraser was Head of Corporate Broking at Merrill Lynch and subsequently Bank of America Merrill 
Lynch until his retirement in 2011. He began his career in the City in 1986 with BZW and joined Merrill 
Lynch in 1997. He led initial public offerings, rights issues, placings, demergers and mergers and acquisitions 
transactions during his career and advised many UK companies on stock market and LSE issues. Mr Fraser 
has an MA degree in Modern History from the University of St Andrews.

External appointments/Other roles:
Mr Fraser is a Non-Executive Director of Legal and General Investment Management (Holdings) Limited 
and Non-Executive Director SEGRO plc, where he sits on the Audit and Nominations Committees as well 
as Chair of the Remuneration Committee. Mr Fraser also serves as a Non-Executive Director of LSL.

Date of appointment to the Board: 26 July 2022

Board meeting attendance: 1/1

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Jack Gressier has over thirty years’ experience in the insurance industry, including as Chief Operating Officer 
of Axis Capital Holdings Ltd. and the Chief Executive Officer of its Insurance segment. He served as an 
underwriter at Charman Underwriting Agencies from 1989 until 1998, when acquired by ACE Limited.  
At ACE, he served in a number of senior roles including as a member of the Global Markets Executive 
Underwriting Committee and was appointed Joint Active Underwriter of Syndicate 2488 and director  
of the ACE Agency Board, where he served until joining AXIS in 2002. 

External appointments/Other roles:
Currently serving as Non-Executive Chair to strategic intelligence firm, Herminius Holdings Ltd. Previous 
Non-Executive appointments include Chair of Syndicate Holdings Corp, the holding company for the 
Lloyd’s managing agency, Vibe Syndicate Management. In addition, Mr Gressier served as Non-Executive 
Chair of Limehouse Agencies Limited.

Key

Chair

B

Board of 
Directors

A

I

N

R

U

Audit  
Committee

Investment  
Committee

Nomination,  
Corporate Governance 
and Sustainability 
Committee

Remuneration 
Committee 

Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk 
Committee

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

73

GovernanceBoard of directors continued

Robert Lusardi
Senior Independent  
Non-Executive Director

B

A

I

R

Date of appointment to the Board: 8 July 2016

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
From 1980 until 1998, Robert Lusardi was an investment banker in New York, ultimately as Managing 
Director of the insurance and asset management industries. From 1998 until 2005, he was a member  
of the Executive Management Board of XL Group plc, first as Group CFO then as CEO of one of their three 
operating/reporting segments; from 2005 until 2010 he was an EVP of White Mountains (an insurance 
merchant bank) and CEO of certain subsidiaries; and from 2010 to 2015 he was CEO of PremieRe Holdings, 
a private insurance entity. He has been a director of a number of insurance-related entities including 
Symetra Financial Corporation, Primus Guaranty Ltd., OneBeacon Insurance Group Ltd., Esurance Inc., 
Delos Inc., Pentelia Ltd. and FSA International Ltd. He received BA and MA degrees in Engineering and 
Economics from Oxford University, an MBA from Harvard University and PhD from Barry University.

External appointments/Other roles:
He is also on the boards of Symetra Financial Holdings, Inc., a life insurer, and a Board member of Oxford 
University’s 501(c)3 charitable organisation.

Irene McDermott Brown
Non-Executive Director

B

N

R

Date of appointment to the Board: 28 April 2021

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Irene McDermott Brown most recently held the position of Chief Human Resources Officer at M&G plc,  
a FTSE 100 international savings and investments firm, retiring from that role on 31 December 2021. Her 
executive career has included international human resources roles at Barclays, BP, and Cable and Wireless. 
Ms McDermott Brown’s UK experience includes over 12 years at Mercury Communications, Digital 
Equipment Company and the Electricity Supply Industry. She has an MSc from the London School of 
Economics in Industrial Relations and is a Fellow of the Chartered Institute of Personnel and Development.

Sally Williams
Non-Executive Director

B

A

N

Date of appointment to the Board: 14 January 2019

Board meeting attendance: 4/4

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Sally Williams has more than 30 years’ experience in the financial services sector, with extensive risk, 
compliance and governance experience, having held senior positions with Marsh, National Australia Bank 
and Aviva. Ms Williams is a chartered accountant and spent the first 15 years of her career with PwC, where 
she was a director specialising in financial services risk management and regulatory relationships. She also 
undertook a two-year secondment from PwC to the Supervision and Surveillance Department at the Bank 
of England. Ms Williams is also a Director of Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited.

External appointments/Other roles:
Ms Williams is a Non-Executive Director of Family Assurance Friendly Society Limited (OneFamily),  
where she is chair of their Audit Committee and their With Profits Committee, and a member of the Risk, 
Nominations and Member & Customer Committees. Ms Williams is also a Non-Executive Director of Close 
Brothers Group plc and Close Brothers Limited, where she is a member of their Audit and Risk Committees. 

Ms Williams was recently appointed as a Trustee to Ovarian Cancer Action Charity.

74

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Christopher Head
Company Secretary

Skills, experience and qualifications:
Christopher Head joined Lancashire in September 2010. He was appointed Company Secretary of LHL in 
2012 and advises on issues of corporate governance and generally on legal affairs for the Group. He also 
advises on the structuring of Lancashire’s third-party capital underwriting initiatives, which have included 
the Accordion and Kinesis facilities. Prior to joining Lancashire, he was in-house Counsel with the Imagine 
Insurance Group, advising specifically on the structuring of reinsurance transactions. He transferred to Max 
at Lloyd’s in 2008 as Lloyd’s and London Counsel. Between 1998 and 2006, Mr Head was Legal Counsel at 
KWELM Management Services Limited, where he managed an intensive programme of reinsurance 
arbitration and litigation for insolvent members of the HS Weavers underwriting pool. Mr Head is a 
qualified solicitor having worked until 1998 at Barlow Lyde & Gilbert in the Reinsurance and International 
Risk Team. Mr Head has a History MA and legal qualification from Cambridge University.

Peter  
Clarke

Alex 
Maloney

Natalie 
Kershaw

Robert 
Lusardi 

Michael 
Dawson

Simon 
Fraser

Jack  
Gressier

Irene 
McDermott 
Brown

Sally 
Williams

Board skills matrix

Corporate Governance1

Strategy2

Accounting / Audit

Insurance / Reinsurance

Corporate Finance / Investment3

Actuarial / Reserving

Risk Management4

ESG5

People and Management6

Digital and Technology7

1.  Including legal, regulatory and compliance
2.  Including business development and M&A
3.  Investment Treasury, portfolio and asset-liability management
4.  Including internal control and internal audit processes
5.  Including sustainability and climate change
6.  Including Senior Management experience, HR, culture, and communications
7.  Including data management, information security and cyber

Key

Chair

B

Board of 
Directors

A

I

N

R

U

Audit  
Committee

Investment  
Committee

Nomination,  
Corporate Governance 
and Sustainability 
Committee

Remuneration 
Committee 

Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk 
Committee

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

75

GovernanceCorporate governance report

Board Committees

Board and Committee administration
The Board of Directors is responsible for the leadership, strategy and 
control and the long-term success and sustainability of Lancashire’s 
business. The Board has reserved a number of matters for its decision, 
including responsibility for setting the Group’s values and standards,  
and approval of the Group’s strategic aims and objectives. The Board  
has delegated certain matters to Committees of the Board, as described 
below. Copies of the Schedule of Board-Reserved Matters and Terms  
of Reference of the Board Committees are available on the Company’s 
website at www.lancashiregroup.com.

The Board has approved and adopted a formal division of responsibilities 
between the Chair and the Group CEO. The Chair is responsible for the 
leadership and management of the Board and for providing appropriate 
support and advice to the Group CEO. The Group CEO is responsible  
for the management of the Group’s business and for the development  
of the Group’s strategy and commercial objectives. The Group CEO  
is responsible, along with the executive team, for implementing the 
Board’s decisions.

The Board and its Committees meet on at least a quarterly basis. At the 
regular quarterly Board meetings, the Directors review all areas of the 
Group’s business, strategy and risk management and receive reports 
from management on underwriting, reserving, reinsurance, finance, 
investments, capital management, internal audit, risk, legal and 
regulatory developments, compliance, climate change risk, ESG and 
sustainability and other matters affecting the Group. Management 
provides the Board with the information necessary for it to fulfil its 
responsibilities. In addition, presentations are made by external advisers 
such as the independent actuary, the investment managers, the external 
auditors, the remuneration consultants and the corporate brokers. The 
Board Committees are authorised to seek independent professional 
advice at the Company’s expense.

The Board also meets to discuss strategic planning matters in addition  
to the customary schedule of quarterly meetings. The Board dedicated 
time to strategic opportunities and capital planning at a dedicated Board 
strategy day which was held in April 2022 in which all Directors and 
members of the management team participated.

The Chair holds regular meetings with the Non-Executive Directors, 
without the Executive Directors present, to discuss a broad range of 
matters affecting the Group. The Chair also holds regular meetings  
with the Chairs of the Group’s principal operating subsidiaries: LICL,  
LUK, LSL and LCM.

All Directors attended the scheduled quarterly proceedings of the 2022 
Board and Committees meetings. 

The Directors
Appointments to the Board are made on merit, against objective criteria, 
and with due regard to the right balance of skills, experience, knowledge, 
independence and diversity required for the Board to operate effectively 
as a whole. The Board considers all the Non-Executive Directors to be 
independent within the meaning of the Code. Michael Dawson, Simon 
Fraser, Robert Lusardi, Irene McDermott Brown and Sally Williams  
are independent, as each is independent in character and judgement  
and has no relationship or circumstance likely to affect his or her 
independence. Peter Clarke was independent upon his appointment  
as Chair on 4 May 2016.

Jack Gressier joined the Board as a Non-Executive Director with effect 
from 26 July 2022. The appointment of Jack Gressier was facilitated  
by the specialist recruitment agency Per Ardua which conducted a 
Non-Executive Director search exercise under the direction of the 
Nomination, Corporate Governance and Sustainability Committee and 
Peter Clarke as the Company Chair. Per Ardua prepared an independent 
candidate report which was considered at the Nomination, Corporate 
Governance and Sustainability Committee meeting held on 25 July 2022. 
The Board also considered the question of Jack’s independence of 
character and judgement, and considered that he should be considered 
independent on his appointment. Jack has over thirty years’ experience  
in the insurance industry, including as Chief Operating Officer of Axis 
Capital Holdings Ltd, and the Chief Executive Officer of its insurance 
segment. Jack Gressier was also appointed as a member of the 
Remuneration Committee, and Underwriting and Underwriting  
Risk Committee.

At the Board meeting held on 9 February 2023, further to a 
recommendation by the Nomination Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee, the Board affirmed its judgement that  
six of the nine members of the Board are independent Non-Executive 
Directors. However, it was noted that Simon Fraser had been first 
appointed to the Board on 5 November 2013 and had therefore recently 
completed nine years’ service as a Director. The Committee considered  
it appropriate for Simon Fraser to participate in the 2022 year end Board 
meetings in February 2023 and to continue to be treated as independent 
in character and judgement. Simon Fraser will not submit himself for 
re-election as a Non-Executive Director at the 2023 AGM. Therefore,  
in the Board’s judgement, the Board’s composition complies with the 
Code requirement that at least half the Board, excluding the Chair, 
should comprise Non-Executive Directors determined by the Board  
to be independent.

In accordance with the provisions of the Company’s Bye-laws and the 
Code, and for 2023, with the exception of Simon Fraser, all the Directors 
are subject to re-election annually at each AGM.

76

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Information and training
On appointment, the Directors receive written information regarding 
their responsibilities as Directors and information about the Group.  
An induction process is tailored for each new Director in the light of  
his or her existing skill set and knowledge of the Group and includes 
meetings with senior management and visiting the Group’s operations. 
Information and advice regarding the Company’s official listing, legal  
and regulatory obligations and on the Group’s compliance with the 
requirements of the Code is also provided on a regular basis. An analysis 
of the Group’s compliance with the Code is collated and summarised in 
quarterly reports together with a more general summary of corporate 
governance developments, which are prepared by the Group’s legal and 
compliance department for consideration by the Nomination, Corporate 
Governance and Sustainability Committee. That Committee also 
receives periodic reports from the ESG Committee Chair on its work.  
The Directors have access to the Company Secretary and the Group 
General Counsel who are responsible for advising the Board on all legal 
and governance matters. 

The Directors also have access to independent professional advice as 
required. Regular sessions are held between the Board and management 
as part of the Company’s quarterly Board meetings, during which 
in-depth presentations covering areas of the Group’s business are  
made. During these presentations the Directors have the opportunity  
to consider, challenge and help shape the Group’s commercial strategy.  
The Directors are also encouraged to seek supplementary know-how 
training suitable to their roles offered by the many external providers of 
training pertinent to governance, in particular the roles of Non-Executive 
Directors, and to consider their training needs and priorities as part of the 
year-end performance evaluation for the Board and its Committees.

Board performance – 2022 evaluation
A formal performance evaluation of the Board, its Committees and 
individual Directors is undertaken on an annual basis and the process is 
initiated by the Nomination, Corporate Governance and Sustainability 
Committee. The aim of this work is to assess the effectiveness of the 
Board and its Committees in terms of performance and risk oversight, 
strategic development, stakeholder and employee engagement, 
composition, skillset, supporting processes and management of the 
Group. The evaluation is forward-looking in terms of identifying strategic 
priorities and actions as well as considering performance, training and 
development needs for the Directors within the context of the work of 
each Committee and that of the Board. In accordance with the Code 
requirements, the 2021 evaluation was facilitated externally by 
Independent Audit, a London-based corporate advisory firm with no 
other connection to the Group. Following the 2021 Board and 
Committee evaluation process, the Board made progress during 2022  
in the areas of board succession planning, the use of “deeper dive” 
sessions in the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee and  
in the delivery of training, in particular around preparation for the 
introduction of IFRS 17. 

The 2022 evaluation was conducted internally, facilitated by the 
Company Secretary and the Chair. The evaluation for the Board and  
each of its Committees was based on a set of questionnaires which  
were prepared by the Company Secretariat and agreed with the Board 
Chair and the Chairs of each of the Committees and made available to 
participants using a web based survey platform. The Group’s principal 
operating subsidiaries, LICL, LUK, LSL and LCM also carried out a 
web-based questionnaire performance appraisal facilitated by the 
respective company secretaries. The draft reports covering the subsidiary 
boards and relevant committees including recommendations were 
discussed with the respective subsidiary chairs and have been discussed 
within the relevant subsidiary boards. Key themes from those subsidiary 
evaluations were also reported to the Lancashire Holdings Board.

The 2022 Lancashire Holdings Board and Committee evaluation process 
involved each Director as well as the Company Secretary, the Group 
CRO, Group General Counsel and other Committee members and 
members of senior management who were invited to review and 
complete the online questionnaires. Further to this process the Company 
Secretary prepared a draft evaluation report for the Board which collated 
feedback from the responses on an anonymised basis and identified a 
series of themes covering both areas of effectiveness and potential 
actions and areas for further discussion or development. The summary 
reports were discussed in draft between the Company Secretary and  
the Board Chair before being distributed to each of the Directors. The 
Chair invited feedback on key findings in the evaluation reports prior  
to their finalisation.

The performance evaluation reports were formally tabled and  
discussed at meetings of the Nomination, Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee and the Board held in February 2023, and  
each of the other Committees discussed the report pertinent to its  
own operation and performance. The reports identified a number of  
key strengths of the Board and its Committees, including; dynamics  
and chairing; skills and expertise of both Non-Executive and Executive 
Directors; effective oversight of strategy and performance; strong 
Committee reporting; effective risk management and controls; subsidiary 
governance; and company secretariat support. The Board discussions on 
the reports were led by the Chair.

In summary, in its consideration of the 2022 performance evaluation 
reports, the Board concluded that it operates effectively and has a good 
blend of insurance, financial, regulatory and other relevant expertise. All 
Non-Executive Directors are committed to the continued success of the 
Group and to making the Board and its Committees work effectively. 
Attendance at Board meetings was found to be good. The Group CEO 
and the Group CFO, the Company’s Executive Directors, were also  
found to be operating effectively.

The Board also concluded that appropriate infrastructure, processes  
and governance mechanisms are in place to support the effective 
performance of the Board and its Committees. The Board is also 
considered to manage risk effectively. Furthermore, the number  
of Directors on the Board and the balance of skills is considered  
to be appropriate.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

77

GovernanceCorporate governance report continued

Further to the Board engagement with the evaluation process and 
consideration of the reports, the Board concluded that Board and 
Committee oversight of strategy, risk tolerances and controls had 
operated effectively. The Board discussions around the wider business 
and market impacts of the conflict in Ukraine were considered to have 
been effective and to have been appropriately focused. Management’s 
presentation to the Board of a strategic vision to 2030 had generated  
a useful discussion of the longer term strategic trajectory of the Group. 
Discussion of the Group’s exposures to hurricane Ian had been 
conducted on the basis of a thorough ground up large loss analysis, 
which had been well presented by management. 

Engagement between the Board and the workforce was considered to be 
generally strong and beneficial to the operation of the business and had 
improved during 2022 as COVID-19 restrictions were relaxed. Effective 
workforce engagement will continue to be a priority for the Board. For 
further information on workforce engagement, please see Peter Clarke’s 
introduction to the Sustainability and Governance sections starting on 
page 40 and the report from the Nomination Corporate Governance  
and Sustainability Committee starting on page 86.

Other strategic priorities identified by the Board for the year ahead 
included ensuring the maintenance of a robust capital base for the Group 
capable of supporting the strategic growth plans for the business and  
to position the business as a leading provider of (re)insurance products. 
The Board plans to keep under review the Group’s capital structures.  
The Board and management are also committed to establish Lancashire 
as the insurance and reinsurance market “employer of choice” and to 
maintaining a close focus on recruitment, skills, employee retention and 
training to further strengthen and build a workforce equipped to deliver 
the Group’s strategic growth plans.

The Board identified a number of areas for training and specific themes 
for monitoring over the coming year, including the following:

•  To monitor the implementation of the IFRS 9 and IFRS 17 accounting 
standards during the course of 2023, supported by appropriate and 
targeted training; and

•  Continue to monitor expected legislative and regulatory changes in 
the area of UK financial reporting, audit and associated regulation.

The Board will continue to review its procedures, training requirements, 
effectiveness and development during 2023.

The Chair’s performance appraisal was conducted by the Senior 
Independent Director, who consulted with the Non-Executive Directors 
with input from the Executive Directors during July 2022. The discussion 
and feedback were positive regarding the Chair’s performance. The Chair 
was considered to be effective in facilitating strategic decision making, 
whilst ensuring an appropriate level of challenge and a culture of open, 
honest and constructive discussion. 

Following the year end, the Chair met with the Group CEO, and the 
Group CEO met with the Group CFO, to conduct a performance 
appraisal in respect of 2022 and to set targets for 2023. The results  
of these performance evaluations were discussed by the Chair and the 
Non-Executive Directors and are reported in the Directors’ Remuneration 
Report commencing on page 96.

Relations with shareholders
During 2022, the Group’s Head of Investor Relations, usually 
accompanied by one or more of the Group CEO, the Group CUO, the 
Group CFO, the Chair or a senior member of the underwriting team, 
made presentations to major shareholders, analysts and the investor 
community. Formal reports of these meetings were provided to the 
Board on at least a quarterly basis.

In September and October 2022, Irene McDermott Brown, the Chair  
of the Remuneration Committee, conducted a consultation with the 
Company’s significant shareholders concerning the review of the 
Remuneration Policy and its implementation in advance of the 
shareholder Remuneration Policy vote which is to be tabled as a 
resolution at the 2023 AGM. The feedback from shareholders was 
reported to the Remuneration Committee at its meeting in November 
2022 and a summary of the consultation process and outcomes can  
be found in Irene McDermott Brown’s introduction to the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report on page 96.

Conference calls with shareholders and analysts hosted by senior 
management are held quarterly following the announcement of the 
Company’s quarterly financial results or trading statements. The Group 
CEO, Group CUO and Group CFO are generally available to answer 
questions at these presentations.

Shareholders are invited to request meetings with the Chair, the Senior 
Independent Director and/or the other Non-Executive Directors by 
contacting the Group Head of Investor Relations. All of the Directors  
are expected to be available to meet in person or virtually with 
shareholders at the Company’s 2023 AGM.

The Company commissions regular independent shareholder analysis 
reports, and also receives periodic reports from the Group’s Head of 
Investor Relations on feedback from shareholders and analysts.

The Company’s bye-laws are governed by Bermuda Company Law and 
subject to approval of shareholders in a general meeting. The bye-laws 
are available on the Company website. A copy of the Company’s 
bye-laws is also available for inspection at the Company’s registered 
office. The bye-laws have been subject to review by the Group’s Legal 
and Compliance department and the Board during 2022 and the Board  
is proposing revisions which will be put as a resolution to shareholders  
at the 2023 AGM. Details of the proposed changes will be summarised  
in the AGM Notice and on the Group website.

78

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Committees
The Board has established Audit, Investment, Nomination, Corporate 
Governance and Sustainability, Remuneration, and Underwriting and 
Underwriting Risk Committees. Each of the Committees has written 
Terms of Reference, which are reviewed regularly and are available on 
the Company’s website. The Committees’ Terms of Reference were 
reviewed by the Board during 2022 and considered again as part of the 
2022 year-end performance evaluation process. The Committees’ Terms 
of Reference are considered to be in line with current best practice. The 
Committees are generally scheduled to meet quarterly, although 
additional meetings and information updates are arranged as business 
requirements dictate. Director attendance at the 2022 Board meetings  
is set out on pages 72 to 74. A report from each of the Committees, 
which covers Committee attendance, is set out from pages 80 to 95.

Enterprise risk management
The Board is responsible for setting the Group’s risk appetites, defining 
its risk tolerances, and setting and monitoring the Company’s risk 
management and internal control systems, including compliance with 
risk tolerances. During 2022, the Board carried out a robust assessment 
of the emerging and principal risks affecting the Group’s business model, 
future performance, solvency and liquidity and the operation of internal 
control systems.

Further discussion of the emerging and principal risks affecting the 
Group, as well as the procedures in place to identify and manage them, 
can be found in the ERM section of this report on pages 26 to 29 and in 
the risk disclosures section on page 144. The Group’s reporting of climate 
change risk and its management within the business can be found in the 
TCFD Report starting on page 61. 

Each of the Committees is responsible for various elements of risk (see 
the various Committee reports from pages 80 to 95 for further detail). 
The Group CRO reports directly to the Group and subsidiary boards and 
facilitates the identification, evaluation, quantification and control of 
risks at a Group and subsidiary level. The Group CRO provides regular 
reports to the Group and subsidiary boards covering, amongst other 
things, actual risk levels against tolerances, emerging risks, loss events 
and near misses, key risk indicators, and an overview of the control 
environment (driven by key control testing and control affirmations,  
and supported by internal audit findings). Areas of particular focus during 
2022 have been the risks associated with global instability arising from 
the conflict in Ukraine, rising inflation during 2022 and heightened 
volatility in international energy, bond and investment markets, the 
associated “cost-of-living” implications in particular for employees and 
also for wider society, risk exposure and capital considerations associated 
with the improving (re)insurance market opportunity and recent growth, 
climate change risk management and the implementation of the TCFD 
recommendations and developments in the area of ESG risk 
management and reporting. The Board considers that a supportive  
ERM culture, established at the Board and embedded throughout  
the business, is of key importance. The facilitating and embedding  
of ERM and helping the Group to improve its ERM practices are a  
major responsibility assigned to the Group CRO. The Group CRO’s 
remuneration is subject to annual review by the Remuneration 
Committee. The Board is satisfied that the Company’s risk management 
and internal control systems have operated effectively for the year under 
review. In this regard, please see the Audit Committee report on page 80.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

79

GovernanceCommittee reports

Audit Committee

“2022 was my first year as Committee Chair and I would  
like to thank my predecessor, Samantha Hoe-Richardson, the 
current Audit Committee members and the management team 
in facilitating an orderly and smooth transition into that role. 
In the year ahead, the Audit Committee will continue to work 
closely with the business and the Company’s external auditors 
in ensuring the Group’s readiness for reporting under the  
IFRS 17 accounting standard, with continued financial 
reporting integrity.”

Sally Williams
Chair of the Audit Committee

Committee membership
The Audit Committee comprises three independent Non-Executive 
Directors and is chaired by Sally Williams. The qualifications for each of 
the Committee members are detailed on pages 72 to 74. The Board 
considers that the three independent Non-Executive Directors all have 
recent and relevant financial experience, with competence in accounting 
and/or auditing. The Audit Committee as a whole has competence in the 
specialty insurance and reinsurance sectors. The internal and external 
auditors have the right of direct access to the Audit Committee. The 
Audit Committee’s detailed Terms of Reference are available on the 
Group’s website.

Committee members
Sally Williams (Chair)
Simon Fraser
Robert Lusardi
Samantha Hoe-Richardson

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
2/2

Sally Williams assumed the role of Committee Chair on 9 February 2022.
Samantha Hoe-Richardson stepped down as Committee Chair and as a member of the 
Board with effect from 9 February 2022 and 27 April 2022, respectively.

Principal responsibilities of the Committee
•  Financial and narrative reporting;

•  External audit oversight;

• 

• 

Internal audit oversight;

Internal controls and risk management systems; and

•  Compliance, speaking up and fraud.

Specific details of the Committee’s responsibilities and activities in these 
five principal areas during the year are set out in the table on the 
following pages. 

During 2022, the Committee focused on the adequacy of the  
Group’s loss reserves, with particular regard to the business’s  
thorough assessment of its exposures arising from the conflict in  
Ukraine, as well as hurricane Ian that occurred during the year; the 
effectiveness of the business’s control environment; the continued 
integrity of external financial reporting; the oversight of corporate  
and risk culture through the reporting of the internal audit and risk 
management functions; and the progress of the Group’s implementation 
plans for the IFRS 9 (Financial Instruments) and IFRS 17 (Insurance 
Contracts) accounting standards.

80

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities
Financial and narrative reporting

Committee responsibility
Monitors the integrity of 
the Group’s consolidated 
financial statements, 
including its annual and 
half-yearly reports, annual 
reporting arising under 
applicable supervisory rules, 
interim management 
statements, preliminary 
announcements and any 
other formal statements 
relating to the Group’s 
financial performance. 

Reviews and reports to 
the Board on significant 
financial reporting issues 
and judgements contained 
in the consolidated 
financial statements.

Reviews the content of 
the Annual Report and 
Accounts and advises the 
Board on whether, taken as 
a whole, it is fair, balanced 
and understandable and 
provides the information 
necessary for shareholders 
to assess the Group’s 
performance, business 
model and strategy.

Committee activities
At each meeting the Committee reviews the Group’s quarterly consolidated financial statements, including the 
annual consolidated financial statements, the Annual Report and Accounts and other public financial disclosures 
for the purpose of recommending their approval by the Board. The Group’s annual regulatory reports, prepared  
in accordance with the BMA’s reporting requirements, were reviewed in April 2022 at the Audit Committee 
meeting prior to the recommendation of their approval by the Board. The Committee also monitors the activities 
of the Group’s Disclosure Committee and reviews the Group’s quarterly financial releases and accompanying 
earnings call investor presentations. 

During 2022, the Committee received regular and ad hoc reports from management on:

• 

loss reserving and developments to the Group’s reserving process, including those to take account of the 
implications of adopting IFRS 17 going forward, considered in conjunction with the comparison of the Group’s 
reserves to the best estimates of its external actuarial consultants and the reports provided by the external 
auditors. The Committee also received a report during the year from the Group Chief Actuary on the impact 
of claims inflation (i.e. above initial inflation projections) on reserve estimates;

•  developments in accounting and financial reporting requirements, including a summary of any updates to 

disclosures in the consolidated financial statements;

• 

the quarterly activities of the Group finance team, which, for 2022, included delivering ‘lunch and learn’ 
sessions for new joiners to facilitate greater organisational awareness and overall alignment across the 
business;

•  any new and/or significant accounting treatments/transactions (including related party transactions) in the 
quarter, with a particular focus this year on the adjustments to estimated premium income in respect of 
insurance contracts impacted by the imposition of sanctions on Russia, arising from the conflict in Ukraine;

• 

• 

• 

• 

• 

the assessment of the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and longer term viability (see page 120 
for further details) which, for 2022, included detailed consideration of the impacts of the conflict in Ukraine 
and the volatility in global investment markets;

the programme of change across the Group, as well as enhancements in information security and the wider 
technology infrastructure. Information security matters are also reported to the Committee as part of the 
quarterly confirmatory compliance statements from the Group’s legal and compliance function; 

the progress of the Group’s IFRS 9 and IFRS 17 implementation project and the related ongoing 
enhancements to the Group’s finance IT framework;

the quarterly activities of LHL’s subsidiary companies, including consideration of any risk issues; and

the Committee also received quarterly reports from the external auditors covering audit planning and  
the results of their assessment of key financial statement judgements and estimates, control testing, 
misstatements identified and other audit and accounting matters.

The Committee attended a refresher training session delivered by the management team to the Board on  
the Group’s IFRS 17 implementation project. In addition, the Audit Committee continued its constructive 
engagement with the Group CFO to ensure maintenance of high standards of financial controls and reporting.

Judgements and estimation in the consolidated financial statements
The Committee gives detailed consideration to the significant judgements and estimations applied in preparing 
the consolidated financial statements. See the summary on the areas of judgement and estimation and the 
related processes applied by management on page 84.

The Committee reviewed the early drafts of the 2022 Annual Report and Accounts in order to keep apprised 
of its key themes and messages. During this review, the Committee carefully considered the clarity of disclosures 
made in respect of the material growth in Group premium income and the related developments in the 
business’s underwriting portfolio; the impact of major market losses and ongoing development events; loss 
reserving; the evolution of the Group’s ESG strategy; the account of the Group’s carbon footprint measurement 
and offsetting; the Group’s TCFD report; and the in-depth assessment conducted around going concern and 
viability. The Committee reviewed the final draft of the 2022 Annual Report and Accounts at the February  
2023 Audit Committee meeting, together with the external auditor’s report. The Committee advised the Board 
that, in its view, the 2022 Annual Report and Accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable 
and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s performance, business model  
and strategy.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

81

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities continued
External audit oversight

Committee responsibility
Oversees the relationship 
with the Group’s external 
auditors, approves their 
remuneration and terms of 
engagement, and assesses 
annually their independence 
and objectivity, taking into 
account relevant legal, 
regulatory and professional 
requirements and the 
Group’s relationship with 
the external auditors as a 
whole. This includes an 
annual assessment of the 
qualifications, expertise  
and resources, and 
independence of the 
external auditors and the 
effectiveness of the external 
audit process.
The development and 
implementation of a formal 
policy on the provision of 
non-audit services by the 
external auditors, taking 
into consideration any 
threats to the independence 
and objectivity of the 
external auditors.

Makes a recommendation 
to the Board, to be put to 
shareholders for approval  
at the AGM, in relation  
to the appointment, 
re-appointment or  
removal of the Group’s 
external auditors.

Committee activities
The Committee approves the annual external audit plan, ensuring its consistency with the scope of the audit 
engagement, and receives reports from the external auditors, including an ongoing assessment of the effective 
performance of the audit compared to the plan.

KPMG LLP’s terms, scope of engagement and fees are approved by the Committee at the start of each audit.

Following the year-end audit, the Committee performs an assessment of the effectiveness of the external audit 
process. This assessment was last conducted, and designed to align with good practice guidance, at the April 
2022 Audit Committee meeting and it was concluded that the external audit process was operating effectively, 
both with respect to the service provided by KPMG LLP and management’s support of the audit process. 
Similarly, the Committee receives from the external auditors a management letter setting out certain findings 
and recommendations in respect of the audit of the control environment and receives regular updates from 
management on the steps taken in addressing the observations raised. 

The Committee also formally reviews the independence of the external auditors, in particular at the half-year 
and year-end meetings, taking into account any non-audit services provided. The Committee considers that 
KPMG LLP remain independent.

The Committee Chair conducts informal meetings with the external auditors and the Group CFO prior to the 
review of the quarterly results. The Committee meets quarterly in executive session with the external auditors  
to discuss any issues arising from the audit, and with management to obtain feedback on the audit process. 

The Committee has approved and adopted a formal non-audit services policy that is reviewed on an annual basis. 
The policy was last reviewed by the Group CFO in April 2022 and subsequently approved by the Committee at 
its first quarter meeting. The policy, which stipulates the approvals required for various types of non-audit 
services that may be provided by the external auditors, as well as those from which the external auditors are 
excluded, is on the Group’s website. During 2022, KPMG LLP provided $0.4 million of non-audit services to  
the Group relating to the half-year reporting review, as well as Solvency II and Lloyd’s regulatory returns. The 
Committee gave careful consideration to the nature of the non-audit services provided, the suitability of KPMG 
LLP as the most suitable supplier of the non-audit services and the level of fees charged and has determined that 
they do not affect the independence and objectivity of KPMG LLP as auditors.

Following a competitive external audit tender process undertaken during 2016, the appointment of KPMG LLP 
as external auditors was first approved by shareholders at the 2017 AGM and has been approved at subsequent 
AGMs. The 2022 financial year was the sixth financial year in which KPMG LLP acted as the Group’s external 
auditors. The incumbent lead audit partner is Salim Tharani, who assumed this role from his predecessor, Rees 
Aronson, at the beginning of the 2022 financial year, in accordance with an orderly plan of partner rotation under 
the guidance of the UK Ethical Standard. 

The external audit fee arrangements across the Group were originally agreed in 2016 as part of the audit tender 
process, with amounts fixed for the 2017-2019 year-end audits. Since 2020, the Audit Committee has discussed 
and agreed with KPMG LLP, in consultation with management, the annual fee structure for the forthcoming 
year-end audit, most recently in respect of the 2022 financial year.

The Committee and the Board are recommending the re-appointment of KPMG LLP as external auditors at the 
2023 AGM. 

The Committee has and will continue to evaluate the impact on the Group of the Department for Business, 
Energy and Industrial Strategy (BEIS) consultation and resulting proposals for restoring trust in audit and 
corporate governance.

82

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities continued
Internal audit oversight

Committee responsibility
Monitors and assesses the 
role and effectiveness of 
the Group’s internal audit 
function in the overall 
context of the Group’s  
risk management system, 
ensuring it has unrestricted 
scope, and the necessary 
resources and access to 
information to enable 
it to fulfil its mandate 
in accordance with 
appropriate professional 
standards.

Committee activities
The Group’s internal audit function reports directly to the Committee. The Committee meets in executive 
session with the Group Head of Internal Audit on a quarterly basis. Each year, the Group Head of Internal Audit 
presents an annual internal audit strategy and plan to the Committee for consideration and approval. In general, 
the most significant business risks and controls are considered for audit annually, whilst less critical risks are 
audited periodically as part of a flexible multi-year programme. The internal audit plan also considers emerging 
risks which may impact on the business, with input in this area from the Group risk management function. 

The Committee receives a quarterly report from the internal audit function summarising the status of the 
internal audit plan; findings from internal audits conducted in the period; and the status of actions taken by 
management to implement recommendations arising. Consideration is also given to the assessment of the 
Group’s culture, including risk culture, for each audit undertaken and an overall summary of observations 
identified in respect of the Group’s culture is presented to the Committee on a quarterly basis. 

During 2022, the Committee reviewed and approved the Internal Audit Charter. This can be viewed on the 
Group’s website. The Committee assessed the level of internal audit resource and the appropriateness of the 
skills and resources of the internal audit function. The Chair of the Committee undertook an annual review of the 
effectiveness of the internal audit function and its activities during 2022. The Committee discussed the report 
and its findings with the Group CRO and the Group Head of Internal Audit and concluded that the internal audit 
function is operating effectively in the overall context of the Group’s risk management system, has appropriate 
standing within the Group and that the Group Head of Internal Audit has the appropriate reporting lines to 
maintain independence.

Internal controls and risk management systems
Reviews the adequacy and 
effectiveness of the Group’s 
internal financial controls 
systems that identify, 
assess, manage and monitor 
financial risks, and other 
internal control and risk 
management systems.

The Board has ultimate responsibility for ensuring the maintenance by the Group of a robust framework of 
internal control and risk management systems and has delegated the monitoring and review of these systems 
to the Committee. The system of internal controls is designed to manage rather than eliminate the risk of failure 
to achieve business objectives and can only provide reasonable and not absolute assurance against material 
misstatement or loss. The Committee received from the Group CRO periodic reports detailing results of the 
quarterly risk and control affirmation review and testing work, together with an overview of the Group’s control 
environment and its effective operation. The Committee also received additional reports from the Group CRO 
and Group Head of Internal Audit on the ongoing effective operation of key controls during the programme of 
change arising through growth in the business and the resultant increase in headcount across the Group. For 
further detail of the emerging and principal risks affecting the Group, including those matters that have informed 
the Board’s assessment of the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern and ongoing viability, as well as the 
risk mitigation procedures in place to identify and manage them, see pages 30 to 37. 

Reviews and approves the 
statements to be included 
in the Annual Report and 
Accounts concerning 
internal control, risk 
management, including  
the assessment of principal 
and emerging risks, and the 
viability statement.

The Committee received from the Group Head of Internal Audit an annual assessment of the effectiveness of  
the Group’s governance, risk and control framework, together with an analysis of themes and trends from the 
internal audit work performed and their impact on the Group’s risk profile. As part of the most recent annual 
appraisal, the Group Head of Internal Audit gave explicit consideration to management’s fraud risk assessment 
and reported to the Committee that no instances of actual or potential fraud had been identified as part of the 
review work and other assurance activities undertaken, nor had the Group Head of Internal Audit been informed 
of, or made aware of, potential fraud by the management team. Fraud risk and the associated controls are, 
otherwise, ordinarily considered by the Group internal audit function as part of the planning phase for each  
audit conducted. In 2022, the Committee and Board were satisfied that the governance, risk and control 
framework continue to remain both effective and appropriate for the Group.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

83

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities continued
Compliance, speaking up and fraud

Committee responsibility
Reviews for adequacy and 
security the Group’s 
compliance, speaking-up 
and fraud controls.

Committee activities
During 2022, the Committee conducted an annual review of the Group’s policies and procedures relevant to 
financial controls to ensure their adequacy and effectiveness, and recommended the adoption by the Board of 
updated policies and procedures in respect of: anti-money laundering; the prevention of bribery and financial 
crime (including the detection of fraud); conflicts of interest; whistleblowing arrangements; and sanctions 
monitoring. The operation of the controls that are documented in these policies and procedures are reported to 
the Committee on a quarterly basis in the form of confirmatory compliance statements from the Group’s legal 
and compliance function, members of which include the Group’s Money Laundering Reporting Officers and 
Group Data Protection Officer. The Committee also keeps under review the adequacy and effectiveness of the 
Group’s legal and compliance function and receives regular updates on compliance training delivered to staff 
across the Group (see page 53 for further details). 

The Group’s whistleblowing policy and procedure provide an internal mechanism for the reporting, investigation 
and remediation of any workplace wrongdoing, with arrangements in place that allow for the independent 
investigation of such matters and appropriate follow-up action. A whistleblowing champion has been appointed 
to each of the Group’s principal operating subsidiaries, as well as at a parent company level, with the Chair of the 
Audit Committee serving in such capacity. The appointed whistleblowing champions have responsibility for 
ensuring and overseeing the integrity, independence and effectiveness of the Company’s policies and procedures 
on whistleblowing. The Group places a high priority on staff understanding of this process to enable them to 
speak out with confidence when appropriate and this message, as well as the arrangements that are in place, is 
regularly communicated to all staff.

Significant areas of judgement and estimation
An annual paper is presented by management to the Committee that 
details the areas of judgement and estimation in the preparation of the 
consolidated financial statements and a semi-annual going concern 
assessment is also presented to the Committee which covers areas 
relevant to the longer term viability of the business.

The valuation of loss reserves and expenses
The most significant area of judgement and estimation considered by  
the Committee during 2022 was the valuation of loss reserves.

As detailed on page 140 of the consolidated financial statements, the 
valuation of loss reserves is a complex actuarial process that incorporates 
a significant amount of judgement. The Committee considers the 
adequacy of the Group’s loss reserves at each Audit Committee meeting, 
for which purpose it receives quarterly reports from the Group’s Chief 
Actuary. The Committee also receives independent estimates of the 
Group’s loss reserves from an external actuary and compares these 
third-party estimates to those of the Group at its second and fourth 
quarter Audit Committee meetings. KPMG LLP conducts a detailed 
re-projection of the Group’s loss reserves as part of the full-year audit.
The Committee meets in executive session with the Group’s Chief 
Actuary twice a year (at half year and year-end) to discuss the operation 
and effectiveness of the actuarial function and the reserving process. 

During 2022, the Committee focused its discussions pertaining to the 
Group’s loss reserves on:

• 

• 

the reserving for natural catastrophe loss events and larger risk  
loss events (including ongoing development events) which occurred 
during the year;

the difference between the Group’s estimates and the independent 
review from external actuaries (these differences being viewed by 
management, the external third parties and the Committee to be 
within a reasonable range);

•  prior year loss development, including ‘back-testing’ of the Group’s 

prior year reserves; 

• 

• 

• 

reserving for each insurance operating subsidiary; 

the assessment and quantification of the impact of excess  
claims inflation (i.e. above initial inflation projections) on reserve 
estimates; and

refinements to the Group’s reserving methodology as we transition 
to IFRS 17.

Having reviewed and challenged these areas, the Committee concurred 
with management’s valuation of the Group’s loss reserves and the 
relevant disclosures around loss reserving in the Group’s consolidated 
financial statements.

84

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

The fair value of financial instruments
Less significant estimates are made in determining the fair value of 
certain financial instruments and management judgement is applied in 
determining impairment charges. The investment portfolio is of a high 
credit quality and highly liquid and the Audit Committee obtains comfort 
from the impairment policy being applied consistently over time. The 
estimation of the fair value, specifically ‘Level (iii)’ investments, is 
discussed on pages 139 and 141 and in note 11.

Valuation of premiums received which are estimated
A portion of the gross premiums written by the Group is based on 
estimates of the ultimate premiums expected. Judgement is therefore 
involved in determining the ultimate estimates to establish the 
appropriate premium value. The Audit Committee obtains comfort  
from quarterly reviews performed by management to validate the 
judgements and compare against actual premium received.

Going concern basis of accounting and longer term 
viability 
The Audit Committee reviewed and challenged the going concern 
assessment prepared by management at both its July 2022 and February 
2023 meetings, with particular consideration of capital management, the 
current underwriting and loss environment, the composition and liquidity 
of the investment portfolio, long-term debt financing arrangements, 
strategic and financial forecasts over the business planning horizon,  
and stress and scenario testing (including climate-change risk scenarios). 
These factors are also relevant to giving assurance to the Board on the 
longer term viability of the Group’s business strategy.

Having reviewed and challenged these areas, the Committee concurred 
with management’s going concern assessment and the relevant 
disclosures around going concern and longer term viability in the  
Group’s consolidated financial statements.

Implementation plans for IFRS 9 and IFRS 17
During 2022, the Committee monitored on a quarterly basis the 
preparation by the Group for the implementation of IFRS 9 and  
IFRS 17 (see future accounting changes on page 137). 

In particular, the Audit Committee received a quarterly IFRS 17  
reporting pack outlining the financial reporting outputs from the  
IFRS 17 implementation project, which included an overall project plan 
and status update to enable the Audit Committee to monitor the IFRS 17 
deliverables. All Board and Audit Committee members attended an  
IFRS 17 training session in November 2022, where the topics covered 
included: accounting policy choices, measurement models, valuation  
and presentation differences, approach to discounting, disclosure 
requirements, key performance indicators and significant estimates  
and judgements.

The Audit Committee also monitored the work of KPMG LLP in  
their ongoing assessment of the Group's preparedness to transition to  
IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 and discussed with them the external audit-related 
implications of these changes.

Priorities for 2023
•  To maintain the focus on the effectiveness of the Group’s control 
environment, the operation of the business’s financial reporting 
systems and the integrity of external financial reporting;

•  To monitor the implementation of IFRS 9 and IFRS 17 in 2023 

financial reporting;

•  To continue to monitor and embed aspects of positive business 
culture in quarterly reporting, in particular regarding the Group’s 
financial and risk control environment; and

•  To continue to monitor developments and implement 

recommendations relating to anticipated changes in the corporate 
governance, corporate reporting and audit practice landscape arising 
from the BEIS consultation.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

85

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

Nomination, Corporate Governance  
and Sustainability Committee

“Strong corporate governance is at the heart of our culture  
and our rigorous system of risk management. During the year, 
we have further refreshed our Board membership, rotated the 
leadership of our Audit and Remuneration Committees and 
appointed a new Senior Independent Director in line with  
Code expectations for director independence.

The Committee’s role continues to focus on sustainability issues 
for the Group, and includes monitoring evolving developments 
in climate risk and ESG management, and within regulation, 
guidance and reporting requirements. During the year, the 
Committee has formalised the reporting line from the 
management ESG Committee.

The focus of the Board and management team is on the  
creation of a diverse and vibrant culture and business  
which is sustainable over the long-term.”

Principal responsibilities of the Committee
•  Reviews the structure, size and composition (including the skills, 

knowledge, independence, experience and diversity) of the Board  
and its engagement with the workforce;

•  Considers succession planning for the Directors and other  

senior executives;

•  Nominates candidates to fill Board vacancies;

•  Makes recommendations to the Board concerning Non-Executive 
Director independence, membership of Committees, suitable 
candidates for the role of Senior Independent Director, and the 
re-election of Directors by shareholders;

•  Reviews the Company’s corporate governance arrangements and 

compliance with the Code;

•  Monitors and makes recommendations to the Board regarding  
the environmental, social and governance responsibilities of the 
Company; and

•  Makes recommendations to the Board concerning the charitable  
and corporate social responsibility activities of the Company and 
donations to the Lancashire Foundation.

Peter Clarke
Chair of the Nomination, Corporate Governance  
and Sustainability Committee

Committee membership
The majority of the Nomination, Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee members are independent Non-Executive 
Directors. The Committee Chair is Peter Clarke, who is the Chair of the 
Board. Samantha Hoe-Richardson stepped down from the Board and the 
Committee with effect from 27 April 2022, having completed nine years 
of service as a Director.

Committee members
Peter Clarke (Chair)
Michael Dawson
Sally Williams
Irene McDermott Brown 
Samantha Hoe-Richardson

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
2/2

86

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities
Corporate governance

Committee responsibility
Board composition and 
effectiveness

UK Code compliance

Governance documentation

Committee activities
The Committee discussed in its meetings the skills and experience needed to complement those already on the 
Board and its Committees. The Committee regularly discussed matters of Board succession and skills planning 
over the medium to longer term including the process for Chair succession planning, which is to be a process 
facilitated by the Board’s Senior Independent Director (SID). The Committee considered questions of fitness  
and independence in recommending to the Board the appointment of Jack Gressier, who was appointed as a 
Non-Executive Director with effect from 26 July 2022. The Committee also approved the appointment of Mr 
Gressier to the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee and the Remuneration Committee. During the 
year the Committee oversaw the appointments of Sally Williams and Irene McDermott Brown respectively to 
the Chairs of the Audit and Remuneration Committees. 

The Committee reviewed the composition of the Board at its November 2022 meeting, and it considered that 
the balance of skills, knowledge, independence, experience and diversity continues to be appropriate for the 
Group’s business to meet its strategic objectives.

The Committee oversaw the process for the year-end review of the effectiveness of the Board, the Committees 
and each of the Directors, which was facilitated internally by the Company Secretariat team. The Committee and 
the Board were satisfied that the Board and each of its Committees were operating effectively. Further details of 
the performance evaluation process and its outcomes can be found on page 77. 

In accordance with the provisions of the Code, all of the Directors are subject to annual (re)election by 
shareholders. With the exception of Jack Gressier who was appointed in July 2022, all of the Group’s current 
Directors were elected or re-elected by shareholders at the 2022 AGM. With the exception of Simon Fraser,  
who will not submit himself for re-election having completed nine years’ service as a Director, all other serving 
Directors will be submitted for re-election at the 2023 AGM. 

In light of Simon Fraser’s planned rotation off the Board, the Committee facilitated a process for the selection  
of a new SID, which resulted in the appointment of Robert Lusardi as SID with effect from 3 November 2022.  
The Committee has also received regular updates with respect to the succession planning for the Board’s Chair. 

The Committee keeps under review the Company’s corporate governance arrangements, particularly the 
Company’s compliance with the FRC’s UK Corporate Governance Code (the ‘Code’). The Committee reviewed 
the Company Secretariat’s checklist record of the Company’s compliance with the Code on a quarterly basis. 

The Committee considered the Terms of Reference for all the Committees which were considered fit for purpose. 
A review was implemented during 2022 to ensure the Terms of Reference reflect the Group’s approach regarding 
the use of non-gendered language and inclusivity. In July 2022, the Committee reviewed and recommended to 
the Board an updated version of both the Board’s Schedule of Reserved Matters and of the document describing 
the division of responsibilities between the Group CEO and the Chair. In November 2022, the Committee 
reviewed and recommended to the Board for recommendation to shareholders the revised Company  
Bye-laws. The revised Bye-laws will be put to shareholders for approval at the Company’s 2023 AGM.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

87

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities continued
Corporate governance

Committee responsibility
Appointments and 
succession planning

Workforce engagement

Audit reform

Committee activities
The Committee reviewed and recommended the approval and adoption by the Board of the Group’s succession 
plan and talent management and development programme for the 2022/2023 year in July 2022. The business 
has the objective of fostering a skilled and diverse workforce to meet the needs of the business. The Committee 
reviewed training and development proposals for a number of key employees across the Group as part of the 
succession planning process.

During 2022, the Group continued the practice of the Group CEO holding ‘town hall’ meetings with employees 
following the announcement of the Group’s quarterly results. In order to further enhance arrangements for 
engagement between the Non-Executive Directors and members of the workforce, the Committee arranged  
for these town hall meetings to be periodically attended by the Chair of the Board or another Non-Executive 
Director. Peter Clarke attended the town hall meetings held virtually for both our Bermuda and London offices  
in February 2022; Sally Williams attended in-person town hall meetings in our London offices in May 2022; Irene 
McDermott Brown attended an in-person meeting in London in both August and November 2022. The Board and 
Committee also received the results of two staff engagement surveys undertaken during 2022. In March 2022, 
the Group conducted a wellbeing survey as a follow up to the engagement survey conducted in 2021 and in 
September 2022, the Group conducted a rewards and benefits survey to better understand the views of staff on 
the compensation and benefits offered at Lancashire (see page 51 for further details of these surveys). With the 
relaxation of COVID-19 related restrictions on social interaction, the Directors once again had the opportunity  
to meet with staff less formally at staff lunches and other social gatherings organised around the time of the 
Board’s regular meetings in Bermuda. The Committee considered these and other tools for workforce 
engagement at its November 2022 meeting and discussed arrangements for workforce engagement during 2023. 
The Committee considers that the mechanisms for workforce engagement and feedback have an appropriately 
high profile and this, in turn, informs debate within the relevant Committees, the Board and the wider Group. 

The Committee has monitored developments in the area of audit market reform, regulation and practice during 
2022, including proposals for UK legislative change as a result of the FRC’s final consultations, the Department 
for Business, Energy and Industrial Strategy’s consultation and the planned establishment of Auditing Reporting 
Governance Authority (ARGA).

Subsidiary boards

The Committee and Board monitored the composition and appointments and changes to the Group’s subsidiary 
boards during 2022.

88

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities continued
Sustainability

Committee responsibility
Sustainability and ESG 
reporting

Environment
Climate change risk and 
opportunity

Social responsibility
Diversity

The Lancashire Foundation

Committee activities
The Committee has continued to monitor developments in the area of the Group’s ESG responsibilities, including 
the impact of climate change, throughout its work in 2022. The Committee has received reports from the 
management ESG Committee (which was established during 2021) regarding the current and developing  
ESG regulatory landscape as well as the Group’s progress in these areas. Upon the recommendation of the 
Committee, the Board agreed the Group’s 2022 ESG strategic statement and the Group’s ESG risk framework, 
both of which have been embedded into the business. 

The Committee also periodically reviews developments in the areas of environmental sustainability and climate 
change, and the management of related risks and opportunities. The Committee reviewed and ratified the 
Group’s 2022 CDP response. For more information on these matters, please see the Group CRO’s report  
on page 26 and the 2022 TCFD report starting on page 61.

The Committee recommended approval of an updated Board diversity policy, which is posted on the Company’s 
website. The main change in this policy was to include a commitment to meet the Parker review target for 
minority ethnic representation by December 2024. The Committee is actively progressing recruitment in  
order to meet this target.

The Committee also noted and approved proposals for the introduction by management of a staff level Diversity, 
Equity and Inclusion Policy, which was approved by the Group Executive Committee during the year.

The Committee is responsible for monitoring and making recommendations to the Board in relation to the 
Company’s charitable giving policy and the operation of, and reporting requirements for, the Lancashire 
Foundation. During 2022, the Committee received a report from the Foundation, including its objectives, 
governance, approach to funding for 2023 and beyond, alongside its investment strategy, donations policy and 
charitable activities, as well as the ways in which the Foundation engages with employees throughout the Group. 
The Committee made a recommendation to the Board that the Company make a donation to the Foundation 
of 0.75% of full-year Group profits (subject to a cap of $750,000 and a $250,000 collar), conditional on the 
determination of financial performance for the full year. 2022 marks 16 years of the Lancashire Foundation – 
for more information regarding its work, please see pages 47 to 50.

UK Modern Slavery Act 2015

During 2022, the Committee recommended the approval by the Board of an updated anti-slavery and human 
trafficking statement, a copy of which is posted on the Company’s website.

Priorities for 2023
•  To continue to ensure that the Company is able to effectively 
discharge its governance responsibilities under the Code;

•  To continue to develop the succession plans for Directors and senior 
executives, and the role of Board Chair, in line with the Group’s 
strategic objectives;

•  To support management in the development of the talent pipeline;

•  To review developments with regards to the Company’s sustainability 
and ESG activities including management of climate change risk and 
opportunity; and

•  To monitor the Company’s progress on diversity and to take steps to 

enhance minority ethnic representation on the Board. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

89

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

Investment Committee

Robert Lusardi
Chair of the Investment Committee

“The Group’s investment portfolio has been negatively impacted 
in 2022 by volatility in global markets, inflationary trends and 
a rapidly rising interest rate environment. In the face of these 
challenges the Group’s defensive short duration profile of the 
investment portfolio has helped mitigate the impacts of rising 
interest rates.

The negative impacts on the portfolio are principally comprised 
of unrealised losses on relatively short duration assets which we 
expect to unwind for the most part over the medium term. The 
Committee conducted a strategic asset allocation review during 
the year, which has served largely to validate our investment 
approach over recent years. The investment portfolio is managed 
with a view to preserving capital to support underwriting 
opportunities and to provide adequate liquidity to match the 
Group’s risk exposures. Given that the vast majority of the 
Company’s premium writings, reserves and investments  
are U.S. dollar denominated, economic and capital market 
conditions in the U.S. are the primary determinant of 
investment results. Currently, inflation is subsiding somewhat 
in the U.S., unemployment is at a long-term low, and interest 
rates, which rose by more than 300 basis points in 2022, have 
recently stabilised. As such we expect the portfolio to make a 
more significant contribution to returns in 2023, particularly 
as lower yielding assets roll off.”

Committee membership
The Terms of Reference of the Investment Committee provide that the 
Committee shall comprise at least two Non-Executive Directors (one  
of whom may be the Chair of the Board) and the Group CFO and/or the 
Group CIO. Any Executive Director may also serve on the Committee.

Principal responsibilities of the Committee
•  Recommends investment strategies, guidelines and policies to the 

Board and other Group entities to approve;

•  Recommends and sets risk asset definitions and investment risk 

tolerance levels;

The Investment Committee comprises one independent Non-Executive 
Director, the Chair of the Board, one Executive Director (the Group CFO) 
and the Group CIO (who is not a Director).

•  Recommends to the relevant Boards the appointment of investment 

managers to manage the Group’s investments;

•  Monitors the performance of investment strategies within the risk 

Committee members
Robert Lusardi (Chair)
Peter Clarke
Natalie Kershaw
Denise O’Donoghue

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

framework; and

•  Establishes and monitors compliance with investment operating 

guidelines.

90

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities
For the full 2022 year there was a negative return on the Group’s 
investment portfolio of $76.7 million, being a portfolio percentage return 
of negative 3.5%. The largest factor in the negative return was mark to 
market unrealised losses, which for the full year were $93.2 million. 

During 2022, the Committee focused on the challenge of volatility 
arising from the effects of the continuing impact of the COVID-19 
pandemic, the conflict in Ukraine, inflationary pressures and changes  
in the U.S. Federal Reserve’s interest rate policy and the wider U.S. and 
global economic and political environment. The Committee monitored 
the impacts on the fixed income assets within the investment portfolio 
of the rising interest rate environment within the U.S. and the impact  
on mark to market valuations and unrealised losses within the portfolio. 

The Committee continued to work with management to articulate, 
support and implement the Board’s investment philosophy. The Group’s 
investment strategy continues to be conservative in nature, to support 
the Group’s underwriting strategy, to provide appropriate liquidity to 
match the Group’s risk exposures and to contribute to the Group’s 
growth in FCBVS. The Committee received a proposal from management 
with regard to asset allocation guidelines further to the biennial asset 
allocation review, which was externally facilitated by an independent 
advisory firm. The strategic asset allocation review was discussed and 
agreed at the November 2022 meeting. The analysis factored in 
consideration of growth in the Group’s casualty reinsurance portfolio 
reserves on the desired overall target investment portfolio duration  
and liquidity requirements. A number of investment strategy 
recommendations were debated and agreed.

The Committee held regular discussions with the professional 
investment portfolio managers concerning the macroeconomic 
environment and implications for investment asset classes and strategy.

The Committee considered regular reports on the performance of the 
Group’s investment portfolios, including asset allocation and compliance 
with pre-defined guidelines and tolerances; and recommended 
amendments to portfolio investment guidelines to the Board.

The Committee monitored a suite of investment portfolio risk analytics 
throughout the year including a 1 in 100 Value at Risk measure, realistic 
disaster scenarios and realistic loss scenarios, credit risk, liquidity risk  
and other market risks. The Committee also tracked FX exposure and  
its management.

The Committee continues to monitor ESG and climate change 
developments and expectations within the market. The Committee 
monitors and will continue to develop a number of tools to measure  
the ESG profile, climate change risk exposure and carbon intensity of  
the Group’s investment portfolio. It is recognised by the Committee that 
most of the available measurement metrics and methodologies for these 
factors are imperfect, and the Committee expects to further develop and 
refine its ability to analyse these factors in future years, in consultation 
with the Group’s external advisors and portfolio managers, particularly 
as external tools and standards for measuring potential climate effects 
on investments become more developed.

The Committee noted that 93.9% of the Group’s externally managed 
investment portfolio are signatories to the UNPRI. The Committee 
monitored the ESG profile of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio by 
reference to the MSCI ESG rating tool, noting that the Lancashire 
portfolio sits near the high end of the average ESG category rating. The 
proportion of the fixed maturity portfolio covered by the available rating 
methodology was approximately 47.2% of the public fixed maturity 
portfolio, due to the high number of U.S. treasuries and structured 
products that are not covered by the available methodology. 

The Committee has for the second year operated a framework for the 
measurement of climate sensitivity for corporate bonds within the fixed 
maturity portfolio through the use of a Climate Value at Risk metric 
(Climate VaR), which is aligned with the Paris Accord goal of limiting 
global temperature increases to a maximum of 1.5°C, for the Group’s 
investment risk tolerance statements. The Committee and Board have a 
preference for the financial impact of this scenario on the Group’s fixed 
maturity portfolio, covered by MSCI, to have a less detrimental impact 
than the MSCI benchmark model. Due to limited coverage of the 
available measurement tool mentioned above, the portfolio performance 
is grossed up by reference to covered assets. The Committee noted that 
the fixed maturity portfolio continues to outperform the benchmark 
portfolio on the Climate VaR measure.

The Committee monitored the implementation of carbon intensity 
guidelines for investment managers in the fixed maturity portfolio. The 
carbon intensity score for the fixed maturity portfolio reduced against 
the prior year. The Committee expects to see a further reduction in the 
carbon intensity of the fixed income portfolio as securities with a greater 
carbon intensity score roll off the portfolio over the next few years, 
although the reductions will be lower because of management actions 
previously taken.

The Committee and the Board continued to operate ESG and carbon 
management investment guidelines implemented by the Group’s 
investment managers across the Group’s fixed maturity investment 
portfolios. 

Priorities for 2023
•  To maintain a continued focus on a diversified portfolio, continuation 
of its contribution to the Group’s operating income and FCBVS, the 
preservation of capital, the maintenance of liquidity in order to pay 
claims and the prudent management of investment risks aligned with 
the developing profile of the Group’s underwriting portfolio, including 
the addition of longer tail lines;

•  To focus on the implications of macroeconomic trends, in particular 
the threat of more sustained inflationary pressures, trends in interest 
rates, the U.S. domestic economy and instability within the 
international political environment; and 

•  To monitor climate change risk sensitivity, the ESG profile and carbon 
intensity profile of the Group’s investment portfolio as the external 
market for measurement of such items continues to develop.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

91

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

Underwriting Committee

“The Committee’s principal focus in 2022 was in monitoring 
the strong premium growth trend during the year as pricing  
in the insurance and reinsurance markets continued to harden. 
With organic and complementary growth in the Group’s core 
specialty lines, improved pricing on the catastrophe book and the 
strong build out of the Group’s newer casualty and financial 
lines exposures, the Committee has monitored the relative 
rebalancing of catastrophe risk within the overall portfolio.

Overall, the Group has developed a more diversified portfolio 
which, over time, is expected to generate more consistent and  
less volatile returns.

In another year of global volatility marked by the conflict in 
Ukraine, the Committee has continued to monitor both the risks 
and the underwriting opportunities arising from dislocation in 
a number of insurance and reinsurance classes.”

Principal responsibilities of the Committee
•  Reviews Group underwriting strategy, including consideration of  

new lines of business;

•  Oversees the development of, and adherence to, underwriting criteria, 

limits, guidelines and authorities by operating company CUOs;

•  Reviews underwriting performance;

•  Reviews significant changes in underwriting rules and policies; and

•  Monitors underwriting risk and its consistency with the Group’s  

risk profile and risk appetite.

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities
During 2022, the Committee continued to focus upon the improved 
pricing and market conditions in most of the Group’s existing lines of 
business, the development of the Group’s casualty and financial lines 
portfolios and other more recently established business lines, and the 
opportunities to grow and diversify the underwriting portfolio through 
the addition of new lines of business. 

Throughout the year the Committee discussed areas of risk and 
opportunity, in particular arising from market dislocation caused by  
the conflict in Ukraine and the impacts of hurricane Ian. The Committee 
monitored what was, for the most part, an improving pricing trend which 
facilitated strong premium growth as the year developed. The Group’s 
RPI, which shows the trend in renewal pricing on like-for-like contracts, 
was 108% for the full year across the portfolio. Gross premiums written 
for the full year increased to $1.7 billion, which was a 34.9% increase on 
2021. The Committee benefitted from the enhancements to the 

Alex Maloney
Group CEO and Chair of the Underwriting  
and Underwriting Risk Committee

Committee membership
During 2022, the Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee 
comprised one Executive Director (the Group CEO) and two Non-
Executive Directors (Jack Gressier joined the Committee during the  
third quarter), together with the Group CUO, the CUO of LICL, the  
CUO of LUK, the CEO and CUO of LSL, the LICL CEO and the Group 
Chief Actuary (who are not Directors).

Committee members
Alex Maloney (Chair)
Jon Barnes
Michael Dawson
James Flude
Paul Gregory
Jack Gressier 
James Irvine
Hayley Johnston
Ben Readdy
John Spence

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4
1/1
4/4
4/4
4/4
4/4

92

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

reporting of management performance data introduced during 2021  
and the more readily digestible and granular detail of pricing trends  
and premium income, claims developments and overall performance  
by underwriting segment.

The Committee monitors underwriting performance on a quarterly basis 
to ensure that good risk selection and disciplined underwriting remain at 
the core of the Group’s underwriting strategy. This is facilitated through 
regular update reports from the CUOs for LUK and LICL, the Active 
Underwriters of Syndicates 2010 and 3010, and the CEO of LCM. 

The Committee also discussed and monitored growth and new business 
opportunities during the year including the following areas:

The Group’s programme of outwards reinsurance protections is a  
core risk and exposure management tool. The Committee reviewed  
the structure, pricing and operation of the outwards reinsurance 
programme and regularly discussed management reports covering 
outwards reinsurance developments. In particular, the Committee  
held a dedicated strategic discussion at its November 2022 meeting  
to consider reinsurance market dynamics, in particular in the light of 
market dislocation as a result of the impacts of hurricane Ian. The 
Committee discussed options for the development and focus of the 
Group’s outwards reinsurance programmes, the opportunities for 
alignment and efficiencies across the Group and the related strategic 
opportunities within the Group’s inwards reinsurance portfolio. 

•  Casualty reinsurance;

•  Development of the Syndicate 3010 Lloyd’s Australian D&F  

property class;

•  Syndicate 3010 and LUK marine and energy liability growth;

•  The newly established construction and engineering classes;

•  Lloyd’s casualty consortium participation; and

•  Aviation classes – in particular opportunity arising from market 

dislocation.

The Committee also received reports on a number of initiatives which 
were explored but were not pursued.

The Committee received a claims update on a quarterly basis and 
monitored the claims and reserving processes for any material losses  
as they developed during the year. During 2022, the Committee had  
a particular focus on the Group’s potential exposures arising from the 
conflict in Ukraine and also monitored the claims and reserving process  
for the Group’s Florida and other U.S. exposures to hurricane Ian. The 
Committee also monitored developments in international law relating  
to insurance coverage for COVID-19 related claims.

The Committee has been actively engaged during 2022 in the 
development and implementation of the Group’s underwriting strategy.  
It considers the articulation of, and adherence to, formal underwriting risk 
tolerances, which are approved and monitored by the Committee and the 
Board. This included the discussion and approval of tolerances in relation 
to mortgage risk and cyber exposures. In particular, the Committee 
received quarterly risk data tracking movements in the Group’s exposures 
to modelled PMLs and RDSs. The Committee also reviewed developments 
in the formal underwriting authorities implemented across the Group. The 
Committee also reviewed and approved underwriting risk appetite 
statements, including in relation to adherence to formal Group ESG  
and climate risk underwriting guidelines which have been articulated  
and operated by reference to Lloyd’s guidance. 

The Committee, through the review and monitoring of underwriting 
PMLs, continued to monitor exposures to a range of natural catastrophe 
risks, including regional windstorm and hurricane exposures, and the 
articulation of an appropriate underwriting and risk management 
strategy and management preference for these and other risk exposures 
linked to climate change factors. The Committee discussed the impacts 
of hurricane Ian during the third quarter. The Committee is satisfied that 
the Group’s underwriting strategy and reinsurance and risk management 
programmes are appropriate for the management of underwriting risk 
and natural catastrophe and climate linked exposures relating to these 
factors. For more detail, please see the ERM report starting on page 26 
and the Group’s TCFD report starting on page 61.

The Committee also convened a number of other themed ‘deeper dive’ 
strategic sessions at its quarterly meetings involving the participation  
of underwriters from across the Group. These included sessions on the 
Group’s aviation underwriting strategy, discussion of developments in 
the specialty reinsurance markets and related risks and opportunities for 
the Group, and the Group’s inward retrocessional reinsurance portfolio.

The Committee received management reports on the progress and 
approval by Lloyd’s of the business plans for Syndicates 2010 and 3010, 
including the Lloyd’s approval of growth plans for 2023.

The Committee also reviewed developments in the third-party 
reinsurance capital markets and the performance of the LCM platform, 
The Committee discussed changes in the ownership of LCM to achieve 
full alignment with the Group and the related opportunities to use third 
party capital structures to support Group underwriting initiatives. 

During 2022, the Committee meetings were attended by all Board 
members. The Committee and Board seek to match the Company’s 
capital to the underwriting requirements of the business in all parts  
of the underwriting cycle.

A more detailed analysis of the Group’s underwriting performance 
appears in the business review starting on page 20.

Priorities for 2023
•  To continue to monitor the development and implementation of a 

forward-looking and disciplined underwriting strategy with a focus on 
disciplined growth appropriate to the current market opportunities 
and nimble use of the Group’s underwriting platforms, within a 
framework of appropriate risk tolerances;

•  To work actively with management in the identification, analysis  
and consideration of new underwriting opportunities, including 
potential new lines of business, opportunities in new markets and 
opportunities for the managed ‘organic’ growth in the Group’s 
existing business lines;

•  To consider opportunities for development of the Group’s 
reinsurance structures including in the area of third party  
reinsurance capital; and

•  To continue to foster a nimble, sustainable and responsive 
underwriting culture, capable of responding to the needs  
of clients, investors, employees and other stakeholders.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

93

GovernanceCommittee reports continued

Remuneration Committee

“I was pleased to take on the role of the Remuneration 
Committee Chair during 2022. The Committee has carried out 
a review of our Remuneration Policy for Executive Directors  
and its implementation and I would like to thank shareholders 
who engaged in this process.

The Committee has recommended some minor changes to the 
Remuneration Policy, and for 2023 we have introduced a new 
RoE measure for use in the annual bonus for our Executive 
Directors. The Committee is satisfied that Lancashire’s 
remuneration structures are appropriately aligned with the 
Group’s strategic priorities. Our focus remains to ensure 
appropriate reward for our people, who are the Group’s  
key asset, to deliver on our strategy.”

Irene McDermott Brown
Chair of the Remuneration Committee

Committee membership
The Remuneration Committee comprises five independent Non-
Executive Directors and the Chair of the Board. Immediately following 
the April 2022 AGM, Irene McDermott Brown assumed the role of 
Committee Chair succeeding Simon Fraser in that role. Simon Fraser  
will remain a member of the Committee until the 2023 AGM when he 
will step down as a Director, having completed nine years’ service. Jack 
Gressier was appointed as a member following his appointment to the 
Board in July 2022. Jack has extensive insurance industry management 
experience including knowledge of remuneration practice.

Committee members
Irene McDermott Brown (Chair)
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Jack Gressier 
Robert Lusardi
Simon Fraser 

Meetings attended
4/4
4/4
4/4
1/1
4/4
4/4

Principal responsibilities of the Committee
•  Sets the Remuneration Policy for all Directors and determines the 

total individual remuneration packages of the Company’s Chair, the 
Executive Directors, Company Secretary and other designated senior 
executives, to deliver long-term benefits to the Group;

•  Agrees financial and personal objectives for each Executive Director 
and the performance against these objectives for the annual bonus;

•  Determines each year whether awards will be made under the 
Group’s RSS and, if so, the overall amount of such awards, the 
individual awards to Executive Directors and other designated  
senior executives, and the performance targets to be used;

•  Ensures that contractual terms on termination or retirement, and  

any payments subsequently made, are fair to the individual and the 
Company; and

•  Oversees any major changes in employee benefit structures 

throughout the Group.

94

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

The Committee also approved the grant of long-term incentivisation 
awards under the Company’s RSS, considering a range of factors 
including the Company’s share price movement. For further discussion  
of the linkage between performance and remuneration outcomes, please 
see Irene McDermott Brown’s introduction to the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report on pages 96 and 97.

The Committee held discussions throughout the year on areas of 
developing best practice, regulation and investor expectation. The 
Committee also considered developments in guidance from several  
of the leading shareholder advisory groups.

During 2022, the Committee reviewed Executive Directors’ 
shareholdings in the context of the Company’s share ownership 
guidelines for senior/key executives. Share ownership targets have either 
been met, or progress made in accordance with guideline requirements.

The Committee continued to monitor progress made during the year on 
the implementation and alignment of remuneration practices across the 
Group and reviewed the operation of the Group’s remuneration policy. 

The Directors’ Remuneration Policy and the Annual Report on 
Remuneration, for which the Committee is responsible, can be found  
on pages 97 to 117. 

Priorities for 2023
•  To review the ongoing appropriateness and relevance of the Group’s 
remuneration structures, ensuring that they are in line with the 
Group’s business strategy, ESG strategy, changes in accounting and 
financial reporting in particular as a result of the introduction of IFRS 
17, risk profile, objectives, risk management practices and long-term 
interests of stakeholders;

•  To ensure that remuneration across the wider Group remains 

competitive and appropriate to meet the skills and staffing needs  
and staff retention requirements of the business in a period of 
significant growth and developing complexity; and

•  To work with the Group’s independent remuneration advisers to  

keep abreast of compensation levels amongst the Group’s London, 
Bermudian and other international peers, and the latest 
remuneration-related regulations, guidance and market practices.

How the Committee discharged its responsibilities
Throughout the year the Committee kept under review the Group’s 
performance and remuneration structures, in the light of investor and 
stakeholder input.

The Directors’ Remuneration Policy has a three-year term following its 
approval by shareholders at the 2020 AGM, with a majority of 88% of 
votes cast. The Committee conducted a review of the Remuneration 
Policy during the course of the year in a process which was informed by 
advice from Alvarez & Marsal on current good practice. Irene McDermott 
Brown led a shareholder consultation with major shareholders and 
several of the key shareholder governance advisory services. The 
Committee is proposing certain minor changes to the Remuneration 
Policy, which we are recommending to shareholders for approval at the 
2023 AGM. A summary of the key Remuneration Policy changes is set 
out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on page 106. Subject to 
shareholder approval of these changes the Remuneration Committee 
considers that the Policy remains fit for purpose 

The Remuneration Committee also sought shareholder feedback on a 
proposal to change the financial performance metric to be used in the 
annual bonus for Executive Directors. For 2023, the annual bonus will 
utilise a profit related RoE measure. Further details of this change are  
set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report on pages 96 and 107. 

More generally during 2022, the Committee reviewed the Group’s 
incentive packages to ensure that remuneration is structured 
appropriately in order to promote the long-term success of the 
Company. The Committee also reviewed the RSS structures for Executive 
Directors to ensure that the performance metrics continue to align the 
interests of the Company with its investors and executive management. 

The Committee considered the salary and bonus awards for the 
Executive Directors, as well as other designated senior executives, and  
in this context had regard to remuneration levels and practices across 
the workforce. The Committee and the Board discussed the outcomes  
of the staff surveys conducted during the year and the results of a gender 
pay gap data review (see the Nomination, Corporate Governance and 
Sustainability Committee report pages 86 to 89). The Committee also 
noted management actions to help mitigate inflationary pressures for 
lower paid staff and to promote a family friendly working environment 
(see page 51).

During 2022, the Committee addressed the need to review the 
remuneration package for the Group CFO on an exceptional, mid-year 
basis, and agreed to an increase in the salary for the Group CFO. Details 
of the change and the surrounding process are set out in the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report on page 96. The salary increase was also explained 
to and discussed with the Group’s major shareholders as part of the 
shareholder consultation conducted during the third quarter of 2022.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

95

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report

Annual statement

Dear Shareholder,
I am pleased to present the 2022 Directors’ Remuneration Report to 
shareholders.

As we set out at the front of this annual report, 2022 has been a year 
marked by an improving underwriting environment and strong premium 
growth in the face of another year of insurance losses and volatility in 
investment markets. Our results have been affected by the impact of 
hurricane Ian which is likely to be the second largest insured wind loss  
on record. Additionally, the conflict in Ukraine has impacted the business 
both as an insured loss and as a source of geo-political volatility, and a 
rapidly rising U.S. interest rate environment has further affected results. 
As Peter Clarke notes in his introduction on page 8, the combined ratio 
of 97.7% in the face of another year of exceptional insurance losses 
illustrates the benefits of growth and portfolio diversification which  
the Group has achieved, in particular over the last two years. With regard 
to the investment portfolio performance, as Rob Lusardi notes in the 
Investment Committee report, the rapidly increasing interest rate 
environment has resulted in material unrealised losses on the Group’s 
investment portfolio and this has had a material impact on the Group’s 
negative change in FCBVS of 6.7% for the year. However, these 
unrealised losses are expected to unwind in the relatively short term  
and the higher interest rate environment is expected to boost future 
investment returns in the investment portfolio.

In light of these factors, whilst the negative change in FCBVS of 6.7% is 
disappointing, it is principally driven by volatility in global investment 
markets and it tends to mask the strong growth and diversification which 
the Group has achieved this year in its underwriting portfolio. Moreover, 
current indications are that the strong pricing environment and growth 
opportunity will continue into 2023. Overall, as we enter 2023, the 
Group is in a strong position to maximise attractive underwriting 
opportunities in what we believe to be an improving pricing environment. 

Against this background our Group CEO’s total remuneration has 
decreased in comparison to 2021 by 21% and the Group CFO total 
remuneration has increased in comparison to 2021 by 38%, the increase 
observed is partly due to the 2020 Long Term Incentive award vesting 
which was reported in 2022. She did not receive an executive LTI Award 
in 2019 therefore she had no LTI vesting in 2021. The increase excluding 
the effect of this Long Term Incentive vesting is 16% (see the comparison 
table for single figure remuneration on page 109).

96

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Remuneration report voting outcome 2022 and 
shareholder engagement 
The Committee was pleased with the level of shareholder support for  
the remuneration report at the 2022 AGM with a vote of almost 90%  
in favour of the report.

Since the 2022 AGM, the Committee has maintained its ongoing 
engagement with shareholders and in the autumn of 2022, I led a 
shareholder consultation exercise in which shareholder feedback was 
sought, with a particular focus on the updated Remuneration Policy 
which is included in this report. Changes to the Remuneration Policy are 
modest, reflecting feedback from the engagement, and are set out at the 
end of the Policy section. The 2023 Remuneration Policy will be put to 
binding shareholder vote at the 2023 AGM, and will be applicable to 
remuneration for the three years from 2023 to 2025, inclusive.

During the consultation we also sought shareholder feedback on Policy 
implementation, in particular a proposal to simplify the financial metric 
for bonus purposes from Change in FCBVS, which has formed part of 
bonus metrics for several years, to a new measure of Return on Equity, 
which was well received. Updating the financial performance measure 
will add clarity to the bonus measures and remove the use of essentially 
the same metric in both short-term and long-term incentive awards.  
We believe that the focus on a profit measure in the annual bonus and  
a focus on capital growth in the longer term model will ensure an 
appropriate balance.

The final substantive point from the recent shareholder consultation  
was the decision taken to adjust Group CFO salary at the mid-year point 
from £406,250 to £500,000 per annum, a 23% uplift. Natalie Kershaw 
was appointed Group CFO in March 2020, as an internal appointment. 
The Committee elected to use the flexibility offered by the Policy to set 
a salary at the lower end of the market range at appointment with a view 
to adjusting the level as she developed in the role. Shareholders were 
supportive of the change to salary, but were clear that material 
adjustments should not become a regular occurrence. The Committee 
did not take the decision to make an out of cycle adjustment lightly, but 
the argument to align CFO salary with the appropriate external market 
level and thereby to mitigate retention risk in a competitive jobs market 
was compelling, and it was felt essential that this correction should be 
implemented immediately in a single move so that executive pay can 
revert to the normal annual cycle. The Committee will continue to 
consider individual performance, stakeholder experience, including  
the broader employee base, and external influences when reviewing 
Executive Director salary levels in future.

The Board and management continue to believe that there is a strong 
link between the Remuneration Policy and business strategy, which will 
be further enhanced with the introduction of an RoE profit measure for 
the 2023 annual bonus structure.

The Committee and Board intend to keep remuneration performance 
metrics under review in future to ensure appropriate focus and alignment 
of our management team with the interests of our stakeholders.

Performance outcomes for 2022 
The Executive Directors’ annual bonus performance targets for both 
financial and personal performance were stretching. The financial 
element, which made up 75% of the annual bonus opportunity, resulted 
in no bonus pay out for this element given the Company’s Change in 
FCBVS in 2022 was below the threshold. This was due to the 
combination of a challenging loss environment and volatility in our 
investment portfolio, resulting in a negative impact on our returns  
from unrealised investment losses.

In the face of these dual challenges, the Board considered that the 
Executive Directors had nonetheless performed well in achieving strong 
organic growth in underwriting premium income, in establishing and 
embedding new lines of underwriting, in managing risk within the 
business and in structuring a more diversified and resilient underwriting 
portfolio (see pages 10 and 16). The business has achieved controlled 
growth during the year and demonstrated strong operational 
effectiveness. As we note on page 15, with regard to the work performed 
during 2022 in relation to the capital requirements of the business, the 
Board also noted the dynamic action of management in continuing to 
use the full range of capital and risk management tools at its disposal to 
match the capital resources of the business to the exciting underwriting 
opportunities that developed during the year and will continue to 
develop in the current hardening pricing environment. In view of these 
factors the Board considered that our Executive Directors have continued 
to provide effective leadership, strong and targeted growth in premium 
income, an effective programme to broaden the talent base of the 
business in both underwriting and other business functions to maximise 
market opportunities and strong project management to enhance 
control and reporting systems (see page 111 for further details). 

In relation to long-term incentives for Executive Directors and other 
senior management, the 2020 Performance RSS awards were 85% based 
on annual Change in FCBVS targets and 15% on compound annual 
growth TSR targets over the three-year period to 31 December 2022. 
The Company’s TSR (calculated in U.S. dollars) for the performance 
period resulted in a compound annual rate of negative 8.8%, resulting  
in 0% vesting for the TSR component. 

The Change in FCBVS performance over the three-year performance 
period was assessed based on the change for each of the separate 
financial years as disclosed on page 112, resulting in 23.3% of this 
component of the 2020 Performance RSS awards vesting. Therefore 
overall, the 2020 Performance RSS awards vested at 19.8%. 

The Committee believes in setting challenging performance criteria and 
having a significant proportion of the overall package linked to Company 
performance. Furthermore, the Committee also continues to recognise 
the need to ensure that Executive Directors are appropriately 
remunerated and incentivised throughout every phase of the insurance 
cycle. The Board seeks to ensure that Executive Director compensation is 
structured in such a way as to discourage excessive risk to the business. 

Overall, in light of the annual and three-year performance delivered,  
the Committee notes the 19.8% vesting of the 2020 RSS and is satisfied 
that there has been sufficient linkage between performance and reward 
for Executive Directors and that the Executive Directors will not benefit 
from any windfall gains; as a result no discretion was applied to the 
formulaic outcome. The Committee will continue to ensure that there  
is appropriate alignment between executive remuneration and Company 
performance in line with the Group’s cross-cycle return expectations.

During the year, the Committee also engaged with management on 
matters of broader employee engagement and remuneration. The 
Committee was particularly supportive of the additional family friendly 
policies and the introduction of a sabbatical policy in response to 
employee survey feedback. The proposal to make one-off cost-of-living 
payments to employees and to take a tiered approach to salary increases 
to benefit those employees most impacted by rising inflation, and to 
enhance the provision of free lunches was also strongly supported.

As a Committee, we value the opportunity to hear the views of employees 
and to support management in considering feedback and implementing 
changes. It was a pleasure to join the Group CEO in thanking employees 
directly for their feedback during a recent town hall meeting.

Application of Remuneration Policy for 2023
The Committee has reviewed and discussed the remuneration structures 
to be used in 2023 in some detail. As outlined above in response to 
shareholder feedback, this included a detailed review of the performance 
metrics and the shareholder consultation, which I conducted during the 
autumn of 2022. The Committee had agreed to implement some minor 
changes to the existing structure, principally with the introduction of  
the new RoE profit measure for the 2023 annual bonus element. For  
the second year running, we have also agreed to the use of certain ESG 
linked metrics as part of the personal performance metrics to be used  
in the 2023 annual bonus. The performance metrics for the 2023 
Performance RSS awards will remain unchanged. 

The Annual Report on Remuneration provides detailed disclosure on  
how the Policy will be implemented for 2023 and how Directors have 
been paid in relation to 2022.

The disclosures provide our shareholders with the information necessary 
to form a judgement as to the link between Company performance and 
how the Executive Directors are paid. This Annual Statement, together 
with the Annual Report on Remuneration, will be subject to an advisory 
vote, and I hope that you will be able to support this resolution at the 
forthcoming AGM. As I noted above, there will also be a binding 
shareholder vote on the proposed three-year Remuneration Policy set 
out in this report at the 2023 AGM. The Committee is committed to 
maintaining an open and constructive dialogue with our shareholders  
on remuneration matters and I welcome any feedback you may have.

Irene McDermott Brown
Chair of the Remuneration Committee

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

97

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Directors’ Remuneration Policy section

As a Company incorporated in Bermuda, LHL is not bound by UK  
law or regulation in the area of Directors’ remuneration to the same 
extent that it applies to UK incorporated companies. However, by virtue 
of the Company’s premium listing on the LSE, and for the purposes of 
explaining its compliance against the requirements of the Code, the 
Board is committed to providing full information on Directors’ 
remuneration to shareholders. 

The Company’s current Remuneration Policy was approved by 
shareholders at the 2020 AGM, which is effective for a period of  
three years. 

The Committee carried out a detailed review of the current Policy during 
2022, taking into account the Code, pay and employment conditions of 
other employees in the Company and the shareholder feedback received 
during the year. Following the review, the Committee concluded that the 
current Policy continues to be in line with best practice and shareholder 
expectations. Therefore, the Committee is not proposing any material 
amendments to the Policy this year. However, some minor wording 
changes have been made to the current Policy in various sections for 
greater clarity. 

98

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

The Remuneration Policy addresses the following principles as set out in 
the Code:

•  Clarity – the Committee regularly engages with shareholders to take 
into account shareholder feedback, as it did in developing the current 
policy, to ensure there is transparency on the Remuneration Policy 
and its implementation. The Remuneration Policy has a clear 
objective: to enable the Group to attract, retain and motivate 
Executive Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company’s 
interests and to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, 
within appropriate risk parameters.

•  Simplicity – the Remuneration Policy is designed such that the 
arrangements are considered easy to communicate to all 
stakeholders. This includes variable pay which operates as an annual 
bonus plan and a single LTIP. The objective and rationale for each 
element of the Remuneration Policy is clearly explained in the  
Policy table. 

•  Risk – the Committee considers that the structure of remuneration 
does not encourage inappropriate risk-taking. The performance 
metrics used ensure remuneration aligns to the Board’s strategic 
objective which is to achieve attractive returns appropriate to overall 
risk levels across the (re)insurance market cycle. There is a mixture of 
short-term and long-term performance metrics with an appropriate 
mix of performance conditions. Clawback provisions are in place 
across all incentive plans and the Committee has the ability to use its 
discretion to override formulaic outcomes. The Committee receives  
a report from the Group CRO with regard to risk management 
developments which may be relevant to remuneration outcomes, 
and also makes inquiry with the Group’s external auditors.

•  Predictability – the range of possible reward outcomes is shown  

in the ‘Illustrations of annual application of Remuneration Policy’  
(see page 106 for full details), which demonstrates the potential 
threshold, on-target and maximum scenarios of performance and  
the resulting pay outcomes which could be expected. 

•  Proportionality – a significant proportion of pay is delivered through 
variable remuneration. No variable remuneration will be delivered  
for below threshold performance with incentives only paying out if 
strong performance has been delivered by the Executive Directors. 
The Committee has the discretion to override outcomes if they are 
deemed inappropriate to ensure a robust link between reward and 
performance.

•  Alignment to culture – the Policy has been designed to support the 
delivery of the Group’s long-term strategy, and the interests of its 
shareholders and employees. Annual bonus performance metrics 
include an assessment of whether each Executive Director’s 
contribution aligns to the Group values. The Policy seeks to 
appropriately motivate Executive Directors to deliver long-term, 
sustainable performance which benefits all stakeholders.

Governance and approach
The Company’s Remuneration Policy is geared towards providing a  
level of remuneration which attracts, retains and motivates Executive 
Directors of the highest calibre to further the Company’s interests and  
to optimise long-term shareholder value creation, within appropriate  
risk parameters. The Remuneration Policy also seeks to ensure that 
Executive Directors are provided with appropriate incentives to drive 
Company and individual performance and to reward them fairly for  
their contribution to the successful performance of the Company.

The Remuneration Committee and the Board have again considered 
whether any element of the Remuneration Policy could conceivably 
encourage Executive Directors to take inappropriate risks and have 
concluded that this is not the case, given the following:

• 

• 

• 

• 

there is an appropriate balance between fixed and variable pay, and 
therefore Executive Directors are not required to earn performance-
related pay to meet their day-to-day living expenses;

there is a blend of short-term and long-term performance metrics 
with an appropriate mix of performance conditions, meaning that 
there is no undue focus on any one particular metric;

in the case of Alex Maloney, the Group CEO, there is a high level of 
share ownership, and in the case of Natalie Kershaw, who assumed 
the role of Group CFO and Executive Director during 2020, there is 
an appropriate opportunity to acquire a longer-term equity holding 
on a measured basis, meaning that there is a strong focus on 
sustainable long-term shareholder value; and

the Company has the power to claw back bonuses (including the 
deferred element of the annual bonus) and long-term incentive 
payments made to Executive Directors in the event of material 
misstatements in the Group’s consolidated financial statements, 
errors in the calculation of any performance condition, corporate 
failure and material damage to the Group’s business or reputation  
or the Executive Director ceasing to be a Director and/or employee 
due to gross misconduct (see pages 101 to 102 for the full  
Policy details).

How the views of shareholders are taken 
into account
The Committee Chair and, where appropriate, the Company Chair 
consult with major investors and representative bodies on any significant 
remuneration proposal relating to Executive Directors. Views of 
shareholders at the AGM, and feedback received at other times, will be 
considered by the Committee. 

How the views of employees are taken into account 
The Remuneration Committee takes into account levels of pay elsewhere 
in the Group when determining the pay levels for Executive Directors. 
The Remuneration Policy for all staff is, in principle, broadly the same as 
that for Executive Directors in that any of the Group’s employees may be 
offered similarly structured packages, with participation in annual bonus 
and long-term incentive plans, although award types (restricted cash, 
restricted stock or performance shares) and size may vary between 
different categories of staff. For Executive Directors, with higher 
remuneration levels, a higher proportion of the compensation package  
is subject to performance pay, share-based remuneration and deferral. 
This ensures that there is a strong link between remuneration, Company 
performance and the interests of shareholders.

Reflecting good practice in this area, Executive Directors’ pension 
provision is the same as the standard pension contributions made  
to employees in the Group (in percentage of salary terms).

Whilst the Company does not expressly consult with employees on 
Executive Directors’ remuneration, the Board and Committee, through 
the structured arrangements for regular workforce engagement, do 
receive employee feedback, including where relevant to matters of 
remuneration. As noted above, the Committee is made aware of pay 
structures across the wider Group when setting the Remuneration Policy 
for Executive Directors. The Committee also reviews and approves the 
size of any annual bonus pot to be distributed amongst the staff 
population and the allocation of RSS awards or other LTI structures, and 
its practice in this regard is well aligned with the expectations introduced 
within the Code.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

99

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Remuneration Policy table
Fixed pay
Base salary
Purpose and link to strategy
Helps recruit, motivate and retain high-calibre Executive Directors by offering salaries at market competitive levels.

Reflects individual experience and role.

Operation
Normally reviewed annually and fixed for 12 months, typically effective from 1 January. Positioning would be assessed with due regard to market 
conditions at the time, taking into account role, experience and performance. Percentage increases would normally be aligned with the rates for  
the wider workforce, other than by exception, such as: 

•  changes to the size and complexity of the business; and

•  changes in responsibility, workload or position.

Where new appointees (whether external or internal) have been given a starting salary below mid-market level, increases above those granted to  
the wider workforce (in percentage terms) may be awarded, subject to individual performance and development in the role.

Salaries are benchmarked periodically against comparable insurance company peers in the UK, U.S. and Bermuda as these are where we would 
normally expect to recruit from or lose talent to.
Opportunity
No maximum.
Benefits
Purpose and link to strategy
Market competitive structure to support recruitment and retention.

Medical cover aims to ensure minimal business interruption as a result of illness.

Operation
Executive Directors’ benefits may include healthcare, dental, vision, gym membership and life insurance. Other additional benefits may be offered 
from time to time that the Committee considers appropriate based on the Executive Director’s circumstances.

Executive Directors who are expatriates or are required to relocate may be eligible for a housing allowance or other relocation-related expenses.

Any reasonable business-related expense can be reimbursed, including any personal tax thereon if such expense is determined to be a taxable benefit.
Opportunity
No maximum.
Pension
Purpose and link to strategy
Contribution towards funding post-retirement lifestyle.
Operation
The Company operates a defined contribution pension scheme (via outsourced pension providers) or cash-in-lieu of pension.

There is a salary sacrifice structure in the UK.

There is the opportunity for additional voluntary contributions to be made by individuals, if elected.
Opportunity
Company contribution is currently 10% of base salary. The maximum pension payable to both existing and new Executive Directors will be at a rate 
not greater than that which is available to the majority of the Group workforce.

100

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Remuneration Policy table continued
Annual bonus1,2
Purpose and link to strategy
Rewards the achievement of financial and strategic/personal targets.
Operation
The annual bonus is based on financial and strategic/personal performance.

The precise weightings may differ each year, although there will be a greater focus on financial as opposed to strategic/personal performance.

The Committee will have the ability to override the formulaic bonus outcome by either increasing or decreasing the amount payable (subject to  
the cap) to ensure a robust link between reward and performance.

At least one third of each Executive Director’s bonus is automatically deferred into shares as nil-cost options or conditional awards over three years, 
with one-third vesting each subsequent year.

A dividend equivalent provision operates enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on unvested deferred bonus shares in the form of 
nil-cost options up to the point of exercise.

The bonus is subject to clawback if:

(i) the financial statements of the Company were materially misstated or an error occurred in assessing the performance conditions of the bonus; 

(ii) the Company has suffered an instance of corporate failure which has resulted in the appointment of a liquidator or administrator or resulted in  
the Company reaching a compromise arrangement with its creditors;

(iii) the Company or the relevant business unit for which the participant works suffers damage to its business or reputation which, in the 
determination of the Committee, is at least partly due to a breach of corporate risk policies/tolerances and to a failure in the management of the 
Company or relevant business unit and to which the participant made a material contribution; and/or

(iv) the Executive ceased to be a Director or employee due to gross misconduct.
Opportunity
The maximum bonus for Executive Directors for achieving the target level of performance as a percentage of salary is 200%. Maximum opportunity  
is two times target (i.e. 400%).

Note: The Committee may set bonus opportunities less than the amounts set out above – see Implementation of Remuneration Policy section of the 
Annual Report on Remuneration.
Performance metrics
The weightings that apply to the bonus measures and the degree of stretch in objectives may vary each year depending on the business aims and the 
broader economic or industry environment at the start of the relevant year. For Executive Directors, the financial component will be at least 75% of 
the overall opportunity, and no more than 25% will be based on personal or strategic objectives.

Financial performance
The financial component is based on the Company’s key financial measures of performance. For any year, these may include (but are not limited to) 
the growth in DBVS, profit, comprehensive income, combined ratio, investment return, simple return on equity or any other financial KPI3.

Typically, a sliding scale of targets applies for financial performance targets. Bonus is earned on an incremental basis once a predetermined  
threshold level is achieved. Up to 25% of the target bonus opportunity is payable for achieving threshold performance, rising to maximum bonus  
for stretch performance.

The degree of stretch in targets may vary each year depending on the business aims and the broader economic or industry environment at the start  
of the relevant year.

Strategic/personal performance
Strategic/personal performance is based upon achievement of clearly articulated objectives, which may include ESG measures that are aligned with 
the Company’s overall purpose and strategy. A performance rating is attributed to participating Executive Directors, which determines the pay-out  
for this part of the bonus.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

101

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Remuneration Policy table continued
Long Term Incentives (LTI)
Purpose and link to strategy
Rewards Executive Directors for achieving superior returns for shareholders over a longer time frame.

Enables Executive Directors to build a meaningful shareholding over time and align goals with shareholders.
Operation2,3
RSS awards are normally made annually in the form of nil-cost options (or conditional awards) with vesting dependent on the achievement of 
performance conditions over at least three financial years, commencing with the year of grant. This three-year period is longer than the typical 
pattern of loss reserve development on the Group’s insurance business, which is approximately two years.

The number of shares to be awarded will normally be determined by reference to the share price around the time of grant unless the Committee, at 
its discretion, determines otherwise.

The Committee considers carefully the quantum of awards each year to ensure that they are competitive in light of peer practice and the targets set.

Awards are subject to clawback if there is a material misstatement in the Company’s financial statements, an error in the calculation of any 
performance conditions, the Company has suffered an incident of corporate failure, material damage to the Group’s business or reputation or  
if the Executive Director ceases to be a Director or employee due to gross misconduct.

A dividend equivalent provision operates, enabling dividends to be accrued (in cash or shares) on RSS awards up to the point of exercise.

The Committee has the discretion, in exceptional circumstances, to settle an award made to Executive Directors in cash.

The Committee has the discretion, in exceptional circumstances, to scale back RSS vesting outcomes or to impose additional vesting conditions.  
The use of such discretion should be limited to exceptional circumstances, such as a downturn in the performance of the individual or the Company 
or Group.

A two-year post-vesting holding period applies to awards made to Executive Directors (see page 109).
Opportunity
Award levels are determined primarily by seniority. A maximum individual grant limit of 350% of salary applies. 

Note: The Committee may set the normal level of award at less than the percentage set out above – see Implementation of Remuneration Policy 
section of the Annual Report on Remuneration.
Performance metrics
Awards vest at the end of a three-year performance period based on performance measures reflecting the long-term strategy of the business at the 
time of grant. 

These may include (but are not limited to) measures such as TSR, the growth in DBVS, Company profitability, or any other relevant financial or 
strategic measures.

If more than one measure is used, the Committee will review the weightings between the measures chosen and the target ranges prior to each  
LTI grant to ensure that the overall balance and level of stretch remain appropriate.

A sliding scale of targets applies for financial metrics with no more than 25% vesting for threshold performance.

For TSR, none of this part of the award will vest below median ranking or achievement of an index or a threshold target if absolute rather than relative 
TSR is used. No more than 25% of this part of the award will vest for achieving median or index or a threshold target of absolute TSR.

102

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Remuneration Policy table continued
Share ownership guidelines and requirements4
Under the guidelines, Executive Directors are expected to maintain an interest equivalent in value to no less than two times salary, to be achieved 
normally within five years of appointment. Until such time as the guideline threshold is achieved Executive Directors are required to retain no less 
than 50% of the net of tax value of awards that vest under the RSS. 

In respect of performance RSS and deferred bonus RSS awards made after 1 January 2020, there is to be a requirement on each Executive Director to 
retain 50% of the vested shares (net of tax) resulting on exercise in order to hold an interest equivalent in value of up to two times salary for a period 
of two years (or such other period or amount as the Committee may in future determine) following the date of termination of employment of the 
relevant Executive Director.

A nominee account may be established into which shares acquired under RSS awards (i.e. on exercise of (nil cost) options) will ordinarily be directed 
for the purposes of enforcing the guidelines and requirements. The Remuneration Committee shall retain a discretion to waive the requirements, in 
whole or in part, in exceptional circumstances such as death, critical illness or personal financial hardship.

In the event of a change of control (takeover) of LHL the guidelines and requirements shall cease to apply on the date of such change of control.
Chair and Non-Executive Directors’ fees
Purpose and link to strategy
Helps recruit, motivate and retain a Chair and Non-Executive Directors of a high calibre by offering a market competitive fee level.

Operation
The Chair is paid a single fee for his responsibilities as Chair. The level of these fees is reviewed periodically by the Committee and the Group CEO  
by reference to broadly comparable businesses in terms of size and operations.

In general, the Non-Executive Directors are paid a single fee for all responsibilities, although supplemental fees may be payable where additional 
responsibilities are undertaken, including a Non-Executive Director role on a subsidiary board.

Any reasonable business-related expenses (including any personal tax payable) can be reimbursed.
Opportunity
No maximum.

1.  The Committee operates the annual bonus plan and RSS according to their respective rules and in accordance with the Listing Rules. The Committee, consistent with normal 

market practice, retains discretion over a number of areas relating to the operation and administration of these plans and this discretion forms part of this Policy.

2.  All historic awards that were granted under any current or previous share scheme operated by the Company that remain outstanding remain eligible to vest based on their original 

award terms and this provision forms part of the Policy.

3.  Performance measures: these may include the KPIs shown on page 3 or others described within the Annual Report and Accounts Glossary commencing on page 191 or any other 

measure that supports the achievement of the Company’s short to long-term objectives.

4.  Share ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly-owned shares or the net of tax value of RSS awards which have vested but are unexercised and the net of tax value of 

deferred bonus RSS awards. Shares include those owned by persons closely associated with the relevant Executive Director.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

103

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Committee discretion
The Committee will operate the annual bonus plan and the LTI plan 
according to the rules of each respective plan and consistent with normal 
market practice and the Listing Rules, where relevant. The Committee 
will retain flexibility in a number of areas regarding the operation and 
administration of these plans, including, but not limited to, the following:

•  Who participates in the plans;

•  When to make awards and payments;

•  How to determine the size of an award, a payment, or when and how 

much of an award should vest;

•  How to deal with a change of control or restructuring of the Group;

• 

In the case of stated good leaver reasons or otherwise, whether a 
Director is a good/bad leaver for incentive plan purposes and whether 
and what proportion of awards vest at the time of leaving or at the 
original vesting date(s) as relevant;

•  How and whether an award may be adjusted in certain circumstances 

(e.g. for a rights issue, a corporate restructuring or for special 
dividends); and 

• 

In the event of a capital raise, whether a greater percentage of any 
annual bonus payable should be deferred, where performance metrics 
have been beneficially influenced by the capital actions taken; and 
whether the remuneration outcomes should be adjusted to limit the 
impact of such capital actions, where appropriate.

The Committee also has the discretion within the Policy to adjust targets 
and/or set different measures and alter weightings for annual bonus and 
the LTI if events happen that cause it to determine that the original 
targets or conditions are no longer appropriate and the amendment is 
required so that the targets or conditions achieve their original purpose 
and are not materially less difficult to satisfy. The Committee has the 
discretion to adjust the application of the minimum shareholding 
requirements, in role or post-cessation, to take account of exceptional 
circumstances.

Any use of exceptional discretion to override formulaic outcomes would, 
where relevant, be explained in the Annual Report on Remuneration,  
as appropriate.

Approach to recruitment remuneration
The remuneration package for a new Executive Director would be set  
in accordance with the terms of the Company’s prevailing approved 
Remuneration Policy at the time of appointment and would take into 
account the skills and experience of the individual, the market rate for  
a candidate of that experience and the importance of securing the 
relevant individual.

Salary would be provided at such a level as is required to attract the 
most appropriate candidate. The Committee retains the flexibility to  
set base salary for a newly appointed Executive Director below the 
mid-market level and allow them to progress quickly to or around 
mid-market level once expertise and performance have been proven. 
This decision would take into account all relevant factors noted above. 
Similarly, the Committee retains the flexibility to set base salary for a 
newly appointed Executive Director at above the mid-market level to 
secure an individual who is considered by the Committee to possess 
significant and relevant experience which is critical to the delivery of  
the Company’s strategy.

The annual bonus and LTI potential would be in line with the Policy. 
Participation in the annual bonus will normally be pro-rated for the year 
of joining. Depending on the timing of the appointment, the Committee 
may deem it appropriate to set different bonus performance measures 
for the performance year during which he or she became an Executive 
Director. The Committee may grant an LTI award to an Executive 
Director shortly after joining, up to the plan limits set out in the 
Remuneration Policy table (assuming the Company is not in a  
closed period).

In addition, the Committee may offer additional cash and/or share-based 
elements to replace deferred or incentive pay forfeited by an Executive 
Director leaving a previous employer. It would seek to ensure, where 
possible, that these awards would be consistent with awards forfeited in 
terms of vesting periods (which may be less than three years), expected 
value and performance conditions.

For an internal Executive Director appointment, any variable pay element 
awarded in respect of the prior role may be allowed to pay out according 
to its terms, adjusted as relevant to take into account the appointment. 
In addition, any other ongoing remuneration obligations existing prior  
to appointment may continue. 

The Committee may agree that the Company will meet certain 
relocation expenses as appropriate and is able to provide expatriate 
benefits including housing, a relocation allowance, assignment-related 
costs or tax equalisation.

104

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Service contracts and loss of office payment policy 
for Executive Directors
Notice periods for Executive Directors will normally be limited to six 
months from either the Company or from the Executive Director. In  
the event of termination, the Executive Directors would ordinarily 
receive payment up to a maximum of base salary plus the value of 
benefits to which the Executive Directors are contractually entitled  
for the unexpired portion of the notice period. The Company may pay 
statutory claims. No Executive Director has a contractual right in their 
employment terms to a bonus for any period of notice not worked. 

The service contract for a new appointment will be on similar terms as 
existing Executive Directors, with the ability to include a notice period  
of no more than 12 months from either party.

The Company seeks to apply the principle of mitigation in the payment 
of compensation on the termination of the service contract of any 
Executive Director. There are no special provisions in the service 
contracts for payments to Executive Directors on a change of control  
of the Company.

In the event of an exit of an Executive Director, the overriding principle 
will be to honour contractual remuneration entitlements and determine, 
on an equitable basis, in accordance with the relevant plan rules, the 
appropriate treatment of deferred and performance-linked elements  
of the package, taking account of the circumstances. Failure will not  
be rewarded. 

Depending on the leaver classification, an Executive Director may be 
eligible for certain payments or benefits continuation after cessation  
of employment.

If an Executive Director resigns or is summarily dismissed, salary, pension 
and benefits will cease on the last day of employment and there will be 
no further payments.

Leaver on arranged terms or good leaver
If an Executive Director leaves on agreed terms, including compassionate 
circumstances, there may be payments after cessation of employment. 
Salary, pension and benefits will be paid up to the length of the agreed 
notice period or agreed period of garden leave. 

Subject to performance, a bonus may be payable at the discretion of the 
Committee pro-rata for the portion of the financial year worked. The 
Committee has discretion to permit any bonus payable to be settled  
in cash with no deferral.

Vested but unexercised deferred bonus RSS awards will remain 
exercisable. Unvested deferred bonus RSS awards will ordinarily vest in 
full, relative to the normal vesting period. All such vested awards must 
be exercised within 12 months of the vesting date. 

Vested but unexercised RSS awards may remain exercisable for 
12 months. Unvested awards may vest on the normal vesting date unless 
the Committee determines that such awards shall instead vest at the 
time of cessation. Unvested awards will only vest to the extent that the 
performance conditions have been satisfied (over the full or curtailed 
period as relevant). A pro-rata reduction in the size of awards may apply, 
based upon the period of time after the grant date and ending on the 
date of cessation of employment relative to the three-year or other 
relevant vesting period. 

The Committee has discretion to permit unvested RSS awards to vest 
early rather than continue on the normal vesting timetable, subject to 
performance, and also retains discretion as to whether or not to apply  
(or to apply to a lesser extent) the pro-rata reduction to the RSS awards 
where it feels the reduction would be inappropriate. The Committee 
may, in its discretion, waive any post vesting holding requirement for  
any good leaver.

In respect of RSS awards made to Executive Directors after 1 January 
2020, there is a requirement on each Executive Director to retain 50%  
of the net of tax shares resulting on exercise in order to hold an interest 
equivalent in value of up to two times salary for a period of two years (or 
such other period or amount as the Committee may in future determine) 
following the date of termination of employment of the relevant 
Executive Director (see page 109).

Depending upon circumstances, the Committee may consider other 
payments in respect of any claims in connection with a termination of 
employment where deemed appropriate, including an unfair dismissal 
award, outplacement support and assistance with legal fees.

Cessation of employment in other circumstances
If an Executive Director ceases to be a Director or employee of the 
Company for any reason other than:

a.  Death;

b.  Retirement with the agreement of the Committee;

c.  Injury or disability evidenced to the satisfaction of the Committee;

d.  Change of control; or

e.  For any other reason, if the Committee at its discretion so decides 
then any outstanding RSS awards shall lapse in full immediately 
on such cessation.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

105

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Terms of appointment for Non-Executive Directors 
The Non-Executive Directors serve subject to the Company’s Bye-laws and 
under letters of appointment. They are appointed subject to re-election at 
the AGM and are also terminable by either party on six months’ notice 
except in the event of earlier termination in accordance with the Bye-laws. 
The Non-Executive Directors are typically expected to serve for up to six 
years, although the Board may invite a Non-Executive Director to serve for 
an additional period. Their letters of appointment are available for 
inspection at the Company’s registered office and at each AGM. 

In accordance with best practice under the Code, the Board ordinarily 
submits the Directors individually for re-election by the shareholders at 
each AGM. 

Legacy arrangements 
In approving the Policy, authority is given to the Company for the 
duration of the Policy to honour commitments paid, promised to be paid 
or awarded to: (i) current or former Directors prior to the date of this 
Policy being approved (provided that such payments or promises were 
consistent with any Remuneration Policy of the Company, which was 
approved by shareholders and was in effect at the time they were made); 
or (ii) to an individual (who subsequently is appointed as a Director of 
the Company) at a time when the relevant individual was not a Director 
of the Company and, in the opinion of the Committee, was not paid, 
promised to be paid or awarded as financial consideration of that 

individual becoming a Director of the Company, even where such 
commitments are inconsistent with the provisions of the revised Policy.

For the avoidance of doubt, this includes all awards granted under the 
2008 RSS rules in accordance with the Policy first approved at the 2014 
AGM and as varied at subsequent AGMs, and to employees of the 
Company who are not Directors at the date of grant. Outstanding RSS 
awards that remain unvested or unexercised at the date of this Annual 
Report and Accounts (including for current Executive Directors as 
detailed on page 113) remain eligible for vesting or exercise based on 
their original award terms.

Proposed 2023 Policy changes vs 2020
•  Clarification on normal salary positioning considerations, and when 

exceptions to this may be considered by the Committee

•  Minimum bonus deferral increased from 25% to one-third of annual 

award

•  Minor clarification points relating to potential annual bonus and  

Long Term Incentive metrics

•  Stating clearly the timeframe in which Executive Directors should 

achieve a shareholding at least equal to two times salary

•  A description of the operational and administrative areas in which  

the Committee retains discretion to take a flexible approach

•  Minor clarification points relating to the approach to recruitment  
and cessation and, particularly, the treatment of ‘bad leavers’ 

Illustrations of annual application of Remuneration Policy
The charts below show the potential total remuneration opportunities for the Executive Directors in 2023 at different levels of performance under  
the Directors’ Remuneration Policy. 

)

m
£
(
n
o
i
t
a
s
n
e
p
m
o
c

l
a
t
o
T

3.14

36.5%

36.5%

27%

0.85

100%

6.58

17%

35%

5.43

42%

42%

35%

16%

13%

Fixed pay

On-target

Maximum

Maximum +50% 
growth in shares

Group CEO

3.60

40%

44%

4.32

17%

33%

36%

2.09

34%

38%

28%
On-target

16%
Maximum

14%
Maximum +50% 
growth in shares

Group CFO

0.58

100%

Fixed pay

Fixed pay

Annual bonus

LTI awards (RSS)

LTI awards (RSS) + 50% share price growth

Fixed pay = 2023 Salary + Actual Value of 2022 Benefits + 2023 Pension Contribution.

On-target = Fixed Pay + Target Bonus (being half the Maximum Bonus Opportunity) + Target Value of 2023 RSS grant (assuming 50% vesting with 
the face values of grant). 

Maximum = Fixed Pay + Maximum Bonus Opportunity + Maximum Value of 2023 RSS grant (assuming 100% vesting with the face values of grant).

Maximum + 50% growth over performance period = Fixed Pay + Maximum Bonus Opportunity + Maximum Value of 2023 RSS grant + 50% share 
price appreciation (assuming 100% vesting with the face values of grant).

106

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Annual Report on Remuneration 

This Annual Report on Remuneration together with the Chair’s 
statement, as detailed on pages 96 to 97 and 107 to 121, will be subject 
to an advisory vote at the 2023 AGM. The following sections in respect 
of Directors’ emoluments have been audited by KPMG LLP:

•  Single figure of remuneration

•  Non-Executive Director fees

Annual bonus
For 2023, the Group CEO and the Group CFO will have a target bonus  
of 150% of salary and, therefore, a maximum opportunity of 300% of 
salary. This is within the approved policy limit and is in line with last 
year’s opportunity and represents a maximum bonus opportunity which 
is 100% of salary less than the set policy limit. 

•  2023 annual bonus payments in respect of 2022 performance

•  Long-term share awards with performance periods ending in the  

year – 2020 RSS awards

The financial and personal portions of the annual bonus will remain 
unchanged with 75% on financial performance and 25% on personal 
performance. 

•  Scheme interests awarded during the year

•  Performance and deferred bonus awards under the RSS

•  Directors’ shareholdings and share interests.

Implementation of Remuneration Policy for 2023
Base salary and fees
Executive Directors
Salaries effective from 1 January 2023 are set out below:

•  Group CEO – £764,000, a 5% increase

•  Group CFO – £525,000, a 5% increase

•  Salary uplifts for Group employees were graduated with larger uplifts 
targeted at lower paid employees with an average salary uplift of 11% 
for the lowest paid cohort and 5% for the highest paid. The overall 
average uplift for Group employees for 2023 is 8%.

Non-Executive Directors
The Chairman’s and Non-Executive Directors’ fees are as follows  
for 2023:

Financial performance (75%)
During 2022, a review of financial metrics for annual bonus purposes was 
undertaken. Shareholders were consulted on a proposal to move from 
Change in FCBVS to a simplified measure of RoE. For 2023 annual bonus, 
financial performance will be measured on the basis of simple RoE 
adjusted for unrealised gains and losses and discounting with targets  
set by reference to the RFR based on the average 13 week UST rates  
for the year as follows:

Performance
RoE equal to RFR + <5%
RoE equal to RFR + 5%
RoE equal to RFR + 8%
RoE equal to RFR + 14%

Payout level
Below threshold
Threshold
Target
Maximum

% of target bonus 
payable
0%
25%
100%
200%

R
F
R
o
t

l
a
u
q
e
E
o
R

25%

0% 
payable

100%

200%

0

+5%

+8%

+14%

•  The fee for the Board Chair (Peter Clarke) will remain at $350,000 

% of target bonus payable

per annum

•  The Non-Executive Director fee will remain at $175,000 per annum. 

Other fees
•  Simon Fraser is a Non-Executive Director of LSL in which capacity  

he will receive a fee of $100,000 per annum.

•  Sally Williams was appointed as a Non-Executive Director of LUK  

on 10 May 2022 in which capacity she will receive a fee of  
£50,000 per annum.

There shall be linear interpolation between these points. When 
considering appropriate target ranges, the Board was mindful that the 
inclusion of equity compensation charges results in RoE outcomes 
typically 1% lower than those delivered by the Change in FCBVS, where 
the equity compensation charge in the income statement is offset in 
shareholders’ equity. The agreed threshold vesting level of RFR + 5% is 
therefore 1% lower than previously applied. The performance required  
to meet target and maximum outturns has been set at the same levels  
of RoE over the RFR as previously applied to FCBVS, making achievement 
of target more challenging. In current insurance market conditions, the 
Board believes these ranges are suitably challenging and will help to 
ensure a strong link between remuneration for the Executive Directors 
and the Company’s financial performance, the strategy and risk profile  
of the business and the investment return environment, without 
encouraging excessive risk-taking.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

107

Governance 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Personal performance (25%)
This element of the bonus plan is based upon the individual achievement of clearly articulated objectives created at the beginning of each year. 

The table below sets out a broad summary of the 2023 personal objectives for each Executive Director.

Executive Director

Alex Maloney

Personal performance

Business Management and Leadership, including transformation and values.

Implementation of agreed long-term Business Strategy, designed, approved and rolled out in 2022 and continuing 
to develop the ESG strategy for the business as a whole.

Natalie Kershaw

ESG, focusing on People and Culture and further embedding environmental considerations in underwriting and 
investment portfolio management.
Business Management and Leadership, including transformation and values.

Strategic Financial Management supporting growth and transformation.

ESG, focusing on maintaining environmental considerations in investment portfolio management, ensuring fairness 
and equity in remuneration for all employees and continued strong financial governance.

Due to their close link to Business Strategy detail, personal objectives for both CEO and CFO are considered commercially sensitive at the present 
time. Detailed objectives have been presented to and approved by the Committee and will be described in the 2023 annual report.

Restricted Share Scheme
Performance conditions

For Executive Directors, 2023 RSS awards are subject to a range of 
performance conditions based on (i) annual Change in FCBVS; and (ii) 
absolute compound annual growth in TSR, both measured by reference 
to a period ending on 31 December 2025. These metrics aim to provide 
an appropriate focus on the Company’s underlying financial performance 
and cycle management, and in the case of absolute TSR to provide an 
objective reward for delivering value to shareholders.

Weighting 
For 2023, the weighting is 85% on annual Change in FCBVS and 15%  
on absolute compound annual growth in TSR.

Target ranges 
The annual Change in FCBVS target range for 2023 awards is:

• 

threshold – 6%; and

•  maximum – 13%.

Within the three-year performance period each of the separate financial 
years will be treated as a separate element, each one contributing 
one-third to the overall outcome of the vesting of this element of the 
RSS award. In each year, performance will be measured against the 
target range to determine the ultimate level of vesting in respect of 
one-third of the RSS award. Vesting will only occur after completion  
of the full three-year performance period, and continued employment  
of the Executive Director at the time of vesting. 

The relevant elements of the RSS award will not vest if annual Change  
in FCBVS is below threshold, 25% of the relevant element of the RSS 
award will vest at threshold, and 100% of the relevant element of the 
RSS award will vest at maximum. Performance between threshold and 
maximum is determined on a straight-line basis.

108

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

The TSR target range for 2023 awards is:

• 

threshold – 8% compound annual growth; and

•  maximum – 12% compound annual growth.

Absolute TSR will be measured for compound annual growth over  
the full three-year performance period rather than looking at each  
year separately.

None of the relevant elements of the award will vest if compound  
annual growth in TSR is below threshold, 25% of the award will vest at 
threshold, and 100% of the award will vest at maximum. Performance 
between threshold and maximum is determined on a straight-line basis.

Overriding downwards discretion
If any year produces a return that the Committee believes is significantly 
worse than competitors and reflects poor management decisions, the 
Remuneration Committee will use its discretion to determine the extent 
to which any relevant element of the RSS award shall vest fully (or to a 
lesser extent) based on the performance over the full three-year period.

Award levels

2023 RSS award levels are as follows:

•  Group CEO – RSS awards in respect of shares to the value of 

£2,292,000 (being 300% of salary)

•  Group CFO – RSS awards in respect of shares to the value of 

£1,443,750 (being 275% of salary)

The number of shares subject to the awards shall be determined  
based on the closing average share price for a period of five trading  
days immediately prior to the date of the award. 

Post-vesting holding period

Post-employment holding requirements

It is a term of RSS awards granted to Executive Directors that they are 
expected to hold vested RSS awards (or the resultant net of tax shares), 
which had a performance period of at least three years, for a further 
period of not less than two years following vesting.

In respect of RSS awards made after 1 January 2020, there is a 
requirement on each Executive Director to retain 50% of the net of  
tax shares resulting on exercise in order to hold an interest equivalent  
in value of up to two times salary for a period of two years (or such  
other period or amount as the Committee may in future determine) 
following the date of termination of employment of the relevant 
Executive Director.

Single figure of remuneration
The following table presents the Executive Directors’ emoluments in GBP in respect of the years ended 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021  
for time served as an Executive Director. 

Executive Directors

Alex Maloney, Group CEO

Natalie Kershaw, Group CFO

Salary  
£’000
728
700
453
391

Pension  
£’000
73
70
45
39

2022
2021
2022
2021

Taxable  
benefits4 
£’000 
8
8
7
7

Total  
Fixed pay  
£’000
809
777
505
437

Annual bonus1  
£’000 
484
394
306
264

Long-term 
incentives  
(RSS)2,3 
£’000
307
862
157
–

Total  
Variable  
pay £’000
791
1,255
463
264

Total  
‘000
1,600
2,033
968
700

The following charts set out the above disclosed 2022 total remuneration received by serving Executive Directors as a percentage of their total  
2022 remuneration. 

Alex Maloney

LTI awards (RSS): 19%

Fixed Pay: 51%

Natalie Kershaw

LTI awards (RSS): 16%

Fixed Pay: 52%

Annual Bonus: 30%

Annual Bonus: 32%

1.  Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2022 and are based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal performance on a 75:25 basis. Company 
financial performance is based on absolute financial performance against the RFRoR. The Company financial performance component did not pay out as it did not meet the 
required threshold. The final bonus payout to Executive Directors will be 22% of the maximum for the Group CEO, 23% of the maximum for the Group CFO. For full details  
of Executive Directors’ bonuses and the associated performance delivered see pages 111 and 112. 25% of the serving Executive Directors’ annual bonus is deferred into RSS awards 
without performance conditions, vesting at 33.3% per year over a three-year period.

2.  For 2022, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2020 Performance RSS awards which vested at 19.8% and are based on a three-year performance period that ended  
on 31 December 2022. The values above are based on the average share price for the final quarter of 2022, being £5.6005, and includes the value of dividends accrued on vested 
shares. 

3.  For 2021, the long-term incentive values are based on the 2019 RSS awards which vested at 48.2%, and have been restated using the share price as at the date of vesting: 

(11 February 2022) which was £5.480.

4.  Benefits shown include taxable benefits only (Private Medical, Critical Illness, Dental and Gym reimbursement). 2021 figures have been adjusted from the published amounts  

of CEO £16,102 and CFO £11,737 (which included non-taxable benefits of Life Assurance and Income Protection) to show a true comparison. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

109

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Non-Executive Directors’ fees

Current Non-Executive Directors
Peter Clarke

Michael Dawson

Simon Fraser

Jack Gressier1

Samantha Hoe-Richardson2

Robert Lusardi

Irene McDermott Brown

Sally Williams3

2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021
2022
2021

Fee  
$’000
350
350
175
175
175
175
75
–
58
175
175
175
175
118
175
175

Other 
$’000
–
–
–
–
95
80
–
–
 24
69
–
–
–
–
39
–

Total  
$’000
350
350
175
175
270
255
75
–
82
244
175
175
175
118
214
175

1.  Jack Gressier was appointed to the Board on 26 July 2022 and his fees represent his time as a Director.
2.  Samantha Hoe-Richardson stepped down from the Board on 27 April 2022 and her fees represent her 2022 tenure. Her LUK fees were paid in GBP and converted at the average 

exchange rate for the month of payment.

3.  Sally Williams was appointed to the LUK Board on 10 May 2022 and fees for LUK represent her time as a Director in 2022 and were paid in GBP and converted at the average 

exchange rate for the month of payment.

Annual bonus payments in respect of 2022 performance
As detailed in the Remuneration Policy, each Executive Director participates in the annual bonus plan, under which performance is measured over  
a single financial year. 

Bonus targets were set at the beginning of 2022 and based on a clear split between Company financial performance and personal performance on  
a 75:25 basis. The target value of bonus was 150% of salary for the Group CEO and Group CFO respectively, and the maximum payable was two  
times the target value. 

Financial performance

75% of the 2021 bonus was based on Company performance conditions and the extent to which these were achieved is as follows: 

Performance measure

Financial performance 
weighting (of total bonus) 
%

Threshold  
%

Target  
%

Max  
%

Actual performance 
%

Change in FCBVS

75 RFRoR +6%  RFRoR +8%  RFRoR +14%

(6.7)

% payout
0% of target payable in respect 
of Company performance

In 2022, the Company financial performance component paid out at 0% of target (being 0% of the maximum) as the Change in FCBVS was negative 
6.7% against a target level of RFRoR +8% and a threshold of RFRoR +6%.

110

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Personal performance

25% of the 2022 bonus was based on performance against clearly defined personal objectives set at the start of the year. 

The table below sets out a summary of the 2022 personal objectives for each Executive Director and some of the factors the Board has considered  
to determine whether the objectives have been met.

Executive Director
Alex Maloney

Personal objectives
•  Effective leadership and 

management of the senior 
executive team and the 
Group.

•  Development of the general 

business strategy.

•  To further develop and deliver 
the Group’s climate and ESG 
strategy and to lead the 
Company’s values.

Natalie Kershaw

•  Effective management of the 

finance function and 
participation in Group 
management and the Board, 
including leading the 
transition and preparations 
for the implementation of 
IFRS 17 in 2023.

•  Overall responsibility for the 

IT, Change and Data functions.

• 

Innovative contribution to 
strategic planning with 
particular focus on capital 
and business planning 
processes.

•  Climate, sustainability and 
ESG strategy and values.

Factors relevant to the Board’s determination for the 2022 performance year
•  Creation and roll-out of the long-term Group Strategic Vision; Realisation of initial 
benefits from ongoing transformation projects; Key senior executive succession 
commenced.

•  Achieving growth in GWP of 34.9% year on year; Delivery of a combined ratio of 97.7%  
in a year of substantial claims losses, demonstrating the portfolio resilience achieved 
through growth and diversification in underwriting of exposures; Focused capital 
management matched to risk appetite and strategic opportunity; Leadership of  
investor engagement.

•  Promoted the reporting line of the ESG Committee to the Group Executive Committee  
to reflect importance and focus; Joined ClimateWise and continued reporting within the 
CDP framework; Climate VaR target met.

•  Significant improvement in staff turnover and 85% participation in employee survey with 
tangible responses implemented including new family friendly policies and the creation  
of a sabbatical policy.

•  Company values are demonstrated consistently with the positive culture central to the 
roll-out of the long-term strategic vision; Production of a revised ESG framework and 
policy, forming a strong foundation for continued evolution.

•  Demonstrated diligent leadership and oversight in all aspects of financial and capital 
reporting.; Ownership and management of relationships with ratings agencies and  
brokers; Efficiencies identified and realised and strong leadership, planning and oversight 
demonstrated on IFRS 17 and 9 implementation project. 

•  Direct management of ongoing business transformation projects with 2022 delivery 

targets achieved on schedule and under budget due to a number of stretch achievements; 
Shift to a Group-wide product lines based approach to reporting and significant 
improvement in the quality of data presentation achieved.

• 

Instigated and developed a clear strategic view for the Group, and led the delivery of  
the long-term strategic plan; Improvements to production and presentation of financial 
reporting and capital metrics are ongoing, reflecting the requirements of IFRS 17 and 9.

•  Leadership by example with a strong foundation in the Lancashire values has been 

demonstrated consistently resulting in improved inter-department relationships and  
more productive working practices.

The personal targets were tailored to each of the Executive Directors, according to their respective roles and areas of personal development.

During the 2022 annual performance reviews of each Executive Director, a performance rating was assigned to determine the level of bonus payout  
for which each Executive Director was eligible for the personal performance element of the bonus.

For the 2022 performance against personal objectives, the ratings were determined following a process for the evaluation of performance of the 
Executive Directors against the agreed personal targets and discussion and agreement of the outcomes with the Chair and members of the Board with 
particular focus on those factors identified as pertinent to 2022 performance. As a result of the 2022 personal performance evaluation process for the 
Executive Directors, a bonus at 44% of target (being 89% of the maximum personal element) for the Group CEO and 45% of target (being 90% of  
the maximum personal element) for the Group CFO were awarded for the personal component. The overall 2022 bonus outcomes are expressed as  
a percentage of the maximum award as illustrated in the table below. The Board considers the business to be well positioned for the opportunities  
and challenges which lie ahead. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

111

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

A table of performance measures and total 2022 bonus achievement is set out below: 

Executive Director
Alex Maloney1
Natalie Kershaw1

Financial 
performance  
(max % of  
total bonus)  
%
75
75

Personal 
performance  
(max % of  
total bonus)  
%
25
25

Bonus %  
of maximum 
awarded  
%
22
23

Total bonus  
value  
£’000
484
306

Value of bonus  
paid in cash  
(75% of total 
bonus)  
£’000
363
229

Value of bonus 
deferred into RSS 
awards (25% of 
total bonus)1  
£’000
121
77

1.  In line with the 2020 Remuneration Policy, 25% of total bonus award will be deferred into RSS awards with one-third vesting annually, each year, over a three-year period with the 
first third becoming exercisable in February 2024, subject to the Company not being in a closed period. These awards vest on the relevant dates subject to continued employment. 

Long-term share awards with performance periods ending in the year – 2020 RSS awards
The 2020 RSS awards were based on a three-year performance period ending on 31 December 2022 and vest following the determination of financial 
results by the Board. The tables below set out the achievement against the performance conditions attached to the award, resulting in aggregate 
vesting of 19.8%. This is calculated as 23.3% vesting of the Change in FCBVS element (for 85%) and 0% vesting of the TSR element (for 15%).

Performance level
Below threshold
Threshold
Stretch or above
Actual achieved

1. Change in FCBVS
Vesting % of one third by performance year
2020 RSS Awards

Absolute compound annual growth in TSR 
(relevant to 15% of the 2020 RSS awards)

Annual Change in FCBVS 
(within the three year performance period) 
(relevant to 85% of the 2020 RSS awards)1

Performance required 
(%)
Below 8
8
12 or above
(8.8)

% vesting
–
25
100
–

Performance required 
(%)
Below 6
6
13 or above
see note1

2022
(6.7%)
0.0%
0.0%

2021
(5.8%)
0.0%
0.0%

% vesting
0
25
100
23.3

2020
10.2%
70%
23.3%

The table above shows the growth in FCBVS for the performance period and the table below shows the details of the vesting for each Executive Director. 

Executive Director3
Alex Maloney
Natalie Kershaw

Number of shares at 
grant
260,292
133,216

Number of shares to 
lapse
208,754
106,839

Number of shares to 
vest
51,538
26,377

Dividend accrual on 
vested shares value1 £ 
18,056
9,241

Value of shares 
including dividend 
accrual 2£ 
306,695
156,966

1.  Dividend equivalent accrues on awards at the record date of a dividend payment and upon exercise the cash value of the accrued dividend equivalent is paid to the employee on the 

number of vested awards net of tax required.

2.  The value of vested shares is based on the 2020 RSS awards which vest at 19.8% and are based on a three-year performance period that ended on 31 December 2022. The average 

share price rate for the final quarter of 2022 (£5.6005) is used for this calculation. 

3.  There is a two-year post-vesting holding requirement for the 2020 RSS awards for Executive Directors.

Scheme interests awarded during the year
The table below sets out the performance RSS awards that were granted to the serving Executive Directors as nil-cost options on 22 February 2022. 

Executive Director
Alex Maloney
Natalie Kershaw

Number of awards 
granted during  
the year
415,078
212,434

Face value of 
awards granted 
during the year1,3  
£
2,182,895
1,117,190

Grant date2
22-Feb-22
22-Feb-22

% vesting  
at threshold 
performance
25
25

1.  The awards were based on the five-day average closing share price following announcement of the 2021 results, being £5.259 and the awards were granted as nil-cost options.

2.  These awards are due to vest subject to performance conditions being met at the end of the performance period ending 31 December 2024 and becoming exercisable in the first 

open period following the release of the Company’s 2024 year-end results after the meeting of the Board in February 2025.
3.  The exercise share price is determined once an award has vested on the basis of the share price on the date an award is exercised.

112

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Details of all outstanding share awards 
In addition to awards made during the 2022 financial year, the table below sets out details of all outstanding awards made under the RSS held by 
Executive Directors.

Awards made under the RSS6

Grant date1

Exercise 
price

Awards held 
at 01-Jan-22

Awards granted 
during the year

Awards vested 
during the year

Awards lapsed 
during the year

Awards 
exercised during 
the year 

Awards held at 
31-Dec-22

End of 
performance 
period

Alex Maloney, Group CEO
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Total 
Natalie Kershaw, Group CFO
Non-Performance RSS5
Performance RSS2,4
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Performance RSS2,4
Deferred Bonus RSS3
Total 

22-Feb-19
22-Feb-19
21-Feb-20
21-Feb-20
19-Feb-21
19-Feb-21
22-Feb-22
22-Feb-22

15-Feb-19
21-Feb-20
19-Feb-21
19-Feb-21
22-Feb-22
22-Feb-22

– 306,915 
–
 4,656 
–  260,292 
 33,551 
–
– 313,321
43,622 
 – 
–
–
 – 
 – 
962,357

–
 12,075 
–  133,216 
– 160,356
 26,873
–
–
–
–
–
332,520

 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
–
 – 
 415,078
 18,709 
 433,787

 – 
 – 
 –
 – 
212,434
12,535
 224,969 

147,934 
 4,656 
 – 
 16,775 
 – 
 14,540
 – 
 – 
 183,905

 12,075
 – 
 – 
 8,957
–
–
 21,032

 158,981
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
 158,981 

 147,934 
 4,656 
 – 
 16,775 
 – 
 14,540
 – 
 – 

–  31-Dec-21
–

 260,292  31-Dec-22

 16,776 

 313,321  31-Dec-23

 29,082 

 415,078  31-Dec-24

 18,709
 183,905  1,053,258 

 – 
 – 
 – 
 – 
–
–
 –

12,075
 – 
 – 
8,957
–
–
 21,032

 –  31-Dec-21
 133,216  31-Dec-22
 160,356  31-Dec-23

 17,916
212,434 31-Dec-24

12,535
 536,457

1.  The market values of the common shares on the dates of grant were:

4.  The vesting of the RSS performance awards above is subject to two performance 

•  15 February 2019 £6.37 

•  22 February 2019 £6.54 •  21 February 2020 £7.61

•  19 February 2021: £6.37 •  22 February 2022 £4.93

2.  The vesting dates of the RSS performance awards are subject to being out of a closed 

period and are as follows:

•  2020 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2022 year-end 

results and

•  2021 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2023 year-end 

results and

•  2022 – first open period following the release of the Company’s 2024 year-end 

results

3.  The vesting dates of the RSS deferred bonus awards are subject to being out of a 
closed period and, for the 2020 to 2022 deferred bonus awards, are as follows:

•  2020 – vest 33.33% per year over a three-year period at the first open period 
following the release of the Company’s year-end results for 2020, 2021, and  
2022 and

•  2021 – vest 33.33% per year over a three-year period at the first open period 
following the release of the Company’s year-end results for 2021, 2022, and  
2023 and

•  2022 – vest 33.33% per year over a three-year period at the first open period 

following the release of the Company’s year-end results for 2022, 2023, and 2024.

conditions as follows: 

•  15% of each award is subject to a performance condition measuring the absolute 
compound annual growth in TSR performance of the Company over a three-year 
performance period. 25% of this part of the award vests for threshold performance 
(8% compound annual growth) by the Company, rising to 100% vesting of this part 
of the award for maximum performance (12% compound annual growth) by the 
Company or better. Performance between threshold and maximum is determined  
on a straight-line basis.

•  The other 85% of each award is subject to a performance condition based on the 
Change in FCBVS over a three-year performance period. 25% of this part of the 
award will vest if Change in FCBVS over the performance period exceeds the criteria 
set out in the table on page 114, whilst all of this part of the award will vest if the 
Company’s Change in FCBVS is equal to the more stringent criteria set out in the 
table. Between these two points vesting will take place on a straight-line basis. Within 
the three-year performance period each of the separate financial years will be treated 
as a separate element, each one contributing one-third to the overall outcome of the 
vesting of this element of the RSS award. Details of this calculation method were 
disclosed on page 79 of the 2018 Annual Report and Accounts.

5.  These RSS awards were granted to staff with no performance conditions attached. 

The awards were granted to Natalie Kershaw prior to becoming an Executive Director. 

6.  All awards made under the RSS have an expiry date of 10 years from the date on 

which they were granted.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

113

Governance 
 
 
 
 
 
Directors’ Remuneration Report continued

Absolute compound annual growth in TSR targets for RSS (15% weighting)*

100%
25%
Nil

2020
12%
8%
< 8%

2021
12%
8%
<8%

Annual internal rate of return of the Change in FCBVS targets for RSS (85% weighting)*

100%
25%
Nil

2020
13%
6%
< 6%

2021
13%
6%
<6%

2022
12%
8%
<8%

2022
13%
6%
<6%

2023
12%
8%
<8%

2023
13%
6%
<6%

 * See page 108 for the vesting methodology to be applied for the RSS awards.

Directors’ shareholdings and share interests
Formal shareholding guidelines were first introduced in 2012 and have subsequently been modified. The guidelines require the Group CEO and Group 
CFO to build and maintain a shareholding in the Company worth two times annual salary as set out in the Policy Report. 

Details of the Directors’ interests in shares are shown in the table below. 

Total as at  
1 January 2022

1,749,927
373,735
82,500 
20,000 
3,000 
N/A
5,356
28,000 
–
11,082 

Directors
Alex Maloney
Natalie Kershaw
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Simon Fraser
Jack Gressier
Samantha Hoe-Richardson 
Robert Lusardi
Irene McDermott Brown
Sally Williams

Number of common shares

As at 31 December 2022

Legally owned
910,899
77,922
82,500
20,000
3,000
–
–
48,000
–
11,082

Subject to deferral 
under the RSS
64,567
30,451
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Subject to 
performance 
conditions under 
the RSS
988,691
506,006
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Unvested and not 
subject to 
performance 
conditions under 
the RSS
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Vested but 
unexercised awards 
under other 
share-based plans

Total
N/A 1,964,157
614,379
N/A
82,500
N/A
20,000
N/A
3,000
N/A
–
N/A
–
N/A
48,000
N/A
–
N/A
11,082
N/A

Shareholding 
guideline  
achieved
726%
104%
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A

Note: Share ownership interest equivalent is defined as wholly owned shares or the net of taxes value of RSS awards which have vested but are unexercised and the net of tax value  
of deferred bonus and/or non-performance RSS awards. Shares include those owned by persons closely associated with the relevant Executive Director. 

The Committee has noted the shareholdings maintained by Natalie Kershaw during her initial period as an Executive Director and considers that 
progress in establishing a shareholding has been made in accordance with guideline requirements.

114

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Performance graph and total remuneration history for Group CEO 
The following graph shows the Company’s performance, measured by TSR, compared with the performance of the FTSE 250 Index. The Company’s 
common shares commenced trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009 and the Company joined the FTSE 250 Index on 22 June 2009 
and is currently a constituent of this.

£

300

250

200

150

100

50

0

2012

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019

2020

2021

2022

LRE LN Equity

FTSE 250 Index

Source: Datastream (Thomson Reuters)

This graph shows the value, by 31 December 2022, of £100 invested in LHL on 31 December 2012 compared with the value of £100 invested in the 
FTSE 250 Index. The other points plotted are the values at intervening financial year ends. 

The table below sets out the total single figure of remuneration for the Group CEOs over the last 10 years with the annual bonus paid as a percentage 
of the maximum and the percentage of long-term share awards vesting in each year.

Total remuneration (£000s3)
Annual bonus (% of maximum)
LTI vesting (%)

2013
6,511
80
100

20141
6,088 
80 
611

20142
1,453 
73 
50 

2015
2,511
72
75

2016
2,758
76
67

2017
1,517
17
22.5

2018
1,067
19
–

2019
2,398
80
–

2020
3,193
60
48.2

2021
2,033
19
48.2

2022
1,600
22
19.8

1.  Richard Brindle was the Group CEO from 2005 until he retired from the Group and as a Director on 30 April 2014. Mr Brindle was afforded good leaver status and all RSS award 
interests were vested upon his departure, using estimated TSR and RoE values (as then defined) at the time of his retirement. The amounts in the table above reflect all awards 
which vested in 2014. Further particulars of the vesting were reported in the Group’s 2014 Annual Report and Accounts.

2.  Alex Maloney was appointed Group CEO effective 1 May 2014, after the retirement of Mr Brindle. For the purposes of this table his numbers have been pro-rated to account for 

only his time in office as CEO for 2014. 

3.  For the years 2013 – 2020 these figures were converted to GBP using the average exchange rate for the relevant year.

The table above shows the total remuneration figure for the Group CEO during each of the relevant financial years; figures for the current Group CEO 
are shown since his appointment to the position on 1 May 2014. The total remuneration figure includes the annual bonus and LTI awards which vested 
based on performance in those years. The annual bonus and LTI percentages show the payout for each year as a percentage of the maximum.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

115

GovernanceDirectors’ Remuneration Report continued

Group Chief Executive Pay Ratio 

2022

Method
C

25th percentile  
Total Pay Ratio
24:1

Median  
Total Pay Ratio
15:1

75th percentile  
Total Pay Ratio
8:1

During 2022 the number of UK based employees of the Group exceeded 250 for the first time. The table above sets out how the single total figure  
of remuneration (STFR) for the Group Chief Executive compares to the STFR of the UK employees at the 25th percentile, median and 75th percentile. 
The table below sets out the split between total remuneration (fixed and variable pay and benefits) and the salary component of that total for UK 
employees used in the above total pay ratio calculations. Lancashire has chosen to use methodology C (as defined in the applicable regulations)  
to calculate the figures in the tables above and below.

2022

25th percentile pay ratio

Median pay ratio

75th percentile pay ratio

Total Remuneration  
(£)
65,627
24:1

Base Salary  
(£)
50,000
15:1

Total Remuneration  
(£)
107,128
15:1

Base Salary  
(£)
75,000
10:1

Total Remuneration  
(£)
196,277
8:1

Base Salary  
(£)
130,000
6:1

Lancashire uses methodology C and has used the population identified to calculate the average percentage change in remuneration based in the  
UK to identify the relevant comparator employee falling at each percentile and to calculate the annual total remuneration relating to 2022 for the 
three identified employees on the same basis as the Group Chief Executive’s annual total remuneration for the same period in the single figure table. 
Methodology C was chosen over Methodology B as, at the point of producing this report, the Group had not yet reached the threshold number of 
employees based in the UK for gender pay gap reporting.

Percentage change in Directors’ remuneration1
The following table sets out the percentage change in the aggregate value of salary, benefits and bonus for the Directors from the preceding year and 
the average percentage change in respect of the employees of the Group taken as a whole.

Executive Directors
Alex Maloney
Natalie Kershaw3
Non-Executive Directors 
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Simon Fraser
Samantha Hoe-Richardson 
Robert Lusardi
Irene McDermott Brown
Sally Williams
Employees of the parent company4
Employees of the Group

2022

2021

2020

Base salary/
Fees

Benefits2

Bonus

Base salary/
Fees

Benefits1

Bonus

Base salary/
Fees

Benefits1

Bonus

4.0
16.0

–
–
5.9
–
–
–
34.1
N/A
7.5

4.3
13.4

N/A
7.9

23.1
16.0

N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
105.0

(0.2)
16.2

(0.5)
11.1

(223.1)
(197.0)

3.1
N/A

–
N/A

(27.9)
N/A

–
–
–
–
–
N/A
–
N/A
15.2

–
–
–
–
–
N/A
–
N/A
27.5

N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
(57.9)

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
8.7

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17.5

N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
4.3

1.  The change in remuneration for employees of the Group reported in the 2020 and 2021 annual reports and shown in the table above include the effect of headcount changes.  
The figures presented for 2022 represent employees in post on 31 December 2021 and 31 December 2022 to provide a like-for-like comparison to Directors. This will form the  
basis of calculation going forward.

2.  Benefits include pension and all taxable benefits as reported on page 109 in the Single Figure on Remuneration table.
3.  The change to Natalie Kershaw’s salary in 2022 reflects salary paid including the mid-year adjustment described in the Chair’s statement on page 96. There was no change  
in her CFO salary from 2020 to 2021. The apparent increase has arisen due to her 2020 salary being pro-rated following her appointment as Group CFO on 1 March 2020. 
4.  As the parent company does not have any employees, it is not possible to provide a percentage change in their pay and therefore the comparison is to the Group as a whole.

116

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Relative importance of the spend on pay
The following table sets out the percentage change in dividends and overall spend on pay in the year ended 31 December 2022 compared with the 
year ended 31 December 2021. 

Employee remuneration costs
Dividends

2022  
$m
82.6
36.2

2021  
$m
79.6
36.4

Percentage change  
%
3.8
(0.5)

Committee members, attendees and advice
For Remuneration Committee membership and attendance at meetings through 2022, please refer to page 94 of this Annual Report and Accounts. 

The Remuneration Committee’s responsibilities are contained in its Terms of Reference, a copy of which is available on the Company’s website. 

These responsibilities include determining the framework for the remuneration, including pension arrangements, for all Executive Directors, the  
Chair and senior executives. The Committee is also responsible for approving employment contracts for senior executives.

Remuneration Committee adviser
The Remuneration Committee is advised by the Executive Compensation practice at Alvarez & Marsal Taxand UK LLP (‘A&M’). A&M was appointed  
by the Remuneration Committee during 2020. A&M has discussions with the Remuneration Committee Chair regularly on Committee processes and 
topics which are of particular relevance to the Company. 

The primary role of A&M is to provide independent and objective advice and support to the Committee’s Chair and members. The Committee is 
satisfied that the advice that it receives is objective and independent. A&M is also a signatory to the Remuneration Consultants Group (‘RCG’) Code  
of Conduct which sets out guidelines for managing conflicts of interest, and has confirmed to the Committee its compliance with the RCG Code. 

The total fees paid to A&M in respect of its services to the Committee for the year ended 31 December 2022 were $115,192. Fees are predominantly 
charged on a ‘time spent’ basis. 

Engagement with shareholders
Details of votes cast for and against the resolution to approve last year’s Remuneration Report are shown below along with the votes to approve  
the 2020 Remuneration Policy; any matters discussed with shareholders during the year, including the autumn 2022 consultation led by the 
Remuneration Committee Chair, are provided in the Annual Statement for 2022 starting on page 96. Details on the 2022 AGM vote are also  
outlined in the statement.

For 
Against
Total
Abstentions

Vote to approve 2021 Annual Report on 
Remuneration (at the 2022 AGM)

Vote to approve 2020-2022 
Remuneration Policy (at the 2020 AGM)

Total number  
of votes
162,129,911
18,531,453
180,660,364
1,018

% of  
votes cast
89.7
10.3
100.0

Total number 
 of votes
139,296,316
18,944,612
158,240,928
395,937

% of  
votes cast
88.0
12.0
100.0

Please see page 96 for the Chair’s discussion of the 2022 AGM Remuneration vote outcomes and for the proposal to submit a revised Remuneration 
Policy for the period from 2023 to 2025 inclusive for shareholder approval at the April 2023 AGM. 

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board.

Irene McDermott Brown
Chair of the Remuneration Committee

9 February 2023

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

117

GovernanceDirectors’ Report

Directors’ Report

Overview of the Group
LHL is a Bermuda incorporated company (Registered Company No. 
37415) with operating subsidiaries in Bermuda, London and Australia  
and two syndicates at Lloyd’s.

The Company’s common shares were admitted to trading on AIM in 
December 2005 and were subsequently moved up to the Official List 
and to trading on the main market of the LSE on 16 March 2009. The 
shares have been included in the FTSE 250 Index since 22 June 2009  
and have a premium listing on the LSE.

Principal activities
The Company’s principal activity, through its wholly-owned subsidiaries, 
is the provision of global specialty, catastrophe and casualty insurance 
and reinsurance products. An analysis of the Group’s business 
performance can be found in the business review starting on page 20.

Dividends
During the year ended 31 December 2022, the following dividends  
were declared:

•  a final dividend of $0.10 per common share was declared  

on 10 February 2022 subject to shareholder approval, which  
was received at the 2022 AGM. The final dividend was paid  
on 10 June 2022 in pounds sterling at the pound/U.S. dollar  
exchange rate of 1.2196 or £0.082 per common share; and

•  an interim dividend of $0.05 per common share was declared  

on 26 July 2022 and paid on 2 September 2022 in pounds sterling  
at the pound/U.S. dollar exchange rate of 1.2141 or £0.0412 per 
common share. 

Dividend policy
The Group intends to maintain a strong balance sheet at all times,  
while generating an attractive risk-adjusted total return for shareholders. 
We actively manage capital to achieve those aims. Capital management 
is expected to include the payment of a sustainable annual (interim  
and final) ordinary dividend, supplemented by special dividends  
from time-to-time. Dividends will be linked to past performance  
and future prospects.

Under most scenarios, the annual ordinary dividend is not expected  
to reduce from one year to the next. Special dividends are expected  
to vary substantially in size and in timing. The Board may cancel the 
payment of any dividend between declaration and payment for  
purposes of compliance with regulatory requirements or for  
exceptional business reasons.

Current Directors
•  Peter Clarke (Non-Executive Chair)

•  Alex Maloney (Group Chief Executive Officer)

•  Natalie Kershaw (Group Chief Financial Officer)

•  Michael Dawson (Non-Executive Director)

•  Simon Fraser (Non-Executive Director)

• 

Jack Gressier (Non-Executive Director)

•  Robert Lusardi (Senior Independent Non-Executive Director)

• 

Irene McDermott Brown (Non-Executive Director)

•  Sally Williams (Non-Executive Director)

Directors’ interests
The Directors’ beneficial interests in the Company’s common shares  
as at 31 December 2022 and 2021, including interests held by family 
members, were as follows:

Directors
Peter Clarke
Michael Dawson
Simon Fraser
Jack Gressier1
Samantha Hoe-Richardson2
Natalie Kershaw3
Robert Lusardi4
Alex Maloney5
Irene McDermott Brown
Sally Williams

Common shares 
held as at 
31 December 2022
82,500
20,000
3,000
–
N/A
77,922
48,000
910,899
–
11,082

Common shares 
held as at 
31 December 2021
82,500
20,000
3,000
N/A
5,356
41,215
28,000
787,570
–
11,082

1.  Jack Gressier was appointed to the Board with effect from 26 July 2022
2.  Samantha Hoe-Richardson ceased being a Director on 27 April 2022.  

Ms Hoe-Richardson held 5,356 shares in the Company as at 27 April 2022
3.  Includes 25,082 shares held by her spouse, Adam Burton. Natalie Kershaw  
conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2022: 
•  15 February 2022 – exercise of 21,032 RSS awards and related sale of 9,407 shares 

to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £5.32 realising £50,045.24.

•  14 March 2022 – purchase of 12,438 shares at a price of £4.02 costing £49,985.09 

by Adam Burton

•  9 May 2022 – purchase of 12,644 shares at a price of £3.95 costing £49,986.21  

by Adam Burton

4.  Robert Lusardi conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares  

during 2022:
•  11 May 2022 – purchase of 20,000 shares at a price of $5.87 costing $97,490.94

5.  Includes 181,819 shares owned by his spouse, Amanda Maloney. Alex Maloney 
conducted the following transactions in the Company’s shares during 2022: 
•  23 February 2022 – exercise of 183,905 RSS awards and related sale of 86,673 

shares to cover tax liabilities, at a price of £4.99 realising £432,680.28

•  10 March 2022 – purchase of 22,135 shares at a price of £3.84 and 3,962 shares  

at a price of £3.79 for a total costing of £99,998.25 by Amanda Maloney. 

Transactions in own shares
Pursuant to the authority granted at the AGM held on 27 April 2022, the 
Company has carried out three separate share repurchase programmes 
commencing on 16 May 2022, 8 August 2022 and 14 November 2022 
respectively and repurchasing a total of 4,589,592 common shares  
for an aggregate amount of $23.3 million. The repurchased shares  
were acquired to satisfy future exercises of awards made under the 
Group’s RSS.

118

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Under the current authority, the Company has 19,811,408  
common shares remaining to be purchased as at 31 December 2022 
(approximately $155.8 million at the 31 December 2022 share price). 
Further details of the share repurchase authority and programme are set 
out in note 19 to the consolidated financial statements on page 183. The 
authority to repurchase shares is subject to renewal at the 2023 AGM  
for an amount of up to 10% of the then issued common share capital.

Directors’ remuneration
The Directors have decided to prepare voluntarily a Directors’ 
Remuneration Report in accordance with Schedule 8 to The Large  
and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) 
Regulations 2008 made under the Companies Act 2006, as if those 
requirements applied to the Company. Details of the Directors’ 
remuneration are set out in the Directors’ Remuneration Report  
starting on page 96.

Substantial shareholders
As at 9 February 2023, the Company was aware of the following 
interests of 3% or more in the Company’s issued share capital:

Shareholder
Baillie Gifford
Setanta Asset Management 
GLG Partners 
Polar Capital
Vanguard Group
BlackRock
Invesco
Fidelity International

No. of Shares
28,663,197
24,154,461
13,998,754
11,847,231
11,361,922
11,287,888
9,607,325
8,088,204 

% of issued ISC
11.75
9.90
5.74
4.86
4.66
4.63
3.94
3.31

Corporate governance – compliance statement
The Company’s compliance with the Code is detailed in the 
Sustainability and Governance reporting sections of this Annual Report 
and Accounts on pages 44 to 46 and more particularly in Peter Clarke’s 
introduction to those sections on page 40.

The Board considers, and the Company confirms, in accordance with  
the principle of ‘comply or explain’, that the Company has applied the 
principles and complied with the provisions and guidance set out in the 
Code throughout the year ended 31 December 2022.

Health and safety
The Group considers the health and safety of its employees to be  
a management responsibility equal to that of any other function.

The Group operates in compliance with health and safety legislative 
requirements in Bermuda and the UK.

Greenhouse gas emissions and TCFD reporting
The Group’s greenhouse gas emissions are detailed in this Annual Report 
and Accounts on page 60. The Group’s TCFD Report is included in this 
Annual Report and Accounts starting on page 61.

Employees 
The Group is an equal opportunities employer and does not tolerate 
discrimination of any kind in any area of employment or corporate  
life. The Group believes that education and training for employees  
is a continuous process and employees are encouraged to discuss  
training needs with their managers. The Group’s health and safety,  
equal opportunities, training and other employment policies are  
available to all employees in the staff handbook which is located  
on the Group’s intranet.

Creditor payment policy
The Group aims to pay all creditors promptly and in accordance with 
contractual and legal obligations.

Financial instruments and risk exposures
Information regarding the Group’s risk exposures is included in the ERM 
report starting on page 26 and in the risk disclosures section starting on 
page 144 of the consolidated financial statements. The Group’s use of 
derivative financial instruments can be found on page 141.

Accounting standards
The Group’s consolidated financial statements are prepared on a going 
concern basis in accordance with IFRS as adopted by the EU. Where  
IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects 
relating to the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS framework 
allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting 
principles. In such instances, the Group’s management determines 
appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information 
to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement 
and considering U.S. GAAP.

Annual General Meeting
The Notice of the 2023 AGM, to be held on 26 April 2023 at the 
Company’s head office, Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton  
HM 11, Bermuda, is contained in a separate circular to shareholders 
which is made available to shareholders at the same time as this  
Annual Report and Accounts. The Notice of the AGM is also available  
on the Company’s website.

Electronic and website communications
Provisions of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 enable companies  
to communicate with shareholders by electronic and/or website 
communications. The Company will notify shareholders (either in  
writing or by other permitted means) when a relevant document or 
other information is placed on the website and a shareholder may 
request a hard copy version of the document or information.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

119

GovernanceGoing Concern
Based on the going concern assessment performed as at 31 December 
2022, the Directors consider there to be no material uncertainties that 
may cast significant doubt over the Group’s ability to continue to 
operate as a going concern and to adopt the going concern basis of 
accounting. The Directors have formed a judgement that there is a 
reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to 
continue in operational existence as a going concern in the foreseeable 
future, a period of at least 12 months from the date of signing the 
Group’s consolidated financial statements.

Auditors
Resolutions will be proposed at the Company’s 2023 AGM to re-appoint 
KPMG LLP as the Company’s auditors and to authorise the Directors to 
set the auditors’ remuneration. 

Disclosure of information to the auditors
Each of the persons who is a Director at the date of approval of this 
Annual Report and Accounts confirms that:

• 

• 

so far as the Director is aware, there is no relevant audit information 
of which the Company’s auditors are unaware; and

the Director has taken all the steps that he or she ought to have 
taken as a Director in order to make himself or herself aware of  
any relevant audit information and to establish that the Company’s 
auditors are aware of that information.

Approved by the Board of Directors and signed on behalf of the Board. 

Christopher Head
Company Secretary

9 February 2023

Directors’ Report continued

Going concern and viability statement
The performance review section starting on page 20 sets out details  
of the Group’s financial performance, capital management, business 
environment and outlook. In addition, further discussion of the principal 
risks and material uncertainties affecting the Group can be found on 
pages 30 to 37. Starting on page 144 the risk disclosures section of the 
consolidated financial statements sets out the principal risks to which 
the Group is exposed, including insurance, climate change, pandemic, 
market, liquidity, credit, operational and strategic, together with the 
Group’s policies for monitoring, managing and mitigating its exposures 
to these risks. Further details of the Group’s scenario testing and 
resilience to climate change risk can be found in the TCFD Report 
starting on page 61.

The Board considers annually and on a rolling basis, a strategic plan for 
the business which the Company progressively implements. The strategic 
plan approved by the Board at its meeting on 26 July 2022 covered the 
five-year period, including the current year, from 2022 to 2026 as well  
as a longer term strategic plan towards the year 2030. The Board also 
approved at its meeting on 2 November 2022 a management proposal 
for a more detailed three-year business forecast covering 2023 to 2025, 
which (as in 2022 and prior years) will be revised and reviewed by the 
Board at each of its quarterly meetings throughout 2023. The three year 
business plan period aligns to the predominantly short-tail nature of  
the Group’s liabilities and the agility in the business model, allowing  
the Group to adapt capital and solvency quickly in response to market 
cycles, events and opportunities. This is consistent with the outlook 
period in the Group’s ORSA report. The Board receives quarterly  
reports from the Group CRO and sets, approves and monitors  
risk tolerances for the business.

During 2022, the Board carried out a robust assessment of the principal 
risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business 
model, future performance, solvency or liquidity. As part of this 
assessment the business plan was stressed for a number of severe but 
plausible scenarios and the impact on capital evaluated. As we note in 
the Audit Committee report on page 80 and throughout this Annual 
Report and Accounts, the Board had a particular focus on the impacts  
of the conflict in Ukraine and a number of major natural catastrophe  
loss events, including the U.S. hurricane Ian. The Board also continued  
to monitor the ongoing volatility in the global investment markets.  
The Audit Committee also considered a formal and thorough `going 
concern’ analysis from management at both its July 2022 and February 
2023 meetings (for further details see page 85 in the Audit Committee 
report). The Directors believe that the Group is well placed to manage  
its business risks successfully, having considered the current economic 
outlook. Accordingly, the Board has a reasonable expectation that,  
taking into account the Group’s current position, and subject to the 
principal risks faced by the business, the Group will be able to continue  
in operation and to meet its liabilities as they fall due for the period up  
to 31 December 2025, being the period considered under the Group’s 
current three-year business plan.

120

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Statement of Directors’ Responsibilities

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and 
Accounts and the Group’s consolidated financial statements in 
accordance with applicable law and regulations.

Company law requires the Directors to prepare financial statements for 
each financial year that give a true and fair view of the state of affairs  
of the Group and of the profit or loss of the Group for that year. The 
consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance 
with IFRS as adopted by the EU. Where IFRS, as adopted by the EU, is 
silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement  
of insurance products, the IFRS framework allows reference to another 
comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the 
Group’s management determines appropriate measurement bases  
to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated 
financial statements, using their judgement and considering U.S. GAAP. 
Further detail on the basis of preparation is described in the consolidated 
financial statements.

In preparing the consolidated financial statements, the Directors are 
required to:

• 

select suitable accounting policies and apply them consistently;

•  make judgements and accounting estimates that are reasonable, 

relevant and reliable;

• 

• 

state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRS  
as adopted by the EU;

state whether applicable accounting standards have been followed, 
subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the 
Group’s consolidated financial statements;

•  provide additional disclosures where compliance with the specific 
requirements of IFRS as adopted by the EU are considered to be 
insufficient to enable users to understand the impact of particular 
transactions, events and conditions on the financial position and 
performance;

•  assess the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern, disclosing, 

as applicable, matters related to going concern; and

•  use the going concern basis of accounting unless they either intend  
to liquidate the Group or to cease operations or have no realistic 
alternative but to do so.

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records 
that are sufficient to show and explain the Group’s transactions and 
disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of 
the Group, and enable them to ensure that the consolidated financial 
statements comply with applicable laws and regulations. They are also 
responsible for such internal control as they determine is necessary to 
enable the preparation of the consolidated financial statements that are 
free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and also 
have general responsibility for safeguarding the assets of the Group, and 
hence for taking reasonable steps for prevention and detection of fraud 
and other irregularities.

Directors’ responsibility statement
The Directors confirm that to the best of their knowledge:

• 

• 

• 

the consolidated financial statements, prepared in accordance with 
IFRS as adopted by the EU, give a true and fair view of the assets, 
liabilities, financial position and profit of the Group;

the Board considers the Annual Report and Accounts, taken as  
a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the 
information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s  
position and performance, business model and strategy; and

the strategy and the business review sections of this Annual Report 
and Accounts include a fair review of the development and 
performance of the business and the position of the Group,  
together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties 
that the Group faces.

Legislation in Bermuda governing the preparation and dissemination of 
the consolidated financial statements may differ from legislation in other 
jurisdictions. In addition, the rights of shareholders under Bermuda law 
may differ from those for shareholders of companies incorporated in 
other jurisdictions.

By order of the Board

9 February 2023

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

121

GovernanceIndependent Auditor’s Report to the Members of Lancashire Holdings Limited

1. Our opinion is unmodified 
We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Lancashire Holdings Limited (“the Group”) for the year ended 31 December 2022  
which comprise the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, the consolidated balance sheet, the consolidated statement of changes  
in shareholders’ equity, the statement of consolidated cash flows, and the related notes, including the accounting policies on pages 136 to 143  
of this Annual Report and Accounts. 

In our opinion: 

• 

• 

the consolidated financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of the Group’s affairs as at 31 December 2022 and of the Group’s loss 
for the year then ended; and

the consolidated financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted  
by the European Union.

Basis for opinion 

We conducted our audit in accordance with International Standards on Auditing (UK) (“ISAs (UK)”) and applicable law. Our responsibilities are 
described below. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is a sufficient and appropriate basis for our opinion. We have fulfilled our ethical 
responsibilities under, and we remain independent of, the Group in accordance with UK ethical requirements including the FRC Ethical Standard as 
applied to other listed entities. 

2. Key audit matters: our assessment of risks of material misstatement 
Key audit matters are those matters that, in our professional judgement, were of most significance in the audit of the consolidated financial 
statements and include the most significant assessed risks of material misstatement (whether or not due to fraud) identified by us, including those 
which had the greatest effect on: the overall audit strategy; the allocation of resources in the audit; and directing the efforts of the engagement team. 
These matters were addressed, in the context of our audit of the consolidated financial statements as a whole, and in forming our opinion thereon  
and we do not provide a separate opinion on these matters. In arriving at our audit opinion above, the key audit matters, in decreasing order of audit 
significance, were as follows: 

122

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Valuation of insurance contract liabilities for losses and loss adjustment expenses of IBNR on a gross and net of outwards 
reinsurance basis

(2022: $1,780.8 million gross, $1,188.7 million net of outwards reinsurance, of which incurred but not reported represented $1,069.8 million gross, 
$609.9 million net of outwards reinsurance; 2021: $1,291.1 million gross, $872.3 million net of outwards reinsurance, of which incurred but not 
reported (IBNR) represented $664.2 million gross, $364.1 million net of outwards reinsurance). 

Refer to pages 80 to 85 (Audit Committee report), page 140 (accounting policy) and pages 177 to 179 (financial disclosures)

Risk vs 2021: <>
The risk
The Group maintains insurance contract liabilities 
to cover the estimated ultimate cost of settling all 
losses and loss adjustment expenses arising from 
events including any arising from the Ukraine 
conflict which have occurred up to the balance 
sheet date, regardless of whether those losses 
have been reported to the Group.

Subjective valuation:
Insurance contract liabilities represent the single 
largest liability for the Group. Valuation of the 
incurred, but not reported, liabilities is highly 
judgmental because it requires a number of 
assumptions to be made with high estimation 
uncertainty such as initial expected loss ratios, 
estimates of ultimate premium, claim development 
patterns, inflation and rate changes. The 
determination and application of the methodology 
and performance of the calculations are also 
complex. These judgmental and complex 
calculations for insurance contract liabilities are  
also used to derive the valuation of the related 
reinsurance assets.

In setting the provision for insurance contract 
liabilities, an allowance is made for specific risks. 
The determination of the allowance is a subjective 
judgement based on the perceived uncertainty 
and potential for volatility in the underlying 
claims. We consider the uncertainty to be elevated 
in the current year as a result of the judgement 
required in respect of potential claim scenarios 
that could arise in respect of the Ukraine conflict.

The effect of these matters is that, as part of our 
risk assessment, we determined that valuation of 
gross and net insurance contract liabilities for losses 
and loss adjustment expenses has a high degree of 
estimation uncertainty, with a potential range of 
reasonable outcomes greater than our materiality 
for the consolidated financial statements as a 
whole, and possibly many times that amount.  
The consolidated financial statements (note 13) 
disclose the sensitivity estimated by the Group.

Our response
We have used our own actuarial specialists to assist us in performing our procedures in  
this area.

Our procedures included:

Controls design and implementation
Evaluating and testing the design and implementation of key controls over the 
appropriateness of the methodology, actuarial assumptions and data used in the valuation 
process of insurance contract liabilities. 

Assessment of assumptions and methodology
Assessing and challenging the reserving assumptions and methodology (on a gross and net  
of outwards reinsurance basis) based on our understanding of the reserving policy within the 
Group. This has also involved comparing the Group’s reserving methodology with industry 
practice and understanding the rationale for any key differences. 

We have also specifically assessed the methodology employed to determine potential losses 
that could arise in respect of the Ukraine conflict.

Historical experience
Challenging the quality of the Group’s historical reserving estimates by monitoring the 
development of losses against initial estimates.

Independent re-projections
Applying our own assumptions, across all attritional classes of business, to perform re-
projections on the insurance contract liabilities on both a gross and net of outwards reinsurance 
basis and comparing these to the Group’s projected results including any allowance for specific 
risks. Where there were significant variances in the results, we have challenged the Group’s 
assumptions with respect to selected initial expected loss ratios and inflation.

Data reconciliations
Assessing the completeness and accuracy of the data used within the reserving process  
by reconciling the actuarial source data to the financial systems. 

Sector experience and benchmarking of large losses
Assessing and challenging the reserving assumptions by comparing the Group’s loss 
experience to peers in the market, on a gross and net of outwards reinsurance basis,  
including on a contract by contract basis for large loss and catastrophe events. A large  
loss is defined as a single loss or event greater than $5m on a gross ultimate basis. 

We performed the tests above over the valuation rather than seeking to rely on the  
Group’s controls because the nature of the balance is such that we would expect to  
obtain audit evidence primarily through the detailed procedures described. 

Assessing transparency
Considering the adequacy of the Group’s disclosures in respect of the valuation of  
insurance liabilities.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

123

Financial StatementsIndependent Auditor’s Report to the Members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued

Valuation of premiums receivable from insureds and cedants which are estimated (related to one component of the Group, 
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited “LICL”)

(2022: $688.3 million, 2021: $490.6 million) A portion of inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are estimated and relate to LICL. 

Refer to pages 80 to 85 (Audit Committee report), page 140 (accounting policy) and page 180 (financial disclosures)

Our response
Our procedures over the LICL EPI balances in the consolidated financial 
statements included:

Controls design and implementation
Evaluating and testing the design and implementation of key  
controls over the initial recording and periodic review of premium 
estimates booked. 

Tests of detail
Assessing estimated premium balances for a sample of policies, by 
corroborating to third party supporting evidence or signed contracts. 

Independent re-projections
Using our own actuarial specialist, performing reprojections of the 
ultimate premium on a sample of mortgage contracts and comparing 
these to the Group’s projected ultimate premium estimates. 

Retrospective analysis
Assessing the Group’s past expertise in making premium estimates by 
comparing the estimates and actuals for prior year estimated debtor 
balance for a sample of policies.

We performed the tests above over the valuation rather than seeking  
to rely on the Group’s controls because the nature of the balance is  
such that we would expect to obtain audit evidence primarily through 
the detailed procedures described. 

Assessing transparency
Considering the adequacy of the Group’s disclosures in respect of  
the valuation of premiums which are estimated.

Risk vs 2021: <>
The risk
Subjective valuation:
A material proportion of premiums written through the syndicates 
(LSL), UK and Bermudan insurers (LUK and LICL), is based on a best 
estimate of ultimate premiums. Judgement is involved in determining 
the ultimate estimates in order to establish the appropriate premium 
value and, ultimately, the cash to be received. As updated information  
is received over the life of the contract, adjustments are made to  
the premium recognised with inwards premiums receivable from 
insureds and cedants recorded on the consolidated balance sheet  
at the year end.

Adjustments are made to gross premiums written to reflect the 
underlying adjustment to ultimate premium estimates such as 
declarations received on binding authority contracts, reinstatement 
premiums on reinsurance contracts and other routine adjustments  
to premium income due to policy amendments.

We consider the judgement and the estimation uncertainty to be 
significant within LICL as there is limited historical data to assess 
management’s past accuracy of estimating premium income (“EPI”) 
within LICL and the EPI monitoring process within LICL is newly 
established. We note that LICL increased its revenue from existing  
and new lines of business in the year. For LUK and LSL, although we 
continue to perform procedures over the estimated premium receivable, 
we did not identify significant subjectivity and estimation uncertainty 
within these balances as part of our risk assessment, and therefore  
have not assessed these as a significant risk in our current year audit. 

The effect of these matters is that, as part of our risk assessment, we 
determined that the valuation of inwards premiums receivable from 
insureds and cedants at the year-end related to the LICL balances in  
the consolidated Group balance sheet has a high degree of estimation 
uncertainty, with a potential range of reasonable outcomes greater  
than our materiality for the consolidated financial statements as a 
whole, and possibly many times that amount

It should however be noted that it is only a portion of the inwards 
premiums receivable from insureds and cedants balance (and of  
total gross premiums written in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income) that is subject to this valuation risk.

124

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Valuation of level 3 investments

(2022: $215.1 million, 2021: $212.5 million)

Refer to pages 80 to 85 (Audit Committee report), page 141 (accounting policy) and pages 172 to 175 (financial disclosures)

Risk vs 2021: <>
The risk
A proportion of the Group’s invested assets comprise holdings in hedge 
funds and private investment funds which are classified as level 3 
investments. 

The valuations of these investments are based on the relevant fund 
managers’ valuation reports. These assets are inherently harder to  
value due to the inability to obtain a market price of these assets  
as at the balance sheet date. 

The effect of these matters is that, as part of our risk assessment, we 
determined that valuation of level 3 investments has a high degree of 
estimation uncertainty, with a potential range of reasonable outcomes 
greater than our materiality for the consolidated financial statements as 
a whole, and possibly many times that amount.

Our response
Our procedures included:

Control design and implementation
Evaluating and testing the design and implementation of the controls 
associated with the valuation of level 3 investments. 

Comparing valuations
Obtaining the latest fund managers’ valuation reports and comparing 
them to the valuations recorded by the Group as at year end to assess 
for any material valuation differences.

Benchmarking hedge funds & private debt funds
Understanding the strategy for each investment fund held by the Group 
to identify relevant comparable indices and comparing their valuations 
with the hedge funds and private investment funds held by the Group. 
Where this benchmarking identifies a material difference we investigate 
the possible reasons for differences and assess if any adjustment is 
required at the year-end.

Historical accuracy
Retrospectively assessing the historical accuracy of the valuations used 
by the Group by comparing interim fund manager valuation reports  
to the final year-end reports for prior periods. Where this identifies  
a material difference we investigate the reasons for differences and 
evaluate the reliability of management’s valuation process and their 
historic ability to estimate the year end valuation. 

We performed the tests above over the valuation rather than seeking  
to rely on the Group’s controls because the nature of the balance is  
such that we would expect to obtain audit evidence primarily through 
the detailed procedures described. 

Assessing transparency
Considering the adequacy of the Group’s disclosures in respect of the 
valuation of level 3 investments.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

125

Financial StatementsIndependent Auditor’s Report to the Members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued

3. Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit 
Materiality for the consolidated financial statements as a whole was set at $12.0 million (2021: $9.7 million), determined with reference to a 
benchmark of gross premiums written (2021: gross premiums written), of which it represents 0.7% (2021: 0.8%). We consider gross premiums written 
to be the most appropriate benchmark given the size and complexity of the business as it provides a stable measure year on year. We also compared 
our materiality against other relevant benchmarks (total assets, net assets and loss before tax) to ensure the materiality selected was appropriate for 
our audit. 

In line with our audit methodology, our procedures on individual account balances and disclosures were performed to a lower threshold: performance 
materiality, so as to reduce to an acceptable level the risk that individually immaterial misstatements in individual account balances add up to a 
material amount across the consolidated financial statements as a whole. 

Performance materiality was set at 75% (2021: 75%) of materiality for the consolidated financial statements as a whole, which equates to $9.0 million 
(2021: $7.2 million). We applied this percentage in our determination of performance materiality because we did not identify any factors indicating an 
elevated level of risk. 

We agreed to report to the Audit Committee any corrected or uncorrected identified misstatements exceeding $0.56 million (2021: $0.4 million),  
in addition to other identified misstatements that warranted reporting on qualitative grounds. 

We were able to rely upon the Group’s internal control over financial reporting in several areas of our audit, where our controls testing supported  
this approach, which enabled us to reduce the scope of our substantive audit work; in the other areas the scope of the audit work performed was  
fully substantive.

Of the Group’s ten (2021: nine) reporting components, we subjected five (2021: five) to full scope audits for Group purposes which were the parent 
company (LHL), UK insurance company (LUK), Bermudan insurance company (LICL), UK service entity (LISL) and the Group’s participation in Lloyd’s 
Syndicate 2010 and 3010. Including the audit of the consolidation adjustments, our scope covered 100% (2021: 100%) of gross premiums written, 
total assets and total liabilities. 

For the residual components, we performed analysis at an aggregated group level to re-examine our assessment that there were no significant risks  
of material misstatement within these.

The Group team instructed component auditors as to the significant areas to be included within audit scope, including the relevant risks detailed  
above and the information to be reported back. 

The Group team determined the component materialities, which ranged from $3.0 million to $8.9 million (2021: $2.4 million to $8.0 million),  
having regard to the mix of size and risk profile of the Group across the components. 

The work on four of the five full scope components (2021: four of the five components) was performed by component auditors with the audit  
of the parent company performed by the Group team. 

In working with component auditors, we:

•  Held planning calls with component audit teams to discuss the significant areas of the audit relevant to the components; 

• 

Issued group audit instructions to component auditors on the scope of their work; 

•  Held risk assessment update discussions with the component audit teams before the commencement of the final phases of the audit led by  

the Group engagement partner and engagement quality control partner; 

•  Visited Bermuda and UK (2021: UK) components in-person as the audit progressed to understand and challenge the audit approach and organised 
video conferences with the partners and directors of the Group and component audit teams. At these visits and video conferences, the findings 
reported to the Group team were discussed in more detail, and any further work required by the Group team was then performed by the 
component audit teams;

• 

Inspected component audit teams’ key work papers in person and/or using remote technology capabilities to evaluate the quality of execution  
of the audits of the components.

4. The impact of climate change on our audit
In planning our audit, we performed a risk assessment, including enquiries of management, to determine how the impact of commitments made by 
the Group in respect of the transition to net zero carbon emissions, as well as the physical risks of climate change, and transition risks faced by the 
Group’s customer base, could impact on the financial statements and our audit. We held discussions with our own climate change professionals to 

126

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

challenge our risk assessment. Through the procedures we performed, we did not identify any material impact of climate change on the Group’s 
material accounting estimates and there was no significant impact of this assessment on our key audit matters.

The Group predominantly underwrites short-tail catastrophe risks. Climate change may result in an increase in the frequency and severity of 
climate-related catastrophe events, leading to higher insurance pay-outs. However, the short-term nature of the Group’s insurance contracts means 
that the impact of losses from catastrophes for the year ended 31 December 2022 is already recorded within the group’s insurance contract liabilities 
at the balance sheet date. The Group considers this loss experience in evaluating individual risk exposures, and the setting of insurance premium rates 
for both new policies and the periodic renewal of its existing insurance underwriting portfolio. The Group expects any increase in the frequency and 
severity of climate-related catastrophe events to be reflected in future market premium rates. These considerations are factored into the Group’s 
going concern assessments, in the assessment of which the Group performed a specific climate change stress scenario. 

The Group also holds investments and assesses climate risk exposure within the portfolio. Given the predominantly short-term nature of these 
investments, we have assessed that there is no significant risk related to climate with regards to the valuation of these investments at the balance 
sheet date. 

Taking into account the extent of the headroom of the recoverable amount over the carrying amount of the cash generating units, including the 
Group’s intangible assets with indefinite useful lives, we assessed the risk of climate change to the carrying amount of these assets at the balance 
sheet date to be not significant. 

We have read the disclosures of climate related information in the Annual Report and Accounts and considered their consistency with the 
consolidated financial statements and our audit knowledge. We have not been engaged to provide assurance over the accuracy of the climate risk 
disclosures in the Annual Report and Accounts.

5. Going concern
The directors have prepared the consolidated financial statements on the going concern basis as they do not intend to liquidate the Group or to  
cease their operations, and as they have concluded that the Group’s financial position means that this is realistic. They have also concluded that  
there are no material uncertainties that could have cast significant doubt over their ability to continue as a going concern for at least a year from  
the date of approval of the consolidated financial statements (“the going concern period”). 

We used our knowledge of the Group, its industry, and the general economic environment to identify the inherent risks to its business model and 
analysed how those risks might affect the Group’s financial resources or ability to continue operations over the going concern period. The risk that  
we considered most likely to adversely affect the Group’s available financial resources over this period was the valuation of insurance contract 
liabilities, given the estimation and judgement involved in setting these reserves. 

We also considered less predictable but realistic second order impacts that could affect demand in the Group’s markets, such as the impact of climate 
change on the Group’s results and operations, the performance of the investment portfolio, credit ratings for key insurance subsidiaries, solvency and 
capital adequacy.

We considered whether these risks could plausibly affect the liquidity and solvency in the going concern period by comparing severe, but plausible 
downside scenarios and the degree of downside changes in assumptions that, individually and collectively, could result in a liquidity and solvency  
issue taking into account the Group’s current and projected financial resources (a reverse stress test).

We considered whether the going concern disclosure on page 136 of the consolidated financial statements gives a full and accurate description  
of the Directors’ assessment of going concern, including the identified risks and dependencies.

Our conclusions based on this work:

•  we consider that the directors’ use of the going concern basis of accounting in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements is 

appropriate;

•  we have not identified, and concur with the directors’ assessment that there is not, a material uncertainty related to events or conditions that, 
individually or collectively, may cast significant doubt on the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern for the going concern period; and

•  we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to the directors’ statement on page 121 of the consolidated financial statements 
on the use of the going concern basis of accounting with no material uncertainties that may cast significant doubt over the Group’s use of that 
basis for the going concern period, and we found the going concern disclosure on page 136 to be acceptable

However, as we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events may result in outcomes that are inconsistent with judgements 
that were reasonable at the time they were made, the above conclusions are not a guarantee that the Group will continue in operation. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

127

Financial StatementsIndependent Auditor’s Report to the Members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued

6. Fraud and breaches of laws and regulations – ability to detect
Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to fraud 

To identify risks of material misstatement due to fraud (“fraud risks”) we assessed events or conditions that could indicate an incentive or pressure  
to commit fraud or provide an opportunity to commit fraud. Our risk assessment procedures included: 

•  Enquiring of Directors, the Audit Committee, Internal Audit, the Risk function, Head of Group legal and the Company Secretary, together with 
inspection of policy documentation, as to the Group’s high-level policies and procedures to prevent and detect fraud, including the internal  
audit function, and the Group’s channel for “whistleblowing”, as well as whether they have knowledge of any actual, suspected or alleged fraud; 

•  Reading Board and Audit Committee minutes; 

•  Considering remuneration incentive schemes and performance conditions for management remuneration which includes the annual change  

in fully converted book value per share and absolute total shareholder return; 

•  Using analytical procedures to identify any unusual or unexpected relationships. 

We communicated identified fraud risks throughout the audit team and remained alert to any indications of fraud throughout the audit. This included 
communications from the Group to full scope component audit teams of relevant fraud risks identified at the Group level and requests to full scope 
component audit teams to report to the Group audit team any instances of fraud that could give rise to a material misstatement at the Group level. 

As required by auditing standards, and taking into account possible pressures to meet profit targets, recent revisions to guidance and our overall 
knowledge of the control environment, we perform procedures to address the risk of management override of controls and the risk of fraudulent 
revenue recognition, in particular the risk that management may be in a position to make inappropriate accounting entries and the risk of bias in 
accounting estimates and judgements such as the portion of premium which is estimated. 

We also identified a fraud risk in relation to the following area: 

•  The valuation of insurance contract liabilities due to the estimation required in setting these liabilities and the ability for changes in the valuation  

to be used to impact profit.

Further detail in respect of our procedures around the valuation of insurance contract liabilities and the valuation of premiums which are estimated  
is set out in the key audit matter disclosures in section 2 of this independent auditor’s report. The Audit Committee report on pages 80 to 85 also 
references the entity level controls in operation across the Group.

In determining the audit procedures we took into account the results of our evaluation and testing of the operating effectiveness of some of the 
Group-wide fraud risk management controls. In order to address the risk of fraud specifically as it relates to the valuation of insurance contract 
liabilities, we involved actuarial specialists to assist in our challenge of management. We challenged management in relation to the selection of 
assumptions and the consistency of those assumptions both year on year and across different aspects of the financial reporting process. 

With respect to the valuation of premiums receivable which are estimated, we evaluated and tested the design and implementation of key controls 
over the periodic review of premium estimates booked and assessed estimated premium balances for a sample of policies, including consideration  
of the basis of estimation, and consistency in estimation methodology over time.

We also performed procedures including: 

• 

Identifying journal entries and other adjustments to test for all full scope components based on risk criteria and comparing the identified entries  
to supporting documentation. These included those posted by individuals who do not frequently post journals, those posted with descriptions 
containing key words or phrases, those posted to unusual accounts including those related to cash, consolidation journals and post-closing  
journals meeting certain criteria.

128

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Identifying and responding to risks of material misstatement due to non-compliance with laws and regulations 

We identified areas of laws and regulations that could reasonably be expected to have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements from 
our general commercial and sector experience, through discussion with the Directors and other management (as required by auditing standards), from 
inspection of the Group’s regulatory and legal correspondence and discussed with the Directors and other management the policies and procedures 
regarding compliance with laws and regulations. 

As certain entities within the Group are regulated, our assessment of risks involved gaining an understanding of the control environment including  
an entity’s procedures for complying with regulatory requirements. This was achieved through the procedures noted above. 

We communicated identified laws and regulations throughout our team and remained alert to any indications of non-compliance throughout the 
audit. This included communication from the Group audit team to full-scope component audit teams of relevant laws and regulations identified at  
the Group level, and a request for full scope component auditors to report to the Group audit team any instances of non-compliance with laws and 
regulations that could give rise to a material misstatement at the Group level. 

The potential effect of these laws and regulations on the consolidated financial statements varies considerably. 

Firstly, the Group is subject to laws and regulations that directly affect the consolidated financial statements including financial reporting legislation 
(including related companies legislation), distributable profits legislation, taxation legislation and regulatory capital, solvency and liquidity regulations 
and we assessed the extent of compliance with these laws and regulations as part of our procedures on the related financial statement items. 

Secondly, the Group is subject to many other laws and regulations where the consequences of non-compliance could have a material effect on 
amounts or disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, for instance through the imposition of fines, litigation or loss of regulatory approval 
to write insurance contracts. We identified the following areas as those most likely to have such an effect: anti-bribery and certain aspects of company 
legislation, recognising the financial and regulated nature of certain of the Group’s activities and its legal form. Auditing standards limit the required 
audit procedures to identify non-compliance with these laws and regulations to enquiry of the Directors and other management and inspection of 
regulatory and legal correspondence, if any. Therefore, if a breach of operational regulations is not disclosed to us or evident from relevant 
correspondence, an audit will not detect that breach. 

We discussed with the Audit Committee and those charged with governance matters related to actual or suspected breaches of laws or regulations, 
for which disclosure is not necessary, and considered any implications for our audit. 

Context of the ability of the audit to detect fraud or breaches of law or regulation 

Owing to the inherent limitations of an audit, there is an unavoidable risk that we may not have detected some material misstatements in the 
consolidated financial statements, even though we have properly planned and performed our audit in accordance with auditing standards. For 
example, the further removed non-compliance with laws and regulations is from the events and transactions reflected in the consolidated financial 
statements, the less likely the inherently limited procedures required by auditing standards would identify it. 

In addition, as with any audit, there remained a higher risk of non-detection of fraud, as these may involve collusion, forgery, intentional omissions, 
misrepresentations, or the override of internal controls. Our audit procedures are designed to detect material misstatement. We are not responsible 
for preventing non-compliance or fraud and cannot be expected to detect non-compliance with all laws and regulations. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

129

Financial StatementsIndependent Auditor’s Report to the Members of Lancashire Holdings Limited continued

7. We have nothing to report on the other information in the Annual Report and Accounts
The directors are responsible for the other information presented in the Annual Report and Accounts together with the consolidated financial 
statements. Our opinion on the consolidated financial statements does not cover the other information and, accordingly, we do not express an  
audit opinion or, except as explicitly stated below, any form of assurance conclusion thereon. 

Our responsibility is to read the other information and, in doing so, consider whether, based on our consolidated financial statements audit work,  
the information therein is materially misstated or inconsistent with the consolidated financial statements or our audit knowledge. Based solely on  
that work we have not identified material misstatements in the other information. 

Directors’ remuneration report 

In addition to our audit of the consolidated financial statements, the Directors have engaged us to audit the information in the Directors’ 
Remuneration Report that is described as having been audited, which the Directors have decided to prepare as if the Company was required  
to comply with the requirements of Schedule 8 to The Large and Medium-sized Companies and Groups (Accounts and Reports) Regulations 2008  
(SI 2008 No. 410) made under the UK Companies Act 2006. 

In our opinion the part of the Directors’ Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the UK Companies Act 
2006, as if those requirements applied to the Company. 

Disclosures of emerging and principal risks and longer-term viability 

We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the directors’ disclosures in respect of emerging 
and principal risks and the viability statement, and the consolidated financial statements and our audit knowledge. 

Based on those procedures, we have nothing material to add or draw attention to in relation to: 

• 

• 

• 

the Directors’ confirmation within the viability statement on page 120 that they have carried out a robust assessment of the emerging  
and principal risks facing the Group, including those that would threaten its business model, future performance, solvency and liquidity; 

the Emerging and Principal Risks disclosures describing these risks and how emerging risks are identified, and explaining how they are being 
managed and mitigated; and 

the Directors’ explanation in the viability statement of how they have assessed the prospects of the Group, over what period they have done  
so and why they considered that period to be appropriate, and their statement as to whether they have a reasonable expectation that the Group 
will be able to continue in operation and meet its liabilities as they fall due over the period of their assessment, including any related disclosures 
drawing attention to any necessary qualifications or assumptions. 

Our work is limited to assessing these matters in the context of only the knowledge acquired during our consolidated financial statements audit.  
As we cannot predict all future events or conditions and as subsequent events may result in outcomes that are inconsistent with judgements  
that were reasonable at the time they were made, the absence of anything to report on these statements is not a guarantee as to the Group’s 
longer-term viability.

Corporate governance disclosures 

We are required to perform procedures to identify whether there is a material inconsistency between the Directors’ corporate governance disclosures 
and the consolidated financial statements and our audit knowledge.

Based on those procedures, we have concluded that each of the following is materially consistent with the consolidated financial statements and  
our audit knowledge: 

• 

• 

• 

the Directors’ statement that they consider that the Annual Report and Accounts taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable,  
and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group’s position and performance, business model and strategy; 

the section of the Annual Report and Accounts describing the work of the Audit Committee, including the significant issues that the Audit 
Committee considered in relation to the consolidated financial statements, and how these issues were addressed; and

the section of the Annual Report and Accounts that describes the review of the effectiveness of the Group’s risk management and internal  
control systems.

We are required to review the part of the Corporate Governance Statement relating to the Group’s compliance with the provisions of the UK 
Corporate Governance Code specified by the Listing Rules for our review. We have nothing to report in this respect. 

130

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

8. Respective responsibilities 
Directors’ responsibilities 

As explained more fully in their statement set out on page 121, the Directors are responsible for: the preparation of the consolidated financial 
statements including being satisfied that they give a true and fair view; such internal control as they determine is necessary to enable the preparation 
of consolidated financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; assessing the Group’s ability to continue 
as a going concern, disclosing, as applicable, matters related to going concern; and using the going concern basis of accounting unless they either 
intend to liquidate the Group or to cease operations, or have no realistic alternative but to do so. 

Auditor’s responsibilities 

Our objectives are to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements as a whole are free from material 
misstatement, whether due to fraud or error, and to issue our opinion in an auditor’s report. Reasonable assurance is a high level of assurance, but  
does not guarantee that an audit conducted in accordance with ISAs (UK) will always detect a material misstatement when it exists. Misstatements 
can arise from fraud or error and are considered material if, individually or in aggregate, they could reasonably be expected to influence the economic 
decisions of users taken on the basis of the consolidated financial statements. 

A fuller description of our responsibilities is provided on the FRC’s website at www.frc.org.uk/auditorsresponsibilities. 

The Company is required to include these financial statements in an annual financial report prepared using the single electronic reporting format 
specified in the TD ESEF Regulation. This auditor’s report provides no assurance over whether the annual financial report has been prepared in 
accordance with that format.

9. The purpose of our audit work and to whom we owe our responsibilities 
This report is made solely to the Company’s members, as a body, in accordance with section 90 of the Bermuda Companies Act 1981 and the terms  
of our engagement. Our audit work has been undertaken so that we might state to the Company’s members those matters we are required to state  
to them in an auditor’s report and for no other purpose. To the fullest extent permitted by law, we do not accept or assume responsibility to anyone 
other than the Company and the Company’s members, as a body, for our audit work, for this report, or for the opinions we have formed. 

Salim Tharani 
for and on behalf of KPMG LLP, Statutory Auditor  
Chartered Accountants  
15 Canada Square, London, E14 5GL 

9 February 2023

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

131

Financial StatementsFinancial Statements 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Gross premiums written 
Outwards reinsurance premiums 
Net premiums written 
Change in unearned premiums 
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
Net premiums earned 
Net investment income 
Net other investment (loss) income  
Net realised (losses) gains and impairments 
Share of loss of associate 
Other income 
Net foreign exchange (losses) gains 
Total net revenue 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 
Net insurance losses 
Insurance acquisition expenses 
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 
Equity based compensation 
Other operating expenses 
Total expenses 
Results of operating activities 

Financing costs 
Loss before tax 

Tax charge 
Loss for the year 
Loss for the year attributable to: 
Equity shareholders of LHL 
Non-controlling interests 
Loss for the year 

Other comprehensive loss to be reclassified to profit or loss in subsequent periods 
Net change in unrealised losses on investments 
Tax credit on net change in unrealised losses on investments 
Other comprehensive loss  
Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Total comprehensive loss attributable to: 
Equity shareholders of LHL 
Non-controlling interests 
Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Loss per share 
Basic 
Diluted 

132 
132

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Notes 
2 
2 

2 
2 

3 
3 
3 
16 
5 

2, 13 
2, 13 

2, 4 
2, 4 
7 
6, 7, 20 

8 

9 

3, 11 
11, 15 

23 

22 
22 

2022
 $m
1,652.3
(464.3)
1,188.0
(223.2)
23.6

988.4
43.7
(4.5)
(22.7)
(6.5)
6.5
(3.6)
1,001.3
922.7
(346.3)
576.4
298.8
(37.6)
8.6
128.7
974.9
26.4
29.2
(2.8)
(0.5)
(3.3)

(3.3)
–
(3.3)

(93.2)
3.9
(89.3)
(92.6)

(92.6)
–

(92.6)

2021
$m
1,225.2
(409.1)
816.1
(140.0)
20.4

696.5
23.0
3.8
6.1
(3.9)
18.2
3.5
747.2
667.6
(197.1)

470.5
188.6
(31.6)
11.1
119.6

758.2
(11.0)

45.8
(56.8)

(4.8)
(61.6)

(62.2)
0.6
(61.6)

(31.6)
0.9
(30.7)
(92.3)

(92.9)
0.6

(92.3)

($0.01)
($0.01)

($0.26)
($0.26)

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 

Financial Statements 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Gross premiums written 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Net premiums written 

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Net investment income 

Net other investment (loss) income  

Net realised (losses) gains and impairments 

Share of loss of associate 

Other income 

Net foreign exchange (losses) gains 

Total net revenue 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Net insurance losses 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Equity based compensation 

Other operating expenses 

Total expenses 

Results of operating activities 

Financing costs 

Loss before tax 

Tax charge 

Loss for the year 

Loss for the year attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Loss for the year 

Other comprehensive loss  

Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Total comprehensive loss attributable to: 

Equity shareholders of LHL 

Non-controlling interests 

Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Loss per share 

Basic 

Diluted 

Other comprehensive loss to be reclassified to profit or loss in subsequent periods 

Net change in unrealised losses on investments 

Tax credit on net change in unrealised losses on investments 

Notes 

2 

2 

2 

2 

3 

3 

3 

16 

5 

2, 13 

2, 13 

2, 4 

2, 4 

7 

6, 7, 20 

8 

9 

3, 11 

11, 15 

23 

22 

22 

(223.2)

(140.0)

2022

 $m

1,652.3

(464.3)

1,188.0

23.6

988.4

43.7

(4.5)

(22.7)

(6.5)

6.5

(3.6)

1,001.3

922.7

(346.3)

576.4

298.8

(37.6)

8.6

128.7

974.9

26.4

29.2

(2.8)

(0.5)

(3.3)

(3.3)

–

(3.3)

(93.2)

3.9

(89.3)

(92.6)

(92.6)

–

(92.6)

2021

$m

1,225.2

(409.1)

816.1

20.4

696.5

23.0

3.8

6.1

(3.9)

18.2

3.5

747.2

667.6

(197.1)

470.5

188.6

(31.6)

11.1

119.6

758.2

(11.0)

45.8

(56.8)

(4.8)

(61.6)

(62.2)

0.6

(61.6)

(31.6)

0.9

(30.7)

(92.3)

(92.9)

0.6

(92.3)

($0.01)

($0.01)

($0.26)

($0.26)

 Consolidated balance sheet 

As at 31 December 2022 

Assets 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Accrued interest receivable 
Investments 
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants 
Reinsurance assets 
•  Unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
•  Reinsurance recoveries 
•  Other receivables 
Other receivables 
Corporation tax receivable 
Investment in associate 
Property, plant and equipment 
Right-of-use assets 
Deferred acquisition costs 
Intangible assets 
Total assets 
Liabilities 
Insurance contracts 
•  Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
•  Unearned premiums 
•  Other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Deferred acquisition costs ceded 
Other payables 
Corporation tax payable 
Deferred tax liability 
Lease liabilities 
Long-term debt 
Total liabilities 
Shareholders’ equity 
Share capital 
Own shares 
Other reserves 
Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income  
Retained earnings 
Total shareholders’ equity attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 
Non-controlling interests 
Total shareholders’ equity 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity 

Notes 

10, 18 

11, 12, 18 
14 

13 
14 
14 

12, 16 

20 

17 

13 

15 
20 
18 

19 
19 
19 
11 

23 

2022
$m

2021
$m

548.8
11.3
2,204.9
688.3

141.4
592.1
96.8
30.1
1.1
57.2
1.1
20.3
180.8
172.4
4,746.6

1,780.8
821.1
52.9
268.2
32.9
44.1
–
9.3
23.3
446.1
3,478.7

122.0
(34.0)
1,221.9
(86.4)
44.4

1,267.9
–

1,267.9
4,746.6

517.7
7.1
2,048.1
490.6

117.8
418.8
38.2
18.8
–
118.7
0.8
13.4
121.6
157.9
4,069.5

1,291.1
597.9
20.3
205.6
27.0
37.4
1.6
12.2
17.9
445.7

2,656.7

122.0
(18.1)
1,221.6
2.9
83.9

1,412.3
0.5

1,412.8
4,069.5

The consolidated financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors on 9 February 2023 and signed on its behalf by: 

Peter Clarke 
Director/Chair 

Natalie Kershaw
Director/CFO 

132 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

133 
133

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Balance as at 31 December 2020 

Total comprehensive loss for the year 
Share repurchases 
Distributed by the trust 
Shares donated to the trust 
Dividends paid on common shares 
Dividends paid to minority interest holders 
Net deferred tax 
Equity based compensation  
Balance as at 31 December 2021 

Total comprehensive loss for the year 
Share repurchases 
Distributed by the trust 
Shares donated to the trust 
Dividends on common shares 
Repurchase of shares from non-controlling 
interest 
Net deferred tax 
Equity based compensation 
Balance as at 31 December 2022 

Notes 

19 
19 
19 
19 
23 
15 

19 
19 
19 
19 

23 
15 

Share 
capital 
$m 
122.0
–
–
–

–
–
–
–
122.0
–
–
–
–
–

–
–
–
122.0

Accumulated 
other 
comprehensive 
(loss) income 
$m 
33.6
(30.7)
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
2.9
(89.3)
–
–
–
–

Shareholders’ 
equity 
attributable  
to equity 
shareholders  
of LHL  
$m 
1,538.5 
(92.9) 
(6.9) 
(1.0) 
– 
(36.4) 
– 
(0.5) 
11.5 
1,412.3 
(92.6) 
(23.3) 
(0.8) 
– 
(36.2) 

Retained 
earnings 
$m 
182.5
(62.2)
–
–
–
(36.4)
–
–
–
83.9
(3.3)
–
–
–
(36.2)

Non-
controlling 
interests 
$m 
0.4
0.6
–
–
–
–
(0.5)
–
–
0.5
–
–
–
–
–

Total 
shareholders’ 
equity 
$m 
1,538.9
(92.3)
(6.9)
(1.0)
–
(36.4)
(0.5)
(0.5)
11.5
1,412.8
(92.6)
(23.3)
(0.8)
–
(36.2)

Own 
 shares 
$m 

–
(6.9)
9.9
0.1
–
–
–
–

Other 
reserves 
$m 
(21.2) 1,221.6
–
–
(10.9)
(0.1)
–
–
(0.5)
11.5
(18.1) 1,221.6
–
–
(8.9)
0.7
–

–
(23.3)
8.1
(0.7)
–

–
–
–

(0.6)
0.1
9.0
(34.0) 1,221.9

–
–
–
(86.4)

–
–
–
44.4

(0.6) 
0.1 
9.0 
1,267.9 

(0.5)
–
–
–

(1.1)
0.1
9.0
1,267.9

134 
134

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Consolidated statement of changes in shareholders’ equity 

Balance as at 31 December 2020 

Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Share repurchases 

Distributed by the trust 

Shares donated to the trust 

Dividends paid on common shares 

Dividends paid to minority interest holders 

Net deferred tax 

Equity based compensation  

Balance as at 31 December 2021 

Total comprehensive loss for the year 

Share repurchases 

Distributed by the trust 

Shares donated to the trust 

Dividends on common shares 

Repurchase of shares from non-controlling 

interest 

Net deferred tax 

Equity based compensation 

Balance as at 31 December 2022 

19 

19 

19 

19 

23 

15 

19 

19 

19 

19 

23 

15 

Accumulated 

other 

Notes 

Share 

capital 

$m 

122.0

Own 

 shares 

$m 

Other 

comprehensive 

reserves 

(loss) income 

$m 

Retained 

earnings 

$m 

182.5

$m 

33.6

(21.2) 1,221.6

Shareholders’ 

equity 

attributable  

to equity 

of LHL  

$m 

1,538.5 

shareholders  

controlling 

shareholders’ 

Non-

Total 

equity 

$m 

1,538.9

interests 

$m 

0.4

0.6

(30.7)

(62.2)

(92.9) 

122.0

(18.1) 1,221.6

1,412.3 

0.5

1,412.8

2.9

(89.3)

83.9

(3.3)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(6.9)

9.9

0.1

(23.3)

8.1

(0.7)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(10.9)

(0.1)

(0.5)

11.5

–

–

–

–

–

–

(8.9)

0.7

–

(0.6)

0.1

9.0

(36.4)

(36.4) 

(0.5)

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(6.9) 

(1.0) 

– 

– 

(0.5) 

11.5 

(92.6) 

(23.3) 

(0.8) 

– 

0.1 

9.0 

(92.3)

(6.9)

(1.0)

–

(36.4)

(0.5)

(0.5)

11.5

(92.6)

(23.3)

(0.8)

–

(36.2)

0.1

9.0

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

(36.2)

(36.2) 

(0.6) 

(0.5)

(1.1)

122.0

(34.0) 1,221.9

(86.4)

44.4

1,267.9 

1,267.9

Statement of consolidated cash flows 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Cash flows from operating activities 
Loss before tax 
Adjustments for: 
Tax paid 
Depreciation 
Interest expense on long-term debt 
Interest expense on lease liabilities 
Interest income 
Net amortisation of fixed maturity securities 
Redemption cost on senior and subordinated loan notes 
Net realised / unrealised losses on interest rate swaps 
Equity based compensation 
Foreign exchange gains 
Share of loss of associate 
Net other investment loss (income) 
Net realised losses (gains) and impairments 
Changes in operational assets and liabilities 
Insurance and reinsurance contracts 
• 
•  Other assets and liabilities 
Net cash flows from operating activities 
Cash flows used in investing activities 
Interest received 
Purchase of property, plant and equipment 
Purchase of underwriting capacity 
Internally generated intangible asset 
Investment in associate 
Purchase of investments 
Proceeds on sale of investments 
Net cash flows used in investing activities 
Cash flows (used in) from financing activities 
Interest paid 
Interest rate swap 
Lease liabilities paid 
Proceeds from issue of long-term debt 
Redemption of long-term debt 
Dividends paid 
Dividends paid to minority interest holders 
Repurchase of shares from non-controlling interest 
Share repurchases 
Distributions by trust 
Net cash flows (used in) from financing activities 
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year 
Effect of exchange rate fluctuations and other items on cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year 

Notes 

2022
$m

2021
$m

(2.8)

(56.8)

(2.1)
3.1
25.8
0.8
(46.1)
(0.2)
–
–
8.6
(4.9)
6.5
3.8
22.7

313.1
(4.5)
323.8

(3.2)
3.3
25.8
1.1
(34.1)
7.0
12.8
3.4
11.1
(0.4)
3.9
(4.7)
(6.1)

285.6
(4.9)
243.8

50.0
(0.7)
(4.2)
(10.3)
55.0
(1,130.2)
845.5
(194.9)

42.7
(0.7)
(0.2)
(3.2)
4.6
(1,348.5)
1,118.5

(186.8)

(25.8)
–
(3.6)
–
–
(36.2)
–
(1.1)
(23.3)
(0.8)

(90.8)
38.1
517.7
(7.0)

548.8

(20.8)
(3.4)
(4.0)
445.4
(339.6)
(36.4)
(0.5)
–
(6.9)
(1.0)

32.8
89.8
432.4
(4.5)
517.7

6, 20 
8 
20 
3 

8 
8 
7 

16 

3 

17 
17 
23 

8 
20 
18 
18 
19 
23 
23 
19 

10 

134 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

135 
135

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies  

Summary of significant accounting policies 
The basis of preparation, use of judgements and estimates, consolidation principles and significant accounting policies adopted in the preparation of 
these consolidated financial statements are set out below.  

Basis of preparation 
Going concern basis of accounting 
The consolidated financial statements are prepared on a going concern basis using accounting policies consistent with IFRS Standards as adopted by 
the EU.  

In assessing the Group's going concern position as at 31 December 2022, the Directors have considered a number of factors. These include the 
current balance sheet and liquidity position, the level and composition of the Group's capital and solvency ratios, the Group's ability to service its 
long-term debt financing arrangements, the current performance against the Group's strategic and financial business plan, the Group's dividend 
distribution policy, and the current market environment, including consideration for climate change and the ongoing conflict in Ukraine. In addition, 
the ORSA report is a key document informing the going concern assessment that is submitted to the Board on a quarterly and annual basis.  

The Group's financial forecasts reflect the outcomes that the Directors consider most likely, based on the information available at the date of signing 
these consolidated financial statements. To assesses the Group's going concern, the financial stability of the Group was modelled for a period of at 
least 12 months and a number of sensitivity, stress and scenario tests were applied. This included, among other analysis, a best estimate forecast as 
well as various scenarios. This incorporated different magnitudes of reserve releases and attritional, large and catastrophe loss events plus optimistic 
and pessimistic investment return scenarios. To further stress the financial stability of the Group, additional testing was performed. This included 
modelling the breakeven capital requirements of our regulators and rating agencies, the impact of potential management actions to reduce the 
Group's exposure to climate change-related risks, the occurrence of a number of high severity loss events impacting the Group in 2023, alongside an 
investment shock and finally a reverse stress test scenario designed to render the business model unviable. The testing identified that even under the 
more severe but plausible stress scenarios, the Group had more than adequate liquidity and solvency headroom. 

Based on the going concern assessment performed as at 31 December 2022, the Directors consider there to be no material uncertainties that may 
cast significant doubt over the Group's ability to continue to operate as a going concern. The Directors have formed a judgement that there is a 
reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence in the foreseeable future: a period of at least 12 
months from the date of signing these consolidated financial statements. 

Use of judgements and estimates 
The preparation of the Group's consolidated financial statements requires management to make judgements and estimates that affect the reported 
amounts of revenue, expenses, assets, liabilities and the accompanying financial statement disclosures. In the course of preparing the consolidated 
financial statements no key judgements have been made in the process of applying the Group's accounting policies that do not include a related 
element of estimation uncertainty. 

The key assumptions and other sources of estimation uncertainty as at 31 December 2022, that have a significant risk of resulting in a material 
adjustment to the carrying amount of assets and liabilities in the next financial year, are described below. Assumptions and estimates are based on 
parameters available when the consolidated financial statements were prepared. Existing circumstances and assumptions about future 
developments, however, may change or circumstances may arise, that are beyond the control of the Group. Such changes are reflected in the 
assumptions when they occur. 

The most significant judgements and estimates made by management are in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses, both gross and net of 
outwards reinsurance recoverable. These are discussed on page 140, within the risk disclosures section from page 145 and within note 13. 

Less significant estimates are made in determining the fair value of certain financial instruments and judgement is applied in determining 
impairment charges. The estimation of the fair value, specifically for 'Level (iii)' investments, is discussed on page 141 and in note 11. In addition, a 
portion of gross premiums written is based on estimates of the ultimate premiums expected to be received (see the premium and acquisition costs 
accounting policy on page 140). Judgement is involved in determining the ultimate estimates in order to establish the appropriate premium value 
and, ultimately, the cash to be received. 

The consolidated balance sheet includes indefinite life intangible assets and internally generated intangible assets. Whilst not significant, estimates 
and assumptions made by management in performing annual impairment tests on these intangible assets are also subject to estimation uncertainty 
(see note 17).  

Other basis of preparation 
Where IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS 
framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group’s management determines 
appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement 
and considering U.S. GAAP.  

The consolidated balance sheet is presented in order of decreasing liquidity. All amounts, excluding share data or where otherwise stated, are in 
millions of U.S. dollars.  

136 
136

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies  

Summary of significant accounting policies 

these consolidated financial statements are set out below.  

Basis of preparation 

Going concern basis of accounting 

the EU.  

The basis of preparation, use of judgements and estimates, consolidation principles and significant accounting policies adopted in the preparation of 

The consolidated financial statements are prepared on a going concern basis using accounting policies consistent with IFRS Standards as adopted by 

In assessing the Group's going concern position as at 31 December 2022, the Directors have considered a number of factors. These include the 

current balance sheet and liquidity position, the level and composition of the Group's capital and solvency ratios, the Group's ability to service its 

long-term debt financing arrangements, the current performance against the Group's strategic and financial business plan, the Group's dividend 

distribution policy, and the current market environment, including consideration for climate change and the ongoing conflict in Ukraine. In addition, 

the ORSA report is a key document informing the going concern assessment that is submitted to the Board on a quarterly and annual basis.  

The Group's financial forecasts reflect the outcomes that the Directors consider most likely, based on the information available at the date of signing 

these consolidated financial statements. To assesses the Group's going concern, the financial stability of the Group was modelled for a period of at 

least 12 months and a number of sensitivity, stress and scenario tests were applied. This included, among other analysis, a best estimate forecast as 

well as various scenarios. This incorporated different magnitudes of reserve releases and attritional, large and catastrophe loss events plus optimistic 

and pessimistic investment return scenarios. To further stress the financial stability of the Group, additional testing was performed. This included 

modelling the breakeven capital requirements of our regulators and rating agencies, the impact of potential management actions to reduce the 

Group's exposure to climate change-related risks, the occurrence of a number of high severity loss events impacting the Group in 2023, alongside an 

investment shock and finally a reverse stress test scenario designed to render the business model unviable. The testing identified that even under the 

more severe but plausible stress scenarios, the Group had more than adequate liquidity and solvency headroom. 

Based on the going concern assessment performed as at 31 December 2022, the Directors consider there to be no material uncertainties that may 

cast significant doubt over the Group's ability to continue to operate as a going concern. The Directors have formed a judgement that there is a 

reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence in the foreseeable future: a period of at least 12 

months from the date of signing these consolidated financial statements. 

Use of judgements and estimates 

The preparation of the Group's consolidated financial statements requires management to make judgements and estimates that affect the reported 

amounts of revenue, expenses, assets, liabilities and the accompanying financial statement disclosures. In the course of preparing the consolidated 

financial statements no key judgements have been made in the process of applying the Group's accounting policies that do not include a related 

element of estimation uncertainty. 

The key assumptions and other sources of estimation uncertainty as at 31 December 2022, that have a significant risk of resulting in a material 

adjustment to the carrying amount of assets and liabilities in the next financial year, are described below. Assumptions and estimates are based on 

parameters available when the consolidated financial statements were prepared. Existing circumstances and assumptions about future 

developments, however, may change or circumstances may arise, that are beyond the control of the Group. Such changes are reflected in the 

assumptions when they occur. 

The most significant judgements and estimates made by management are in relation to losses and loss adjustment expenses, both gross and net of 

outwards reinsurance recoverable. These are discussed on page 140, within the risk disclosures section from page 145 and within note 13. 

Less significant estimates are made in determining the fair value of certain financial instruments and judgement is applied in determining 

impairment charges. The estimation of the fair value, specifically for 'Level (iii)' investments, is discussed on page 141 and in note 11. In addition, a 

portion of gross premiums written is based on estimates of the ultimate premiums expected to be received (see the premium and acquisition costs 

accounting policy on page 140). Judgement is involved in determining the ultimate estimates in order to establish the appropriate premium value 

and, ultimately, the cash to be received. 

The consolidated balance sheet includes indefinite life intangible assets and internally generated intangible assets. Whilst not significant, estimates 

and assumptions made by management in performing annual impairment tests on these intangible assets are also subject to estimation uncertainty 

(see note 17).  

Other basis of preparation 

and considering U.S. GAAP.  

millions of U.S. dollars.  

Where IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts is silent, as it is in respect of certain aspects relating to the measurement of insurance products, the IFRS 

framework allows reference to another comprehensive body of accounting principles. In such instances, the Group’s management determines 

appropriate measurement bases, to provide the most useful information to users of the consolidated financial statements, using their judgement 

The consolidated balance sheet is presented in order of decreasing liquidity. All amounts, excluding share data or where otherwise stated, are in 

136 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Changes in accounting standards 
There were no new standards that became effective in the year ended 31 December 2022 that have had a material impact on the Group. 

Future accounting changes  
The Group will apply IFRS 17, Insurance Contracts and IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement for the first time on 1 January 
2023.  

Estimated financial impact of the adoption of IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 
The cumulative after tax impact of adopting IFRS 17 will be a reduction to the Group's opening retained earnings and resulting shareholders' equity, 
as at 1 January 2022. The Group estimates this to be in the range of $17 million to $22 million. 

IFRS 17 will create timing differences (see discussion below on onerous losses and discounting) in how insurance contracts are recognised over their 
lifetime. This may impact the financial reporting period in which profits are recognised but will not amend the overall profitability of the insurance 
contract. There is no change in the Group's underwriting strategy, fundamentals or risk appetite as a result of adopting IFRS 17.  

The adoption of IFRS 9 will result in a $2.9 million, net of tax reclassification adjustment between opening accumulated other comprehensive 
income and opening retained earnings, as at 1 January 2022. This reclassification adjustment does not impact opening shareholders' equity. 

The estimated financial impact disclosed above is still preliminary and may change. IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 are principles based accounting standards. 
The assumptions, accounting policy choices, judgements and estimation techniques used to interpret these standards continue to be refined as the 
Group embeds the related new accounting systems, processes and internal controls. The actual financial impact of adopting IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 will 
first be reported in the Group's consolidated financial statements for the six months ending 30 June 2023.  

IFRS 17, insurance contracts 
IFRS 17, issued in May 2017, including amendments issued in June 2020, specifies the financial reporting for insurance contracts and supersedes IFRS 
4, Insurance Contracts. IFRS 17 is effective for accounting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2023.  

The standard includes a number of significant changes regarding the measurement and disclosure of insurance contracts both in terms of liability 
measurement and profit recognition.  

The IFRS 17 general measurement model requires insurance contract liabilities to be measured using: 

•  probability-weighted estimates of future cash flows; 
•  discounting; 
•  a risk adjustment for non-financial risk; and 
•  a contractual service margin representing the unearned profit that will be recognised over the coverage period. 

IFRS 17 is a principles-based accounting standard and the valuation of insurance contract liabilities will continue to be the largest area of estimation 
uncertainty. This will, however, include additional elements such as the consideration of the cashflows within the contract boundary, discounting 
and the risk adjustment calculation. There are a number of accounting policy choices that are allowed under the standard and this will require the 
application of judgement and an increased use of estimation techniques. Management have applied judgement in interpreting the standard in areas 
such as determining the applicable measurement model, the approach to discounting and the level of aggregation. 

The Group has performed an assessment and determined that it will be eligible to apply the simplified model (PAA) to its portfolios and groups of 
contracts as the measurement of the liability for remaining coverage is not expected to differ materially from that calculated under the general 
measurement model. For reinsurance contracts held, the Group will apply the PAA (adapted to reflect the features of reinsurance contracts held that 
differ from insurance contracts issued) to simplify the measurement of a group of reinsurance contracts held. The PAA principally simplifies the 
measurement of the liability for remaining coverage, replacing the fulfilment cashflow plus contractual service margin approach of the GMM with a 
measurement based on net of acquisition cost premiums received less those recognised through revenue. For reinsurance contracts held, the 
measurement of the carrying amount of the asset for remaining coverage is simplified instead of adjusting the contractual service margin. 

For contracts measured under the PAA, acquisition cash flows can be recognised as an expense when incurred or included in the cash flows in the 
measurement of the liability for remaining coverage. The Group will include the cash flows in the measurement of the liability for remaining 
coverage. 

The two largest valuation adjustments that the Group expects to see when adopting IFRS 17 include: 

•  establishing a directly attributable expense reserve. This is due to the IFRS 17 requirement that all future cash flows related to the fulfilment of 

insurance contracts be captured within portfolios and applied to groups of insurance contracts. This will replace, at an increased amount, the existing 
ULAE provision. After initial recognition this reserve should stabilise; and 

•  discounting the liability for incurred claims. As not all cash flows are expected to be paid or received in one year or less from the date claims are 

incurred, the Group is required to discount the estimate of future cash flows included in the liability for incurred claims. As current discount rates are 
applied, this is subject to a degree of volatility. 

The Group anticipates applying the bottom-up approach when deriving its discount rates for discounting the liability for incurred claims. This 
approach requires the use of an appropriate (liquid) risk-free yield curve plus a specific illiquidity premium above the risk-free yield curve. The Group 
has elected to recognise changes in the effect of discounting as part of insurance finance income or expense in the consolidated income statement. 
Yield curve information will be sourced from a third-party service provider. The Group writes predominantly short tail business and has not 
identified any significant financing component in the liability for remaining coverage and has therefore applied judgement to determine that there is 
no requirement to discount these balances.  

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

137 
137

Financial Statements 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Other, smaller, individually immaterial, valuation adjustments on adoption of IFRS 17 will arise from: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

the requirement to revalue all component parts of insurance contract assets and liabilities at current foreign exchange rates. Under IFRS 4 unearned 
premium and deferred acquisition costs are considered non-monetary assets and are not currently retranslated at the balance sheet date; 
including expected premiums in the estimates of future cash flows. Under IFRS 4, for the majority of the Group’s excess of loss contracts, premiums 
written are recorded based on the minimum and deposit or flat premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and 
deposit premium are recognised in the period in which they are determined;  
the requirement to recognise immediately an onerous loss component and, if applicable reinsurance coverage is in place, a loss recovery component, 
on the initial recognition of an onerous group of contracts; and 
the requirement to include an element of non-performance risk in the cash flow assumptions when measuring reinsurance contracts held balances 
under IFRS 17. Under IFRS 4, the Group has not previously recognised a bad debt provision on losses recoverable from reinsurers. 

Under IFRS 17, insurance contracts that are subject to similar risks and that are managed together are classified into a portfolio of insurance 
contracts. Each portfolio of insurance contracts is then divided into a minimum of three groups: 

•  A group of contracts that are onerous at initial recognition; 
•  A group of contracts that at initial recognition have no significant possibility of becoming onerous; and 
•  A group of the remaining contracts in the portfolio. 

A group of contracts that are considered onerous at initial recognition will result in a loss being recognised immediately in the consolidated 
statement of comprehensive income. In the consolidated balance sheet, we would be required to recognise a loss component in the liability for 
remaining coverage. A loss recovery component will be recognised if there is appropriate reinsurance coverage in place.  

A risk adjustment for non-financial risk will be determined to reflect the compensation that the Group would require for bearing non-financial risk 
and its degree of risk aversion. The risk adjustment for non-financial risk under IFRS 17 is not expected to differ materially from the reserve margin 
under IFRS 4 as the fundamentals of our reserving will remain consistent. The risk adjustment for non-financial risk will be subject to discounting 
and the confidence level will be inferred. 

IFRS 17 will result in a number of presentation differences compared to the existing IFRS 4 consolidated financial statements: 

•  The insurance service result will comprise insurance revenue, insurance service expense, net expenses from reinsurance contracts held and insurance 

finance income or expense;  

•  Reinsurance contracts held are required to be presented separately from insurance contracts issued; 
•  The reporting of gross premiums written is no longer applicable under IFRS 17 and insurance revenue will equate more closely to gross earned 

premium. Reinstatement premiums will be recognised against insurance service expense while commissions paid to cedants will be recognised as a 
deduction from insurance revenue. Non-distinct investment components, which are defined as amounts that are repayable in all circumstances, are 
required to be excluded from insurance revenue and expenses;  

•  A portion of operating expenses will be included in insurance service expense; and 
•  On the face of the balance sheet all re(insurance) related balances will be presented in either insurance liabilities/assets or reinsurance assets/liabilities. 

IFRS 17 has been endorsed by the EU and UK. The Group anticipates applying the fully retrospective transition approach when adopting IFRS 17, 
which will result in a restatement of the Group's comparative information for insurance contracts in scope of IFRS 17. 

IFRS 9, financial instruments: classification and measurement 
IFRS 9 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. The amendments to IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts, issued in 2016, provide a 
temporary exemption from applying IFRS 9. The Group continues to qualify for, and has elected to apply, the temporary exemption available to 
companies whose predominant activity is to issue insurance contracts. The exemption lasts until the implementation date of IFRS 17 and addresses 
the accounting consequences of applying IFRS 9 to insurers prior to the adoption of IFRS 17. In addition, the Group elected, under the amendments 
of the initial application of IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 - Comparative Information - issued in December 2021, to apply the classification overlay to all 
financial assets. The Group aims to apply this narrow scope amendment using the classification and measurement categories on the initial 
application date of IFRS 9, being 1 January 2023 and has also elected to apply the impairment requirements of IFRS 9 for comparative periods. 

The Group will therefore apply IFRS 9 retrospectively and restate comparative information for financial instruments in scope of IFRS 9, except for 
the determination of the business model within which a financial asset is held. This assessment will be made on the basis of the facts and 
circumstances that existed as at 1 January 2023. 

IFRS 9 introduces new classification and measurement requirements for financial instruments: an expected credit loss impairment model that 
replaces the IAS 39 incurred loss model and new hedge accounting requirements. Applying the new requirements of IFRS 9, all investments held by 
the Group will be classified as at FVTPL mandatory, because they are managed on a fair value basis. As a result, all investments currently disclosed in 
note 11 as AFS will be reclassified as at FVTPL mandatory with changes in unrealised gains (losses) currently recorded within accumulated other 
comprehensive (loss) income to be reclassified and recorded within net investment income in profit or loss. The reclassification from AFS to FVTPL 
mandatory will not result in a change in the carrying value of the investments disclosed in note 11. The change in classification from AFS to FVTPL 
mandatory will result in balances within accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income being reclassified to retained earnings on the date of 
transition. The Group expects the impact of the expected credit loss model to be immaterial. 

138 
138

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Other, smaller, individually immaterial, valuation adjustments on adoption of IFRS 17 will arise from: 

• 

• 

• 

• 

the requirement to revalue all component parts of insurance contract assets and liabilities at current foreign exchange rates. Under IFRS 4 unearned 

premium and deferred acquisition costs are considered non-monetary assets and are not currently retranslated at the balance sheet date; 

including expected premiums in the estimates of future cash flows. Under IFRS 4, for the majority of the Group’s excess of loss contracts, premiums 

written are recorded based on the minimum and deposit or flat premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and 

deposit premium are recognised in the period in which they are determined;  

the requirement to recognise immediately an onerous loss component and, if applicable reinsurance coverage is in place, a loss recovery component, 

on the initial recognition of an onerous group of contracts; and 

the requirement to include an element of non-performance risk in the cash flow assumptions when measuring reinsurance contracts held balances 

under IFRS 17. Under IFRS 4, the Group has not previously recognised a bad debt provision on losses recoverable from reinsurers. 

Under IFRS 17, insurance contracts that are subject to similar risks and that are managed together are classified into a portfolio of insurance 

contracts. Each portfolio of insurance contracts is then divided into a minimum of three groups: 

•  A group of contracts that are onerous at initial recognition; 

•  A group of contracts that at initial recognition have no significant possibility of becoming onerous; and 

•  A group of the remaining contracts in the portfolio. 

A group of contracts that are considered onerous at initial recognition will result in a loss being recognised immediately in the consolidated 

statement of comprehensive income. In the consolidated balance sheet, we would be required to recognise a loss component in the liability for 

remaining coverage. A loss recovery component will be recognised if there is appropriate reinsurance coverage in place.  

A risk adjustment for non-financial risk will be determined to reflect the compensation that the Group would require for bearing non-financial risk 

and its degree of risk aversion. The risk adjustment for non-financial risk under IFRS 17 is not expected to differ materially from the reserve margin 

under IFRS 4 as the fundamentals of our reserving will remain consistent. The risk adjustment for non-financial risk will be subject to discounting 

and the confidence level will be inferred. 

IFRS 17 will result in a number of presentation differences compared to the existing IFRS 4 consolidated financial statements: 

•  The insurance service result will comprise insurance revenue, insurance service expense, net expenses from reinsurance contracts held and insurance 

finance income or expense;  

•  Reinsurance contracts held are required to be presented separately from insurance contracts issued; 

•  The reporting of gross premiums written is no longer applicable under IFRS 17 and insurance revenue will equate more closely to gross earned 

premium. Reinstatement premiums will be recognised against insurance service expense while commissions paid to cedants will be recognised as a 

deduction from insurance revenue. Non-distinct investment components, which are defined as amounts that are repayable in all circumstances, are 

required to be excluded from insurance revenue and expenses;  

•  A portion of operating expenses will be included in insurance service expense; and 

•  On the face of the balance sheet all re(insurance) related balances will be presented in either insurance liabilities/assets or reinsurance assets/liabilities. 

IFRS 17 has been endorsed by the EU and UK. The Group anticipates applying the fully retrospective transition approach when adopting IFRS 17, 

which will result in a restatement of the Group's comparative information for insurance contracts in scope of IFRS 17. 

IFRS 9, financial instruments: classification and measurement 

IFRS 9 is effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2018. The amendments to IFRS 4, Insurance Contracts, issued in 2016, provide a 

temporary exemption from applying IFRS 9. The Group continues to qualify for, and has elected to apply, the temporary exemption available to 

companies whose predominant activity is to issue insurance contracts. The exemption lasts until the implementation date of IFRS 17 and addresses 

the accounting consequences of applying IFRS 9 to insurers prior to the adoption of IFRS 17. In addition, the Group elected, under the amendments 

of the initial application of IFRS 17 and IFRS 9 - Comparative Information - issued in December 2021, to apply the classification overlay to all 

financial assets. The Group aims to apply this narrow scope amendment using the classification and measurement categories on the initial 

application date of IFRS 9, being 1 January 2023 and has also elected to apply the impairment requirements of IFRS 9 for comparative periods. 

The Group will therefore apply IFRS 9 retrospectively and restate comparative information for financial instruments in scope of IFRS 9, except for 

the determination of the business model within which a financial asset is held. This assessment will be made on the basis of the facts and 

circumstances that existed as at 1 January 2023. 

IFRS 9 introduces new classification and measurement requirements for financial instruments: an expected credit loss impairment model that 

replaces the IAS 39 incurred loss model and new hedge accounting requirements. Applying the new requirements of IFRS 9, all investments held by 

the Group will be classified as at FVTPL mandatory, because they are managed on a fair value basis. As a result, all investments currently disclosed in 

note 11 as AFS will be reclassified as at FVTPL mandatory with changes in unrealised gains (losses) currently recorded within accumulated other 

comprehensive (loss) income to be reclassified and recorded within net investment income in profit or loss. The reclassification from AFS to FVTPL 

mandatory will not result in a change in the carrying value of the investments disclosed in note 11. The change in classification from AFS to FVTPL 

mandatory will result in balances within accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income being reclassified to retained earnings on the date of 

transition. The Group expects the impact of the expected credit loss model to be immaterial. 

Consolidation principles 
The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries as at and for the year ended 31 
December 2022. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date of acquisition, being the date on which the Group obtains control, and continue to 
be consolidated until the date when such control ceases. Intercompany balances, profits and transactions are eliminated. Control is achieved when 
the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the subsidiary and has the ability to affect those returns through its 
power over the subsidiary.  

The Group participates in two syndicates at Lloyd’s, which are managed by the Group’s managing agent subsidiary. In view of the several liability of 
underwriting members at Lloyd’s, the Group recognises its proportion of all the transactions undertaken by the syndicates in which it participates 
within its consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Similarly, the Group’s proportion of the syndicates’ assets and liabilities has been 
reflected in its consolidated balance sheet. This proportion is calculated by reference to the Group’s participation as a percentage of each syndicate’s 
total capacity for each year of account. 

Subsidiaries’ accounting policies are generally consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. Where they differ, adjustments are made on 
consolidation to bring accounting policies in line. 

Associate 
Investments in which the Group has significant influence over the operational and financial policies of the investee are recognised at cost and 
thereafter accounted for using the equity method. Under this method, the Group records its proportionate share of income from such investments 
in its consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the period. Adjustments are made to associate accounting policies, where necessary, in 
order to be consistent with the Group’s accounting policies. 

Foreign currency  
Functional currency 
Items included in the financial statements of each of the Group’s entities are measured using the currency of the primary economic environment in which 
operations are conducted (the 'functional currency'). The consolidated financial statements are presented in U.S. dollars (the 'presentation currency'). 

Transactions and balances 
Foreign currency transactions are recorded in the functional currency for each entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the 
transactions, or at the average rate for the period when this is a reasonable approximation. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign 
currencies are revalued at period end exchange rates. The resulting exchange differences on revaluation are recorded in the consolidated statement 
of comprehensive income within net foreign exchange gains (losses). Non-monetary assets and liabilities denominated in a foreign currency are 
carried at historic rates. Non-monetary assets and liabilities carried at estimated fair value and denominated in a foreign currency are translated at 
the exchange rate at the date the estimated fair value was determined. 

Foreign operations 
The results and financial position of all the Group entities that have a functional currency different from the presentation currency are translated 
into the presentation currency as follows: 

•  assets and liabilities are translated at the closing rate on the balance sheet date; 
• 
•  all resulting foreign exchange differences are recognised in other comprehensive income and as a separate component of shareholders' equity. 

income and expenses are translated at average exchange rates for the period; and 

On disposal of foreign operations, cumulative exchange differences previously recognised in other comprehensive income are recognised in profit or 
loss as part of the gain or loss on disposal. 

Intangible assets 
The Group's intangible assets comprise indefinite life intangible assets and internally generated intangible assets. 

The Group's indefinite life intangible assets comprise syndicate participation rights and goodwill. The cost of syndicate participation rights and 
goodwill acquired in a business combination is their fair value as at the date of acquisition. Additional syndicate participation rights may be 
purchased from time to time and are recorded at the cost on the date of the syndicate capacity auction. Goodwill and syndicate participation rights 
are considered to have an indefinite useful life and are not amortised. They are carried at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. Intangible 
assets with an indefinite useful life are tested annually for impairment at the CGU level by comparing the net present value of the future cash flow 
stream of the CGU to the carrying value of the CGU and related intangible assets. The useful life of an indefinite life intangible asset is reviewed 
annually to determine if the assessment continues to be supportable.  

Internally generated intangible assets represent directly attributable costs incurred in the development phase of implementing a cloud based target 
operating model. An internally generated intangible asset is recognised if it can be demonstrated that there is an intent, available resource and 
technical feasibility to complete the intangible asset so that it is available for use and that it will generate probable future economic benefits. The 
costs must be capable of being measured reliably. They are carried at cost less any accumulated impairment losses. Intangible assets not yet 
available for use are tested annually for impairment at the CGU level by comparing the net present value of the future cash flow stream of the CGU 
to the carrying value of the CGU and related intangible assets.  

Internally generated intangible assets available for use are considered to have a finite life. Applying the cost model, intangible assets with finite lives 
are amortised over their estimated useful economic life and assessed for impairment whenever there are indicators of impairment. 

138 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

139 
139

Financial Statements 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Insurance contracts 
Classification 
Insurance contracts are those contracts that transfer significant insurance risk at the inception of the contract. Contracts that do not transfer 
significant insurance risk are accounted for as investment contracts. Insurance risk is transferred when an insurer agrees to compensate a 
policyholder if a specified uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder.  

Premiums and acquisition costs 
Premiums are first recognised as written at the later of a contract’s binding or inception date. The Group writes both excess of loss and pro-rata 
(proportional) contracts. For the majority of excess of loss contracts, premiums written are recorded based on the minimum and deposit or flat 
premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and deposit premium are recognised in the period in which they are 
determined. For pro-rata contracts and excess of loss contracts where no deposit is specified in the contract, premiums written are recognised based 
on estimates of ultimate premiums provided by the insureds or ceding companies. Initial estimates of premiums written are recognised in the period 
in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. Subsequent adjustments, based on reports of actual premium by 
the insureds or ceding companies, or revisions in estimates, are recorded in the period in which they are determined.  

Premiums written are earned evenly over the term of the underlying risk period of the insurance contract, except where the period of risk differs 
significantly from the contract period. In these circumstances, premiums are recognised over the period of risk in proportion to the amount of 
insurance protection provided. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of the risk period is reflected in unearned premiums. 

Where contract terms require the reinstatement of coverage after an insured’s or ceding company’s loss, the estimated mandatory reinstatement 
premiums are recorded as premiums written when a specific loss event occurs. Reinstatement premiums are not recorded for losses included within 
the provision for IBNR that do not relate to a specific loss event. 

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are recorded net of commissions, brokerage, premium taxes and other levies on premiums, 
unless the contract specifies otherwise. These balances are regularly reviewed for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised as an expense in 
the period in which it is determined.  

Acquisition costs represent commissions, brokerage, profit commissions and other variable costs that relate directly to the successful securing of 
new contracts and the renewing of existing contracts. They are generally deferred over the period in which the related premiums are earned to the 
extent they are recoverable out of expected future revenue margins. All other acquisition costs are recognised as an expense when incurred.  

Outwards reinsurance  
Outwards reinsurance premiums comprise the cost of reinsurance contracts held entered into. Outwards reinsurance premiums are accounted for in 
the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. The provision for the reinsurers’ share of unearned 
premiums represents that part of reinsurance premiums ceded which are estimated to be earned in future financial periods. Unearned reinsurance 
commissions are recognised as a liability using the same principles.  

Any amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated using the same methodology as for the underlying losses. The Group monitors the 
creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and assesses any reinsurance assets for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised as an 
expense in the period in which it is determined.  

Losses 
Losses comprise losses and loss adjustment expenses paid in the period and changes in the provision for outstanding losses and ACR, including the 
provision for IBNR and related expenses. Losses and loss adjustment expenses are charged to profit or loss as they are incurred.  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses represent the estimated ultimate cost of settling all insurance claims arising from events which have occurred 
up to the balance sheet date, including a provision for IBNR. The Group does not discount its liabilities for unpaid losses. Outstanding losses are 
initially set on the basis of reported losses received from third parties. ACR are determined where management’s best estimate of the reported loss 
is greater than that reported and are allocated with IBNR in the Group’s financial reporting. Estimated IBNR reserves may also consist of a provision 
for additional development in excess of losses reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for losses which have occurred but 
which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. IBNR reserves are estimated by management using various actuarial methods as 
well as a combination of the Group’s own loss experience, historical insurance industry loss experience, underwriters’ experience, estimates of 
pricing adequacy trends and management’s professional judgement.  

A portion of the Group’s business is in classes with high attachment points of coverage, including property catastrophe excess of loss. Reserving for 
losses in such programmes is inherently complicated in that losses in excess of the attachment level of the Group’s policies are characterised by high 
severity and low frequency and other factors which could vary significantly as losses are settled. This limits the volume of industry loss experience 
available from which to reliably predict ultimate losses following a loss event.  

The estimation of the ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liability is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It is 
reasonably possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, together with 
the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in estimated losses and loss adjustment expenses.  

Liability adequacy tests 
At each balance sheet date, the Group performs a liability adequacy test to determine if there is an overall excess of expected claims over unearned 
premiums for the period of unexpired risk by using current best estimates of future cash outflows generated by its insurance contracts, plus any 
investment income thereon. If, as a result of these tests, the carrying amount of the Group’s insurance liabilities is found to be inadequate, the 
deficiency is charged to income for the period, initially by writing off deferred acquisition costs and subsequently by establishing a provision.  
140 
140

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Insurance contracts 

Classification 

Premiums and acquisition costs 

Insurance contracts are those contracts that transfer significant insurance risk at the inception of the contract. Contracts that do not transfer 

significant insurance risk are accounted for as investment contracts. Insurance risk is transferred when an insurer agrees to compensate a 

policyholder if a specified uncertain future event adversely affects the policyholder.  

Premiums are first recognised as written at the later of a contract’s binding or inception date. The Group writes both excess of loss and pro-rata 

(proportional) contracts. For the majority of excess of loss contracts, premiums written are recorded based on the minimum and deposit or flat 

premium, as defined in the contract. Subsequent adjustments to the minimum and deposit premium are recognised in the period in which they are 

determined. For pro-rata contracts and excess of loss contracts where no deposit is specified in the contract, premiums written are recognised based 

on estimates of ultimate premiums provided by the insureds or ceding companies. Initial estimates of premiums written are recognised in the period 

in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. Subsequent adjustments, based on reports of actual premium by 

the insureds or ceding companies, or revisions in estimates, are recorded in the period in which they are determined.  

Premiums written are earned evenly over the term of the underlying risk period of the insurance contract, except where the period of risk differs 

significantly from the contract period. In these circumstances, premiums are recognised over the period of risk in proportion to the amount of 

insurance protection provided. The portion of the premium related to the unexpired portion of the risk period is reflected in unearned premiums. 

Where contract terms require the reinstatement of coverage after an insured’s or ceding company’s loss, the estimated mandatory reinstatement 

premiums are recorded as premiums written when a specific loss event occurs. Reinstatement premiums are not recorded for losses included within 

the provision for IBNR that do not relate to a specific loss event. 

Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants are recorded net of commissions, brokerage, premium taxes and other levies on premiums, 

unless the contract specifies otherwise. These balances are regularly reviewed for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised as an expense in 

the period in which it is determined.  

Acquisition costs represent commissions, brokerage, profit commissions and other variable costs that relate directly to the successful securing of 

new contracts and the renewing of existing contracts. They are generally deferred over the period in which the related premiums are earned to the 

extent they are recoverable out of expected future revenue margins. All other acquisition costs are recognised as an expense when incurred.  

Outwards reinsurance  

Outwards reinsurance premiums comprise the cost of reinsurance contracts held entered into. Outwards reinsurance premiums are accounted for in 

the period in which the contract incepts, or the period in which the contract is bound if later. The provision for the reinsurers’ share of unearned 

premiums represents that part of reinsurance premiums ceded which are estimated to be earned in future financial periods. Unearned reinsurance 

commissions are recognised as a liability using the same principles.  

Any amounts recoverable from reinsurers are estimated using the same methodology as for the underlying losses. The Group monitors the 

creditworthiness of its reinsurers on an ongoing basis and assesses any reinsurance assets for impairment, with any impairment loss recognised as an 

expense in the period in which it is determined.  

Losses 

Losses comprise losses and loss adjustment expenses paid in the period and changes in the provision for outstanding losses and ACR, including the 

provision for IBNR and related expenses. Losses and loss adjustment expenses are charged to profit or loss as they are incurred.  

Losses and loss adjustment expenses represent the estimated ultimate cost of settling all insurance claims arising from events which have occurred 

up to the balance sheet date, including a provision for IBNR. The Group does not discount its liabilities for unpaid losses. Outstanding losses are 

initially set on the basis of reported losses received from third parties. ACR are determined where management’s best estimate of the reported loss 

is greater than that reported and are allocated with IBNR in the Group’s financial reporting. Estimated IBNR reserves may also consist of a provision 

for additional development in excess of losses reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for losses which have occurred but 

which have not yet been reported by insureds or ceding companies. IBNR reserves are estimated by management using various actuarial methods as 

well as a combination of the Group’s own loss experience, historical insurance industry loss experience, underwriters’ experience, estimates of 

pricing adequacy trends and management’s professional judgement.  

A portion of the Group’s business is in classes with high attachment points of coverage, including property catastrophe excess of loss. Reserving for 

losses in such programmes is inherently complicated in that losses in excess of the attachment level of the Group’s policies are characterised by high 

severity and low frequency and other factors which could vary significantly as losses are settled. This limits the volume of industry loss experience 

available from which to reliably predict ultimate losses following a loss event.  

The estimation of the ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liability is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It is 

reasonably possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, together with 

the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in estimated losses and loss adjustment expenses.  

Liability adequacy tests 

At each balance sheet date, the Group performs a liability adequacy test to determine if there is an overall excess of expected claims over unearned 

premiums for the period of unexpired risk by using current best estimates of future cash outflows generated by its insurance contracts, plus any 

investment income thereon. If, as a result of these tests, the carrying amount of the Group’s insurance liabilities is found to be inadequate, the 

deficiency is charged to income for the period, initially by writing off deferred acquisition costs and subsequently by establishing a provision.  

140 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Financial instruments 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Cash and cash equivalents are carried in the consolidated balance sheet at amortised cost and include cash in hand, deposits held on call with banks 
and other short-term, highly-liquid investments with a maturity of three months or less at the date of purchase. Carrying amounts approximate fair 
value due to the short-term nature and high liquidity of the instruments.  

Interest income earned on cash and cash equivalents is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying value of accrued interest 
income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. 

Investments  
The Group’s fixed maturity securities include quoted and unquoted investments that are classified as either AFS or at FVTPL and are carried at fair 
value. The classification of the Group’s financial assets is determined at the time of initial purchase and depends on the nature of the investment. A 
financial asset is classified at FVTPL if it is managed and evaluated on a fair value basis or if acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short 
term, or if it forms part of a portfolio of financial assets in which there is evidence of short-term profit taking. Equity securities classified as AFS are 
those that are neither classified as held for trading nor designated at FVTPL. Fixed maturity securities classified as AFS are those that are intended to 
be held for an indefinite period, however, these securities are also managed on a fair value basis. The composition, duration and allocation of these 
investments are reviewed by management on a regular basis in order to respond to needs for liquidity, changes in interest rates and other market 
conditions.  

The Group has elected to designate certain fixed maturity securities, index linked securities, exchange traded funds and its private investment funds 
at FVTPL upon initial recognition. This category includes instruments in which the cash flows are linked to the performance of an underlying pool of 
securities. Presentation of these securities in the FVTPL category is consistent with how management monitors and evaluates the performance of 
these securities. 

The Group’s hedge funds are unquoted investments classified at FVTPL and are carried at fair value. Fair values are determined using a combination 
of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. 

Regular way purchases and sales of investments are recognised at fair value including, in the case of investments not carried at FVTPL, transaction 
costs attributable to the acquisition of that investment on the trade date and are subsequently carried at fair value. The fair values of quoted and 
unquoted investments are determined based on bid prices from recognised exchanges, broker-dealers, recognised indices or pricing vendors. 
Unrealised gains and losses from changes in the fair value of AFS investments are included in accumulated other comprehensive income in 
shareholders’ equity. Changes in fair value of investments classified at FVTPL are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive 
income within net other investment income. 

Investments are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership. On derecognition of an AFS 
investment, previously recorded unrealised gains and losses are recycled from accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income in shareholders’ 
equity and included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income as a realised gain or loss within net realised gains (losses) and 
impairments. 

Amortisation and accretion of premiums and discounts on AFS fixed maturity securities are calculated using the effective interest rate method and 
are recognised in current period net investment income. Interest income is recognised on the effective interest rate method. The carrying value of 
accrued interest income approximates estimated fair value due to its short-term nature and high liquidity. Dividends on equity securities are 
recorded as income on the date the dividends become payable to the holders of record. 

The Group regularly reviews the carrying value of its AFS investments for evidence of impairment. Such evidence would include a prolonged decline 
in estimated fair value below cost or amortised cost, where other factors, such as expected cash flows, do not support a recovery in value. If an 
impairment is deemed appropriate, the difference between cost or amortised cost and estimated fair value is removed from accumulated other 
comprehensive income in shareholders’ equity and charged to current period profit or loss. Impairment losses on fixed maturity securities may be 
subsequently reversed through profit or loss while impairment losses on equity securities are not subsequently reversed through profit or loss. 

Derivative financial instruments 
Derivatives are classified as financial assets or liabilities at FVTPL. They are initially recognised at fair value on the date a contract is entered into, the 
trade date, and are subsequently carried at fair value. Derivative instruments with a positive estimated fair value are recorded as derivative financial 
assets and those with a negative fair value are recorded as derivative financial liabilities.  

Derivative financial instruments include exchange-traded future and option contracts, forward foreign currency contracts, interest rate swaps, credit 
default swaps and interest rate swaptions. They derive their value from the underlying instrument and are subject to the same risks as that 
underlying instrument, including liquidity, credit and market risk. Fair values are based on exchange or broker-dealer quotations, where available, or 
discounted cash flow models, which incorporate the pricing of the underlying instrument, yield curves and other factors. Changes in the estimated 
fair value of derivative instruments are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income within net other investment income. The 
Group does not currently apply hedge accounting to any derivative contracts. For discounted cash flow techniques, estimated future cash flows are 
based on management’s best estimates and the discount rate used is an appropriate market rate. 

Derivative financial assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount is reported in the consolidated balance sheet only to the extent there is a 
legally enforceable right of offset and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and liabilities simultaneously. Derivative 
financial assets and liabilities are derecognised when the Group has transferred substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership or the liability 
is discharged, cancelled or expired. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

141 
141

Financial Statements 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Other income 
Other income is measured based on the consideration specified in a contract and excludes amounts collected on behalf of third parties. 

Nature of services 
The table below shows the nature, specific performance obligation and significant payment terms for the services within the scope of IFRS 15, 
Revenue from Contracts with Customers. 

Services 
LCM underwriting fees 

LCM profit commission 

LSL consortium management fees 

LSL consortium profit commission 

LSL managing agency fees 

Nature, timing of satisfaction of performance obligation and significant payment terms
The Group recognises underwriting fees over the underwriting cycle based on the underlying 
exposure of the covered contracts. Underwriting fees are received on or before the collateral 
funding date, which is prior to commencement of the underwriting cycle. 

The Group recognises profit commission following the end of the underwriting cycle based on 
the underlying performance of the covered contracts and as collateral is released. Profit 
commissions may only be received once the profit commission hurdle has been met. 

The Group recognises consortium fees over the risk period based on the underlying exposure of 
the covered contracts. Consortium fees are received quarterly. 

The Group recognises profit commission in line with the underlying performance of covered 
contracts once the year of account closes, which is also when the profit commissions are 
received. 

The Group recognises managing agency fees in line with services provided for each year of 
account. Managing agency fees are received quarterly. 

LSL managing agency profit commission  The Group recognises profit commission on open years of account when measurement is highly 

LSL coverholder fee income 

probable. Profit commissions are received once the year of account closes. 

The Group recognises coverholder fee income in line with services provided. Coverholder fee 
income is received quarterly. 

Long-term debt 
Long-term debt is recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Thereafter it is held at amortised cost, with the amortisation 
calculated using the effective interest rate method. Derecognition occurs when the obligation has been extinguished. 

Property, plant and equipment 
Property, plant and equipment is carried at historical cost, less accumulated depreciation and any impairment in value. Depreciation  
is calculated to write off the cost over the estimated useful economic life on a straight-line basis as follows: 

IT equipment 

Office furniture and equipment 

Leasehold improvements 

33% per annum

20% to 33% per annum

20% per annum

The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. 

An item of property, plant or equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the continued 
use of the asset.  

Gains and losses on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing proceeds with the carrying amount of the asset, 
and are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Costs for repairs and maintenance are charged to profit or loss as 
incurred. 

Leases 
The Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains, a lease at the inception of a contract for all contracts that have been entered into or modified 
on or after 1 January 2019. A contract is, or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of 
time in exchange for consideration. The Group recognises a right-of-use asset and a lease liability at the lease commencement date. The Group is 
not a lessor to any lease contracts. 

The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of the future lease payments at the lease commencement date. Lease payments are 
discounted using the rate implicit in the lease, if readily determinable, or the Group’s incremental borrowing rate. Lease payments included in the 
measurement of the lease liability comprise: 

•  Fixed lease payments; 
•  Variable lease payments that depend on an index or rate, initially measured using the index or rate at the commencement date; or 
•  Payments in respect of purchase options, lease termination options or lease extension options that the Group is reasonably certain to exercise. 

142 
142

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Accounting policies continued 

Other income 

Nature of services 

Other income is measured based on the consideration specified in a contract and excludes amounts collected on behalf of third parties. 

The table below shows the nature, specific performance obligation and significant payment terms for the services within the scope of IFRS 15, 

Revenue from Contracts with Customers. 

Services 

Nature, timing of satisfaction of performance obligation and significant payment terms

LCM underwriting fees 

The Group recognises underwriting fees over the underwriting cycle based on the underlying 

exposure of the covered contracts. Underwriting fees are received on or before the collateral 

funding date, which is prior to commencement of the underwriting cycle. 

LCM profit commission 

The Group recognises profit commission following the end of the underwriting cycle based on 

the underlying performance of the covered contracts and as collateral is released. Profit 

commissions may only be received once the profit commission hurdle has been met. 

LSL consortium management fees 

The Group recognises consortium fees over the risk period based on the underlying exposure of 

the covered contracts. Consortium fees are received quarterly. 

LSL consortium profit commission 

The Group recognises profit commission in line with the underlying performance of covered 

contracts once the year of account closes, which is also when the profit commissions are 

received. 

LSL managing agency fees 

The Group recognises managing agency fees in line with services provided for each year of 

account. Managing agency fees are received quarterly. 

LSL managing agency profit commission  The Group recognises profit commission on open years of account when measurement is highly 

probable. Profit commissions are received once the year of account closes. 

LSL coverholder fee income 

The Group recognises coverholder fee income in line with services provided. Coverholder fee 

income is received quarterly. 

Long-term debt 

Long-term debt is recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Thereafter it is held at amortised cost, with the amortisation 

calculated using the effective interest rate method. Derecognition occurs when the obligation has been extinguished. 

Property, plant and equipment 

Property, plant and equipment is carried at historical cost, less accumulated depreciation and any impairment in value. Depreciation  

is calculated to write off the cost over the estimated useful economic life on a straight-line basis as follows: 

IT equipment 

Office furniture and equipment 

Leasehold improvements 

33% per annum

20% to 33% per annum

20% per annum

The assets’ residual values, useful lives and depreciation methods are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. 

An item of property, plant or equipment is derecognised on disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected to arise from the continued 

Gains and losses on the disposal of property, plant and equipment are determined by comparing proceeds with the carrying amount of the asset, 

and are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income. Costs for repairs and maintenance are charged to profit or loss as 

use of the asset.  

incurred. 

Leases 

The Group assesses whether a contract is, or contains, a lease at the inception of a contract for all contracts that have been entered into or modified 

on or after 1 January 2019. A contract is, or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of 

time in exchange for consideration. The Group recognises a right-of-use asset and a lease liability at the lease commencement date. The Group is 

not a lessor to any lease contracts. 

The lease liability is initially measured at the present value of the future lease payments at the lease commencement date. Lease payments are 

discounted using the rate implicit in the lease, if readily determinable, or the Group’s incremental borrowing rate. Lease payments included in the 

measurement of the lease liability comprise: 

•  Fixed lease payments; 

•  Variable lease payments that depend on an index or rate, initially measured using the index or rate at the commencement date; or 

•  Payments in respect of purchase options, lease termination options or lease extension options that the Group is reasonably certain to exercise. 

The lease liability is subsequently measured by increasing the lease carrying amount to reflect the interest due on the lease liability using the 
effective interest rate method and by reducing the carrying amount to reflect the lease payments made. 

The Group re-measures the lease liability and the related right-of-use asset whenever: 

•  The lease term changes as a result of the Group changing its assessment of whether it will exercise a purchase, extension or termination option, in 

which case the lease liability is re-measured by discounting the revised lease payments using a revised discount rate; 

•  The lease payments change due to changes in an index or rate or a change in expected payment under a guaranteed residual value, in which case the 

lease liability is re-measured by discounting the revised lease payments using the initial discount rate; or 

•  A lease contract is modified and the lease modification is not accounted for as a separate lease, in which case the lease liability is re-measured by 

discounting the revised lease payments using a revised discount rate. 

The right-of-use asset is initially measured at cost, which comprises the initial measurement of the corresponding lease liability adjusted for any 
lease payments made at or before the commencement date, plus any initial direct costs incurred and an estimate of any costs to be incurred at 
expiration of the lease agreement.  

Right-of-use assets are subsequently measured at cost less accumulated depreciation and any impairment losses. Straight-line depreciation is 
calculated from the commencement date of the lease to the earlier of either the end date of the lease term or the useful life of the underlying asset.  

Both the right-of-use assets and lease liabilities are presented as separate financial statement line items on the consolidated balance sheet. 

Employee benefits 
Equity compensation plans 
The Group currently operates a RSS under which nil-cost options have been granted. The fair value of the equity instruments granted is estimated 
on the date of grant. The estimated fair value is recognised as an expense pro-rata over the vesting period of the instrument, adjusted for the impact 
of any non-market vesting conditions. No adjustment to vesting assumptions is made in respect of market vesting conditions.  

At each balance sheet date, the Group revises its estimate of the number of RSS nil-cost options that are expected to become exercisable. It 
recognises the impact of the revision of original estimates, if any, as equity based compensation expense in the consolidated statement of 
comprehensive income, and a corresponding adjustment is made to other reserves in shareholders’ equity over the remaining vesting period.  

On exercise, the differences between the expense charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income and the actual cost to the 
Group, if any, is transferred within the components of other reserves in shareholders’ equity.  

Pensions 
The Group operates a defined contribution plan. On payment of contributions to the plan there is no further obligation for the Group. Contributions 
are recognised as employee benefits in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in the period when the services are rendered. 

Tax 
Income tax represents the sum of tax currently payable and any deferred tax. The tax payable is calculated based on taxable profit for the period 
using tax rates and tax laws enacted or substantively enacted at the year end reporting date and any adjustments to tax payable in respect of prior 
periods. Taxable profit for the period can differ from that reported in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income due to non-taxable 
income and certain items which are not tax deductible or which are deferred to subsequent periods.  

Deferred tax is recognised on all temporary differences between the carrying value of the assets and liabilities in the consolidated balance sheet and 
their tax base, except when the deferred tax liability arises from the initial recognition of goodwill. Deferred tax assets or liabilities are accounted for 
using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future 
taxable profits is likely and are reassessed each year for recognition.  

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current tax assets against current tax liabilities and 
when the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority.  

Where the current estimated fair value of equity based compensation awards differs from the estimated fair value at the time of grant, adjusted 
where applicable for dividends, the related corporation tax and deferred tax charge or credit is recognised directly in other reserves.  

The Group determines, based on its tax compliance and transfer pricing study, the probability/certainty of the tax treatments being accepted by the 
taxation authorities and accounts for these in line with its determination. 

Own shares 
Own shares include shares repurchased under share repurchase authorisations and held in treasury, plus shares repurchased and held in trust, for the 
purposes of employee equity-based compensation schemes. Own shares are deducted from shareholders’ equity. No gain or loss is recognised on 
the purchase, sale, cancellation or issue of own shares and any consideration paid or received is recognised directly in equity. 

142 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

143 
143

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Risk disclosures: introduction 
The Group is exposed to risks from several sources, classified into six primary risk categories. These are insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, 
credit risk, operational risk and strategic risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk.  

The primary objective of the Group’s ERM framework is to ensure that the capital resources held are matched to the risk profile of the Group and 
that the balance between risk and return is considered as part of all key business decisions. The Group has formulated, and keeps under review, a risk 
appetite which is set by the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary from time to time to reflect the potential risks and returns that 
present themselves. However, protecting the Group’s capital and maximising risk-adjusted returns for investors over the long term are constants. 
The risk appetite of the Group is central to how the business is run and permeates into the risk appetites that the individual operating entity boards 
of directors have adopted. These risk appetites are expressed through detailed risk tolerances at both a Group and an operating entity level. Risk 
tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, generally on a modelled basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to 
certain risks.  

The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual entity boards of 
directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least an annual review and 
consideration by the respective boards of directors. The LHL Board and individual entity boards of directors review actual risk levels versus 
tolerances, emerging risks and any risk learning events at least quarterly. In addition, on a monthly basis, management assesses the modelled 
potential catastrophe losses against the risk tolerances and ensures that risk levels are managed in accordance with them. 

Emerging risks 
Climate change 
The Group is exposed to both climate-related risks and opportunities. The two major categories of risk being transition risk and physical risk. 

Transition risks are those relating to the transition to a lower carbon economy and include risks such as policy and legal risk, technology risk, market 
risk and reputation risk. Physical risks are those relating to the physical impacts of climate change which can be acute (those from increased 
frequency and severity of climate related events) or chronic (due to longer-term shifts in climate patterns). As a (re)insurance company, the Group is 
more significantly affected by physical risk through its exposure to acute and chronic climate change. The potential financial impact from these 
climate-related risks is assessed through scenario testing and mitigated by the Group's strategic and risk management decisions around managing 
these risks. A risk radar has been prepared to illustrate the risks identified and the likelihood and magnitude of these risks; this diagram can be found 
on page 65. The risk assessment also considers the products currently offered by the Group and how these might change over time during the 
transition to a lower carbon economy. A table summarising potential opportunities, their timeframe, likelihood and magnitude is included on page 
66. The Group's current assessment of risk in relation to climate change is discussed in more detail within the TCFD report of this Annual Report and 
Accounts on pages 67 to 69. 

The Group's process in identifying, assessing and managing climate risk with respect to insurance risk, investment risk and business plan risk is 
discussed further below in our risk disclosures. 

Ongoing conflict in Ukraine 
We continue to closely monitor our exposure with regards to the ongoing conflict in Ukraine, which remains a complex and fluid situation. We 
believe that any potential losses would be within our risk tolerances. 

Economic capital models 
The Group maintains economic capital models at the LICL, LUK and syndicate levels. These models are primarily focused on insurance risks, however 
they are also used to model other risks including market, credit and operational risks. The syndicate models are vetted by Lloyd’s as part of its own 
capital and solvency regulations. 

The economic capital models produce data in the form of stochastic distributions for all classes, including non-elemental classes. The distributions 
include the mean outcome and the result at various return periods, including very remote events. Projected financial outcomes for each insurance 
class are calculated, as well as the overall portfolio including diversification credit. Diversification credit arises as individual risks are generally not 
strongly correlated and are unlikely to all produce profits or losses at the same time.  

144 
144

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 

Risk disclosures: introduction 

The Group is exposed to risks from several sources, classified into six primary risk categories. These are insurance risk, market risk, liquidity risk, 

credit risk, operational risk and strategic risk. The primary risk to the Group is insurance risk.  

The primary objective of the Group’s ERM framework is to ensure that the capital resources held are matched to the risk profile of the Group and 

that the balance between risk and return is considered as part of all key business decisions. The Group has formulated, and keeps under review, a risk 

appetite which is set by the Board of Directors. The Group’s appetite for risk will vary from time to time to reflect the potential risks and returns that 

present themselves. However, protecting the Group’s capital and maximising risk-adjusted returns for investors over the long term are constants. 

The risk appetite of the Group is central to how the business is run and permeates into the risk appetites that the individual operating entity boards 

of directors have adopted. These risk appetites are expressed through detailed risk tolerances at both a Group and an operating entity level. Risk 

tolerances represent the maximum amount of capital, generally on a modelled basis, that the Group and its entities are prepared to expose to 

The Board of Directors is responsible for setting and monitoring the Group’s risk appetite and tolerances, whereas the individual entity boards of 

directors are responsible for setting and monitoring entity level risk tolerances. All risk tolerances are subject to at least an annual review and 

consideration by the respective boards of directors. The LHL Board and individual entity boards of directors review actual risk levels versus 

tolerances, emerging risks and any risk learning events at least quarterly. In addition, on a monthly basis, management assesses the modelled 

potential catastrophe losses against the risk tolerances and ensures that risk levels are managed in accordance with them. 

certain risks.  

Emerging risks 

Climate change 

The Group is exposed to both climate-related risks and opportunities. The two major categories of risk being transition risk and physical risk. 

Transition risks are those relating to the transition to a lower carbon economy and include risks such as policy and legal risk, technology risk, market 

risk and reputation risk. Physical risks are those relating to the physical impacts of climate change which can be acute (those from increased 

frequency and severity of climate related events) or chronic (due to longer-term shifts in climate patterns). As a (re)insurance company, the Group is 

more significantly affected by physical risk through its exposure to acute and chronic climate change. The potential financial impact from these 

climate-related risks is assessed through scenario testing and mitigated by the Group's strategic and risk management decisions around managing 

these risks. A risk radar has been prepared to illustrate the risks identified and the likelihood and magnitude of these risks; this diagram can be found 

on page 65. The risk assessment also considers the products currently offered by the Group and how these might change over time during the 

transition to a lower carbon economy. A table summarising potential opportunities, their timeframe, likelihood and magnitude is included on page 

66. The Group's current assessment of risk in relation to climate change is discussed in more detail within the TCFD report of this Annual Report and 

The Group's process in identifying, assessing and managing climate risk with respect to insurance risk, investment risk and business plan risk is 

Accounts on pages 67 to 69. 

discussed further below in our risk disclosures. 

Ongoing conflict in Ukraine 

Economic capital models 

capital and solvency regulations. 

We continue to closely monitor our exposure with regards to the ongoing conflict in Ukraine, which remains a complex and fluid situation. We 

believe that any potential losses would be within our risk tolerances. 

The Group maintains economic capital models at the LICL, LUK and syndicate levels. These models are primarily focused on insurance risks, however 

they are also used to model other risks including market, credit and operational risks. The syndicate models are vetted by Lloyd’s as part of its own 

The economic capital models produce data in the form of stochastic distributions for all classes, including non-elemental classes. The distributions 

include the mean outcome and the result at various return periods, including very remote events. Projected financial outcomes for each insurance 

class are calculated, as well as the overall portfolio including diversification credit. Diversification credit arises as individual risks are generally not 

strongly correlated and are unlikely to all produce profits or losses at the same time.  

A. Insurance risk 
The Group underwrites worldwide, predominantly short-tail, insurance and reinsurance contracts that transfer insurance risk, including risks 
exposed to both natural and man-made catastrophes. The Group’s exposure in connection with insurance contracts is, in the event of insured losses, 
whether premiums will be sufficient to cover the loss payments and expenses. Insurance and reinsurance markets are cyclical and premium rates 
and terms and conditions vary by line of business depending on market conditions and the stage of the cycle. Market conditions are impacted by 
capacity and recent loss events, and broader economic cycle impacts amongst other factors. The Group’s underwriters assess likely losses using their 
experience and knowledge of past loss experience, industry trends and current circumstances. This allows them to estimate the premiums sufficient 
to meet likely losses and expenses and desired levels of profitability. 

The Group considers insurance risk at an individual contract level, at a segment level, at a geographic level and at an aggregate portfolio level. This 
ensures that careful risk selection, limits on concentration and appropriate portfolio diversification are accomplished. The level of insurance risk 
tolerance per peril is set by the Board and the boards of directors at individual entity level. 

A number of controls are deployed to manage the amount of insurance exposure assumed: 

the Group has a rolling three-year strategic plan that helps establish the over-riding business goals that the Board of Directors aims to achieve; 

• 
•  a detailed business plan is produced annually, which includes expected premiums and combined ratios by class and considers risk-adjusted profitability, 

capital usage and requirements. The plan is approved by the Board of Directors and is monitored, reviewed and updated on an ongoing basis; 
for LSL, the syndicates’ business forecasts and business plans are subject to review and approval by Lloyd’s; 

the Group and individual operating entities have predetermined tolerances on probabilistic and deterministic losses of capital for certain single events; 
risk levels versus tolerances are monitored on a regular basis; 

• 
•  economic capital models are used to measure occurrence risks, aggregate risks and correlations between classes and other non-insurance risks; 
•  each authorised class has a predetermined normal maximum line structure; 
•  each underwriter has a clearly defined limit of underwriting authority; 
• 
• 
•  a daily underwriting call is held for LICL and LUK to peer review insurance proposals, opportunities and emerging risks ;  
•  a daily post-binding review process with exception reporting to management based on underwriting authority operates at LSL; 
• 
•  a number of modelling tools are deployed to model catastrophes and resultant losses to the portfolio and the Group; and 
• 

reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate both frequency and severity of losses on a facultative, excess of loss treaty or proportional treaty basis. 

sophisticated pricing and aggregation models are utilised in certain areas of the underwriting process; 

Some of the Group’s business provides coverage for natural catastrophes (e.g. hurricanes, earthquakes, wildfires and floods) and is subject to 
potential seasonal variation and the effects of climate change. A proportion of the Group’s business is exposed to large catastrophe losses in North 
America, Europe and Japan as a result of windstorms. The level of windstorm activity, and landfall thereof, during the North American, European and 
Japanese wind seasons may materially impact the Group’s loss experience. The North American and Japanese wind seasons are typically June to 
November and the European wind season November to March. The Group also bears exposure to large losses arising from other non-seasonal 
natural catastrophes, such as earthquakes, tsunamis, droughts, floods and tornadoes, from risk losses throughout the year and from war, terrorism 
and political risk and other events. The Group’s associate bears exposure to catastrophe losses and any significant loss event could potentially result 
in impairment in the value of the Group’s investment in associate. 

Climate change may expose the Group to the risk of heightened severity and frequency of weather-related losses. Climate related risks are identified 
and assessed as part of the usual risk identification and management process which includes but is not limited to: discussions with risk owners and 
with subject matter experts across the Group, discussions at the Emerging Risk Working Forum, the CCWG, and the ESG Co-ordination Committee. 
Climate-related risks specific to the (re)insurance portfolios are identified and assessed as part of the day-to-day underwriting process by individual 
underwriters in their analysis of specific risk information, and more broadly in the context of the wider portfolio during the daily UMCC and the 
fortnightly RRC meetings. These reviews include: the physical location of assets insured, weather related perils that have impacted the location and 
their historical frequency and severity, as well as expected short and long-term changes. The annual individual entity underwriting strategy days and 
the annual Group catastrophe underwriting strategy day assess climate-related risks of both current and anticipated future risks, which include but 
are not limited to transition risk arising from a decline in the value of assets to be insured, changing energy costs, and liability risks that could arise 
from climate-related litigation. Physical, transition and liability risks are considered by business segment and geographical location, and the 
expected impact from the risks identified is considered with respect to both magnitude and timescale. 

We manage climate risk by using stochastic models from third-party vendors which have a long history of data quality governance. We adapt these 
models based upon our views of climate risk, as well as our clients’ exposure data, to create aggregate loss scenarios. During 2022 we have increased 
our modelling capabilities to include additional secondary perils. Underwriting guidelines support the underwriting process and provide guidance to 
assist underwriters in their decision making. Performance against guidelines is monitored via the UMCC and related reporting. We have clear 
tolerances and preferences in place to actively manage exposures, and the Board regularly monitors our PMLs.  

The Group accepts risks for periods primarily of one year, which mitigates the impact of climate risk. The Group has the ability to re-evaluate the 
portfolio on an annual basis and therefore reprice physical risk and reset exposure levels to consider new data regarding the frequency and severity 
of elemental catastrophe events. 

144 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

145 
145

Financial Statements 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Catastrophe management 
The Group actively monitors risk levels and manages catastrophe risk accumulations using reinsurance and PML based risk tolerances, which are 
monitored as part of our climate-related risks as outlined on page 68. The Group’s exposures to certain peak zone elemental losses, as a percentage 
of tangible capital, including long-term debt, are shown below. Net loss estimates are before income tax and net of reinstatement premiums and 
outwards reinsurance on a first occurrence return period basis. The exposure to catastrophe losses that would result in an impairment to the 
investment in associate is included in the figures below. 

As at 31 December 2022 
Zones 
Gulf of Mexico1 
California 
Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 
Pan-European 
Japan 
Japan 
Pacific North West 

1.  Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 
2.  Estimated net loss balances presented in the table are unaudited. 

As at 31 December 2021 
Zones 
Gulf of Mexico1 
California 
Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 
Pan-European 
Japan 
Japan 
Pacific North West 

100 year return period2  
estimated net loss 

250 year return period2
estimated net loss 

% of  
tangible capital 

$m 

% of
tangible capital 

$m 

301.2
248.0
217.2
181.2
144.5
121.6
29.5

19.5 
16.1 
14.1 
11.8 
9.4 
7.9 
1.9 

348.0
291.9
362.5
218.4
180.3
172.1
137.5

22.6
18.9
23.5
14.2
11.7
11.2
8.9

100 year return period2  
estimated net loss 

250 year return period2
estimated net loss 

% of  
tangible capital 

$m

% of 
tangible capital

$m

309.0
160.5
206.8
154.1
118.3
89.9
26.8

18.2 
9.4 
12.2 
9.1 
7.0 
5.3 
1.6 

558.2
325.4
600.5
228.5
131.7
143.3
139.0

32.8
19.1
35.3
13.4
7.7
8.4
8.2

Perils 
Hurricane 
Earthquake 
Hurricane 
Windstorm 
Typhoon 
Earthquake 
Earthquake 

Perils 
Hurricane 
Earthquake 
Hurricane 
Windstorm 
Typhoon 
Earthquake 
Earthquake 

1.  Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 
2.  Estimated net loss balances presented in the table are unaudited. 

There can be no guarantee that the modelled assumptions and techniques deployed in calculating these figures are accurate. There could also be an 
unmodelled loss which exceeds these figures. In addition, the models contain loss scenarios which could cause a larger loss to capital than the 
modelled expectation from the above return periods. 

Details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks insured are provided below:  

U.S. and Canada 
Worldwide – multi territory 
Europe 
Rest of world 
Total gross premiums written 

Details of annual gross premiums written by business segment are provided below: 

Reinsurance  
Insurance  
Total gross premiums written 

2022

2021

$m
639.6
616.1
140.5
256.1
1,652.3

% 
38.7 
37.3 
8.5 
15.5 
100.0 

$m
465.2
424.8
138.8
196.4
1,225.2

2022

2021

$m
842.1
810.2
1,652.3

% 
51.0 
49.0 
100.0 

$m
561.0
664.2
1,225.2

%
38.0
34.7
11.3
16.0
100.0

%
45.8
54.2
100.0

Comparative figures for the year ended 31 December 2021 have been re-presented in conformity with the current year view. 

146 
146

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1.  Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

2.  Estimated net loss balances presented in the table are unaudited. 

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Catastrophe management 

As at 31 December 2022 

Zones 

Gulf of Mexico1 

California 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

As at 31 December 2021 

Zones 

Gulf of Mexico1 

California 

Non-Gulf of Mexico – U.S. 

Pan-European 

Japan 

Japan 

Pacific North West 

U.S. and Canada 

Worldwide – multi territory 

Europe 

Rest of world 

Total gross premiums written 

Reinsurance  

Insurance  

Total gross premiums written 

Perils 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Hurricane 

Windstorm 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

Earthquake 

Perils 

Hurricane 

Earthquake 

Hurricane 

Windstorm 

Typhoon 

Earthquake 

Earthquake 

100 year return period2  

estimated net loss 

250 year return period2

estimated net loss 

$m

tangible capital 

$m

tangible capital

% of  

19.5 

16.1 

14.1 

11.8 

9.4 

7.9 

1.9 

% of  

18.2 

9.4 

12.2 

9.1 

7.0 

5.3 

1.6 

% 

38.7 

37.3 

8.5 

15.5 

% 

51.0 

49.0 

301.2

248.0

217.2

181.2

144.5

121.6

29.5

309.0

160.5

206.8

154.1

118.3

89.9

26.8

2022

$m

639.6

616.1

140.5

256.1

2022

$m

842.1

810.2

% of

22.6

18.9

23.5

14.2

11.7

11.2

8.9

% of 

32.8

19.1

35.3

13.4

7.7

8.4

8.2

%

38.0

34.7

11.3

16.0

%

45.8

54.2

100.0

348.0

291.9

362.5

218.4

180.3

172.1

137.5

558.2

325.4

600.5

228.5

131.7

143.3

139.0

2021

$m

465.2

424.8

138.8

196.4

2021

$m

561.0

664.2

1.  Landing hurricane from Florida to Texas. 

2.  Estimated net loss balances presented in the table are unaudited. 

There can be no guarantee that the modelled assumptions and techniques deployed in calculating these figures are accurate. There could also be an 

unmodelled loss which exceeds these figures. In addition, the models contain loss scenarios which could cause a larger loss to capital than the 

modelled expectation from the above return periods. 

Details of annual gross premiums written by geographic area of risks insured are provided below:  

Details of annual gross premiums written by business segment are provided below: 

1,652.3

100.0 

1,225.2

100.0

Comparative figures for the year ended 31 December 2021 have been re-presented in conformity with the current year view. 

1,652.3

100.0 

1,225.2

The Group actively monitors risk levels and manages catastrophe risk accumulations using reinsurance and PML based risk tolerances, which are 

monitored as part of our climate-related risks as outlined on page 68. The Group’s exposures to certain peak zone elemental losses, as a percentage 

of tangible capital, including long-term debt, are shown below. Net loss estimates are before income tax and net of reinstatement premiums and 

outwards reinsurance on a first occurrence return period basis. The exposure to catastrophe losses that would result in an impairment to the 

investment in associate is included in the figures below. 

100 year return period2  

estimated net loss 

250 year return period2

estimated net loss 

I. Reinsurance segment 
The Group's reinsurance segment comprises the following management groups: 

Property reinsurance 
Property catastrophe treaty covers elemental risks and is written on an excess of loss treaty basis. The property catastrophe excess of loss portfolio 
is written within the U.S. and also internationally. Cover is offered for specific perils and regions or countries.  

Property risk excess of loss is written on an excess of loss basis through UNL treaty arrangements, predominantly covering fire and allied perils in 
addition to natural catastrophe exposure. The portfolio is written on a worldwide basis, with particular focus on the U.S. market. 

$m 

tangible capital 

$m 

tangible capital 

Other property treaty business includes property proportional which is written predominantly within the U.S. on a quota share basis. 

The Group is exposed to large natural catastrophe losses, such as windstorm and earthquake losses, primarily from assuming property catastrophe 
excess of loss risks. Exposure to such events is controlled and measured by setting limits on stochastic modelling exposures in certain classes per 
geographic zone and through loss modelling. The accuracy of the latter exposure analysis is limited by the quality of data and the effectiveness of 
the modelling. It is possible that a catastrophic event significantly exceeds the expected modelled event loss.  

Casualty reinsurance 
The casualty treaty book is written predominantly on a quota share basis with a limited amount of excess of loss sold. The book is made up of 
predominantly U.S. exposure in general casualty and professional lines with some smaller specialty casualty deals and excess casualty.  

Financial lines treaty encompasses our mortgage book as well as a small amount of non-mortgage credit. The mortgage book is split between quota 
share and excess of loss structures. It is made up of predominantly U.S exposure on GSE and PMI reinsurance with a small amount in Australia. 

The vast majority of the Accident and Health treaty reinsurance business is excess of loss, either facultative or treaty. The distribution is global but 
with a focus on the U.S., Canada, UK and EU. There is very little exposure in Asia, Australasia, Africa or South America. Typical coverage offered is 
death & disablement, medical expenses, evacuation and repatriation, and other limited ancillary expenses. 

Specialty reinsurance 
Property retrocession is written on an excess of loss basis through treaty arrangements and covers elemental risks. Cover may be on a worldwide or 
regional basis and may cover specific risks or all catastrophe perils. Coverage may be given on a UNL basis, meaning that loss payments are linked 
directly to the ceding company’s own loss, or on a UNL basis warranted on an overall industry loss, as measured by third party index providers, 
known as ILW coverage. 

The energy and marine treaty book is written predominantly on an excess of loss basis and comprises similar exposures to those underwritten out of 
our insurance operation with a focus on 'Blue Chip' clients. 

Aviation treaty provides excess of loss catastrophe cover to the insurers of the world’s major airlines and aircraft manufacturers and includes cover 
for the aircraft themselves as well as losses arising from passenger and third-party liability claims against airlines and/or manufacturers. 

For property treaty and specialty reinsurance, outwards reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to large natural catastrophe losses. 
Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of 
loss basis, however ILWs or proportional treaty arrangements may be entered into. 

II. Insurance segment 
The Group's insurance segment comprises the following management groups: 

Aviation insurance 
Aviation airline comprises aviation deductible and aviation hull and liability. Aviation deductible business is a specialist area with small individual 
limits normally up to $1.0 million and covers the deductible the airline would normally have for each and every loss under the terms of their airline 
policy. Aviation hull and liability provides cover to the airlines directly and includes cover for the aircraft themselves as well as losses arising from 
passenger and third-party liability claims against airlines and/or manufacturers. 

AV52 is written on a risk-attaching excess of loss basis and provides coverage for third-party liability, excluding own passenger liability, resulting 
from acts of war or hijack of aircraft. Cover excludes countries whose governments provide a backstop coverage, but does include some U.S. 
commercial airlines.  

Aviation war covers loss or damage to aviation assets from war, terrorism and similar causes. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to mitigate exposures to an AV52 event loss. Reinsurance is typically purchased on a treaty excess of loss basis. 
Proportional treaty reinsurance is typically used to reduce the Group’s exposure to aviation deductible and the aviation hull and liability business 
and AV52 business. 

Casualty insurance 
Accident & health is a combination of open-market placements, some binding authorities and broker lineslips, with the focus being Group and 
commercial personal accident and disability. The distribution is global but with a focus on the U.S., Canada, UK and EU. There is very little exposure 
in Asia, Australasia, Africa or South America. Typical coverage offered is death & disablement, medical expenses, evacuation and repatriation, and 
other limited ancillary expenses. 

146 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

147 
147

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

The casualty insurance book is currently made up of a small number of consortia opportunities, where established Lloyd’s leads write on our behalf. 
The exposure is currently worldwide and includes both primary and excess exposures for a broad range of middle market risks.  

Energy and marine insurance 
Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value basis.  

Energy upstream comprises upstream energy and energy construction policies which are typically package policies which may include physical 
damage, business interruption and third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets 
covered can be high value and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers. 
Construction energy upstream contracts generally cover all risks of platform and drilling units under construction at yards and offshore, during 
towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.  

Downstream energy risks are generally those with an operational hydrocarbon risk – either processing and/or storage and/or transmission – and 
may also include the production of chemicals and intermediates. Policies typically cover property for physical damage (including natural 
catastrophe) and machinery breakdown perils plus consequential business interruption exposure and may be written on a proportional or excess of 
loss basis, often with loss limits set at a level commensurate with a modelled estimated maximum loss scenario. The portfolio encompasses a global 
spread of accounts. Critical natural catastrophe coverage is usually sub-limited, with underwriting assessment employing industry-accepted 
modelling tools to assess this exposure where possible. The sector provides cover for operational assets, albeit some construction risk is covered 
where it is not deemed the policy’s primary exposure. Third-party liabilities are not covered except where required under legislation for small sub-
limited property damage. 

Power generation comprises power, energy downstream renewables and energy nuclear. Power business can be written either ground-up or on a 
primary or excess basis. The core composition of the portfolio is operational conventional thermal power generation, renewable energy and 
associated transmission and distribution assets. Within the various energy sub-classes are also elements of energy renewables business written, 
which can cover the construction and subsequent operational phases of various renewable energy types. These cover a broad spectrum of power 
generation across the offshore and onshore renewable industry, including wind (offshore and onshore), solar, hydropower, geothermal and biomass. 
Nuclear in this context is written via a binding authority of a large multi-national nuclear pool. A limited amount of reinsurance contracts are also 
written covering nuclear insurance pools. 

The Group writes energy liability business on a stand-alone basis, across the energy sector. Asset types span the full spectrum of energy risks from 
upstream, midstream, to downstream and power, including renewable energy both on and offshore. Unlike the liability contained within the energy 
packages policies, stand-alone energy liability is written on a layered, excess of loss basis and can be written on a primary or excess basis. Coverage 
is worldwide and provides for variety of damages and loss to third parties, arising from elemental and non-elemental events. Our portfolio is focused 
on the upstream operating sector but will include all phases of upstream risk from exploration, construction, operating through to decommissioning 
along with the many contractors and subcontractors that service the upstream sector. Midstream, Downstream and Power coverage will remain 
focused on the operation of physical assets rather than construction, servicing, or demolition. Renewables are most commonly wind or solar and our 
underwriting focus remains on the operators of these assets rather than construction, installation or servicing. 

Cargo and specie is an international account and is written either on a direct basis or by way of reinsurance. It covers the (re)insurance of 
commodities or goods in transit. Typically, transit cover is provided on an all-risks basis for marine perils for the full value of the goods concerned, 
although higher value or capacity business may be written on a layered basis. Static cover is also provided for losses to cargo, from both elemental 
and non-elemental causes, whilst static at points along its route. In addition, the cargo account can include specie and fine art, vault risks, artwork 
on exhibition and marine war business relating to cargo in transit.  

Marine liability is split into two main sections. The first is the general marine liability portfolio which encompasses a broad a spectrum of third-party 
risks emanating from global maritime industry and trade. The second area concerns Protection and Indemnity and is dominated by the reinsurance 
of the International Group of Protection and Indemnity Clubs and covers marine liabilities arising from their members' activities. 

Marine hull and war comprises marine hull, marine builders risk and marine war. Marine hull is generally written on a direct basis and covers marine 
risks on a worldwide basis, primarily for physical damage. Most policies are written on a ground-up basis. Marine builders’ risk covers the building of 
ocean-going vessels in specialised yards worldwide and their testing and commissioning. Marine war is mostly direct insurance of the loss of vessels 
from war, piracy or terrorist attack, with a very limited amount of facultative reinsurance. Marine excess of loss is written on a treaty basis and 
covers ocean and inland marine risks. 

The largest expected exposure in the marine class is from physical loss rather than from elemental loss events, although there is exposure to 
elemental perils and to the costs for removal of wrecks. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to protect a portion of loss from elemental and non-elemental energy and marine claims, and from the 
accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis but, from time to time, proportional treaty 
arrangements may be entered into. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

Property insurance 
Property direct and facultative is a worldwide book of largely commercial property business, written both in the open market and under delegated 
authorities. The account spans small individual locations to Fortune 500 accounts but with a bias towards small to medium-sized risks. Policies are 
generally provided both for non-elemental and elemental perils, although not all risks include both elemental and non-elemental coverage. 
Coverage is generally written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis, although the very largest accounts are currently seldom written at the 
primary level.  

148 
148

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

The casualty insurance book is currently made up of a small number of consortia opportunities, where established Lloyd’s leads write on our behalf. 

The exposure is currently worldwide and includes both primary and excess exposures for a broad range of middle market risks.  

Energy and marine insurance 

Energy risks are written mostly on a direct basis and may be ground-up or for primary or excess layers on either a first loss or full value basis.  

Energy upstream comprises upstream energy and energy construction policies which are typically package policies which may include physical 

damage, business interruption and third-party liability sections. Coverage can include fire and explosion and elemental risks. Individual assets 

covered can be high value and are therefore mostly written on a subscription basis, meaning that coverage is placed with multiple risk carriers. 

Construction energy upstream contracts generally cover all risks of platform and drilling units under construction at yards and offshore, during 

towing and installation. Onshore construction contracts are generally not written.  

Downstream energy risks are generally those with an operational hydrocarbon risk – either processing and/or storage and/or transmission – and 

may also include the production of chemicals and intermediates. Policies typically cover property for physical damage (including natural 

catastrophe) and machinery breakdown perils plus consequential business interruption exposure and may be written on a proportional or excess of 

loss basis, often with loss limits set at a level commensurate with a modelled estimated maximum loss scenario. The portfolio encompasses a global 

spread of accounts. Critical natural catastrophe coverage is usually sub-limited, with underwriting assessment employing industry-accepted 

modelling tools to assess this exposure where possible. The sector provides cover for operational assets, albeit some construction risk is covered 

where it is not deemed the policy’s primary exposure. Third-party liabilities are not covered except where required under legislation for small sub-

limited property damage. 

Power generation comprises power, energy downstream renewables and energy nuclear. Power business can be written either ground-up or on a 

primary or excess basis. The core composition of the portfolio is operational conventional thermal power generation, renewable energy and 

associated transmission and distribution assets. Within the various energy sub-classes are also elements of energy renewables business written, 

which can cover the construction and subsequent operational phases of various renewable energy types. These cover a broad spectrum of power 

generation across the offshore and onshore renewable industry, including wind (offshore and onshore), solar, hydropower, geothermal and biomass. 

Nuclear in this context is written via a binding authority of a large multi-national nuclear pool. A limited amount of reinsurance contracts are also 

written covering nuclear insurance pools. 

The Group writes energy liability business on a stand-alone basis, across the energy sector. Asset types span the full spectrum of energy risks from 

upstream, midstream, to downstream and power, including renewable energy both on and offshore. Unlike the liability contained within the energy 

packages policies, stand-alone energy liability is written on a layered, excess of loss basis and can be written on a primary or excess basis. Coverage 

is worldwide and provides for variety of damages and loss to third parties, arising from elemental and non-elemental events. Our portfolio is focused 

on the upstream operating sector but will include all phases of upstream risk from exploration, construction, operating through to decommissioning 

along with the many contractors and subcontractors that service the upstream sector. Midstream, Downstream and Power coverage will remain 

focused on the operation of physical assets rather than construction, servicing, or demolition. Renewables are most commonly wind or solar and our 

underwriting focus remains on the operators of these assets rather than construction, installation or servicing. 

Cargo and specie is an international account and is written either on a direct basis or by way of reinsurance. It covers the (re)insurance of 

commodities or goods in transit. Typically, transit cover is provided on an all-risks basis for marine perils for the full value of the goods concerned, 

although higher value or capacity business may be written on a layered basis. Static cover is also provided for losses to cargo, from both elemental 

and non-elemental causes, whilst static at points along its route. In addition, the cargo account can include specie and fine art, vault risks, artwork 

on exhibition and marine war business relating to cargo in transit.  

Marine liability is split into two main sections. The first is the general marine liability portfolio which encompasses a broad a spectrum of third-party 

risks emanating from global maritime industry and trade. The second area concerns Protection and Indemnity and is dominated by the reinsurance 

of the International Group of Protection and Indemnity Clubs and covers marine liabilities arising from their members' activities. 

Marine hull and war comprises marine hull, marine builders risk and marine war. Marine hull is generally written on a direct basis and covers marine 

risks on a worldwide basis, primarily for physical damage. Most policies are written on a ground-up basis. Marine builders’ risk covers the building of 

ocean-going vessels in specialised yards worldwide and their testing and commissioning. Marine war is mostly direct insurance of the loss of vessels 

from war, piracy or terrorist attack, with a very limited amount of facultative reinsurance. Marine excess of loss is written on a treaty basis and 

covers ocean and inland marine risks. 

The largest expected exposure in the marine class is from physical loss rather than from elemental loss events, although there is exposure to 

elemental perils and to the costs for removal of wrecks. 

Reinsurance may be purchased to protect a portion of loss from elemental and non-elemental energy and marine claims, and from the 

accumulation of smaller, attritional losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis but, from time to time, proportional treaty 

arrangements may be entered into. Reinsurance may be purchased on a facultative or treaty basis. 

Property direct and facultative is a worldwide book of largely commercial property business, written both in the open market and under delegated 

authorities. The account spans small individual locations to Fortune 500 accounts but with a bias towards small to medium-sized risks. Policies are 

generally provided both for non-elemental and elemental perils, although not all risks include both elemental and non-elemental coverage. 

Coverage is generally written on a full value, primary or excess of loss basis, although the very largest accounts are currently seldom written at the 

Property insurance 

primary level.  

148 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Construction is a worldwide book targeted on SME construction risks, with limited appetite for the larger civil engineering project. It is written in the 
open market and under delegated authorities and whilst not exclusively so, the territorial focus is on North America and Australia. As with Property 
direct and facultative, policies are exposed to both non-elemental and elemental perils. Coverage includes Contractors/Erection All Risks, Frame, 
Plant & Equipment, Machinery Breakdown and associated third party liability. 

Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of 
loss basis, however ILWs or proportional treaty arrangements may be entered into. 

Specialty insurance 
Terrorism business can be written either ground-up or for primary or excess layers, with cover provided for U.S. and worldwide property risks, but 
typically excluding nuclear, chemical, biological and cyber coverage in most territories. Cover is generally provided to medium to large commercial 
and industrial enterprises. Policies are typically written for scheduled locations and exposure is controlled by setting limits on aggregate exposure 
within a ‘blast zone’ radius. The term of these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying exposures. Some national pools are 
also written, which may include nuclear, chemical and biological coverage and may have an element of life coverage. 

Property political risk cover is written either ground-up or on an excess of loss basis. Coverage that the Group provides in the political risk book is 
split between confiscation perils coverage and sovereign obligor coverage. Confiscation perils coverage protects against CEND and may be extended 
to include other perils. Sovereign obligors coverage protects against the non-payment or non-honouring of an obligation by a sovereign or quasi-
sovereign entity. Cover is provided to medium to large commercial and industrial clients as well as bank and commodity trading clients. The term of 
these contracts is often multi-year reflecting the term of the underlying exposures. We have introduced a capability to selectively write Credit 
Insurance as a complementary product to our core Political Risk and Public Obligor portfolio. This is focused on a limited number of established 
client relationships and would target business in geographies that add diversification to the existing portfolio. 

Reinsurance may also be purchased to reduce the Group’s worldwide exposure to large risk losses. Reinsurance is typically purchased on an excess of 
loss basis, however ILWs or proportional treaty arrangements may be entered into. 

Reinsurance 
The Group, in the normal course of business and in accordance with its risk management practices, seeks to reduce certain types of losses that may 
arise from events that could cause unfavourable underwriting results by entering into reinsurance arrangements. Reinsurance does not relieve the 
Group of its obligations to policyholders. Under the Group’s reinsurance security policy, reinsurers are assessed and approved as appropriate security 
based on their financial strength ratings, amongst other factors. The RSC considers reinsurers that are not rated or do not fall within the predefined 
rating categories on a case-by-case basis, and may require collateral to be posted to support such obligations. There are specific guidelines for these 
collateralised contracts. The RSC monitors the Group’s reinsurers on an ongoing basis and formally reviews the Group’s reinsurance arrangements at 
least quarterly. Exposure to the Group’s reinsurance counterparties, compared to the Board-approved tolerances, is reported to the Board of 
Directors on a quarterly basis. 

Reinsurance protection is typically purchased on an excess of loss basis, however it may also include ILW covers or proportional treaty 
arrangements. The mix of reinsurance cover is dependent on the specific loss mitigation requirements, market conditions and available capacity. 
Reinsurance may also be purchased to optimise the risk-adjusted return of the underwriting portfolio. The structure varies between types of peril 
and sub-class. The Group regularly reviews its catastrophe and other exposures and may purchase reinsurance in order to reduce the Group’s net 
exposure to a large natural catastrophe loss and/or to reduce net exposures to other large losses. The Group can purchase both facultative and 
treaty reinsurance with varying cover and attachment points. The reinsurance coverage is not intended to be available to meet all potential loss 
circumstances. The Group will retain some losses, as the cover purchased is unlikely to transfer the totality of the Group’s exposure. Any loss 
amount which exceeds the reinsurance programme would be retained by the Group. Some parts of the reinsurance programme have limited 
reinstatements, therefore the number of claims which may be recovered from second or subsequent losses in those particular circumstances is 
limited.  

Insurance liabilities 
For most insurance and reinsurance companies, the most significant judgement made by management is the estimation of losses and loss 
adjustment expenses. The estimation of the ultimate liability arising from claims made under insurance and reinsurance contracts is a critical 
estimate for the Group, particularly given the nature of the business written.  

Loss reserves are not permitted until the occurrence of an event which may give rise to a claim. As a result, only loss reserves applicable to losses 
incurred up to the reporting date are established, with no allowance for the provision of a contingency reserve to account for expected future losses 
or for the emergence of new types of latent claims. Claims arising from future events can be expected to require the establishment of substantial 
reserves from time to time. All of the Group’s reserves are reported on an undiscounted basis. 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses are maintained to cover the Group’s estimated liability for both reported and unreported claims. Reserving 
methodologies that calculate an actuarial best estimate for the ultimate losses, along with a reserve margin, are utilised. This represents the 
management best estimate of ultimate loss and loss adjustment expenses. The Group’s internal actuaries review the reserving assumptions and 
methodologies on a quarterly basis with loss estimates being subject to a semi-annual independent review by external actuaries. The results of the 
independent review are presented to the Group’s Audit Committee. The Group has also established Reserve Committees at the operating entity 
level, which have responsibility for the review of large claims and IBNR levels, their development and any changes in reserving methodology and 
assumptions. 

The extent to which the reserving process relies on management’s judgement is dependent on a number of factors including whether the business is 
insurance or reinsurance, whether it is short-tail or long-tail and whether the business is written on an excess of loss or pro-rata basis.  

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

149 
149

Financial Statements 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Insurance versus reinsurance 
Loss reserve calculations, whether reserving for direct insurance business or for reinsurance classes are not precise in that they deal with the inherent 
uncertainty of assumptions regarding future reporting and development patterns, frequency and severity trends, claims settlement practices, 
potential changes in the legal environment and other factors, such as inflation. The estimates and judgements relied on in making loss reserve 
calculations are based on a number of factors and may be revised as additional experience or other data becomes available. 

Loss reserve calculations are also reviewed as new or improved methodologies are developed and as laws or regulations change. Furthermore, as a 
business operating within a broker market, management must rely on loss information reported to brokers by other insurers and their loss adjusters, 
who must estimate their own losses at the policy level, often based on incomplete and changing information. The information management 
receives varies by cedant and may include paid losses, estimated case reserves and an estimated provision for IBNR reserves. Additionally, reserving 
practices and the quality of data reporting may vary among ceding companies, which adds further uncertainty to management’s estimates of the 
ultimate losses. 

Short-tail versus long-tail 
In general, claims relating to short-tail risks, such as the majority of risks underwritten by the Group, are reported more promptly than those relating to 
long-tail risks, including the majority of casualty risks. The timeliness of reporting can be affected by such factors as the nature of the event causing the 
loss, the location of the loss and whether the losses are from policies in force with insureds, primary insurers, reinsurers or vendor binding authorities. 

Excess of loss versus proportional 
For excess of loss contracts, which make up the majority of the Group’s business, management is aided by the fact that each policy has a defined 
limit of liability arising from one event. Once that limit has been reached, there is no further exposure to additional losses from that policy for the 
same event. For proportional business, an initial estimated loss and loss expense ratio is generally used. This is based upon information provided by 
the insured or ceding company and/or their broker and management’s historical experience of that treaty, if any, and the estimate is adjusted as 
actual experience becomes known. 

Time lags 
There is a time lag inherent in reporting from the original claimant to the primary insurer or binding authority holder to the broker and then to the 
reinsurer. Also, the combination of low claims frequency and high severity across many of our classes makes the available data more volatile and less 
useful for predicting ultimate losses. In the case of proportional contracts, reliance is placed on an analysis of a contract’s historical experience, 
industry information, and the professional judgement of underwriters in estimating reserves for these contracts. In addition, if available, reliance is 
placed partially on ultimate loss ratio forecasts as reported by insureds or cedants, which are normally subject to a quarterly or six-month time lag. 

Uncertainty 
As a result of the time lag described above, an estimate must be made of IBNR reserves, which consists of a provision for additional development in 
excess of the case reserves reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for claims which have occurred but which have not yet 
been reported by insureds or ceding companies. Due to the degree of reliance that is necessarily placed on insureds or ceding companies for claims 
reporting, the associated time lag, the low frequency/high severity nature of much of the business that the Group underwrites, and the varying 
reserving practices among ceding companies, reserve estimates are highly dependent on management judgement and are therefore uncertain. 
During the loss settlement period, which may be years in duration, additional facts regarding individual claims and trends, including inflation often 
will become known, and current laws and case law may change as well as regulatory directives, with a consequent impact on reserving. 

For certain catastrophic events there are greater uncertainties underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses and loss 
adjustment expenses. Complexity resulting from problems such as policy coverage issues, multiple events affecting one geographic area and the 
resulting impact on claims adjusting (including the allocation of claims to the specific event and the effect of demand surge on the cost of building 
materials and labour) by, and communications from, insureds or ceding companies, can cause delays to the timing with which the Group is notified 
of changes to loss estimates.  

The breakdown of losses and loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, ACR and IBNR is shown in note 13. The majority of the 
IBNR estimate relates to catastrophe events from 2017-2022, in addition to potential claims on non-elemental risks where timing delays in insured 
or cedant reporting may mean losses could have occurred of which the Group was not made aware by the balance sheet date. 

B. Market risk 
The Group is at risk of loss due to movements in market factors. The main risks include: 

Insurance market risk;  
Investment risk;  

i. 
ii. 
iii.  Debt risk; and  
iv.  Currency risk.  

These risks, and the management thereof, are described below. 

I. Insurance Market Risk 
The Group is exposed to insurance market risk from several sources, including the following: 

• 

the advent or continuation of a soft market, which may result in a stabilisation or decline in premium rates and/or terms and conditions for certain 
lines, or across all lines; 

150 
150

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Insurance versus reinsurance 

Loss reserve calculations, whether reserving for direct insurance business or for reinsurance classes are not precise in that they deal with the inherent 

uncertainty of assumptions regarding future reporting and development patterns, frequency and severity trends, claims settlement practices, 

potential changes in the legal environment and other factors, such as inflation. The estimates and judgements relied on in making loss reserve 

calculations are based on a number of factors and may be revised as additional experience or other data becomes available. 

Loss reserve calculations are also reviewed as new or improved methodologies are developed and as laws or regulations change. Furthermore, as a 

business operating within a broker market, management must rely on loss information reported to brokers by other insurers and their loss adjusters, 

who must estimate their own losses at the policy level, often based on incomplete and changing information. The information management 

receives varies by cedant and may include paid losses, estimated case reserves and an estimated provision for IBNR reserves. Additionally, reserving 

practices and the quality of data reporting may vary among ceding companies, which adds further uncertainty to management’s estimates of the 

ultimate losses. 

Short-tail versus long-tail 

In general, claims relating to short-tail risks, such as the majority of risks underwritten by the Group, are reported more promptly than those relating to 

long-tail risks, including the majority of casualty risks. The timeliness of reporting can be affected by such factors as the nature of the event causing the 

loss, the location of the loss and whether the losses are from policies in force with insureds, primary insurers, reinsurers or vendor binding authorities. 

Excess of loss versus proportional 

For excess of loss contracts, which make up the majority of the Group’s business, management is aided by the fact that each policy has a defined 

limit of liability arising from one event. Once that limit has been reached, there is no further exposure to additional losses from that policy for the 

same event. For proportional business, an initial estimated loss and loss expense ratio is generally used. This is based upon information provided by 

the insured or ceding company and/or their broker and management’s historical experience of that treaty, if any, and the estimate is adjusted as 

actual experience becomes known. 

Time lags 

There is a time lag inherent in reporting from the original claimant to the primary insurer or binding authority holder to the broker and then to the 

reinsurer. Also, the combination of low claims frequency and high severity across many of our classes makes the available data more volatile and less 

useful for predicting ultimate losses. In the case of proportional contracts, reliance is placed on an analysis of a contract’s historical experience, 

industry information, and the professional judgement of underwriters in estimating reserves for these contracts. In addition, if available, reliance is 

placed partially on ultimate loss ratio forecasts as reported by insureds or cedants, which are normally subject to a quarterly or six-month time lag. 

Uncertainty 

As a result of the time lag described above, an estimate must be made of IBNR reserves, which consists of a provision for additional development in 

excess of the case reserves reported by insureds or ceding companies, as well as a provision for claims which have occurred but which have not yet 

been reported by insureds or ceding companies. Due to the degree of reliance that is necessarily placed on insureds or ceding companies for claims 

reporting, the associated time lag, the low frequency/high severity nature of much of the business that the Group underwrites, and the varying 

reserving practices among ceding companies, reserve estimates are highly dependent on management judgement and are therefore uncertain. 

During the loss settlement period, which may be years in duration, additional facts regarding individual claims and trends, including inflation often 

will become known, and current laws and case law may change as well as regulatory directives, with a consequent impact on reserving. 

For certain catastrophic events there are greater uncertainties underlying the assumptions and associated estimated reserves for losses and loss 

adjustment expenses. Complexity resulting from problems such as policy coverage issues, multiple events affecting one geographic area and the 

resulting impact on claims adjusting (including the allocation of claims to the specific event and the effect of demand surge on the cost of building 

materials and labour) by, and communications from, insureds or ceding companies, can cause delays to the timing with which the Group is notified 

of changes to loss estimates.  

The breakdown of losses and loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, ACR and IBNR is shown in note 13. The majority of the 

IBNR estimate relates to catastrophe events from 2017-2022, in addition to potential claims on non-elemental risks where timing delays in insured 

or cedant reporting may mean losses could have occurred of which the Group was not made aware by the balance sheet date. 

The Group is at risk of loss due to movements in market factors. The main risks include: 

B. Market risk 

i. 

ii. 

Insurance market risk;  

Investment risk;  

iii.  Debt risk; and  

iv.  Currency risk.  

I. Insurance Market Risk 

lines, or across all lines; 

150 

These risks, and the management thereof, are described below. 

The Group is exposed to insurance market risk from several sources, including the following: 

• 

the advent or continuation of a soft market, which may result in a stabilisation or decline in premium rates and/or terms and conditions for certain 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

the actions and reactions of key competitors, which may directly result in volatility in premium volumes and rates, fee levels and other input costs;  
• 
•  market events, including unusual inflation in rates, may result in a limit in the availability of cover, causing political intervention or national remedies;  
failure to maintain broker, binding authority and client relationships, leading to a limited or substandard choice of risks inconsistent with the Group’s 
• 
risk appetite;  

•  changes in regulation including capital, governance or licensing requirements; and 
•  changes in the geopolitical environment. 

The most important method to mitigate insurance market risk is to maintain strict underwriting standards. The Group manages insurance market 
risk in numerous ways, including the following: 

reviews and amends underwriting plans and outlook as necessary; 
reduces exposure to market sectors where conditions have reached unattractive levels; 

• 
• 
•  purchases appropriate, cost-effective reinsurance cover to mitigate exposures; 
•  closely monitors changes in rates and terms and conditions;  
•  ensures through continuous capital management that it does not allow surplus capital to drive underwriting appetite; 
•  holds a daily underwriting call for LICL and LUK to discuss, inter alia, market conditions and opportunities; 
• 
• 
•  holds a fortnightly RRC meeting to discuss risk and reinsurance; 
•  holds a quarterly UURC meeting to review underwriting strategy; and 
•  holds regular meetings with regulators.  

reviews all new and renewal business post-underwriting for LSL; 
reviews outputs from the economic capital models to assess up-to-date profitability of classes and sectors;  

Insurance contract liabilities are not directly sensitive to the level of market interest rates, as they are undiscounted and contractually non-interest 
bearing.  

II. Investment risk 
Movements in investments resulting from changes in interest and inflation rates and currency exchange rates, amongst other factors, may lead to 
an adverse impact on the value of the Group’s investment portfolio.  

Investment guidelines are established by the Investment Committee of the Board of Directors to manage this risk. Investment guidelines set 
parameters within which the Group’s external investment managers must operate. Important parameters include guidelines on permissible asset 
classes, duration ranges, credit quality, currency, maturity, sectors, geographical, sovereign and issuer exposures. Compliance with guidelines is 
monitored on a monthly basis. Any adjustments to the investment guidelines are approved by the Investment Committee and the Board of 
Directors. In addition, the Group's investment guidelines restricts investments in companies which rely on thermal coal for power generation or 
derive revenues from oil sands or Arctic oil/gas, as well as investments in fixed maturity securities with high carbon intensity ratings. A Climate VaR 
is monitored versus the MSCI benchmark quarterly through analysis of the underlying securities as measured by MSCI for the Group's Level (i) and 
Level (ii) securities. 93.9% of the Group's externally managed portfolio are managed by signatories of the UNPRI.  

The Group’s fixed maturity portfolios are managed by five external investment managers. The Group also has credit funds, principal protected funds, 
private investment funds and a diversified low volatility multi-strategy portfolio of hedge funds. The performance of the managers is monitored on 
an ongoing basis. 

Within the Group’s investment guidelines are subsets of guidelines for the portion of funds required to meet near-term obligations and cash flow 
needs following an extreme event. These guidelines add a further degree of requirements, including fewer allowable asset classes, higher credit 
quality, shorter duration and higher liquidity. The primary objectives for this portion of assets are capital preservation and providing liquidity to meet 
insurance and other near-term obligations. In addition to cash managed internally, funds held in the investment portfolio to cover this potential 
liability are designated as the core and core plus portfolios and the portfolio duration is matched to the duration of the insurance liabilities, within 
an agreed range. The core and core plus portfolios are invested in fixed maturity securities, fixed maturity funds and cash and cash equivalents. The 
combined core and core plus portfolios may, at times, contain assets significantly in excess of those required to meet insurance liabilities or other 
defined funding needs.  

Assets in excess of those required to be held in the core and core plus portfolios are typically held in the surplus portfolio. The surplus portfolio is 
invested in fixed maturity securities, principal protected products, derivative instruments, cash and cash equivalents, private investment funds, 
hedge funds and index linked securities. In general, the duration of the surplus portfolio is slightly longer than the core or core plus portfolios. 

The Group reviews the composition, duration and asset allocation of its investment portfolio on a regular basis in order to respond to changes in 
interest rates and other market conditions. If certain asset classes are anticipated to produce a higher return within management’s risk tolerance, an 
adjustment in asset allocation may be made. Conversely, if the risk profile is expected to move outside of tolerance levels, adjustments may be 
made to reduce the risks in the portfolio. 

The investment portfolio is currently structured to perform similarly in risk-on and risk-off environments. The Group endeavours to limit losses in 
risk-on, risk-off and interest rate hike scenarios. The Group models various periods of significant stress in order to better understand the investment 
portfolio’s risks and exposures. The scenarios represent what could, and most likely will, occur (albeit not in the exact form of the scenarios, which 
are based on historic periods of volatility). The Group also monitors the portfolio impact of more severe disaster scenarios consisting of extreme 
shocks. 

The Investment Committee performs a strategic asset allocation study on a bi-annual basis, which assesses the Group's overall strategy and to 
determine alternative asset allocations to achieve the best risk-adjusted return within our risk tolerances. Additionally, the Investment Committee 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

151 
151

Financial Statements 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

meets quarterly to monitor the management of the investments of the Group against the asset allocations, risk tolerance and risk preference levels, 
and the approved investment guidelines. As part of this the Investment Committee receives information on ESG and carbon intensity scores for the 
fixed income portfolio and the Climate VaR versus the MSCI benchmark at the 1.5°C, 2°C and 3°C Paris Accord level. The IRRC meets quarterly to 
ensure that the Group’s strategic and tactical investment actions are consistent with investment risk preferences, appetite, risk and return objectives 
and tolerances. The IRRC also helps further develop the risk tolerances to be incorporated into the ERM framework. 

The investment mix is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 
•  Short-term investments  
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds  
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

As at 31 December 2021 
•  Short-term investments  
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds  
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

152 
152

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Core
$m 
14.3
29.4
251.3
13.2
3.8
2.8
29.6
11.2
–
–
–
264.7
620.3
–
–
–
–
–
620.3

Core
$m
23.3
17.6
223.5
11.7
4.1
4.2
9.3
10.3
–
–
–
–
244.2
548.2
–
–
–
–
–
548.2

Core plus  
$m 
6.5 
– 
350.0 
– 
15.3 
22.9 
68.3 
13.9 
1.0 
– 
– 
390.9 
868.8 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
868.8 

Core plus  
$m 
21.2 
– 
289.0 
– 
14.8 
29.9 
19.5 
8.6 
4.6 
– 
– 
– 
327.0 
714.6 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
714.6 

Surplus
$m 
0.7
–
48.9
25.7
3.5
33.3
63.0
15.9
13.0
24.2
128.9
96.7
453.8
22.0
108.1
103.9
28.2
(0.2)
715.8

Surplus
$m
–
–
51.7
47.1
5.4
21.1
75.3
66.6
28.6
0.1
20.1
110.2
91.2
517.4
28.9
105.7
102.9
30.5
(0.1)
785.3

Total
$m 
21.5
29.4
650.2
38.9
22.6
59.0
160.9
41.0
14.0
24.2
128.9
752.3
1,942.9
22.0
108.1
103.9
28.2
(0.2)
2,204.9

Total
$m
44.5
17.6
564.2
58.8
24.3
55.2
104.1
85.5
33.2
0.1
20.1
110.2
662.4
1,780.2
28.9
105.7
102.9
30.5
(0.1)
2,048.1

 
 
meets quarterly to monitor the management of the investments of the Group against the asset allocations, risk tolerance and risk preference levels, 

and the approved investment guidelines. As part of this the Investment Committee receives information on ESG and carbon intensity scores for the 

fixed income portfolio and the Climate VaR versus the MSCI benchmark at the 1.5°C, 2°C and 3°C Paris Accord level. The IRRC meets quarterly to 

ensure that the Group’s strategic and tactical investment actions are consistent with investment risk preferences, appetite, risk and return objectives 

and tolerances. The IRRC also helps further develop the risk tolerances to be incorporated into the ERM framework. 

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

The investment mix is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 

•  Short-term investments  

•  Fixed maturity funds 

•  U.S. treasuries 

•  Other government bonds 

•  U.S. municipal bonds 

•  U.S. government agency debt 

•  Asset backed securities 

•  Bank loans 

•  Corporate bonds  

Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 

Private investment funds – at FVTPL 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Index linked securities – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

As at 31 December 2021 

•  Short-term investments  

•  Fixed maturity funds 

•  U.S. treasuries 

•  Other government bonds 

•  U.S. municipal bonds 

•  U.S. government agency debt 

•  Asset backed securities 

•  Bank loans 

•  Corporate bonds  

Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 

Private investment funds – at FVTPL 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Index linked securities – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

The concentration of the Group's fixed maturity securities by country and sector is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 
United States 
United Kingdom 
Cayman Islands 
Canada 
Jersey 
Japan 
Netherlands 
France 
Spain 
Switzerland 
Sweden 
Mexico 
Finland 
Qatar 
Germany 
Other 
Total 

1.  Structured products excludes any Government structured products. 
2.  Other includes overseas deposits and short-term investments. 

As at 31 December 2021 
United States 
United Kingdom 
Canada 
France 
Japan 
Netherlands 
Sweden 
Australia 
Switzerland 
Cayman Islands 
Germany 
Mexico 
Qatar 
United Arab Emirates 
India 
Other 
Total 

Financials
$m 
211.3
39.1
–
21.5
–
14.0
9.3
13.9
10.7
10.0
8.9
2.8
8.1
1.6
3.6
19.3
374.1

Financials
$m 
206.3
29.5
15.8
5.2
15.5
4.7
9.6
6.2
5.5
0.9
5.9
3.3
1.7
5.3
–
22.5
337.9

Industrial
 $m 
426.9
11.8
–
14.3
–
9.8
7.7
2.5
–
0.6
–
4.2
–
–
2.8
23.6
504.2

Industrial
 $m 
359.8
12.0
12.7
4.5
8.6
5.7
–
0.7
2.8
–
1.5
4.0
–
0.9
4.0
16.0
433.2

Government & 
Government 
Agencies 
$m 
772.6 
1.5 
– 
10.5 
– 
– 
– 
0.6 
– 
– 
0.6 
2.0 
– 
5.2 
– 
18.8 
811.8 

Government & 
Government 
Agencies 
$m 
719.3 
5.0 
20.8 
1.1 
1.1 
1.1 
0.6 
2.6 
– 
0.3 
– 
1.5 
6.2 
– 
1.5 
27.0 
788.1 

Utility 
$m 
18.8
–
–
0.5
–
–
3.6
–
–
–
–
0.5
–
–
–
1.5
24.9

Utility
$m 
27.4
–
0.4
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0.2
–
–
0.7
1.6
30.3

Structured1 
$m 
118.3 
0.7 
47.4 
– 
25.8 
– 
– 
2.1 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
4.7 
199.0 

Structured1 
$m 
113.9 
10.5 
5.2 
12.0 
0.7 
0.8 
1.0 
1.3 
2.0 
8.2 
1.9 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
157.5 

Other2
$m 
20.8
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
30.1
50.9

Other2
$m 
33.9
2.3
–
8.3
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
17.6
62.1

Total
$m 
1,568.7
53.1
47.4
46.8
25.8
23.8
20.6
19.1
10.7
10.6
9.5
9.5
8.1
6.8
6.4
98.0
1,964.9

Total
$m 
1,460.6
59.3
54.9
31.1
25.9
12.3
11.2
10.8
10.3
9.4
9.3
9.0
7.9
6.2
6.2
84.7
1,809.1

1.  Structured products excludes any Government structured products. 
2.  Other includes overseas deposits and short-term investments. 

The Group’s net asset value is directly impacted by movements in the fair value of investments held. Values can be impacted by movements in 
interest rates, credit ratings, exchange rates, the current economic environment and outlook.  

Core plus  

Surplus

620.3

868.8 

715.8

2,204.9

Core

$m 

14.3

29.4

251.3

13.2

3.8

2.8

29.6

11.2

$m 

6.5 

– 

– 

350.0 

15.3 

22.9 

68.3 

13.9 

1.0 

264.7

620.3

390.9 

868.8 

Core

$m

23.3

17.6

223.5

11.7

4.1

4.2

9.3

10.3

Core plus  

$m 

21.2 

289.0 

– 

– 

14.8 

29.9 

19.5 

8.6 

4.6 

244.2

548.2

327.0 

714.6 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

$m 

0.7

–

48.9

25.7

3.5

33.3

63.0

15.9

13.0

24.2

128.9

96.7

453.8

22.0

108.1

103.9

28.2

(0.2)

Surplus

$m

–

–

51.7

47.1

5.4

21.1

75.3

66.6

28.6

0.1

20.1

110.2

91.2

517.4

28.9

105.7

102.9

30.5

(0.1)

Total

$m 

21.5

29.4

650.2

38.9

22.6

59.0

160.9

41.0

14.0

24.2

128.9

752.3

1,942.9

22.0

108.1

103.9

28.2

(0.2)

Total

$m

44.5

17.6

564.2

58.8

24.3

55.2

104.1

85.5

33.2

0.1

20.1

110.2

662.4

1,780.2

28.9

105.7

102.9

30.5

(0.1)

548.2

714.6 

785.3

2,048.1

152 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

153 
153

Financial Statements 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Interest rate risk 
The Group’s investment portfolio is mainly comprised of fixed maturity securities and cash and cash equivalents. Fixed maturity funds are overseas 
deposits held by the syndicates in trust for the benefit of the policyholders in those overseas jurisdictions. They consist of high quality, short 
duration fixed maturity securities. The Group also has a hedge fund portfolio as well as principal protected notes and has invested in private 
investment funds. The estimated fair value of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio is generally inversely correlated to movements in market interest 
rates. If market interest rates fall, the fair value of the Group’s fixed maturity securities would tend to rise and vice versa.  

The sensitivity of the price of fixed maturity securities, and certain derivatives, to movements in interest rates is indicated by their duration. The 
greater a security’s duration, the greater its price volatility to movements in interest rates. The sensitivity of the Group’s fixed maturity and 
derivative investment portfolio to interest rate movements is detailed below, assuming linear movements in interest rates: 

As at 31 December 
Immediate shift in yield (basis points) 
100 
75 
50 
25 
(25) 
(50) 
(75) 
(100) 

2022

$m

(34.1)
(25.6)
(17.1)
(8.5)
9.4
18.8
28.2
37.6

% 

(1.7) 
(1.3) 
(0.9) 
(0.4) 
0.5 
1.0 
1.4 
1.9 

2021

$m

(36.6)
(27.4)
(18.3)
(9.1)
9.2
18.4
27.7
36.9

%

(2.0)
(1.5)
(1.0)
(0.5)
0.5
1.0
1.5
2.0

The Group mitigates interest rate risk on the investment portfolio by establishing and monitoring duration ranges in its investment guidelines. The 
Group may manage duration through the use of interest rate futures and swaptions from time to time. The duration of the core portfolio is 
matched to the modelled duration of the insurance reserves, within a permitted range. The permitted duration range for the core plus portfolio is 
between zero and four years and for the surplus portfolio is between one and five years.  

The overall duration for fixed maturities, managed cash and cash equivalents and certain derivatives is 1.6 years (31 December 2021 – 1.8 years). 

In addition to duration management, the Group monitors VaR to measure potential losses in the estimated fair values of its cash and invested assets 
and to understand and monitor risk. The VaR calculation is performed using variance/covariance risk modelling to capture the cash flows and 
embedded optionality of the portfolio. Securities are valued individually using standard market pricing models. These security valuations serve as 
the input to many risk analytics, including full valuation risk analyses, as well as parametric methods that rely on option-adjusted risk sensitivities to 
approximate the risk and return profiles of the portfolio.  

The principal VaR measure that is produced is an annual VaR at the 99th percentile confidence level. Under normal conditions, the portfolio is not 
expected to lose more than the VaR metric listed in the table below, 99% of the time over a one-year time horizon. The appropriateness of this 
measure is considered by the Investment Committee on behalf of the Board of Directors on an annual basis. 

The Group’s annual VaR calculations are as follows: 

As at 31 December 
99th percentile confidence level1 

1.  Including the impact of internal foreign exchange hedges. 

2022

2021

% of 
shareholders’ 
equity 
8.8 

$m 
111.6

% of 
shareholders’ 
equity 
3.6

$m 
50.4

The calculation methodology places emphasis on recent securities price volatility to determine VaR figures. Given interest rate volatility contributes 
to the majority of VaR factors, the significant moves in interest rates during the year ended 31 December 2022 and more importantly the most 
recent volatility, the calculated VaR has increased meaningfully during the year. In addition, the investment portfolio has increased in size relative to 
Shareholders' equity which has also contributed to the increase in VaR. Despite the increase, the total VaR is still considered within acceptable limits. 

Price risk 
Price risk is the risk that the fair value of our investment portfolio will fluctuate because of changes in market prices (other than those arising from 
interest rate or foreign exchange rate risk), whether those changes are caused by factors specific to the individual investment or other market 
factors. 

The Group's price risk exposure relates to our hedge funds, private investment funds and index linked securities. Listed investments that are quoted 
in an active market are recognised at quoted bid price, which is deemed to be the approximate exit price. If the market for the investment is not 
considered to be active, then the Group establishes fair value using valuation techniques (refer to note 11). This includes comparison to orderly 
transactions between market participants, reference to benchmarks or other indices to assess reasonableness and other valuation techniques that 
are commonly used by market participants. 

A 10% downward correction at 31 December 2022 would reduce our hedge funds, private investment funds and index linked securities by 
approximately $24.0 million (31 December 2021 - $23.9 million). 

154 
154

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Interest rate risk 

As at 31 December 

Immediate shift in yield (basis points) 

100 

75 

50 

25 

(25) 

(50) 

(75) 

(100) 

The Group’s investment portfolio is mainly comprised of fixed maturity securities and cash and cash equivalents. Fixed maturity funds are overseas 

deposits held by the syndicates in trust for the benefit of the policyholders in those overseas jurisdictions. They consist of high quality, short 

duration fixed maturity securities. The Group also has a hedge fund portfolio as well as principal protected notes and has invested in private 

investment funds. The estimated fair value of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio is generally inversely correlated to movements in market interest 

rates. If market interest rates fall, the fair value of the Group’s fixed maturity securities would tend to rise and vice versa.  

The sensitivity of the price of fixed maturity securities, and certain derivatives, to movements in interest rates is indicated by their duration. The 

greater a security’s duration, the greater its price volatility to movements in interest rates. The sensitivity of the Group’s fixed maturity and 

derivative investment portfolio to interest rate movements is detailed below, assuming linear movements in interest rates: 

Derivative financial instruments 
The Group uses derivative financial instruments primarily to mitigate exposure to foreign currency risk, interest rate risk and credit risk. The Group’s 
investment guidelines permit the investment managers to utilise exchange-traded futures and options contracts, OTC instruments including interest 
rate swaps, credit default swaps, interest rate swaptions and forward foreign currency contracts.  

The net (losses) gains on the Group’s derivative financial instruments recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income are as follows: 

2022

$m

2021

$m

% 

(1.7) 

(1.3) 

(0.9) 

(0.4) 

0.5 

1.0 

1.4 

1.9 

(36.6)

(27.4)

(18.3)

(9.1)

9.2

18.4

27.7

36.9

%

(2.0)

(1.5)

(1.0)

(0.5)

0.5

1.0

1.5

2.0

(34.1)

(25.6)

(17.1)

(8.5)

9.4

18.8

28.2

37.6

As at 31 December 2022 
Interest rate futures 
Forward foreign currency contracts 
Interest rate swaps  
Total 

As at 31 December 2021 
Interest rate futures 
Forward foreign currency contracts 
Interest rate swaps  
Total 

Net realised  
(losses) gains 
$m 
0.1 
– 
(2.4) 
(2.3) 

Net foreign
exchange 
(losses) gains
$m 
–
(3.0)
0.2
(2.8)

Net realised 
(losses)  
gains  
$m 
(0.5) 
– 
0.3 

Net foreign 
exchange 
(losses) gains
$m
–
(0.6)
–

(0.2) 

(0.6)

The estimated fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments are as follows: 

As at 31 December 
Forward foreign currency contracts 
Interest rate swaps 
Credit default swaps 
Total 

Other
investments 
$m
(0.2)
–
–
(0.2)

2022

Other
receivables 
$m
2.5
–
–
2.5

Other  
payables  
$m 
(0.4) 
– 
– 
(0.4) 

Other  
investments  
$m 
(0.3) 
(0.3) 
0.5 

(0.1) 

2021

Other
receivables 
$m
0.6
–
–

0.6

Financing 
(losses) 
$m 
–
–
–
–

Financing 
(losses) 
$m
–
–
(3.4)

(3.4)

Other 
payables 
$m
(0.6)
–
–

(0.6)

A. Futures  
Futures provide the Group with participation in market movements, determined by the underlying instrument on which the futures contract is 
based, without holding the instrument itself or the individual securities. This allows efficient and less costly access to the exposure than would be 
available by the exclusive use of individual fixed maturity and money market securities. Exchange-traded futures contracts may also be used as 
substitutes for ownership of the physical securities. 

All futures contracts are held on a non-leveraged basis. An initial margin is provided, which is a deposit of cash and/or securities in an amount equal 
to a prescribed percentage of the contract value. The fair value of futures contracts is estimated daily and the margin is adjusted accordingly with 
unrealised gains and/or losses settled daily in cash and/or securities. A realised gain or loss is recognised when the contract is closed. 

Futures contracts expose the Group to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the estimated fair values of the underlying securities. 
Exchange-traded futures are, however, subject to a number of safeguards to ensure that obligations are met. These include the use of clearing 
houses (thus reducing counterparty credit risk), the posting of margins and the daily settlement of unrealised gains and losses. The amount of credit 
risk is therefore considered low. The investment guidelines restrict the maximum notional futures position as a percentage of the investment 
portfolio’s estimated fair value. 

The Group's exposure to interest rate futures is as follows: 

The Group mitigates interest rate risk on the investment portfolio by establishing and monitoring duration ranges in its investment guidelines. The 

Group may manage duration through the use of interest rate futures and swaptions from time to time. The duration of the core portfolio is 

matched to the modelled duration of the insurance reserves, within a permitted range. The permitted duration range for the core plus portfolio is 

between zero and four years and for the surplus portfolio is between one and five years.  

The overall duration for fixed maturities, managed cash and cash equivalents and certain derivatives is 1.6 years (31 December 2021 – 1.8 years). 

In addition to duration management, the Group monitors VaR to measure potential losses in the estimated fair values of its cash and invested assets 

and to understand and monitor risk. The VaR calculation is performed using variance/covariance risk modelling to capture the cash flows and 

embedded optionality of the portfolio. Securities are valued individually using standard market pricing models. These security valuations serve as 

the input to many risk analytics, including full valuation risk analyses, as well as parametric methods that rely on option-adjusted risk sensitivities to 

approximate the risk and return profiles of the portfolio.  

The principal VaR measure that is produced is an annual VaR at the 99th percentile confidence level. Under normal conditions, the portfolio is not 

expected to lose more than the VaR metric listed in the table below, 99% of the time over a one-year time horizon. The appropriateness of this 

measure is considered by the Investment Committee on behalf of the Board of Directors on an annual basis. 

The Group’s annual VaR calculations are as follows: 

As at 31 December 

99th percentile confidence level1 

1.  Including the impact of internal foreign exchange hedges. 

2022

2021

% of 

shareholders’ 

equity 

8.8 

$m 

111.6

shareholders’ 

% of 

equity 

3.6

$m 

50.4

The calculation methodology places emphasis on recent securities price volatility to determine VaR figures. Given interest rate volatility contributes 

to the majority of VaR factors, the significant moves in interest rates during the year ended 31 December 2022 and more importantly the most 

recent volatility, the calculated VaR has increased meaningfully during the year. In addition, the investment portfolio has increased in size relative to 

Shareholders' equity which has also contributed to the increase in VaR. Despite the increase, the total VaR is still considered within acceptable limits. 

Price risk 

factors. 

Price risk is the risk that the fair value of our investment portfolio will fluctuate because of changes in market prices (other than those arising from 

interest rate or foreign exchange rate risk), whether those changes are caused by factors specific to the individual investment or other market 

As at 31 December 
Interest rate futures 

Notional
long 
$m 
–

2022

Notional
short 
$m 
–

Net notional  
long (short)  
$m 
– 

Notional  
long  
$m 
44.1 

2021

Notional 
 short 
 $m 
36.8

Net notional
long (short) 
$m 
7.3

The Group's price risk exposure relates to our hedge funds, private investment funds and index linked securities. Listed investments that are quoted 

in an active market are recognised at quoted bid price, which is deemed to be the approximate exit price. If the market for the investment is not 

considered to be active, then the Group establishes fair value using valuation techniques (refer to note 11). This includes comparison to orderly 

transactions between market participants, reference to benchmarks or other indices to assess reasonableness and other valuation techniques that 

are commonly used by market participants. 

A 10% downward correction at 31 December 2022 would reduce our hedge funds, private investment funds and index linked securities by 

approximately $24.0 million (31 December 2021 - $23.9 million). 

154 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

B. Options 
Exchange-traded options on U.S. treasury futures and Euro dollar futures are used to manage exposure to interest rate risk and also to hedge 
duration. Exchange-traded options are held on a similar basis to futures and are subject to similar safeguards. Options are contractual arrangements 
that give the purchaser the right, but not the obligation, to either buy or sell an instrument at a specific set price at a predetermined future date. The 
Group may enter into option contracts that are secured by holdings in the underlying securities or by other means which permit immediate 
satisfaction of the Group’s obligations. The notional amount of options is $nil as at 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

The investment guidelines also restrict the maximum notional options exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

155 
155

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

C. Forward foreign currency contracts 
A forward foreign currency contract is a commitment to purchase or sell a foreign currency at a future date, at a defined rate. The Group may utilise 
forward foreign currency contracts to gain exposure to a certain currency or market rate or manage the impact of fluctuations in foreign currencies 
on the value of its foreign currency denominated investments, debt, insurance related currency exposures and/or expenses. 

Forward contracts expose the Group to credit, market and liquidity risks. Credit risk arises from the potential inability of counterparties to perform 
under the terms of the contract. The Group is exposed to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the exchange rate of the underlying 
foreign currency. Liquidity risk represents the possibility that the Group may not be able to rapidly adjust the size of its forward positions at a 
reasonable price in times of high volatility and financial stress. These risks are mitigated by requiring a minimum counterparty credit quality, 
restricting the maximum notional exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value and restricting exposures to foreign 
currencies, individually and in aggregate, as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value.  

The notional amount of a derivative contract is the underlying quantity upon which payment obligations are calculated. A long position is 
equivalent to buying the underlying currency whereas a short position is equivalent to having sold the underlying currency. 

The Group has the following open forward foreign currency contracts: 

As at 31 December 
Canadian Dollar 
Euro 
Australian Dollar 
Japanese Yen 
Danish Krone 
Sterling 
Total 

Notional
long 
$m
–
42.7
–
5.2
–
93.5
141.4

2022

Notional
short 
$m
22.8
3.8
13.8
–
0.2
0.8
41.4

Net notional
long (short) 
$m
(22.8)
38.9
(13.8)
5.2
(0.2)
92.7
100.0

Notional  
long  
$m 
– 
19.2 
– 
– 
– 
45.2 

64.4 

2021 

Notional 
 short 
 $m
36.2
21.0
9.3
–
3.9
7.6

78.0

Net notional
long (short) 
$m
(36.2)
(1.8)
(9.3)
–
(3.9)
37.6

(13.6)

D. Swaps 
Interest rate swaps, traded primarily OTC, are used to manage interest rate exposure, portfolio duration or to capitalise on anticipated changes in 
interest rate volatility without investing directly in the underlying securities. Interest rate swap agreements entail the exchange of commitments to 
pay or receive interest, such as an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments, with respect to a notional amount of principal. These 
agreements involve elements of credit and market risk. Such risks include the possibility that there may not be a liquid market, that the 
counterparty may default on its obligation to perform, or that there may be unfavourable movements in interest rates. These risks are mitigated 
through defining a minimum counterparty credit quality and a maximum notional exposure to interest rate swaps as a percentage of the investment 
portfolio’s estimated fair value. The notional amount of interest rate swaps held in the investment portfolio was $nil as at 31 December 2022 (31 
December 2021 – $1.3 million). The notional amount of interest rate swaps held for hedging purposes was $nil as at 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

The Group may utilise credit default swaps to add or reduce credit risk to an individual issuer, or a basket of issuers, without investing directly in 
their securities. The Group held credit default swaps of $nil as at 31 December 2022 (31 December 2021 – $13.4 million). 

During the year ended 31 December 2021, the Group entered into an interest rate swap, in the form of a 'Treasury lock'. This was in order to hedge 
the 10-year treasury rate on the issuance of the $450.0 million fixed-rate reset junior subordinated Notes (see note 18), between the date that the 
Group announced the issuance of the Notes, and the finalisation of the transaction on 11 March 2021. The 10-year treasury reference rate reduced 
over the relevant period and a net payment was made of $3.4 million. 

III. Debt risk 
During the year ended 31 December 2021, the Group issued $450.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 5.625% fixed-rate reset junior 
subordinated notes, repayable on 18 September 2041 (see note 18). The fixed interest rate will reset on 18 September 2031 at a rate per annum 
equal to the prevailing five year treasury rate plus a credit spread of 4.08% and a relevant 100 basis point step up.  

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk in the future if prevailing rates at the time of reset are materially different from the existing rates on the 
debt issue. 

IV. Currency risk 
The Group underwrites from multiple locations and risks are assumed on a worldwide basis. Risks assumed are predominantly denominated in U.S. 
dollars.  

The Group is exposed to currency risk to the extent its assets are denominated in different currencies to its liabilities. Exchange gains and losses can 
impact profit or loss. 

The Group hedges monetary non-U.S. dollar liabilities primarily with non-U.S. dollar assets, but may also use derivatives to mitigate foreign 
currency exposures. The Group’s main foreign currency exposure relates to its insurance obligations, cash holdings, investments, premiums 
receivable and dividends payable. The Group uses forward foreign currency contracts for the purposes of managing currency exposures.  

156 
156

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

C. Forward foreign currency contracts 

A forward foreign currency contract is a commitment to purchase or sell a foreign currency at a future date, at a defined rate. The Group may utilise 

forward foreign currency contracts to gain exposure to a certain currency or market rate or manage the impact of fluctuations in foreign currencies 

on the value of its foreign currency denominated investments, debt, insurance related currency exposures and/or expenses. 

Forward contracts expose the Group to credit, market and liquidity risks. Credit risk arises from the potential inability of counterparties to perform 

under the terms of the contract. The Group is exposed to market risk to the extent that adverse changes occur in the exchange rate of the underlying 

foreign currency. Liquidity risk represents the possibility that the Group may not be able to rapidly adjust the size of its forward positions at a 

reasonable price in times of high volatility and financial stress. These risks are mitigated by requiring a minimum counterparty credit quality, 

restricting the maximum notional exposure as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value and restricting exposures to foreign 

currencies, individually and in aggregate, as a percentage of the investment portfolio’s estimated fair value.  

The notional amount of a derivative contract is the underlying quantity upon which payment obligations are calculated. A long position is 

equivalent to buying the underlying currency whereas a short position is equivalent to having sold the underlying currency. 

The Group has the following open forward foreign currency contracts: 

2022

Notional

Net notional

long (short) 

2021 

Notional 

Net notional

long (short) 

Notional

long 

$m

42.7

5.2

–

–

–

93.5

141.4

short 

$m

22.8

3.8

13.8

–

0.2

0.8

41.4

$m

(22.8)

38.9

(13.8)

5.2

(0.2)

92.7

100.0

Notional  

long  

$m 

– 

19.2 

– 

– 

– 

45.2 

64.4 

 short 

 $m

36.2

21.0

9.3

–

3.9

7.6

78.0

$m

(36.2)

(1.8)

(9.3)

–

(3.9)

37.6

(13.6)

As at 31 December 

Canadian Dollar 

Euro 

Australian Dollar 

Japanese Yen 

Danish Krone 

Sterling 

Total 

D. Swaps 

III. Debt risk 

debt issue. 

IV. Currency risk 

dollars.  

impact profit or loss. 

Interest rate swaps, traded primarily OTC, are used to manage interest rate exposure, portfolio duration or to capitalise on anticipated changes in 

interest rate volatility without investing directly in the underlying securities. Interest rate swap agreements entail the exchange of commitments to 

pay or receive interest, such as an exchange of floating rate payments for fixed rate payments, with respect to a notional amount of principal. These 

agreements involve elements of credit and market risk. Such risks include the possibility that there may not be a liquid market, that the 

counterparty may default on its obligation to perform, or that there may be unfavourable movements in interest rates. These risks are mitigated 

through defining a minimum counterparty credit quality and a maximum notional exposure to interest rate swaps as a percentage of the investment 

portfolio’s estimated fair value. The notional amount of interest rate swaps held in the investment portfolio was $nil as at 31 December 2022 (31 

December 2021 – $1.3 million). The notional amount of interest rate swaps held for hedging purposes was $nil as at 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

The Group may utilise credit default swaps to add or reduce credit risk to an individual issuer, or a basket of issuers, without investing directly in 

their securities. The Group held credit default swaps of $nil as at 31 December 2022 (31 December 2021 – $13.4 million). 

During the year ended 31 December 2021, the Group entered into an interest rate swap, in the form of a 'Treasury lock'. This was in order to hedge 

the 10-year treasury rate on the issuance of the $450.0 million fixed-rate reset junior subordinated Notes (see note 18), between the date that the 

Group announced the issuance of the Notes, and the finalisation of the transaction on 11 March 2021. The 10-year treasury reference rate reduced 

over the relevant period and a net payment was made of $3.4 million. 

During the year ended 31 December 2021, the Group issued $450.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 5.625% fixed-rate reset junior 

subordinated notes, repayable on 18 September 2041 (see note 18). The fixed interest rate will reset on 18 September 2031 at a rate per annum 

equal to the prevailing five year treasury rate plus a credit spread of 4.08% and a relevant 100 basis point step up.  

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk in the future if prevailing rates at the time of reset are materially different from the existing rates on the 

The Group underwrites from multiple locations and risks are assumed on a worldwide basis. Risks assumed are predominantly denominated in U.S. 

The Group is exposed to currency risk to the extent its assets are denominated in different currencies to its liabilities. Exchange gains and losses can 

The Group hedges monetary non-U.S. dollar liabilities primarily with non-U.S. dollar assets, but may also use derivatives to mitigate foreign 

currency exposures. The Group’s main foreign currency exposure relates to its insurance obligations, cash holdings, investments, premiums 

receivable and dividends payable. The Group uses forward foreign currency contracts for the purposes of managing currency exposures.  

The Group’s assets and liabilities, categorised by currency at their translated carrying amount, are as follows: 

Assets 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Accrued interest receivable 
Investments 
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants 
Reinsurance assets 
Other receivables 
Corporation tax receivable 
Investment in associate 
Property, plant and equipment 
Right-of-use assets 
Deferred acquisition costs 
Intangible assets 
Total assets as at 31 December 2022 

Liabilities 
Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Unearned premiums 
Insurance contracts – other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Deferred acquisition costs ceded 
Other payables 
Deferred tax liability 
Lease liabilities 
Long-term debt 
Total liabilities as at 31 December 2022 

Assets 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Accrued interest receivable 
Investments 
Inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants 
Reinsurance assets 
Other receivables 
Investment in associate 
Property, plant and equipment 
Right-of-use assets 
Deferred acquisition costs 
Intangible assets 
Total assets as at 31 December 2021 

U.S.$
$m
434.6
11.2
2,160.8
544.8
748.4
11.2
0.1
57.2
0.5
0.9
138.7
153.8

4,262.2

U.S.$
$m
1,463.5
651.9
26.0
241.2
26.2
11.5
12.5
1.0
446.1
2,879.9

U.S.$
$m 
419.7
6.9
2,015.6
377.9
480.2
8.6
118.7
0.7
1.8
88.4
153.8
3,672.3

Sterling
$m
23.5
–
3.0
49.8
19.6
17.8
1.3
–
0.6
19.2
11.8
18.6

165.2

Sterling
$m
91.3
48.9
5.2
1.8
0.8
25.8
(3.2)
22.1
–
192.7

Sterling
$m 
27.7
–
3.6
53.2
38.2
10.2
–
0.1
11.6
7.3
4.1
156.0

Euro  
$m 
35.6 
– 
(0.3) 
46.5 
55.5 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
12.9 
– 

Japanese Yen  
$m 
10.3 
– 
– 
7.5 
2.1 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
1.6 
– 

Other
$m
44.8
0.1
41.4
39.7
4.7
1.1
(0.3)
–
–
0.2
15.8
–

150.2 

21.5 

147.5

Euro  
$m 
148.2 
57.7 
0.5 
19.1 
4.6 
– 
– 
– 
– 
230.1 

Euro  
 $m 
23.1
0.1
(0.6) 
39.0
51.3
–
–
–
–
18.4
–
131.3

Japanese Yen  
$m 
22.4 
11.7 
(0.1) 
2.1 
0.4 
– 
– 
– 
– 
36.5 

Japanese Yen  
$m 
4.0 
– 
– 
7.1 
2.8 
– 
– 
– 
– 
1.7 
– 
15.6 

Other
$m
55.4
50.9
21.3
4.0
0.9
6.8
–
0.2
–
139.5

Other
$m 
43.2
0.1
29.5
13.4
2.3
–
–
–
–
5.8
–
94.3

Total
$m
548.8
11.3
2,204.9
688.3
830.3
30.1
1.1
57.2
1.1
20.3
180.8
172.4

4,746.6

Total
$m
1,780.8
821.1
52.9
268.2
32.9
44.1
9.3
23.3
446.1
3,478.7

Total
$m 
517.7
7.1
2,048.1
490.6
574.8
18.8
118.7
0.8
13.4
121.6
157.9
4,069.5

156 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

157 
157

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Liabilities 
Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Unearned premiums 
Insurance contracts – other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Deferred acquisition costs ceded 
Other payables 
Corporation tax payable 
Deferred tax liability 
Lease liabilities 
Long-term debt 
Total liabilities as at 31 December 2021 

U.S.$
$m
1,025.3
448.7
15.3
154.8
19.7
16.2
–
12.5
2.0
445.7
2,140.2

Sterling
$m
77.2
35.1
3.5
27.2
0.4
20.8
1.6
(0.3)
15.9
–
181.4

Euro
$m
93.1
72.6
1.0
17.3
6.3
–
–
–
–
–
190.3

Japanese Yen  
$m 
26.2 
15.1 
– 
2.8 
0.4 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
44.5 

Other
$m
69.3
26.4
0.5
3.5
0.2
0.4
–
–
–
–
100.3

Total
$m
1,291.1
597.9
20.3
205.6
27.0
37.4
1.6
12.2
17.9
445.7
2,656.7

The impact on net income of a proportional foreign exchange movement of 10.0% up and 10.0% down against the U.S. dollar at the year end spot 
rates would be an increase or decrease of $4.5 million (2021 – $3.9 million). 

C. Liquidity risk 
Liquidity risk is the risk that cash may not be available to pay obligations when they are due without incurring an unreasonable cost. The Group’s 
main exposures to liquidity risk are with respect to its insurance and investment activities. The Group is exposed if proceeds from financial assets are 
not sufficient to fund obligations arising from its insurance contracts. The Group can be exposed to daily calls on its available investment assets, 
principally to settle insurance claims and to fund trust accounts following a large catastrophe loss. 

Exposures in relation to insurance activities are as follows: 

• 

• 
• 

large catastrophic events, or multiple medium-sized events in quick succession, resulting in a requirement to pay a large value of claims within a 
relatively short time frame or fund trust accounts; 
failure of insureds or cedants to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of premiums in a timely manner; and 
failure of reinsurers to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of claims in a timely manner.  

Exposures in relation to investment activities are as follows: 

•  adverse market movements and/or a duration mismatch to obligations, resulting in investments being disposed of at a significant realised loss; and 
•  an inability to liquidate investments due to market conditions. 

The maturity dates of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 
Less than one year 
Between one and two years 
Between two and three years 
Between three and four years 
Between four and five years 
Over five years 
Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 
Total fixed maturity securities 

As at 31 December 2021 
Less than one year 
Between one and two years 
Between two and three years 
Between three and four years 
Between four and five years 
Over five years 
Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 
Total fixed maturity securities 

158 
158

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Core
$m 
159.5
175.2
113.9
73.2
21.1
36.6
40.8

620.3

Core 
 $m 
119.0
198.1
102.3
61.9
30.2
17.1
19.6
548.2

Core plus  
$m 
212.1 
245.2 
155.3 
80.6 
28.2 
64.2 
83.2 

868.8 

Core plus  
$m 
144.7 
255.4 
133.3 
89.6 
33.6 
25.3 
32.7 
714.6 

Surplus
$m 
20.9
25.2
69.4
50.8
48.2
145.2
116.1

475.8

Surplus 
 $m 
18.5
25.4
38.6
40.8
55.1
177.2
190.7
546.3

Total
$m 
392.5
445.6
338.6
204.6
97.5
246.0
240.1

1,964.9

Total
$m 
282.2
478.9
274.2
192.3
118.9
219.6
243.0
1,809.1

 
 
 
The maturity profile of the insurance contracts and financial liabilities of the Group is as follows:  

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values

As at 31 December 2022 
Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Insurance contracts – other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Other payables 
Lease liabilities 
Long-term debt1 
Total 

1.  The maturity profile of long-term debt includes interest. 

As at 31 December 2021 
Losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Insurance contracts – other payables 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Other payables 
Lease liabilities 
Long-term debt1 
Total 

Balance sheet
$m 
1,780.8
52.9
268.2
44.1
23.3
446.1
2,615.4

Less than one
$m 
879.7
38.7
268.2
44.1
3.6
25.3
1,259.6

One to three  
$m 
595.1 
13.3 
– 
– 
6.6 
50.6 
665.6 

Three to five  
$m 
184.2 
0.9 
– 
– 
6.8 
50.6 
242.5 

Years until liability becomes due – undiscounted values

Balance sheet
$m 
1,291.1
20.3
205.6
37.4
17.9
445.7
2,018.0

Less than one
$m 
676.6
13.7
205.6
37.4
3.7
25.3
962.3

One to three  
$m 
425.1 
6.6 
– 
– 
6.4 
50.6 
488.7 

Three to five  
$m 
114.3 
– 
– 
– 
5.1 
50.6 
170.0 

Over five
$m 
121.8
–
–
–
12.3
551.3
685.4

Over five
$m 
75.1
–
–
–
6.1
576.6
657.8

Total
$m 
1,780.8
52.9
268.2
44.1
29.3
677.8
2,853.1

Total
$m 
1,291.1
20.3
205.6
37.4
21.3
703.1
2,278.8

large catastrophic events, or multiple medium-sized events in quick succession, resulting in a requirement to pay a large value of claims within a 

1.  The maturity profile of long-term debt includes interest. 

Actual maturities of the above may differ from contractual maturities because certain borrowers have the right to call or prepay certain obligations 
with or without call or prepayment penalties. While the estimation of the ultimate liability for losses and loss adjustment expenses is complex and 
incorporates a significant amount of judgement, the timing of payment of losses and loss adjustment expenses is also uncertain and cannot be 
predicted as simply as for other financial liabilities. Actuarial and statistical techniques, past experience and management’s judgement have been 
used to determine a likely settlement pattern. 

As at 31 December 2022, cash and cash equivalents were $548.8 million (31 December 2021 – $517.7 million). The Group manages its liquidity risks 
via its investment strategy to hold high-quality, liquid securities, sufficient to meet its insurance liabilities and other near-term liquidity 
requirements. The creation of the core and core plus portfolios with their subset of guidelines aims to ensure funds are readily available to meet 
potential insurance liabilities in an extreme event plus other near-term liquidity requirements. In addition, the Group has established asset 
allocation and maturity parameters within the investment guidelines such that the majority of the investments are in high quality assets which 
could be converted into cash promptly and at minimal expense. The Group monitors market changes and outlook and reallocates assets as it deems 
necessary. 

As at 31 December 2022, the Group considers that it has more than adequate liquidity to pay its obligations as they fall due.  

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

Liabilities 

Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Unearned premiums 

Insurance contracts – other payables 

Amounts payable to reinsurers 

Deferred acquisition costs ceded 

Other payables 

Corporation tax payable 

Deferred tax liability 

Lease liabilities 

Long-term debt 

U.S.$

$m

1,025.3

448.7

15.3

154.8

19.7

16.2

–

12.5

2.0

445.7

2,140.2

Sterling

$m

77.2

35.1

3.5

27.2

0.4

20.8

1.6

(0.3)

15.9

–

Euro

$m

93.1

72.6

1.0

17.3

6.3

–

–

–

–

–

Japanese Yen  

$m 

26.2 

15.1 

– 

2.8 

0.4 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

Other

$m

69.3

26.4

0.5

3.5

0.2

0.4

–

–

–

–

Total

$m

1,291.1

597.9

20.3

205.6

27.0

37.4

1.6

12.2

17.9

445.7

2,656.7

Total liabilities as at 31 December 2021 

181.4

190.3

44.5 

100.3

The impact on net income of a proportional foreign exchange movement of 10.0% up and 10.0% down against the U.S. dollar at the year end spot 

rates would be an increase or decrease of $4.5 million (2021 – $3.9 million). 

C. Liquidity risk 

Liquidity risk is the risk that cash may not be available to pay obligations when they are due without incurring an unreasonable cost. The Group’s 

main exposures to liquidity risk are with respect to its insurance and investment activities. The Group is exposed if proceeds from financial assets are 

not sufficient to fund obligations arising from its insurance contracts. The Group can be exposed to daily calls on its available investment assets, 

principally to settle insurance claims and to fund trust accounts following a large catastrophe loss. 

Exposures in relation to insurance activities are as follows: 

• 

• 

• 

relatively short time frame or fund trust accounts; 

failure of insureds or cedants to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of premiums in a timely manner; and 

failure of reinsurers to meet their contractual obligations with respect to the payment of claims in a timely manner.  

•  adverse market movements and/or a duration mismatch to obligations, resulting in investments being disposed of at a significant realised loss; and 

Exposures in relation to investment activities are as follows: 

•  an inability to liquidate investments due to market conditions. 

The maturity dates of the Group’s fixed maturity portfolio are as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed maturity securities 

As at 31 December 2021 

Less than one year 

Between one and two years 

Between two and three years 

Between three and four years 

Between four and five years 

Over five years 

Asset backed and mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed maturity securities 

620.3

868.8 

1,964.9

Core

$m 

159.5

175.2

113.9

73.2

21.1

36.6

40.8

Core 

 $m 

119.0

198.1

102.3

61.9

30.2

17.1

19.6

Core plus  

$m 

212.1 

245.2 

155.3 

80.6 

28.2 

64.2 

83.2 

Core plus  

$m 

144.7 

255.4 

133.3 

89.6 

33.6 

25.3 

32.7 

Surplus

$m 

20.9

25.2

69.4

50.8

48.2

145.2

116.1

475.8

Surplus 

 $m 

18.5

25.4

38.6

40.8

55.1

177.2

190.7

546.3

Total

$m 

392.5

445.6

338.6

204.6

97.5

246.0

240.1

Total

$m 

282.2

478.9

274.2

192.3

118.9

219.6

243.0

548.2

714.6 

1,809.1

158 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

159 
159

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

D. Credit risk 
Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty may fail to pay, or repay, a debt or obligation. The Group is exposed to credit risk on its fixed maturity investment 
portfolio and derivative instruments, its inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants, and on any amounts recoverable from reinsurers.  

Credit risk on the fixed maturity portfolio is mitigated through the Group’s policy to invest in instruments of high-credit-quality issuers and to limit 
the amounts of credit exposure with respect to particular ratings categories and any one issuer. Securities rated below an S&P or equivalent rating 
of BBB-/Baa3 may comprise no more than 15.0% of shareholders’ equity. In addition, no one issuer, with the exception of U.S. government and 
agency securities, other G10 government guaranteed securities (excluding Italy) and Australian sovereign debt, should exceed 5.0% of shareholders’ 
equity. The Group is therefore not exposed to any significant credit concentration risk on its investment portfolio, except for fixed maturity 
securities issued by the U.S. government and government agencies and other highly-rated governments.  

Credit risk on exchange-traded derivative instruments is mitigated by the use of clearing houses to reduce counterparty credit risk, requiring the 
posting of margins and settling of unrealised gains and losses daily. Credit risk on OTC derivatives is mitigated by monitoring the creditworthiness of 
the counterparties and by requiring collateral amounts exceeding predetermined thresholds to be posted for positions which have accrued gains. 

Credit risk on inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants is managed by conducting business with reputable broking organisations, 
with whom the Group has established relationships, and by rigorous cash collection procedures. The Group also has a broker approval process in 
place. Binding authorities are subject to standard market controls including credit control. Credit risk from reinsurance recoverables is primarily 
managed by the review and approval of reinsurer security. 

The table below presents an analysis of the Group’s major exposures to counterparty credit risk, based on their rating. The table includes amounts 
due from policyholders and unsettled investment trades. The quality of these receivables is not graded but, based on management’s historical 
experience, there is limited default risk associated with these amounts. 

As at 31 December 2022 
AAA 
AA+, AA, AA- 
A+, A, A- 
BBB+, BBB, BBB- 
Other1 
Total 

1.  Reinsurance recoveries classified as 'other' include $42.0 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2021 
AAA 
AA+, AA, AA- 
A+, A, A- 
BBB+, BBB, BBB- 
Other1 
Total 

Cash and fixed 
maturity 
securities  
 $m 
572.0 
905.9 
622.4 
284.4 
129.0 
2,513.7 

Inwards 
 premiums 
receivable and 
other 
receivables 
$m 
–
0.5
93.3
1.0
720.4
815.2

Cash and fixed 
maturity 
securities  
 $m 
355.6 
816.0 
754.4 
280.4 
120.4 
2,326.8 

Inwards
premiums 
 receivable and 
other receivables 
$m
–
–
28.2
2.1
517.3
547.6

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m 
–
4.6
533.4
2.1
52.0
592.1

Reinsurance 
 recoveries 
$m
–
2.8
369.2
2.2
44.6
418.8

1.  Reinsurance recoveries classified as 'other' include $38.2 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2022, the average credit quality of the fixed maturity portfolio was A+ (31 December 2021 – A+). 

The following table shows inwards premiums receivable that are past due but not impaired: 

Less than 90 days past due 
Between 91 and 180 days past due 
Over 180 days past due 
Total 

2022
 $m 
71.2
10.3
14.5
96.0

2021
$m 
59.1
13.7
8.2
81.0

As at 31 December 2022 there has been no change in our counterparty credit risk exposure, however, it is an area we continue to monitor given the 
ongoing conflict in Ukraine. Provisions of $8.7 million (31 December 2021 – $7.0 million) have been made for impaired or irrecoverable balances 
and $4.1 million (2021 – $1.4 million) was charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in respect of the provision for bad 
debts of which $2.4 million (2021 – $nil) has been written off. 

160 
160

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

D. Credit risk 

Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty may fail to pay, or repay, a debt or obligation. The Group is exposed to credit risk on its fixed maturity investment 

portfolio and derivative instruments, its inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants, and on any amounts recoverable from reinsurers.  

Credit risk on the fixed maturity portfolio is mitigated through the Group’s policy to invest in instruments of high-credit-quality issuers and to limit 

the amounts of credit exposure with respect to particular ratings categories and any one issuer. Securities rated below an S&P or equivalent rating 

of BBB-/Baa3 may comprise no more than 15.0% of shareholders’ equity. In addition, no one issuer, with the exception of U.S. government and 

agency securities, other G10 government guaranteed securities (excluding Italy) and Australian sovereign debt, should exceed 5.0% of shareholders’ 

equity. The Group is therefore not exposed to any significant credit concentration risk on its investment portfolio, except for fixed maturity 

securities issued by the U.S. government and government agencies and other highly-rated governments.  

Credit risk on exchange-traded derivative instruments is mitigated by the use of clearing houses to reduce counterparty credit risk, requiring the 

posting of margins and settling of unrealised gains and losses daily. Credit risk on OTC derivatives is mitigated by monitoring the creditworthiness of 

the counterparties and by requiring collateral amounts exceeding predetermined thresholds to be posted for positions which have accrued gains. 

Credit risk on inwards premiums receivable from insureds and cedants is managed by conducting business with reputable broking organisations, 

with whom the Group has established relationships, and by rigorous cash collection procedures. The Group also has a broker approval process in 

place. Binding authorities are subject to standard market controls including credit control. Credit risk from reinsurance recoverables is primarily 

managed by the review and approval of reinsurer security. 

The table below presents an analysis of the Group’s major exposures to counterparty credit risk, based on their rating. The table includes amounts 

due from policyholders and unsettled investment trades. The quality of these receivables is not graded but, based on management’s historical 

experience, there is limited default risk associated with these amounts. 

1.  Reinsurance recoveries classified as 'other' include $42.0 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2022 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 

Other1 

Total 

As at 31 December 2021 

AAA 

AA+, AA, AA- 

A+, A, A- 

BBB+, BBB, BBB- 

Other1 

Total 

Less than 90 days past due 

Between 91 and 180 days past due 

Over 180 days past due 

Total 

1.  Reinsurance recoveries classified as 'other' include $38.2 million of reserves that are fully collateralised. 

As at 31 December 2022, the average credit quality of the fixed maturity portfolio was A+ (31 December 2021 – A+). 

The following table shows inwards premiums receivable that are past due but not impaired: 

As at 31 December 2022 there has been no change in our counterparty credit risk exposure, however, it is an area we continue to monitor given the 

ongoing conflict in Ukraine. Provisions of $8.7 million (31 December 2021 – $7.0 million) have been made for impaired or irrecoverable balances 

and $4.1 million (2021 – $1.4 million) was charged to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income in respect of the provision for bad 

debts of which $2.4 million (2021 – $nil) has been written off. 

160 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Inwards 

 premiums 

Cash and fixed 

receivable and 

other 

receivables 

Reinsurance 

recoveries 

Cash and fixed 

Inwards

premiums 

maturity 

 receivable and 

securities  

other receivables 

Reinsurance 

 recoveries 

maturity 

securities  

 $m 

572.0 

905.9 

622.4 

284.4 

129.0 

2,513.7 

 $m 

355.6 

816.0 

754.4 

280.4 

120.4 

2,326.8 

$m 

–

0.5

93.3

1.0

720.4

815.2

$m

–

–

28.2

2.1

517.3

547.6

2022

 $m 

71.2

10.3

14.5

96.0

$m 

–

4.6

533.4

2.1

52.0

592.1

$m

–

2.8

369.2

2.2

44.6

418.8

2021

$m 

59.1

13.7

8.2

81.0

E. Operational risk 
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed internal processes, personnel, systems or external events. The Group and its 
subsidiaries have identified and evaluated their key operational risks and these are incorporated in the risk registers and modelled within the 
subsidiaries’ capital models. The Group has also established, and monitors compliance with, internal operational risk tolerances. The RRC reviews 
operational risk on at least an annual basis and operational risk is covered in the Group CRO’s quarterly ORSA report to the LHL Board and entity 
boards and in the LSL RCCC reporting. 

In order to manage operational risks, the Group has implemented a robust governance framework. Policies and procedures are documented and 
identify the key risks and controls within processes. Key risk indicators have been established and are monitored on a regular basis and a formal loss 
event and near-miss reporting process has been implemented. The Group’s internal audit function provides independent feedback with regard to the 
accuracy and completeness of key risks and controls, and independently verifies the effective operation of these through substantive testing. All 
higher risk areas are subject to an annual audit while compliance with tax operating guidelines is reviewed quarterly. Frequency of consideration for 
audit for all other areas varies from quarterly at the most frequent to a minimum of once every four years, on a rotational basis.  

The operational cyber risk that comes with employees working from home is managed through enhanced monitoring of network activity, targeted 
staff training, a quarterly risk and control affirmation process, annual testing of business continuity plans and disaster recovery plans, and our cyber 
security incident response plan. 

F. Strategic risk 
The Group has identified several strategic risks. These include: 

• 

• 

• 
• 

the risks that either the poor execution of the business plan or an inappropriate business plan in itself results in a strategy that fails to adequately 
reflect the trading environment, resulting in an inability to optimise performance, including reputational risk;  
the risks of failing to maintain adequate capital, accessing capital at an inflated cost or the inability to access capital. This includes unanticipated 
changes in vendor, regulatory and/or rating agency models that could result in an increase in capital requirements or a change in the type of capital 
required; 
the risks of succession planning, staff retention and key man risks; and 
the risks of organisational stretch as the Group grows, in terms of volume of business written and number of employees, as well as from 
transformation programmes to ensure the Group has appropriate systems and infrastructure and data in place to support the business. 

I. Business plan risk 
The Group addresses the risks associated with the planning and execution of the business plan through a combination of the following: 

•  an iterative annual forward-looking business planning process with cross departmental involvement; 
•  evaluation and approval of the annual business plan by the Board of Directors; 
• 
•  periodic review and re-forecasting as market conditions change; and  
•  evaluation of climate change and the potential short, medium and long-term implications/considerations for the business. 

regular monitoring of actual versus planned results;  

The forward-looking business planning process covers a three-year period from 2023 to 2025 and applies a number of sensitivity, stress and scenario 
tests. These tests include consideration of climate change risks. The sensitivity and stress testing identified that even under the more extreme stress 
scenarios the Group had more than adequate liquidity and solvency headroom. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

161 
161

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

II. Capital management risk  
The total capital of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 
Shareholders’ equity 
Long-term debt 
Total capital 
Intangible assets 
Total tangible capital 

2022
 $m
1,267.9
446.1

1,714.0
(172.4)
1,541.6

2021
$m
1,412.3
445.7

1,858.0
(157.9)
1,700.1

Risks associated with the effectiveness of the Group’s capital management are mitigated as follows: 

regular monitoring of current and prospective regulatory and rating agency capital requirements; 
regular discussion with the LSL management team regarding Lloyd’s capital requirements;  

• 
• 
•  oversight of capital requirements by the Board of Directors;  
•  ability to purchase sufficient, cost-effective reinsurance; 
•  maintaining contact with vendors, regulators and rating agencies in order to stay abreast of upcoming developments; and  
•  participation in industry groups such as the International Underwriters Association, the Association of Bermuda Insurers and Reinsurers and the Lloyd’s 

Market Association. 

The Group reviews the level and composition of capital on an ongoing basis with a view to: 

•  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders; 
•  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within predetermined risk tolerances;  
•  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and  
•  meeting internal, rating agency and regulatory capital requirements. 

Capital is increased or returned as appropriate. The retention of earnings generated leads to an increase in capital. Capital raising can include debt or 
equity and returns of capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption of debt or any combination thereof. Other capital 
management tools and products available to the Group may also be utilised. All capital actions require approval by the Board of Directors. 

Internal methods have been developed to review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated capital requirements plus the capital 
requirements of the combination of a wide range of other risk categories. These approaches are used by management in decision making.  

The Group's long-term debt held as at 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021 is approved as 'Tier 2 Ancillary Capital' by the Bermuda Monetary 
Authority.  

The Group’s aim is to maximise risk-adjusted returns for its shareholders across the cycle through a purposeful and sustainable business culture. The 
return is measured by management in terms of the Change in FCBVS in the period (see APM on page 198). This aim is a long-term goal, 
acknowledging that management expects both higher and lower results in the shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility of the insurance market is 
expected to be the largest driver of this pattern. Management monitors these peaks and troughs by adjusting the Group’s portfolio to make the 
most effective use of available capital and seeking to maximise the risk-adjusted return. 

The primary source of capital used by the Group is equity shareholders’ funds and borrowings (note 18). As a holding company, LHL relies on 
dividends from its operating entities to provide the cash flow required for debt service and dividends to shareholders. The operating entities’ ability 
to pay dividends and make capital distributions is subject to the legal and regulatory restrictions of the jurisdictions in which they operate. 

Both the Group and LICL are regulated by the BMA and are required to monitor their enhanced capital requirement under the BMA’s regulatory 
framework, which has been assessed as equivalent to the Solvency II regime. The Group and LICL’s capital requirement are calculated using the 
BSCR standard formula model. For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, both the Group and LICL were more than adequately capitalised 
under the BMA’s regulatory regime.  

The Group’s UK regulated insurance companies are required to comply with the Solvency II regime and are regulated by the PRA and FCA. LSL is also 
regulated by Lloyd’s. Under Solvency II, the basis for assessing capital and solvency comprises a market-consistent economic balance sheet and an 
SCR, determined using either an internal model or the standard formula. 

LUK calculates its SCR using the standard formula. LUK’s Solvency II own funds are primarily comprised of Tier 1 items for the years ended 31 
December 2022 and 2021. Tier 1 capital is the highest-quality capital under Solvency II with the greatest loss-absorbing capacity, comprising share 
capital and retained earnings. For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, LUK was more than adequately capitalised under the Solvency II 
regime. The Group is closely monitoring consultations and proposals related to changes to the UK Solvency regime post the UK’s departure from the 
EU on 31 December 2020. A number of material changes were contained within the consultation published by the PRA in November 2022. The 
consultation is open until May 2023 with a view to implementing new requirements from December 2024. Whilst the areas under review are not 
currently expected to have a material impact on the solvency position of any of the Group’s UK regulated entities there will be a change in the 
reporting requirements. 

162 
162

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
2022

 $m

1,267.9

446.1

1,714.0

(172.4)

1,541.6

2021

$m

1,412.3

445.7

1,858.0

(157.9)

1,700.1

The Group’s underwriting capacity in its Lloyd’s syndicates must be supported by providing a deposit in the form of cash, securities or LOCs, which 
are referred to as FAL. The capital framework at Lloyd’s requires each managing agent to calculate the capital requirement for each syndicate they 
manage. Solvency II internal models are used to determine capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 based on the uSCR. Lloyd’s 
has the discretion to take into account other factors at syndicate or member level to uplift the calculated uSCR. This may include perceived 
deficiencies in the internal model result as well as the need to maintain Lloyd’s overall security rating. Currently, as a minimum, Lloyd’s applies a 
35.0% uplift to each syndicate’s uSCR to arrive at the ECA. 

Lloyd’s then uses each syndicate’s ECA as a basis for determining member level capital requirements, which is backed by FAL. For the 2023 calendar 
year the Group’s corporate member’s FAL requirement was set at 83.5% (2022 – 74.0%) of underwriting capacity supported. Further solvency 
adjustments are made to allow for open year profits and losses of the syndicates on which the corporate member participates. The Group has a FAL 
requirement of £544.5 million as at 31 December 2022 (31 December 2021 – £344.0 million). 

For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021 the capital requirements of all the Group’s regulatory jurisdictions were met. 

III. Retention risk 
Risks associated with succession planning, staff retention and key man risks are mitigated through a combination of resource planning processes and 
controls, including: 

the identification of key personnel with appropriate succession plans; 
the identification of key team profit generators and function holders with targeted retention packages;  

• 
• 
•  documented recruitment procedures, position descriptions and employment contracts;  
• 

resource monitoring and the provision of appropriate compensation, including equity based compensation which vests over a defined time horizon; 
and  
training schemes. 

• 

Financial Statements 

Risk disclosures continued 

II. Capital management risk  

The total capital of the Group is as follows: 

As at 31 December 

Shareholders’ equity 

Long-term debt 

Total capital 

Intangible assets 

Total tangible capital 

Risks associated with the effectiveness of the Group’s capital management are mitigated as follows: 

• 

• 

regular monitoring of current and prospective regulatory and rating agency capital requirements; 

regular discussion with the LSL management team regarding Lloyd’s capital requirements;  

•  oversight of capital requirements by the Board of Directors;  

•  ability to purchase sufficient, cost-effective reinsurance; 

•  maintaining contact with vendors, regulators and rating agencies in order to stay abreast of upcoming developments; and  

•  participation in industry groups such as the International Underwriters Association, the Association of Bermuda Insurers and Reinsurers and the Lloyd’s 

Market Association. 

The Group reviews the level and composition of capital on an ongoing basis with a view to: 

•  maintaining sufficient capital for underwriting opportunities and to meet obligations to policyholders; 

•  maximising the risk-adjusted return to shareholders within predetermined risk tolerances;  

•  maintaining adequate financial strength ratings; and  

•  meeting internal, rating agency and regulatory capital requirements. 

Capital is increased or returned as appropriate. The retention of earnings generated leads to an increase in capital. Capital raising can include debt or 

equity and returns of capital may be made through dividends, share repurchases, a redemption of debt or any combination thereof. Other capital 

management tools and products available to the Group may also be utilised. All capital actions require approval by the Board of Directors. 

Internal methods have been developed to review the profitability of classes of business and their estimated capital requirements plus the capital 

requirements of the combination of a wide range of other risk categories. These approaches are used by management in decision making.  

The Group's long-term debt held as at 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021 is approved as 'Tier 2 Ancillary Capital' by the Bermuda Monetary 

Authority.  

The Group’s aim is to maximise risk-adjusted returns for its shareholders across the cycle through a purposeful and sustainable business culture. The 

return is measured by management in terms of the Change in FCBVS in the period (see APM on page 198). This aim is a long-term goal, 

acknowledging that management expects both higher and lower results in the shorter term. The cyclicality and volatility of the insurance market is 

expected to be the largest driver of this pattern. Management monitors these peaks and troughs by adjusting the Group’s portfolio to make the 

most effective use of available capital and seeking to maximise the risk-adjusted return. 

The primary source of capital used by the Group is equity shareholders’ funds and borrowings (note 18). As a holding company, LHL relies on 

dividends from its operating entities to provide the cash flow required for debt service and dividends to shareholders. The operating entities’ ability 

to pay dividends and make capital distributions is subject to the legal and regulatory restrictions of the jurisdictions in which they operate. 

Both the Group and LICL are regulated by the BMA and are required to monitor their enhanced capital requirement under the BMA’s regulatory 

framework, which has been assessed as equivalent to the Solvency II regime. The Group and LICL’s capital requirement are calculated using the 

BSCR standard formula model. For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, both the Group and LICL were more than adequately capitalised 

under the BMA’s regulatory regime.  

The Group’s UK regulated insurance companies are required to comply with the Solvency II regime and are regulated by the PRA and FCA. LSL is also 

regulated by Lloyd’s. Under Solvency II, the basis for assessing capital and solvency comprises a market-consistent economic balance sheet and an 

SCR, determined using either an internal model or the standard formula. 

LUK calculates its SCR using the standard formula. LUK’s Solvency II own funds are primarily comprised of Tier 1 items for the years ended 31 

December 2022 and 2021. Tier 1 capital is the highest-quality capital under Solvency II with the greatest loss-absorbing capacity, comprising share 

capital and retained earnings. For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, LUK was more than adequately capitalised under the Solvency II 

regime. The Group is closely monitoring consultations and proposals related to changes to the UK Solvency regime post the UK’s departure from the 

EU on 31 December 2020. A number of material changes were contained within the consultation published by the PRA in November 2022. The 

consultation is open until May 2023 with a view to implementing new requirements from December 2024. Whilst the areas under review are not 

currently expected to have a material impact on the solvency position of any of the Group’s UK regulated entities there will be a change in the 

reporting requirements. 

162 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 
Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

163 
163

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts 

1. General information 
The Group is a provider of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products with operations in London, Bermuda and Australia. LHL was 
incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on 12 October 2005. On 16 March 2009, LHL (registered number 37415) was added to the Official List and 
its common shares were admitted to trading on the main market of the LSE; previously LHL’s shares were listed on AIM, a subsidiary market of the 
LSE. Since 21 May 2007, LHL’s shares have had a secondary listing on the BSX. LHL’s head office and registered office is Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville 
Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda.  

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2022 include the Company’s subsidiary companies, the Company’s 
investment in associate, and the Group’s share of the syndicates’ assets and liabilities and income and expenses. A full listing of the Group’s related 
parties can be found in note 23. 

2. Segmental reporting 
Management and the Board of Directors review the Group’s business primarily by its two principal segments: reinsurance and insurance. These 
segments are therefore deemed to be the Group’s operating segments for the purposes of segmental reporting. Operating segment performance is 
measured by the net underwriting profit or loss and the combined ratio. 

All amounts reported are transactions with external parties and associates. There are no significant inter-segmental transactions and there are no 
significant insurance or reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in Bermuda, the Group’s country of domicile.  

The Group's operating segments for the purpose of segmental reporting have been revised in the current year. The revenue and expenses previously 
reported in the property and casualty reinsurance, property and casualty insurance, aviation, energy and marine segments are now reported within 
reinsurance and insurance segments. This reflects an internal management restructuring that occurred in the second half of 2022 and is in place as 
at 31 December 2022. Lines of business, written primarily, but not exclusively, on a reinsurance or insurance basis, are now reported under a Head of 
Reinsurance and Head of Insurance based on the products that they manage. Comparative figures for the year ended 31 December 2021 have been 
re-presented in conformity with the current year view. 

164 
164

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts 

1. General information 

The Group is a provider of global specialty insurance and reinsurance products with operations in London, Bermuda and Australia. LHL was 

incorporated under the laws of Bermuda on 12 October 2005. On 16 March 2009, LHL (registered number 37415) was added to the Official List and 

its common shares were admitted to trading on the main market of the LSE; previously LHL’s shares were listed on AIM, a subsidiary market of the 

LSE. Since 21 May 2007, LHL’s shares have had a secondary listing on the BSX. LHL’s head office and registered office is Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville 

The consolidated financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2022 include the Company’s subsidiary companies, the Company’s 

investment in associate, and the Group’s share of the syndicates’ assets and liabilities and income and expenses. A full listing of the Group’s related 

Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda.  

parties can be found in note 23. 

2. Segmental reporting 

Management and the Board of Directors review the Group’s business primarily by its two principal segments: reinsurance and insurance. These 

segments are therefore deemed to be the Group’s operating segments for the purposes of segmental reporting. Operating segment performance is 

measured by the net underwriting profit or loss and the combined ratio. 

All amounts reported are transactions with external parties and associates. There are no significant inter-segmental transactions and there are no 

significant insurance or reinsurance contracts that insure or reinsure risks in Bermuda, the Group’s country of domicile.  

The Group's operating segments for the purpose of segmental reporting have been revised in the current year. The revenue and expenses previously 

reported in the property and casualty reinsurance, property and casualty insurance, aviation, energy and marine segments are now reported within 

reinsurance and insurance segments. This reflects an internal management restructuring that occurred in the second half of 2022 and is in place as 

at 31 December 2022. Lines of business, written primarily, but not exclusively, on a reinsurance or insurance basis, are now reported under a Head of 

Reinsurance and Head of Insurance based on the products that they manage. Comparative figures for the year ended 31 December 2021 have been 

re-presented in conformity with the current year view. 

Revenue and expense by operating segment 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 
Gross premiums written by geographic area 
U.S. and Canada 
Worldwide – multi territory 
Europe 
Rest of world 
Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 
Change in unearned premiums 
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
Net premiums earned 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 
Insurance acquisition expenses 
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 
Net underwriting profit 
Net unallocated income and expenses 
Loss before tax 
Net loss ratio 
Net acquisition cost ratio 
Expense ratio 
Combined ratio 

Reinsurance 
segment 
$m 

Insurance 
segment
$m 

385.3 
347.2 
50.0 
59.6 
842.1 

(213.3) 
(149.2) 
15.9 

495.5 
(546.7) 
194.7 
(136.0) 
5.0 
12.5 

71.0% 
26.4% 
– 
97.4% 

254.3
268.9
90.5
196.5
810.2

(251.0)
(74.0)
7.7

492.9
(376.0)
151.6
(162.8)
32.6
138.3

45.5%
26.4%
–
71.9%

Total
$m 

639.6
616.1
140.5
256.1
1,652.3

(464.3)
(223.2)
23.6

988.4
(922.7)
346.3
(298.8)
37.6
150.8
(153.6)
(2.8)
58.3%
26.4%
13.0%
97.7%

164 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

165 
165

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

2. Segmental reporting continued 
Revenue and expense by operating segment 

For the year ended 31 December 2021 
Gross premiums written by geographic area 
U.S. and Canada 
Worldwide – multi territory 
Europe 
Rest of world 
Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 
Change in unearned premiums 
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
Net premiums earned 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 
Insurance acquisition expenses 
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 
Net underwriting (loss) profit 
Net unallocated income and expenses 
Loss before tax 
Net loss ratio 
Net acquisition cost ratio 
Expense ratio 
Combined ratio 

Reinsurance 
segment 
$m 

Insurance 
segment
$m 

274.9 
174.2 
48.7 
63.2 
561.0 
(175.6) 
(81.1) 
(2.2) 

302.1 
(434.0) 
160.2 
(64.5) 
8.2 

(28.0) 

190.3
250.6
90.1
133.2
664.2
(233.5)
(58.9)
22.6

394.4
(233.6)
36.9
(124.1)
23.4

97.0

90.6% 
18.6% 
– 

109.2% 

49.9%
25.5%
–

75.4%

Total 
$m 

465.2
424.8
138.8
196.4
1,225.2
(409.1)
(140.0)
20.4

696.5
(667.6)
197.1
(188.6)
31.6

69.0
(125.8)

(56.8)
67.6%
22.5%
17.2%

107.3%

166 
166

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

2. Segmental reporting continued 

Revenue and expense by operating segment 

For the year ended 31 December 2021 

Gross premiums written by geographic area 

U.S. and Canada 

Worldwide – multi territory 

Europe 

Rest of world 

Total 

Outwards reinsurance premiums 

Change in unearned premiums 

Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 

Net premiums earned 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses 

Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 

Insurance acquisition expenses 

Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

Net underwriting (loss) profit 

Net unallocated income and expenses 

Loss before tax 

Net loss ratio 

Expense ratio 

Combined ratio 

Net acquisition cost ratio 

Reinsurance 

segment 

$m 

Insurance 

segment

$m 

274.9 

174.2 

48.7 

63.2 

561.0 

(175.6) 

(81.1) 

(2.2) 

302.1 

160.2 

(64.5) 

8.2 

(28.0) 

190.3

250.6

90.1

133.2

664.2

(233.5)

(58.9)

22.6

394.4

23.4

97.0

(434.0) 

(233.6)

(667.6)

36.9

197.1

(124.1)

(188.6)

Total 

$m 

465.2

424.8

138.8

196.4

1,225.2

(409.1)

(140.0)

20.4

696.5

31.6

69.0

(125.8)

(56.8)

67.6%

22.5%

17.2%

90.6% 

18.6% 

– 

49.9%

25.5%

–

109.2% 

75.4%

107.3%

3. Investment return 
The total investment return for the Group is as follows: 

For the year ended 31 December 2022 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities - at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Total investment return 

Net investment 
income and  
net other 
investment 
(loss) income1 
$m 
38.9 
(0.3) 
(2.3) 
(1.5) 
(0.6) 
0.2 
4.8 

Net realised  
(losses) gains  
and 
impairments 
 $m 
(19.3) 
– 
– 
(1.1) 
– 
(2.3) 
– 

Net change 
in unrealised 
losses on AFS2 
$m 
(93.2)
–
–
–
–
–
–

Total 
investment 
 return 
$m 
(73.6)
(0.3)
(2.3)
(2.6)
(0.6)
(2.1)
4.8

39.2 

(22.7) 

(93.2)

(76.7)

1.  Net unrealised gains/(losses) on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income. 
2.  In 2023, when we apply IFRS 9, the net change in unrealised gains /(losses) on AFS will be classified within net investment income and net other investment income. 

For the year ended 31 December 2021 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Cash and cash equivalents 
Total investment return 

Net investment 
income and  
net other 
investment  
(loss) income1 
$m 
22.9 
1.7 
0.5 
(0.6) 
2.3 
(0.1) 
0.1 
26.8 

Net realised  
(losses) gains  
 and 
impairments  
$m 
2.7 
(0.1) 
– 
3.7 
– 
(0.2) 
– 
6.1 

Net change 
in unrealised 
losses on AFS2 
$m
(31.6)
–
–
–
–
–
–
(31.6)

Total 
investment 
return 
$m
(6.0)
1.6
0.5
3.1
2.3
(0.3)
0.1
1.3

1.  Net unrealised gains/(losses) on our FVTPL investments are included within net investment income and net other investment income. 
2.  In 2023, when we apply IFRS 9, the net change in unrealised gains /(losses) on AFS will be classified within net investment income and net other investment income. 

Net investment income includes $46.1 million (2021 – $34.1 million) of interest income on our AFS investment portfolio and cash and cash 
equivalents. Net realised (losses) gains and impairments includes impairment losses of $2.5 million (2021 – $nil) recognised on fixed maturity 
securities. 

Refer to pages 155 to 156 in the risk disclosures section for the fair values of the Group’s derivative instruments. Realised gains and losses on futures 
and options contracts are included in net realised (losses) gains and impairments.  

Included in net investment income and net other investment (loss) income is $4.7 million (2021 – $4.8 million) of investment management, 
accounting and custodian fees. 

4. Net insurance acquisition expenses 

For the year ended 31 December 
Insurance acquisition expenses 
Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses 
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 
Changes in deferred insurance acquisition expenses ceded 
Total net insurance acquisition expenses 

2022
 $m 
358.0
(59.2)
(43.5)
5.9
261.2

2021
$m 
221.2
(32.6)
(39.0)
7.4
157.0

166 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

167 
167

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

5. Other income 

For the year ended 31 December 
Lancashire Capital Management 
•  underwriting fees  
•  profit commission 
Lancashire Syndicates  
•  managing agency fees 
•  consortium fees 
•  consortium profit commission 
•  coverholder commission income 
Total other income 

2022
 $m

3.1
0.9

1.1
1.1
0.1
0.2
6.5

As at 31 December 2022, contract assets in relation to other income amounted to $1.3 million (31 December 2021 – $0.7 million).  

6. Results of operating activities 
Results of operating activities are stated after charging the following amounts: 

For the year ended 31 December 
Depreciation on owned assets 
Auditor’s remuneration 
•  Group audit fees 
•  Other services 
Total 

2022
 $m 
0.4

4.1
0.4
4.9

2021
$m

10.6
5.2

1.1
0.6
0.7
–
18.2

2021
$m 
0.6

2.1
0.4
3.1

During 2022 and 2021, KPMG LLP provided non-audit services in relation to the Group's half-year reporting review, Solvency II reporting and Lloyd's 
reporting. In addition non-audit services in relation to the long-term debt refinancing was provided in the prior year. Fees for non-audit services 
provided in 2022 totalled $0.4 million (2021 – $0.4 million). 

7. Employee benefits 

For the year ended 31 December 
Wages and salaries 
Pension costs 
Bonus and other benefits 
Total cash compensation 
RSS – performance 
RSS – ordinary 
RSS – bonus deferral 
Total equity based compensation 
Total employee benefits 

2022
 $m
54.6 
4.2 
15.2 
74.0 
0.5 
7.4 
0.7 

8.6 
82.6 

2021
$m
49.2 
4.3 
15.0 

68.5 
3.7 
6.0 
1.4 

11.1 
79.6 

Equity based compensation 
The Group’s equity based compensation scheme is its RSS. All outstanding and future RSS grants have an exercise period of ten years from the grant 
date. 

The fair value of any TSR component of the nil-cost options is estimated using a stochastic model. For all other components the Black-Scholes 
model is used to estimate the fair value. 
The following table lists the assumptions used in the stochastic model for the RSS awards granted during the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021: 

Assumptions 
Dividend yield 
Expected volatility1 
Risk-free interest rate2 
Expected average life of options 
Share price 

2022
–
28.1%
1.3%
3.0 years 
$6.72

2021
–
28.0%
0.1%
3.0 years 
$8.92

1.  The expected volatility of the LHL share price is calculated based on the movement in the share price over a period prior to the grant date, equal in length to the expected life of the 

award. 

2.  The risk-free interest rate is consistent with three–year UK government bond yields on the date of grant. 

168 
168

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

5. Other income 

For the year ended 31 December 

Lancashire Capital Management 

•  underwriting fees  

•  profit commission 

Lancashire Syndicates  

•  managing agency fees 

•  consortium fees 

•  consortium profit commission 

•  coverholder commission income 

Total other income 

For the year ended 31 December 

Depreciation on owned assets 

Auditor’s remuneration 

•  Group audit fees 

•  Other services 

Total 

7. Employee benefits 

For the year ended 31 December 

Wages and salaries 

Pension costs 

Bonus and other benefits 

Total cash compensation 

RSS – performance 

RSS – ordinary 

RSS – bonus deferral 

Total equity based compensation 

Total employee benefits 

Equity based compensation 

date. 

model is used to estimate the fair value. 

Assumptions 

Dividend yield 

Expected volatility1 

Risk-free interest rate2 

Expected average life of options 

Share price 

As at 31 December 2022, contract assets in relation to other income amounted to $1.3 million (31 December 2021 – $0.7 million).  

6. Results of operating activities 

Results of operating activities are stated after charging the following amounts: 

During 2022 and 2021, KPMG LLP provided non-audit services in relation to the Group's half-year reporting review, Solvency II reporting and Lloyd's 

reporting. In addition non-audit services in relation to the long-term debt refinancing was provided in the prior year. Fees for non-audit services 

provided in 2022 totalled $0.4 million (2021 – $0.4 million). 

The Group’s equity based compensation scheme is its RSS. All outstanding and future RSS grants have an exercise period of ten years from the grant 

The fair value of any TSR component of the nil-cost options is estimated using a stochastic model. For all other components the Black-Scholes 

The following table lists the assumptions used in the stochastic model for the RSS awards granted during the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021: 

2022

 $m

3.1

0.9

1.1

1.1

0.1

0.2

6.5

2022

 $m 

0.4

4.1

0.4

4.9

2022

 $m

54.6 

4.2 

15.2 

74.0 

0.5 

7.4 

0.7 

8.6 

82.6 

2021

$m

10.6

5.2

1.1

0.6

0.7

–

18.2

2021

$m 

0.6

2.1

0.4

3.1

2021

$m

49.2 

4.3 

15.0 

68.5 

3.7 

6.0 

1.4 

11.1 

79.6 

2022

–

28.1%

1.3%

2021

–

28.0%

0.1%

3.0 years 

3.0 years 

$6.72

$8.92

The calculation of the equity based compensation expense assumes forfeitures due to employee turnover of 10.0% per annum prior to vesting, with 
subsequent adjustments to reflect actual experience.  

RSS – Performance 
The performance RSS options vest three years from the date of grant and are dependent on certain performance criteria. A maximum of 85.0% 
(2021 – 85.0%) of the performance RSS options will vest only on the achievement of a change in FCBVS in excess of a required amount. A maximum 
of 15.0% (2021 – 15.0%) of the performance RSS options will vest only on the achievement of an absolute TSR in excess of a required amount. An 
amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according 
to the number of RSS options that vest.  

Outstanding as at 31 December 2020 
Granted 
Exercised 
Forfeited 
Lapsed 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 
Granted 
Exercised 
Forfeited 
Lapsed 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 
Exercisable as at 31 December 2022 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year 
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Total number 
of restricted 
shares
2,749,396
1,386,635
(377,522)
(14,615)
(480,182)
3,263,712
1,166,257
(387,722)
(186,988)
(457,700)
3,397,559

104,346
140,323

2021
Total
restricted 
shares 
9.0 years 
$7.99
$9.12

2022
Total
restricted 
shares 
8.1 years 
$5.59
$6.59

RSS – Ordinary 
The ordinary RSS options vest three years from the date of grant and do not have associated performance criteria. An amount equivalent to the 
dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise.  

Outstanding as at 31 December 2020 

Granted 
Exercised  
Forfeited 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 
Granted 
Exercised 
Forfeited 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 
Exercisable as at 31 December 2022 

Total number 
of restricted 
shares 
2,619,125

1,035,202
(561,366)
(208,990)

2,883,971
1,994,874
(548,748)
(153,132)
4,176,965

520,249
634,373

1.  The expected volatility of the LHL share price is calculated based on the movement in the share price over a period prior to the grant date, equal in length to the expected life of the 

award. 

168 

2.  The risk-free interest rate is consistent with three–year UK government bond yields on the date of grant. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

169 
169

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

7. Employee benefits continued 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year 
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

2022
Total
restricted 
shares 
8.0 years 
$6.69
$6.02

2021
Total
restricted
 shares 
8.4 years 
$8.92
$9.35

RSS – Bonus deferral
The vesting periods of the bonus deferral RSS options range from one to three years from the date of grant and do not have associated performance 
criteria. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2020 
Granted 
Exercised 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 

Granted 
Exercised 
Forfeited 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 
Exercisable as at 31 December 2022 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 
Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year 
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

Total number of 
restricted shares 
250,605
183,185
(83,638)
350,152
46,648
(114,196)
(14,056)
268,548

59,329
63,247

2022
Total
restricted 
shares 
7.2 years 
$6.04
$6.45

2021
Total
restricted 
shares 
8.9 years 
$8.92
$8.84

RSS – Lancashire syndicates limited acquisition 
The vesting periods of the LSL acquisition RSS options ranged from three to five years and were dependent on certain performance criteria. These 
options vested in full on 31 December 2018. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and 
is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vested. 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 and 2020 
Exercised 
Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 
Exercisable as at 31 December 2022  

Weighted average remaining contractual life 
Weighted average fair value at date of grant 
Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

170 
170

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Total number of
restricted shares
64,742
(33,387)

31,355

64,742
31,355

2021
Total
restricted
 shares 
1.9 years
$13.01
–

2022
Total 
restricted 
shares 
0.9 years
$13.01
$5.59

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
The vesting periods of the bonus deferral RSS options range from one to three years from the date of grant and do not have associated performance 

criteria. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and is paid at the time of exercise. 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

RSS – Lancashire syndicates limited acquisition 

The vesting periods of the LSL acquisition RSS options ranged from three to five years and were dependent on certain performance criteria. These 

options vested in full on 31 December 2018. An amount equivalent to the dividends paid between the grant date and the exercise date accrues and 

is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options that vested. 

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

7. Employee benefits continued 

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average fair value at date of grant during the year 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

RSS – Bonus deferral

Outstanding as at 31 December 2020 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 

Granted 

Exercised 

Granted 

Exercised 

Forfeited 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2022 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2021 and 2020 

Exercised 

Outstanding as at 31 December 2022 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2021 

Exercisable as at 31 December 2022  

Weighted average remaining contractual life 

Weighted average fair value at date of grant 

Weighted average share price at date of exercise during the year 

170 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

2022

Total

restricted 

shares 

$6.69

$6.02

2021

Total

restricted

 shares 

$8.92

$9.35

8.0 years 

8.4 years 

Total number of 

restricted shares 

250,605

183,185

(83,638)

350,152

46,648

(114,196)

(14,056)

268,548

59,329

63,247

2021

Total

restricted 

shares 

$8.92

$8.84

2022

Total

restricted 

shares 

$6.04

$6.45

7.2 years 

8.9 years 

Total number of

restricted shares

64,742

(33,387)

31,355

64,742

31,355

2021

Total

restricted

 shares 

$13.01

–

2022

Total 

restricted 

shares 

$13.01

$5.59

0.9 years

1.9 years

8. Financing costs 

For the year ended 31 December 
Interest expense on long-term debt 
Redemption cost on senior and subordinated loan notes 
Interest rate swap 
Interest expense on lease liabilities 
Other financing costs 
Total 
The increased financing cost during the prior year ended 31 December 2021 was driven by $18.7 million of one-off costs associated with the 
refinancing of the long-term debt.  

2022
$m
25.8
–
–
0.8
2.6
29.2

2021
$m
25.8
12.8
3.4
1.1
2.7
45.8

Refer to note 18 for details of long-term debt and financing arrangements. 

9. Tax  
Bermuda 
LHL, LICL and LCM have received an undertaking from the Bermuda government exempting them from all Bermuda local income, withholding and 
capital gains taxes until 31 March 2035. At the present time no such taxes are levied in Bermuda. 

United Kingdom  
The UK subsidiaries of LHL are subject to normal UK corporation tax on all their taxable profits. 

For the year ended 31 December 
Corporation tax charge for the period 
Adjustments in respect of prior period corporation tax 
Deferred tax credit for the period 
Adjustment in respect of prior period deferred tax 
Tax rate change adjustment 
Total tax charge  

Tax reconciliation1 
Loss before tax 
Tax calculated at the standard corporation tax rate applicable in Bermuda 0% 
Effect of income taxed at a higher rate 
Adjustments in respect of prior period 
Differences related to equity based compensation 
Other expense permanent differences 
Tax rate change adjustment 
Total tax charge  

1.  All tax reconciling balances have been classified as recurring items. 

2022
$m
1.7
(0.6)
(1.7)
1.1
–
0.5

2022
 $m 
(2.8)
–
3.0
0.5
(0.4)
(2.6)
–
0.5

2021
$m
2.9
0.2
(2.5)
0.8
3.4
4.8

2021
$m 
(56.8)

–
0.8
1.0
1.0
(1.4)
3.4

4.8

The current tax charge as a percentage of the Group’s profit before tax is negative 17.9% (2021 – negative 8.5%). The Group has non-taxable income 
in relation to profits of companies within the Group that are non-tax resident in the UK and the share of loss of associate.  

Refer to note 11 for details of the tax expense related to the net change in unrealised gains/losses on investments that is included in accumulated 
other comprehensive (loss) income within shareholders’ equity.  

Global minimum tax 
To address concerns about uneven profit distribution and tax contributions of large multinational corporations, various agreements have been 
reached at the global level, including an agreement by over 135 jurisdictions to introduce a global minimum tax rate of 15%. In December 2021 the 
OECD released a draft legislative framework, followed by detailed guidance in March 2022, that is expected to be used by individual jurisdictions 
that signed the agreement to amend their local tax laws. Once changes to the laws in any jurisdiction in which the Group operates are enacted or 
substantively enacted, the Group may be subject to a top-up tax. At the date when the financial statements were signed none of the jurisdictions in 
which the Group operates had enacted or substantially enacted the tax legislation related to a top-up tax. The Group may potentially be subject to a 
top-up tax because LHL and some of its subsidiaries are domiciled in Bermuda and are currently exempt from corporate income taxes until 31 March 
2035. Management are closely monitoring the progress of the legislative process in the jurisdictions in which it operates.  

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

171 
171

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

10. Cash and cash equivalents 

As at 31 December 
Cash at bank and in hand 
Cash equivalents 
Total cash and cash equivalents 

2022
 $m
191.6
357.2
548.8

2021
$m
275.8
241.9
517.7

The carrying amount of cash and cash equivalents approximates fair value. Refer to note 18 for the cash and cash equivalent balances on deposit as 
collateral. Cash and cash equivalents include managed cash of $260.8 million (31 December 2021 – $260.7 million), which are managed by our 
external investment managers and non-operating cash managed internally. 

11. Investments 

As at 31 December 2022 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
•  Short-term investments 
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds 
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

Cost or
amortised cost 
$m

Unrealised 
gains 
$m 

Unrealised
losses
$m

21.5
29.4
683.0
42.3
23.8
61.0
167.0
45.5
16.4
25.5
131.8
786.2
2,033.4

19.7
116.0
95.0
30.0
–

2,294.1

– 
– 
0.1 
– 
– 
– 
0.2 
– 
– 
– 
0.5 
1.0 
1.8 

4.6 
1.5 
13.4 
– 
0.2 

21.5 

Fair value1 
$m

21.5
29.4
650.2
38.9
22.6
59.0
160.9
41.0
14.0
24.2
128.9
752.3
1,942.9

22.0
108.1
103.9
28.2
(0.2)

–
–
(32.9)
(3.4)
(1.2)
(2.0)
(6.3)
(4.5)
(2.4)
(1.3)
(3.4)
(34.9)
(92.3)

(2.3)
(9.4)
(4.5)
(1.8)
(0.4)

(110.7)

2,204.9

1.  When IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, is implemented, all investments held above will be classified as at FVTPL (mandatory), with no resulting changes in 

the estimated fair value. 

172 
172

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
The carrying amount of cash and cash equivalents approximates fair value. Refer to note 18 for the cash and cash equivalent balances on deposit as 

collateral. Cash and cash equivalents include managed cash of $260.8 million (31 December 2021 – $260.7 million), which are managed by our 

external investment managers and non-operating cash managed internally. 

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

10. Cash and cash equivalents 

As at 31 December 

Cash at bank and in hand 

Cash equivalents 

Total cash and cash equivalents 

11. Investments 

As at 31 December 2022 

Fixed maturity securities – AFS 

•  Short-term investments 

•  Fixed maturity funds 

•  U.S. treasuries 

•  Other government bonds 

•  U.S. municipal bonds 

•  U.S. government agency debt 

•  Asset backed securities 

•  Bank loans 

•  Corporate bonds 

Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 

Private investment funds – at FVTPL 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Index linked securities – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

the estimated fair value. 

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

2022

 $m

191.6

357.2

548.8

2021

$m

275.8

241.9

517.7

Cost or

Unrealised 

Unrealised

amortised cost 

$m

gains 

$m 

losses

$m

Fair value1 

$m

21.5

29.4

683.0

42.3

23.8

61.0

167.0

45.5

16.4

25.5

131.8

786.2

19.7

116.0

95.0

30.0

–

2,033.4

0.1 

(32.9)

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

– 

0.2 

0.5 

1.0 

1.8 

4.6 

1.5 

13.4 

– 

0.2 

21.5 

–

–

(3.4)

(1.2)

(2.0)

(6.3)

(4.5)

(2.4)

(1.3)

(3.4)

(34.9)

(92.3)

(2.3)

(9.4)

(4.5)

(1.8)

(0.4)

21.5

29.4

650.2

38.9

22.6

59.0

160.9

41.0

14.0

24.2

128.9

752.3

1,942.9

22.0

108.1

103.9

28.2

(0.2)

1.  When IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, is implemented, all investments held above will be classified as at FVTPL (mandatory), with no resulting changes in 

2,294.1

(110.7)

2,204.9

As at 31 December 2021 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
•  Short-term investments 
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds 
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

Cost or  
amortised cost  
$m 

Unrealised  
gains  
$m 

Unrealised
losses 
$m 

44.5 
17.6 
566.9 
59.5 
24.0 
54.2 
104.8 
85.5 
33.1 
0.2 
20.2 
110.1 
657.4 
1,778.0 
24.8 
106.0 
93.3 
30.0 
0.3 

2,032.4 

– 
– 
0.6 
0.3 
0.4 
1.1 
0.3 
1.1 
0.3 
– 
– 
0.7 
8.6 
13.4 
5.5 
1.1 
14.8 
0.5 
0.1 

35.4 

–
–
(3.3)
(1.0)
(0.1)
(0.1)
(1.0)
(1.1)
(0.2)
(0.1)
(0.1)
(0.6)
(3.6)
(11.2)
(1.4)
(1.4)
(5.2)
–
(0.5)

(19.7)

Fair value1 
$m 

44.5
17.6
564.2
58.8
24.3
55.2
104.1
85.5
33.2
0.1
20.1
110.2
662.4
1,780.2
28.9
105.7
102.9
30.5
(0.1)

2,048.1

1.  When IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, is implemented, all investments held above will be classified as at FVTPL (mandatory), with no resulting changes in 

the estimated fair value. 

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income in relation to the Group’s AFS fixed maturity is as follows: 

As at 31 December 
Unrealised gains 
Unrealised losses 
Net unrealised foreign exchange losses on fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Tax provision 
Accumulated other comprehensive (loss) income  

2022
$m
1.8
(92.3)
0.6
3.5
(86.4)

2021
$m
13.4
(11.2)
1.1
(0.4)
2.9

The Group determines the fair value of each individual security utilising the highest-level inputs available. Prices for the Group’s investment 
portfolio are provided via a third-party investment accounting firm whose pricing processes and the controls thereon are subject to an annual audit 
on both the operation and the effectiveness of those controls. Various recognised reputable pricing sources are used, including pricing vendors and 
broker-dealers. The pricing sources use bid prices where available, otherwise indicative prices are quoted based on observable market trade data. 
The prices provided are compared to the investment managers’ pricing.  

The Group has not made any adjustments to any pricing provided by independent pricing services or its third-party investment managers for either 
year ending 31 December. 

The fair value of securities in the Group’s investment portfolio is estimated using the following techniques: 

Level (I) 
Level (i) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets. A financial instrument is regarded as quoted in an active market if quoted 
prices are readily and regularly available from an exchange, dealer, broker, industry group, pricing service or regulatory agency and those prices 
represent actual and regularly occurring market transactions on an arm’s length basis.  

Level (II) 
Level (ii) investments are securities with quoted prices in active markets for similar assets or liabilities or securities valued using other valuation 
techniques for which all significant inputs are based on observable market data. Instruments included in Level (ii) are valued via independent 
external sources using directly observable inputs to models or other valuation methods. The valuation methods used are typically industry-accepted 
standards and include broker-dealer quotes and pricing models including present values and future cash flows with inputs such as yield curves, 
interest rates, prepayment speeds and default rates. 

172 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

173 
173

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

11. Investments continued 
Level (III) 
Level (iii) investments are securities for which valuation techniques are not based on observable market data and require significant management 
judgement. The Group determines securities classified as Level (iii) to include hedge funds, private investment funds and loans to the Lloyd's central 
fund. 

The fair values of the Group’s hedge funds are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent 
administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. Independent administrators provide monthly reported NAVs 
with up to a one-month delay in valuation. The most recent NAV available for each hedge fund is adjusted for the estimated performance, as 
provided by the fund manager, between the NAV date and the reporting date. Historically estimated fair values incorporating these performance 
estimates have not been significantly different from subsequent NAVs. Given the Group’s knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of 
the Group’s investment therein, we would not anticipate any material variance between estimated valuations and the final NAVs reported by the 
administrators. 

The fair value of the Group’s private investment funds are determined using statements received from each fund’s investment managers on either a 
monthly or quarterly in arrears basis. In addition these valuations will be compared with benchmarks or other indices to assess the reasonableness of 
the estimated fair value of each fund. Given the Group’s knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of the Group’s investment therein, 
we would not anticipate any material variance between statements and the final NAVs reported by the investment managers. 

The Group determines whether transfers have occurred between levels of the fair value hierarchy by re-assessing the categorisation at the end of 
each reporting period. Transfers between Level (i) to (ii) securities amounted to $124.7 million and transfers from Level (ii) to (i) securities amounted 
to $89.2 million during the year ended 31 December 2022.  

The fair value hierarchy of the Group’s investment holdings is as follows:  

As at 31 December 2022 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
•  Short-term investments 
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds 
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

Level (i)
$m 

Level (ii)  
$m 

Level (iii)
$m 

Total
$m 

18.5
–
650.2
5.5
–
38.0
–
–
–
–
22.7
235.0
969.9
–
–
–
–
–
969.9

3.0 
29.4 
– 
33.4 
22.6 
21.0 
160.9 
41.0 
14.0 
24.2 
106.2 
517.3 
973.0 
18.9 
– 
– 
28.2 
(0.2) 
1,019.9 

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
3.1
108.1
103.9
–
–
215.1

21.5
29.4
650.2
38.9
22.6
59.0
160.9
41.0
14.0
24.2
128.9
752.3
1,942.9
22.0
108.1
103.9
28.2
(0.2)
2,204.9

174 
174

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

11. Investments continued 

Level (III) 

fund. 

Level (iii) investments are securities for which valuation techniques are not based on observable market data and require significant management 

judgement. The Group determines securities classified as Level (iii) to include hedge funds, private investment funds and loans to the Lloyd's central 

The fair values of the Group’s hedge funds are determined using a combination of the most recent NAVs provided by each fund’s independent 

administrator and the estimated performance provided by each hedge fund manager. Independent administrators provide monthly reported NAVs 

with up to a one-month delay in valuation. The most recent NAV available for each hedge fund is adjusted for the estimated performance, as 

provided by the fund manager, between the NAV date and the reporting date. Historically estimated fair values incorporating these performance 

estimates have not been significantly different from subsequent NAVs. Given the Group’s knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of 

the Group’s investment therein, we would not anticipate any material variance between estimated valuations and the final NAVs reported by the 

administrators. 

The fair value of the Group’s private investment funds are determined using statements received from each fund’s investment managers on either a 

monthly or quarterly in arrears basis. In addition these valuations will be compared with benchmarks or other indices to assess the reasonableness of 

the estimated fair value of each fund. Given the Group’s knowledge of the underlying investments and the size of the Group’s investment therein, 

we would not anticipate any material variance between statements and the final NAVs reported by the investment managers. 

The Group determines whether transfers have occurred between levels of the fair value hierarchy by re-assessing the categorisation at the end of 

each reporting period. Transfers between Level (i) to (ii) securities amounted to $124.7 million and transfers from Level (ii) to (i) securities amounted 

to $89.2 million during the year ended 31 December 2022.  

The fair value hierarchy of the Group’s investment holdings is as follows:  

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

As at 31 December 2022 

Fixed maturity securities – AFS 

•  Short-term investments 

•  Fixed maturity funds 

•  U.S. treasuries 

•  Other government bonds 

•  U.S. municipal bonds 

•  U.S. government agency debt 

•  Asset backed securities 

•  Bank loans 

•  Corporate bonds 

Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 

Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 

Private investment funds – at FVTPL 

Hedge funds – at FVTPL 

Index linked securities – at FVTPL 

Other investments 

Total investments 

Level (i)

$m 

Level (ii)  

$m 

Level (iii)

$m 

Total

$m 

18.5

650.2

5.5

38.0

22.7

235.0

969.9

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

3.0 

29.4 

– 

33.4 

22.6 

21.0 

160.9 

41.0 

14.0 

24.2 

106.2 

517.3 

973.0 

18.9 

– 

– 

28.2 

(0.2) 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

3.1

108.1

103.9

21.5

29.4

650.2

38.9

22.6

59.0

160.9

41.0

14.0

24.2

128.9

752.3

1,942.9

22.0

108.1

103.9

28.2

(0.2)

969.9

1,019.9 

215.1

2,204.9

As at 31 December 2021 
Fixed maturity securities – AFS 
•  Short-term investments 
•  Fixed maturity funds 
•  U.S. treasuries 
•  Other government bonds 
•  U.S. municipal bonds 
•  U.S. government agency debt 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Bank loans 
•  Corporate bonds 
Total fixed maturity securities – AFS 
Fixed maturity securities – at FVTPL 
Private investment funds – at FVTPL 
Hedge funds – at FVTPL 
Index linked securities – at FVTPL 
Other investments 
Total investments 

Level (i)  
$m 

Level (ii)  
$m 

Level (iii)
$m

42.2 
– 
564.2 
31.5 
– 
33.5 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 
5.0 
197.7 

874.1 
– 
– 
– 
– 
– 

874.1 

2.3 
17.6 
– 
27.3 
24.3 
21.7 
104.1 
85.5 
33.2 
0.1 
20.1 
105.2 
464.7 

906.1 
25.0 
– 
– 
30.5 
(0.1) 

961.5 

Total
$m

44.5
17.6
564.2
58.8
24.3
55.2
104.1
85.5
33.2
0.1
20.1
110.2
662.4

–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–

–
3.9
105.7
102.9
–
–

212.5

1,780.2
28.9
105.7
102.9
30.5
(0.1)

2,048.1

The table below analyses the movements in investments classified as Level (iii) investments: 

As at 31 December 2020 
Purchases 
Sales 
Net realised gains recognised in profit or loss 
Net unrealised (losses) gains in profit or loss 
As at 31 December 2021 
Purchases 
Sales 
Net realised losses recognised in profit or loss 
Net unrealised (losses) gains in profit or loss 
As at 31 December 2022 

Private 
investment 
funds 
$m 
96.1 
17.1 
(2.8) 
– 
(4.7) 

105.7 
17.6 
(7.6) 
– 
(7.6) 

108.1 

Hedge funds 
$m 
82.0 
39.9 
(23.0) 
3.7 
0.3 

Fixed maturity 
securities1 
$m
–
5.3
–
–
(1.4)

102.9 
13.3 
(10.5) 
(1.1) 
(0.7) 

103.9 

3.9
–
–
–
(0.8)

3.1

Total
$m
178.1
62.3
(25.8)
3.7
(5.8)

212.5
30.9
(18.1)
(1.1)
(9.1)

215.1

1.  Included within fixed maturity securities are central fund loans classified at Level (iii) within the fair value hierarchy. 

12. Interests in structured entities 
Consolidated Structured Entities 
•  The Group provides capital contributions to the EBT to enable it to meet its obligations to employees under the equity based compensation plans. The 

Group has a contractual agreement which may require it to provide financial support to the EBT (see note 23).  

•  As at 31 December 2022, the company held $2.5 million of private investment funds through Lancashire Blocker (Cayman) Limited a wholly owned 

subsidiary of LICL. 

Unconsolidated structured entities in which the group has an interest 
As part of its investment activities, the Group invests in unconsolidated structured entities. The Group does not sponsor any of the unconsolidated 
structured entities. 

174 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

175 
175

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

12. Interests in structured entities continued 
A summary of the Group’s interest in unconsolidated structured entities is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 
Fixed maturity securities 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
Total fixed maturity securities 
Investment funds 
•  Private investment funds 
•  Hedge funds 
Total investment funds 
Specialised investment vehicles 
•  KHL (note 16) 
Total 

As at 31 December 2021 
Fixed maturity securities 
•  Asset backed securities 
•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 
•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 
Total fixed maturity securities 
Investment funds 
•  Private investment funds 
•  Hedge funds 
Total investment funds 
Specialised investment vehicles 
•  KHL (note 16) 
Total 

Investments  
$m 

Interest in 
associate 
$m 

160.9 
41.0 
14.0 
24.2 
240.1 

105.6 
103.9 

209.5 

– 
449.6 

Investments  
$m 

104.1 
85.5 
33.2 
0.1 
20.1 
243.0 

105.7 
102.9 

208.6 

– 
451.6 

–
–
–
–
–

–
–

–

57.2
57.2

Interest in 
associate 
$m 

–
–
–
–
–
–

–
–

–

118.7
118.7

Total 
$m 

160.9
41.0
14.0
24.2
240.1

105.6
103.9

209.5

57.2
506.8

Total 
$m 

104.1
85.5
33.2
0.1
20.1
243.0

105.7
102.9

208.6

118.7
570.3

The fixed maturity structured entities are created to meet specific investment needs of borrowers and investors which cannot be met from 
standardised financial instruments available in the capital markets. As such, they provide liquidity to the borrowers in these markets and provide 
investors with an opportunity to diversify risk away from standard fixed maturity securities. Whilst individual securities may differ in structure, the 
principles of the instruments are broadly the same and it is appropriate to aggregate the investments into the categories detailed above. 

The risk that the Group faces in respect of the investments in structured entities is similar to the risk it faces in respect of other financial investments 
held on the consolidated balance sheet in that fair value is determined by market supply and demand. This is in turn driven by investor evaluation of 
the credit risk of the structure and changes in the term structure of interest rates which change investors’ expectation of the cash flows associated 
with the instrument and, therefore, its value in the market. Risk management disclosures for these financial instruments and other investments are 
provided on pages 151 to 160. The total assets of these structured entities are not considered meaningful for the purpose of understanding the 
related risks and therefore have not been presented. 

The maximum exposure to loss in respect of these structured entities would be the carrying value of the instruments that the Group holds as at 31 
December 2022 and 31 December 2021. Generally, default rates would have to increase substantially from their current level before the Group 
would suffer a loss on maturity and this assessment is made prior to investing and regularly through the holding period for the security. The Group 
has not provided any other financial or other support in addition to that described above as at the reporting date, and there is no intention to 
provide support in relation to any other unconsolidated structured entities in the foreseeable future. 

176 
176

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

12. Interests in structured entities continued 

A summary of the Group’s interest in unconsolidated structured entities is as follows: 

As at 31 December 2022 

Fixed maturity securities 

•  Asset backed securities 

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Total fixed maturity securities 

Investment funds 

•  Private investment funds 

•  Hedge funds 

Total investment funds 

Specialised investment vehicles 

•  KHL (note 16) 

Total 

As at 31 December 2021 

Fixed maturity securities 

•  Asset backed securities 

Total fixed maturity securities 

Investment funds 

•  Private investment funds 

•  Hedge funds 

Total investment funds 

Specialised investment vehicles 

•  KHL (note 16) 

Total 

•  U.S. government agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency mortgage backed securities 

•  Agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

•  Non-agency commercial mortgage backed securities 

Investments  

$m 

Interest in 

associate 

$m 

57.2

57.2

Interest in 

associate 

$m 

Investments  

$m 

160.9 

41.0 

14.0 

24.2 

240.1 

105.6 

103.9 

209.5 

– 

449.6 

104.1 

85.5 

33.2 

0.1 

20.1 

243.0 

105.7 

102.9 

208.6 

– 

451.6 

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

–

118.7

118.7

Total 

$m 

160.9

41.0

14.0

24.2

240.1

105.6

103.9

209.5

57.2

506.8

Total 

$m 

104.1

85.5

33.2

0.1

20.1

243.0

105.7

102.9

208.6

118.7

570.3

The fixed maturity structured entities are created to meet specific investment needs of borrowers and investors which cannot be met from 

standardised financial instruments available in the capital markets. As such, they provide liquidity to the borrowers in these markets and provide 

investors with an opportunity to diversify risk away from standard fixed maturity securities. Whilst individual securities may differ in structure, the 

principles of the instruments are broadly the same and it is appropriate to aggregate the investments into the categories detailed above. 

The risk that the Group faces in respect of the investments in structured entities is similar to the risk it faces in respect of other financial investments 

held on the consolidated balance sheet in that fair value is determined by market supply and demand. This is in turn driven by investor evaluation of 

the credit risk of the structure and changes in the term structure of interest rates which change investors’ expectation of the cash flows associated 

with the instrument and, therefore, its value in the market. Risk management disclosures for these financial instruments and other investments are 

provided on pages 151 to 160. The total assets of these structured entities are not considered meaningful for the purpose of understanding the 

related risks and therefore have not been presented. 

The maximum exposure to loss in respect of these structured entities would be the carrying value of the instruments that the Group holds as at 31 

December 2022 and 31 December 2021. Generally, default rates would have to increase substantially from their current level before the Group 

would suffer a loss on maturity and this assessment is made prior to investing and regularly through the holding period for the security. The Group 

has not provided any other financial or other support in addition to that described above as at the reporting date, and there is no intention to 

provide support in relation to any other unconsolidated structured entities in the foreseeable future. 

As at 31 December 2022, the Group has a commitment of $50.0 million (31 December 2021 – $100.0 million) in respect of one credit facility fund. 
The Group, via the fund, provides collateral for revolving credit facilities purchased at a discount from financial institutions and is at risk for its 
portion of any defaults on those revolving credit facilities. The Group’s proportionate share of these revolving credit facilities purchased by the fund 
as at 31 December 2022 is $19.9 million (31 December 2021 – $39.7 million), which currently remains unfunded. The maximum exposure to the 
credit facility fund is $50.0 million and as at 31 December 2022 there have been no defaults under these facilities. 

13. Losses and loss adjustment expenses 

As at 31 December 2020 
Net incurred losses for: 
Prior years 
Current year 
Exchange adjustments 
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Net paid losses for: 
Prior years 
Current year 
Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 
As at 31 December 2021 
Net incurred losses for: 
Prior years 
Current year 
Other1 
Incurred losses and loss adjustment expenses 
Net paid losses for: 
Prior years 
Current year 
Paid losses and loss adjustment expenses 
As at 31 December 2022 

Losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m 
952.8 

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m
(338.7)

Net losses and
loss adjustment 
expenses 
$m
614.1

(118.8) 
786.4 
(17.2) 
650.4 

192.5 
119.6 
312.1 
1,291.1 

(166.0) 
1,088.7 
(20.3) 
902.4 

304.4 
108.3 
412.7 
1,780.8 

32.3
(229.4)
1.5
(195.6)

(106.7)
(8.8)
(115.5)
(418.8)

65.5
(411.8)
1.8
(344.5)

(81.7)
(89.5)
(171.2)
(592.1)

(86.5)
557.0
(15.7)
454.8

85.8
110.8
196.6
872.3

(100.5)
676.9
(18.5)
557.9

222.7
18.8
241.5
1,188.7

1.  Other movements include primarily foreign exchange adjustments and the effect of prior year of accounts losses and loss adjustment expenses and reinsurance recoveries being reinsured 

to close into the 2020 year of account, to the extent where the Group's syndicate participation has changed between those years of account. 

Further information on the calculation of loss reserves and the risks associated with them is provided in the risk disclosures section from page 145. 
The risks associated with general insurance contracts are complex and do not readily lend themselves to meaningful sensitivity analysis. The impact 
of an unreported event could lead to a significant increase in the Group’s loss reserves. The Group believes that the loss reserves established are 
adequate, however, a 20.0% increase in estimated losses would lead to a $356.2 million (31 December 2021 – $258.2 million) increase in gross loss 
reserves and a $237.7 million (31 December 2021 – $174.5 million) increase in net loss reserves.  

The breakdown of net losses and loss adjustment expenses between notified outstanding losses, ACR and IBNR is shown below:  

Outstanding losses 
Additional case reserves 
Losses incurred but not reported 
As at 31 December 2021 

Outstanding losses 
Additional case reserves 
Losses incurred but not reported 
As at 31 December 2022 

Losses and  
loss adjustment 
expenses  
$m 
402.6 
224.3 
664.2 
1,291.1 
545.2 
165.8 
1,069.8 

Reinsurance 
recoveries 
$m 
(86.9)
(31.8)
(300.1)
(418.8)
(101.3)
(30.9)
(459.9)

Net losses and
loss adjustment 
expenses 
$m 
315.7
192.5
364.1
872.3
443.9
134.9
609.9

1,780.8 

(592.1)

1,188.7

The Group’s losses and loss expenses as at 31 December 2022 and 2021 had an estimated duration of approximately two years.  

176 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

177 
177

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

13. Losses and loss adjustment expenses continued 
Claims development 
The development of insurance liabilities is indicative of the Group’s ability to estimate the ultimate value of its insurance liabilities. The Group began 
writing insurance and reinsurance business in December 2005. With the acquisition of LSL in 2013, the Group assumed additional loss reserves 
relating to 2001 and subsequent years.  

Accident year 
Gross Group losses 
Estimate of ultimate liability1
At end of accident year 
One year later 
Two years later 
Three years later 
Four years later 
Five years later 
Six years later 
Seven years later 
Eight years later 
Nine years later 
Ten years later 
Current estimate of 
cumulative liability 

Paid 
Total Group gross liability 

2012 &  
prior 

1,338.2 
1,626.1 
1,597.6 
1,587.9 
1,579.5 
1,574.2 
1,527.4 
1,518.9 
1,519.6 
1,513.5 
1,507.1 

2013 

2014 

2015 

2016 

2017 

2018 

2019 

2020 

2021 

2022 

Total
$m 

777.6  1,080.6
717.0 

432.1 
392.6 
351.5 

332.4
328.7
294.8
283.5

429.7
462.0
431.1
413.1
385.7

580.1
547.1
511.3
493.1
473.1
444.7

298.5
310.7
274.4
235.0
232.3
223.5
223.4

276.0
214.6
196.2
189.6
184.1
182.6
181.5
180.9

274.8
226.7
206.0
196.5
193.4
192.4
190.1
187.8
186.4

280.0 
259.8 
224.0 
224.4 
222.1 
218.4 
213.7 
215.7 
218.3 
217.4 

186.4

217.4 

1,507.1 
5,578.2
(1,452.6)  (207.9)  (179.2) (168.4) (217.7) (405.0) (331.7) (206.1) (206.6)  (313.9)  (108.3) (3,797.4)
1,780.8

717.0  1,080.6

351.5 

403.1 

144.9 

444.7

385.7

180.9

223.4

283.5

972.3

54.5 

77.4

54.0

39.7

12.5

9.5 

5.7

7.2

1.  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2022. 

Accident year 
Reinsurance 
Estimate of ultimate recovery1
At end of accident year 
One year later 
Two years later 
Three years later 
Four years later 
Five years later 
Six years later 
Seven years later 
Eight years later 
Nine years later 
Ten years later 
Current estimate of 
cumulative recovery 

Paid 

Total Group gross recovery 

2012 &  
prior 

167.5 
327.5 
321.3 
330.8 
330.9 
332.4 
328.1 
327.8 
324.8 
325.1 
323.1 

2013 

2014 

2015 

2016 

2017 

2018 

2019 

2020 

2021 

2022 

Total
$m 

411.4

228.4 
198.8 

93.0 
90.4 
79.0 

114.6
115.0
97.1
99.6

139.3
189.9
181.9
172.3
160.1

177.6
185.0
179.7
181.2
178.6
165.6

73.1
98.5
96.7
76.5
73.9
73.7
73.1

15.3
12.2
12.6
13.0
13.0
13.0
13.4
13.1

17.8
14.1
13.1
11.5
11.9
9.6
9.6
9.0
8.8

9.9 
8.9 
8.8 
8.0 
8.0 
8.0 
7.4 
7.2 
7.3 
7.2 

323.1 
(311.2) 

11.9 

7.2 
(7.2) 

– 

8.8
(8.7)

0.1

13.1
(12.9)

73.1
160.1
165.6
(72.7) (158.0) (135.6)

99.6
(54.2)

79.0 
(48.1) 

198.8 
(49.6) 

411.4
(89.5)

1,539.8
(947.7)

0.2

0.4

7.6

24.5

45.4

30.9 

149.2 

321.9

592.1

1.  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2022. 

178 
178

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Nine years later 

Ten years later 

Current estimate of 

cumulative liability 

Paid 

2012 &  

prior 

167.5 

327.5 

321.3 

330.8 

330.9 

332.4 

328.1 

327.8 

324.8 

325.1 

323.1 

Accident year 

Reinsurance 

Estimate of ultimate recovery1

At end of accident year 

One year later 

Two years later 

Three years later 

Four years later 

Five years later 

Six years later 

Seven years later 

Eight years later 

Nine years later 

Ten years later 

Current estimate of 

cumulative recovery 

Paid 

13. Losses and loss adjustment expenses continued 

Claims development 

The development of insurance liabilities is indicative of the Group’s ability to estimate the ultimate value of its insurance liabilities. The Group began 

writing insurance and reinsurance business in December 2005. With the acquisition of LSL in 2013, the Group assumed additional loss reserves 

2013 

2014 

2015 

2016 

2017 

2018 

2019 

2020 

2021 

2022 

Total

$m 

relating to 2001 and subsequent years.  

Accident year 

Gross Group losses 

Estimate of ultimate liability1

2012 &  

prior 

At end of accident year 

1,338.2 

280.0 

432.1 

777.6  1,080.6

392.6 

717.0 

351.5 

332.4

328.7

294.8

283.5

429.7

462.0

431.1

413.1

385.7

580.1

547.1

511.3

493.1

473.1

444.7

298.5

310.7

274.4

235.0

232.3

223.5

223.4

276.0

214.6

196.2

189.6

184.1

182.6

181.5

180.9

274.8

226.7

206.0

196.5

193.4

192.4

190.1

187.8

186.4

1,626.1 

259.8 

1,597.6 

224.0 

1,587.9 

224.4 

1,579.5 

222.1 

1,574.2 

218.4 

1,527.4 

213.7 

1,518.9 

215.7 

1,519.6 

218.3 

1,513.5 

217.4 

1,507.1 

Total Group gross liability 

54.5 

9.5 

7.2

12.5

5.7

39.7

54.0

77.4

144.9 

403.1 

972.3

1,780.8

1,507.1 

217.4 

186.4

180.9

223.4

444.7

385.7

283.5

351.5 

717.0  1,080.6

5,578.2

(1,452.6)  (207.9)  (179.2) (168.4) (217.7) (405.0) (331.7) (206.1) (206.6)  (313.9)  (108.3) (3,797.4)

1.  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2022. 

2013 

2014 

2015 

2016 

2017 

2018 

2019 

2020 

2021 

2022 

Total

$m 

228.4 

411.4

198.8 

93.0 

90.4 

79.0 

114.6

115.0

97.1

99.6

139.3

189.9

181.9

172.3

160.1

177.6

185.0

179.7

181.2

178.6

165.6

73.1

98.5

96.7

76.5

73.9

73.7

73.1

15.3

12.2

12.6

13.0

13.0

13.0

13.4

13.1

17.8

14.1

13.1

11.5

11.9

9.6

9.6

9.0

8.8

9.9 

8.9 

8.8 

8.0 

8.0 

8.0 

7.4 

7.2 

7.3 

7.2 

Total Group gross recovery 

11.9 

– 

0.1

0.2

0.4

7.6

24.5

45.4

30.9 

149.2 

321.9

592.1

323.1 

7.2 

8.8

13.1

73.1

165.6

160.1

99.6

79.0 

198.8 

411.4

1,539.8

(311.2) 

(7.2) 

(8.7)

(12.9)

(72.7) (158.0) (135.6)

(54.2)

(48.1) 

(49.6) 

(89.5)

(947.7)

1.  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2022. 

Accident year 
Net Group losses 
Estimate of ultimate liability1
At end of accident year 
One year later 
Two years later 
Three years later 
Four years later 
Five years later 
Six years later 
Seven years later 
Eight years later 
Nine years later 
Ten years later 
Current estimate of 
cumulative liability 

Paid 
Total Group net liability 

2013

2014

2015

2016

2017

2018

2019 

2020 

2021

2022

Total
$m

669.2

549.2
518.2

339.1 
302.2 
272.5 

217.8 
213.7 
197.7 
183.9 

290.4
272.1
249.2
240.8
225.6

402.5
362.1
331.6
311.9
294.5
279.1

225.4
212.2
177.7
158.5
158.4
149.8
150.3

260.7
202.4
183.6
176.6
171.1
169.6
168.1
167.8

257.0
212.6
192.9
185.0
181.5
182.8
180.5
178.8
177.6

270.1
250.9
215.2
216.4
214.1
210.4
206.3
208.5
211.0
210.2

2012 & 
 prior 

1,170.7 
1,298.6 
1,276.3 
1,257.1 
1,248.6 
1,241.8 
1,199.3 
1,191.1 
1,194.8 
1,188.4 
1,184.0 

1,184.0 

210.2

177.6

167.8

150.3

279.1

225.6

183.9 

272.5 

518.2

669.2

4,038.4

(1,141.4)  (200.7) (170.5) (155.5) (145.0) (247.0) (196.1) (151.9)  (158.5)  (264.3)
253.9

114.0 

42.6 

32.0 

12.3

32.1

29.5

7.1

5.3

9.5

(18.8) (2,849.7)
1,188.7
650.4

1.  Adjusted for revaluation of foreign currencies at the exchange rate as at 31 December 2022. 

The inherent uncertainty in reserving gives rise to favourable or adverse development on the established reserves. The total favourable development 
on net losses and loss adjustment expenses, excluding the impact of foreign exchange revaluations, was as follows: 

For the year ended 31 December 
2017 accident year and prior 
2018 accident year 
2019 accident year 
2020 accident year 
2021 accident year 
Total favourable development 

2022
$m 
19.9
13.6
13.7
27.5
25.8
100.5

2021
$m 
36.1
7.1
8.8
34.5
–
86.5

The favourable development in 2022 was primarily due to general IBNR releases on the 2021 and 2020 accident years and across most lines of 
business due to a lack of reported claims. There was favourable development on natural catastrophe loss events from the 2019 and 2018 accident 
years as well as beneficial claims settlements on risk losses in the 2017 accident year. 

In the prior year, the Group benefited from general IBNR releases on the 2020 accident year across most lines of business due to a lack of reported 
claims. The prior year also included favourable development on the 2017 accident year, mainly from reserve releases on natural catastrophe loss 
events within the property and casualty reinsurance segment, as well as some beneficial claims settlements from earlier accident years.  

During 2022, we experienced net losses from catastrophe, weather and large loss events of $308.8 million, excluding the impacts of reinstatement 
premiums. Within this, catastrophe and weather related losses for the year ended 31 December 2022, excluding the impacts of reinstatement premiums, 
were $218.4 million. This includes $163.3 million from hurricane Ian. Large claims for the year amounted to $90.4 million. This includes $65.8 million 
related to the ongoing conflict in Ukraine and incorporates a management margin for any potential indirect claims related to the conflict across a 
number of classes of business. Given the nature of the Ukraine conflict, the ultimate claims relating to the event are subject to a high level of uncertainty. 
In addition, the Group has $24.6 million from an accumulation of four large losses in the energy upstream and power generation lines of business. 

In the prior year, the Group was impacted by winter storm Uri, the European floods and hurricane Ida. Our net losses in relation to these combined 
natural catastrophe events, excluding the impacts of reinstatement premiums, were $213.3 million. Large risk losses for the year amounted to $68.8 
million, and were principally related to the unrest in South Africa in July 2021. 

The estimation of the ultimate loss and loss adjustment expense liability is a complex process which incorporates a significant amount of judgement. It 
is reasonably possible that uncertainties inherent in the reserving process, delays in insureds or ceding companies reporting losses to the Group, together 
with the potential for unforeseen adverse developments, could lead to a material change in estimated losses and loss adjustment expenses.  

There were no other individually significant net loss events for the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021.

178 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

179 
179

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

14. Insurance, reinsurance and other receivables 
All receivables are considered current other than $88.9 million (31 December 2021 – $29.2 million) of inwards premiums receivable related to 
multi-year contracts. The carrying value approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the receivables. There are no significant 
concentrations of credit risk within the Group’s receivables. 

15. Provision for deferred tax 

As at 31 December 
Equity based compensation 
Syndicate underwriting profits 
Syndicate participation rights 
Other temporary differences 
Tax losses carried forward 
Net deferred tax liability 

2022
 $m 
(5.0)
(1.3)
18.8
(2.9)
(0.3)

9.3

2021
$m 
(4.2)
(0.7)
18.8
(1.7)
–

12.2

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is likely. It is anticipated that 
sufficient taxable profits will be available within the Group in 2023 and subsequent years to utilise the deferred tax assets recognised when the 
underlying temporary differences reverse.  

For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, the Group had no uncertain tax positions. 

During 2021, changes to the UK main rate of corporation tax were enacted under the Finance Act 2021, increasing the tax rate to 25% from 19%, 
effective 1 April 2023. As at 31 December 2022, this has resulted in the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities at 25% on items where the 
tax reversal is expected to take effect on or after 1 April 2023, with a related tax charge of $nil (31 December 2021 - charge of $3.4 million). 

The table below reconciles the movements within the net deferred tax liability. 

As at 31 December 
Opening liability 
Deferred tax credit for the period 
Adjustment in respect of prior period deferred tax 
Tax rate change adjustment 
Deferred tax in equity 
Deferred tax in other comprehensive income 
Closing liability 

2022
 $m
12.2
(1.7)
1.1
–
(0.1)
(2.2)
9.3

2021
$m
10.9
(2.5)
0.8
3.4
0.5
(0.9)

12.2

All deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as non-current. 

16. Investment in associate 
The Group holds an interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL. KHL is a company incorporated in Bermuda and its 
operating subsidiary, KRL, is authorised by the BMA as a Special Purpose Insurer. KRL commenced writing insurance business on 1 January 2014. As 
at 31 December 2022, the carrying value of the Group’s investment in KHL was $57.2 million (31 December 2021 – $118.7 million). The Group’s 
share of comprehensive loss for KHL for the period was a loss of $6.5 million (2021 – $3.9 million loss). Key financial information for KHL is as 
follows: 

Assets 
Liabilities 
Shareholders’ equity 
Gross premium earned 
Comprehensive loss 

2022
 $m
532.7
302.0
230.7
40.5
(28.4)

2021
$m
887.6
273.6
613.9
137.3
(57.9)

The Group has the power to participate in the operational and financial policy decisions of KHL and KRL through the provision of essential technical 
information by LCM and has therefore classified its investment in KHL as an investment in associate. 

When IFRS 17, Insurance contracts is implemented, adjustments will be made to associate accounting policies, where necessary, in order to be 
consistent with the Group's insurance accounting policies. When IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, is implemented, 
KHL will continue to classify all its financial assets at FVTPL. There will therefore be no impact on the estimated fair value of the financial assets 
disclosed in the table above.  

Refer to note 23 for details of transactions between the Group and its associate. 

180 
180

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
14. Insurance, reinsurance and other receivables 

All receivables are considered current other than $88.9 million (31 December 2021 – $29.2 million) of inwards premiums receivable related to 

multi-year contracts. The carrying value approximates fair value due to the short-term nature of the receivables. There are no significant 

concentrations of credit risk within the Group’s receivables. 

15. Provision for deferred tax 

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

As at 31 December 

Equity based compensation 

Syndicate underwriting profits 

Syndicate participation rights 

Other temporary differences 

Tax losses carried forward 

Net deferred tax liability 

Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that realising the related tax benefit through future taxable profits is likely. It is anticipated that 

sufficient taxable profits will be available within the Group in 2023 and subsequent years to utilise the deferred tax assets recognised when the 

underlying temporary differences reverse.  

For the years ended 31 December 2022 and 2021, the Group had no uncertain tax positions. 

During 2021, changes to the UK main rate of corporation tax were enacted under the Finance Act 2021, increasing the tax rate to 25% from 19%, 

effective 1 April 2023. As at 31 December 2022, this has resulted in the recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities at 25% on items where the 

tax reversal is expected to take effect on or after 1 April 2023, with a related tax charge of $nil (31 December 2021 - charge of $3.4 million). 

The table below reconciles the movements within the net deferred tax liability. 

As at 31 December 

Opening liability 

Deferred tax credit for the period 

Adjustment in respect of prior period deferred tax 

Tax rate change adjustment 

Deferred tax in equity 

Deferred tax in other comprehensive income 

Closing liability 

All deferred tax assets and liabilities are classified as non-current. 

16. Investment in associate 

follows: 

Assets 

Liabilities 

Shareholders’ equity 

Gross premium earned 

Comprehensive loss 

The Group holds an interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL. KHL is a company incorporated in Bermuda and its 

operating subsidiary, KRL, is authorised by the BMA as a Special Purpose Insurer. KRL commenced writing insurance business on 1 January 2014. As 

at 31 December 2022, the carrying value of the Group’s investment in KHL was $57.2 million (31 December 2021 – $118.7 million). The Group’s 

share of comprehensive loss for KHL for the period was a loss of $6.5 million (2021 – $3.9 million loss). Key financial information for KHL is as 

The Group has the power to participate in the operational and financial policy decisions of KHL and KRL through the provision of essential technical 

information by LCM and has therefore classified its investment in KHL as an investment in associate. 

When IFRS 17, Insurance contracts is implemented, adjustments will be made to associate accounting policies, where necessary, in order to be 

consistent with the Group's insurance accounting policies. When IFRS 9, Financial Instruments: Classification and Measurement, is implemented, 

KHL will continue to classify all its financial assets at FVTPL. There will therefore be no impact on the estimated fair value of the financial assets 

disclosed in the table above.  

Refer to note 23 for details of transactions between the Group and its associate. 

180 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

2022

 $m 

(5.0)

(1.3)

18.8

(2.9)

(0.3)

9.3

2022

 $m

12.2

(1.7)

1.1

–

(0.1)

(2.2)

9.3

2021

$m 

(4.2)

(0.7)

18.8

(1.7)

–

12.2

2021

$m

10.9

(2.5)

0.8

3.4

0.5

(0.9)

12.2

2022

 $m

532.7

302.0

230.7

40.5

2021

$m

887.6

273.6

613.9

137.3

(28.4)

(57.9)

17. Intangible assets 

Net book value as at 31 December 2020 

Additions 
Net book value as at 31 December 2021 

Additions 
Net book value as at 31 December 2022 

Syndicate 
participation  
rights  
$m 
83.3 
0.2 
83.5 
4.2 
87.7 

Internally 
generated 
intangible assets
$m 
–
3.2
3.2
10.3
13.5

Goodwill  
$m 
71.2 
– 
71.2 
– 
71.2 

Total 
$m 
154.5
3.4
157.9
14.5
172.4

Syndicate participation rights and goodwill 
In the year ended 31 December 2022, the Group's corporate member acquired additional participation rights in Syndicate 2010, which took the 
Group's share on the 2023 year of account to 69.3% (2021 – 62.3%).  

Indefinite life intangible assets are tested annually for impairment. For the purpose of impairment testing, the syndicate participation rights and 
goodwill have been allocated to the LSL’s CGU. 

The recoverable amount of the LSL’s CGU is determined based on its value in use. Value in use is calculated using projected cash flows of the LSL’s 
CGU. These are approved by management and cover a three-year period. The most significant assumptions used to derive the projected cash flows 
include an assessment of business prospects, business plans approved by Lloyd's, expected future market conditions, premium growth rates, 
outwards reinsurance expenditure, projected loss ratios, investment returns, the ongoing conflict in Ukraine and climate change. To mitigate the 
impact of climate risk the Group accepts insurance risk for periods primarily of one year which provides the Group the ability to re-evaluate the 
portfolio on an annual basis and therefore reprice physical risk and reset exposure levels to consider new data regarding the frequency and severity 
of elemental catastrophe events. 

A pre-tax discount rate of 9.9% (2021 – 8.6%) has been used to discount the projected cash flows, which reflects a combination of factors including 
the Group’s expected weighted average cost of equity and cost of borrowing. This has been calculated using independent measures of the risk-free 
rate of return and is indicative of the Group’s risk profile relative to the market. The higher pre-tax discount rate is primarily due to an overall 
increase in the cost of equity included in the Group's weighted average cost of capital calculation. This was driven by an increase in both the beta 
value and the risk free rate input assumptions. The growth rate used to extrapolate the cash flows is 2.5% (2021 – 3.0%) based on historical growth 
rates and management’s best estimate of future growth rates taking into account current economic market conditions. 

Sensitivity testing has been performed to model the impact of reasonably possible changes in input assumptions to our base case impairment 
analysis and headroom. The discount rate has been flexed to 100 basis points above the central assumption (14% reduction in headroom), the 
growth rate has been flexed to 100 basis points below the central assumption (13% reduction in headroom) and the pre-tax projected cash flows 
have been flexed 500 basis points below the central assumption (6% reduction in headroom). Within these ranges, the recoverable amount remains 
supportable.  

No impairment loss has been recognised for the years ending 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

Internally generated intangible assets 
Internally generated intangible assets represent directly attributable costs incurred in the development phase of implementing a cloud-based target 
operating model. As at 31 December 2022, the internally generated intangible assets are not yet in use. During the year ending 31 December 2022 
$7.5 million (2021 - $5.5 million) of project costs have been expensed and no impairment loss has been recognised. 

18. Long-term debt and financing arrangements 
Long-term debt 
During the year ended 31 December 2021, the Company issued $450.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 5.625% fixed-rate reset junior 
subordinated notes, repayable on 18 September 2041. The long-term debt was issued in two tranches forming part of the same series of notes, with 
$400.0 million issued on 18 March 2021 and $50.0 million issued on 31 March 2021. Interest is payable semi-annually in arrears on 18 March and 18 
September of each year, from 18 September 2021. The fixed interest rate will reset on 18 September 2031, and each reset date thereafter, at a rate 
per annum equal to the prevailing five year treasury rate plus a credit spread of 4.08% and a 100 basis point step up.  

The carrying value of the Company's issued $450.0 million subordinated notes are shown below: 

As at 31 December 
Junior subordinated notes 
$450.0 million 5.625% fixed-rate reset notes issued March 2021, due September 2041 
Carrying value 

2022
 $m 

446.1

446.1

2021
$m 

445.7
445.7

The fair value of the long-term debt is $352.0 million (31 December 2021 – $482.1 million). The fair value measurement is classified within Level (ii) 
of the fair value hierarchy and is based on observable data. The fair value of the long-term debt has decreased from 2021, however, given the 
duration of the long-term debt combined with the increase in treasury rates and the widening of spreads in that credit range, the decrease is within 
expectations. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

181 
181

Financial Statements 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

18. Long-term debt and financing arrangements continued 
The interest accrued on the long-term debt was $7.2 million (31 December 2021 – $7.2 million) at the balance sheet date and is included in other 
payables. Refer to note 8 for details of the interest expense for the year included in financing costs. 

The Company has the option to redeem some or all of the junior subordinated notes, in whole or in part, prior to the maturity date. There are no 
negative or financial covenants attached to the issued junior subordinated notes. 

The table below outlines the cash and non-cash changes from our long-term debt restructuring arising from financing activities during the year 
ended 31 December 2021. During the year ended 31 December 2022, there were no long-term debt re-financing activities. 

As at 31 December 2020 
Fair value, net of transaction costs on issuance of $450.0 million reset junior subordinated notes 
Early redemption costs on senior and subordinated loan notes 
Amortisation of $450.0 million reset junior subordinated notes  
Redemption of senior and subordinated loan notes 
As at 31 December 2021 

2021
$m
327.5
445.4
12.8
(0.4)
(339.6)

445.7

Letters of credit 
As both LICL and LUK are non-admitted insurers or reinsurers throughout the U.S., the terms of certain contracts require them to provide LOCs to 
policyholders as collateral.  

LHL and LICL have a $250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $50.0 million loan sub-limit that has been in place since 20 March 
2020 and will expire on 20 March 2025. There was no outstanding debt under this facility as at 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

The facility is available for the issue of LOCs to ceding companies. The facility is also available for LICL to issue LOCs to LUK to collateralise certain 
insurance balances. 

The following LOCs have been issued: 

As at 31 December 
Issued to third parties 

These LOCs are required to be fully collateralised.  

2022
 $m 
27.3

2021
$m 
27.1

The terms of the $250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility include standard default and cross-default provisions, which require certain 
covenants to be adhered to. These include the following: 

•  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;  
•  a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0%, where the junior subordinated notes are excluded as debt from this calculation; 
•  a maximum subordinated unsecured indebtedness of $350.0 million; and 
•  a maximum aggregated indebtedness (i) under any syndicate arrangement entered into by Lancashire Syndicates in connection with the underwriting 
business carried on by all such members of the syndicates and (ii) incurred by CCL 1998, LHL or LICL in the ordinary course of business in connection 
with coming into line requirements, of $200.0 million. 

On 3 March 2021 and 20 October 2022, LHL and LICL obtained waivers from their lenders in relation to the limits on debt incurrence under the 
$250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility, which allowed (i) LHL to issue its $450.0 million 5.625% fixed-rate reset junior subordinated 
notes due in 2041, and (ii) LICL to increase its uncollateralised facility to $181.5 million and Syndicate 2010 to renew its $60.0 million LOC 
catastrophe facility, respectively. 

An uncollateralised facility has been in place since 30 July 2019, for an original amount of $31.0 million. The facility was most recently increased to 
$181.5 million on 25 October 2022 (from $115.5 million effective 29 October 2021). It is available for utilisation by LICL and guaranteed by LHL for 
FAL purposes. As at 31 December 2022, $181.5 million of LOC were issued under this facility and are due to expire on 28 October 2026. 

The terms of the $181.5 million uncollateralised facility includes standard default and cross-default provisions, which require certain covenants to be 
adhered to. These include the following: 

•  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;  
•  a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0%, where the junior subordinated notes are excluded as debt from this calculation; and 
•  maintenance of a minimum net worth requirement. 

As at all reporting dates, the Group was in compliance with all covenants and waivers under these facilities.  

Syndicate bank facilities 
As at 31 December 2022 and 2021, Syndicate 2010 had in place a $60.0 million LOC catastrophe facility. The facility is available to assist in paying 
claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 2010. A separate uncommitted overdraft facility of $20.0 million is also available to 
Syndicate 2010. 

182 
182

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

18. Long-term debt and financing arrangements continued 

The interest accrued on the long-term debt was $7.2 million (31 December 2021 – $7.2 million) at the balance sheet date and is included in other 

payables. Refer to note 8 for details of the interest expense for the year included in financing costs. 

The Company has the option to redeem some or all of the junior subordinated notes, in whole or in part, prior to the maturity date. There are no 

negative or financial covenants attached to the issued junior subordinated notes. 

The table below outlines the cash and non-cash changes from our long-term debt restructuring arising from financing activities during the year 

ended 31 December 2021. During the year ended 31 December 2022, there were no long-term debt re-financing activities. 

As at 31 December 2020 

Fair value, net of transaction costs on issuance of $450.0 million reset junior subordinated notes 

Early redemption costs on senior and subordinated loan notes 

Amortisation of $450.0 million reset junior subordinated notes  

Redemption of senior and subordinated loan notes 

As at 31 December 2021 

Letters of credit 

policyholders as collateral.  

As both LICL and LUK are non-admitted insurers or reinsurers throughout the U.S., the terms of certain contracts require them to provide LOCs to 

LHL and LICL have a $250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility with a $50.0 million loan sub-limit that has been in place since 20 March 

2020 and will expire on 20 March 2025. There was no outstanding debt under this facility as at 31 December 2022 and 2021. 

The facility is available for the issue of LOCs to ceding companies. The facility is also available for LICL to issue LOCs to LUK to collateralise certain 

2021

$m

327.5

445.4

12.8

(0.4)

(339.6)

445.7

2022

 $m 

27.3

2021

$m 

27.1

insurance balances. 

The following LOCs have been issued: 

As at 31 December 

Issued to third parties 

These LOCs are required to be fully collateralised.  

covenants to be adhered to. These include the following: 

•  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;  

The terms of the $250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility include standard default and cross-default provisions, which require certain 

•  a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0%, where the junior subordinated notes are excluded as debt from this calculation; 

•  a maximum subordinated unsecured indebtedness of $350.0 million; and 

•  a maximum aggregated indebtedness (i) under any syndicate arrangement entered into by Lancashire Syndicates in connection with the underwriting 

business carried on by all such members of the syndicates and (ii) incurred by CCL 1998, LHL or LICL in the ordinary course of business in connection 

with coming into line requirements, of $200.0 million. 

On 3 March 2021 and 20 October 2022, LHL and LICL obtained waivers from their lenders in relation to the limits on debt incurrence under the 

$250.0 million syndicated collateralised credit facility, which allowed (i) LHL to issue its $450.0 million 5.625% fixed-rate reset junior subordinated 

notes due in 2041, and (ii) LICL to increase its uncollateralised facility to $181.5 million and Syndicate 2010 to renew its $60.0 million LOC 

catastrophe facility, respectively. 

An uncollateralised facility has been in place since 30 July 2019, for an original amount of $31.0 million. The facility was most recently increased to 

$181.5 million on 25 October 2022 (from $115.5 million effective 29 October 2021). It is available for utilisation by LICL and guaranteed by LHL for 

FAL purposes. As at 31 December 2022, $181.5 million of LOC were issued under this facility and are due to expire on 28 October 2026. 

The terms of the $181.5 million uncollateralised facility includes standard default and cross-default provisions, which require certain covenants to be 

adhered to. These include the following: 

•  an A.M. Best financial strength rating of at least B++;  

•  maintenance of a minimum net worth requirement. 

•  a maximum debt to capital ratio of 30.0%, where the junior subordinated notes are excluded as debt from this calculation; and 

As at all reporting dates, the Group was in compliance with all covenants and waivers under these facilities.  

As at 31 December 2022 and 2021, Syndicate 2010 had in place a $60.0 million LOC catastrophe facility. The facility is available to assist in paying 

claims and the gross funding of catastrophes for Syndicate 2010. A separate uncommitted overdraft facility of $20.0 million is also available to 

Syndicate bank facilities 

Syndicate 2010. 

182 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

There were no balances outstanding under the Syndicate LOC catastrophe facility as at 31 December 2022 or 2021. The Syndicate LOC catastrophe 
facility is not available to the Group other than through its participation on Syndicate 2010. 

Trusts and restricted balances 
The Group has several trust arrangements in place in favour of policyholders and ceding companies in order to comply with the security 
requirements of certain reinsurance contracts and/or the regulatory requirements of certain jurisdictions.  

In 2012, LICL established a MBRT to collateralise certain reinsurance liabilities associated with U.S. domiciled clients. As at, and for the years ended, 
31 December 2022 and 2021, LICL had been granted accredited or trusteed reinsurer status in all U.S. States. The MBRT is subject to the rules and 
regulations of the aforementioned States and the respective deeds of trust. These rules and regulations include minimum capital funding 
requirements, investment guidelines, capital distribution restrictions and regulatory reporting requirements. 

As at, and for the years ended, 31 December 2022 and 2021, the Group was in compliance with all covenants under its trust facilities. 

The Group is required to hold a portion of its assets as FAL to support the underwriting capacities of Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. FAL are 
restricted in their use and are only drawn down to pay cash calls to syndicates supported by the Group. FAL requirements are formally assessed 
twice a year and any funds surplus to requirements may be released at that time. See page 163 for more information regarding FAL requirements. 

In addition to the FAL, certain cash and investments held by Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010 are only available for paying the syndicates’ claims 
and expenses. See page 163 for more information regarding the capital requirements for Syndicate 2010 and Syndicate 3010. 

The following cash and cash equivalent and investment balances were held in trust, other collateral accounts in favour of third parties, or are 
otherwise restricted: 

Cash and cash 
equivalents 
$m 
2.5
3.1
127.4
69.1
2.3
–
–
204.4

2022
Fixed maturity 
securities 
$m 
398.4
251.9
240.2
24.3
30.8
3.1
–
948.7

Cash and cash 
equivalents  
$m 
108.1 
0.3 
90.9 
16.2 
2.1 
– 
1.4 

2021
Fixed maturity 
securities 
$m 
227.3
259.9
164.3
19.3
32.3
3.9
1.9

219.0 

708.9

Total 
$m 
400.9 
255.0 
367.6 
93.4 
33.1 
3.1 
– 
1,153.1 

Total
$m 
335.4
260.2
255.2
35.5
34.4
3.9
3.3

927.9

As at 31 December 
FAL 
MBRT accounts 
Syndicate accounts 
In trust accounts for policyholders 
In favour of LOCs 
Loan to Lloyd's Central Fund 
In favour of derivative contracts 
Total 

19. Share capital and other reserves 
Authorised common shares of $0.50 each 
As at 31 December 2022 and 2021 

Allocated, called up and fully paid 
As at 31 December 2022 and 2021  

Number
3,000,000,000 

$m
1,500.0

Number
244,010,007 

$m
122.0

$m 
21.2 

Total number
of own shares 
2,198,099

(9.9)  (1,027,201)
1,000,000
– 
–
6.8 
18.1 
2,170,898
(8.1)  (1,084,053)
–  4,589,592
24.0 
–
34.0  5,676,437

$m 
21.2

(9.9)
6.9
(0.1)
18.1
(8.1)
23.3
0.7
34.0

During the year ended 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021 no new shares were issued by the Group.  

Own shares 
As at 31 December 2020 

Shares distributed 
Shares repurchased 
Shares donated to trust 
As at 31 December 2021 
Shares distributed 
Shares repurchased 
Shares donated to trust 
As at 31 December 2022 

Number held 
 in treasury 
–

–
1,000,000
(1,000,000)
–
–
4,589,592
(4,589,592)
–

Number held  
 in Trust 
2,198,099 

$m 
–

6.9

– (1,027,201) 
– 
(6.9) 1,000,000 
–
2,170,898 
– (1,084,053) 
– 
23.3
(23.3) 4,589,592 
5,676,437 

–

The number of common shares in issue with voting rights (allocated share capital less shares held in treasury) as at 31 December 2022 was 
244,010,007 (31 December 2021 – 244,010,007). 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

183 
183

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

19. Share capital and other reserves continued 
Share repurchases 
At the AGM held on 27 April 2022, LHL’s shareholders approved a renewal of the Company’s Repurchase Programme authorising the repurchase of a 
maximum of 24,401,000 common shares, with such authority to expire on the conclusion of the 2023 AGM or, if earlier, 15 months from the date 
the resolution approving the Repurchase Programme was passed. Under the Repurchase Programme, the Board authorised management to 
repurchase up to: 

•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 16 May 2022 and ending no later than 27 July 2022. 
•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 8 August 2022 and ending no later than 30 September 2022. 
•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 14 November 2022 and ending no later than 30 December 2022. 

During the year ended 31 December 2022, 4,589,592 common shares were repurchased by the Company under its Repurchase Programme, at a 
weighted average share price of £4.23. As at 31 December 2022, the Company's current Repurchase Programme has 19,811,408 common shares 
remaining. During the year ended 31 December 2021, 1,000,000 common shares were repurchased by the Company under its Repurchase 
Programme, at a weighted average share price of £5.11. 

Dividends 
The Board of Directors has authorised the following dividends: 

Type 
Final 
Interim 
Final 
Interim 

Per share 
amount 
$0.10
$0.05
$0.10
$0.05

Record date 
7 May 2021 
6 Aug 2021 

Payment date 
4 June 2021 
3 Sep 2021 
13 May 2022  10 June 2022 
2 Sep 2022 

5 Aug 2022 

$m 
24.3
12.1
24.3
11.9

Other reserves 
The Group's other reserves of $1,221.9 million (31 December 2021 – $1,221.6 million) comprises contributed surplus and an equity based 
compensation reserve. The equity based compensation reserve comprises $33.3 million (31 December 2021 – $34.3 million) of this balance and 
relates to the Group's equity compensation plans (see note 7). 

20. Leases 
The Group leases four properties and several items of office equipment.  

Right-of-use assets 
The Group had the following right-of-use assets in relation to leases entered into. 

As at 31 December 2020 

Depreciation charge 
As at 31 December 2021 

Additions 
Modification 
Depreciation charge 
As at 31 December 2022 

Property 
$m 
15.8 
(2.6) 
13.2 
6.3 
3.2 
(2.6) 

20.1 

Equipment
$m
0.3
(0.1)
0.2
0.1
–
(0.1)

0.2

Total
$m
16.1
(2.7)
13.4
6.4
3.2
(2.7)

20.3

During the year ended 31 December 2022, the Group entered into two new lease agreements for additional office space in London and Australia 
and also modified the lease term on its existing London office lease agreement.  

Lease liabilities 

As at 31 December  
Due in less than one year 
Due between one and five years 
Due in more than five years 
Total undiscounted lease liabilities 
Total discounted lease liabilities 
Current 
Non-current 

The Group does not face a significant liquidity risk with regards to its lease liabilities. 

184 
184

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

2022
 $m 
3.6
13.4
12.3
29.3

23.3
2.2
21.1

2021
$m 
3.7
11.5
6.1
21.3
17.9 
2.8
15.1

Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

19. Share capital and other reserves continued 

Share repurchases 

At the AGM held on 27 April 2022, LHL’s shareholders approved a renewal of the Company’s Repurchase Programme authorising the repurchase of a 

maximum of 24,401,000 common shares, with such authority to expire on the conclusion of the 2023 AGM or, if earlier, 15 months from the date 

the resolution approving the Repurchase Programme was passed. Under the Repurchase Programme, the Board authorised management to 

repurchase up to: 

•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 16 May 2022 and ending no later than 27 July 2022. 

•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 8 August 2022 and ending no later than 30 September 2022. 

•  3,000,000 common shares during the period commencing 14 November 2022 and ending no later than 30 December 2022. 

During the year ended 31 December 2022, 4,589,592 common shares were repurchased by the Company under its Repurchase Programme, at a 

weighted average share price of £4.23. As at 31 December 2022, the Company's current Repurchase Programme has 19,811,408 common shares 

remaining. During the year ended 31 December 2021, 1,000,000 common shares were repurchased by the Company under its Repurchase 

Programme, at a weighted average share price of £5.11. 

The Board of Directors has authorised the following dividends: 

Per share 

amount 

$0.10

$0.05

$0.10

$0.05

Record date 

Payment date 

7 May 2021 

4 June 2021 

6 Aug 2021 

3 Sep 2021 

13 May 2022  10 June 2022 

5 Aug 2022 

2 Sep 2022 

$m 

24.3

12.1

24.3

11.9

The Group's other reserves of $1,221.9 million (31 December 2021 – $1,221.6 million) comprises contributed surplus and an equity based 

compensation reserve. The equity based compensation reserve comprises $33.3 million (31 December 2021 – $34.3 million) of this balance and 

relates to the Group's equity compensation plans (see note 7). 

The Group leases four properties and several items of office equipment.  

The Group had the following right-of-use assets in relation to leases entered into. 

Dividends 

Type 

Final 

Interim 

Final 

Interim 

Other reserves 

20. Leases 

Right-of-use assets 

As at 31 December 2020 

Depreciation charge 

As at 31 December 2021 

Additions 

Modification 

Depreciation charge 

As at 31 December 2022 

During the year ended 31 December 2022, the Group entered into two new lease agreements for additional office space in London and Australia 

and also modified the lease term on its existing London office lease agreement.  

Property 

Equipment

$m 

15.8 

(2.6) 

13.2 

6.3 

3.2 

(2.6) 

20.1 

(0.1)

$m

0.3

0.2

0.1

–

(0.1)

0.2

2022

 $m 

3.6

13.4

12.3

29.3

23.3

2.2

21.1

Total

$m

16.1

(2.7)

13.4

6.4

3.2

(2.7)

20.3

2021

$m 

3.7

11.5

6.1

21.3

17.9 

2.8

15.1

Lease liabilities 

As at 31 December  

Due in less than one year 

Due between one and five years 

Due in more than five years 

Total undiscounted lease liabilities 

Total discounted lease liabilities 

Current 

Non-current 

184 

The Group does not face a significant liquidity risk with regards to its lease liabilities. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Amounts recognised in profit or loss 

For the year ended 31 December 
Depreciation of right-of-use assets 
Interest expense on lease liabilities 
Expenses relating to short-term leases, low value leases and variable leases 
Total 

2022
$m
2.7
0.8
0.9

4.4

2021
$m
2.7
1.1
1.0

4.8

For the year ended 31 December 2022, the total lease payments included in the consolidated cash flow statement amounted to $3.6 million (31 
December 2021 – $4.0 million). 

21. Commitments and contingencies 
Credit facility fund 
As at 31 December 2022, the Group has a commitment of $50.0 million (31 December 2021 – $100.0 million) relating to one credit facility fund 
(refer to note 12). 

Private investment funds 
The table below shows the dates on which the Group committed to invest in four different private investment funds and the amount of the total 
commitment that remains undrawn as at 31 December 2022. 

Date of commitment to invest in private investment fund 
18 October 2022 
28 July 2021 
9 December 2020 
5 November 2019 
Total 

Total 
commitment 
$m 
10.0
34.0
25.0
25.0
94.0

Undrawn 
commitment 
$m 
7.5
18.7
4.7
1.0
31.9

Legal proceedings and regulations 
The Group operates in the insurance industry and is subject to legal proceedings in the normal course of business. While it is not practicable to 
estimate or determine the final results of all pending or threatened legal proceedings, management does not believe that such proceedings 
(including litigation) will have a material effect on its results and financial position. 

22. Earnings per share 
The following reflects the profit and share data used in the basic and diluted earnings per share computations: 

For the year ended 31 December 
Loss for the year attributable to equity shareholders of LHL 

2022
$m
(3.3)

2021
$m
(62.2)

Basic weighted average number of shares 
Dilutive effect of RSS 
Diluted weighted average number of shares 

Loss per share 
Basic 
Diluted1 

2022 
Number 
 of shares 

2021
Number 
of shares 
240,328,201 242,447,761
3,151,016
243,345,394 245,598,777

3,017,193

2022
($0.01)
($0.01)

2021
($0.26)
($0.26)

1.  Diluted EPS excludes dilutive effect of RSS when in a loss making position. 

Equity based compensation awards are only treated as dilutive when their conversion to common shares would decrease earnings per share or 
increase loss per share from continuing operations. Unvested restricted shares without performance criteria are therefore included in the number of 
potentially dilutive shares. Incremental shares from ordinary restricted share options where relevant performance criteria have not been met are not 
included in the calculation of dilutive shares. 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

185 
185

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

23. Related party disclosures  
The consolidated financial statements include LHL and the entities listed below: 

Name 
Subsidiaries1 
CCHL 
CCL 
CCL 19982 
CCL 1999 
CUL 
LAPL 
LBCL 
LCM 
LCMMSL 
LICL 
LIHL 
LIMSL 
LISL 
LHAPL 
LMSCL 
LSL 
LUAPL 
LUK 
Associate 
KHL3 
Other controlled entities 
EBT 

Principal Business

Domicile 

Investment company 
Holding company 
Lloyd’s corporate member 
Non trading 
Non trading 
Non trading  
Holding company 
Insurance agent services 
Support services 
General insurance business 
Holding company 
Insurance mediation activities 
Support services 
Holding company 
Support services 
Lloyd’s managing agent 
Lloyd's service company 
General insurance business 

Holding company 

Trust 

United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
Australia 
Cayman Islands 
Bermuda 
United Kingdom 
Bermuda 
United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
United Kingdom 
Australia 
Canada 
United Kingdom 
Australia 
United Kingdom 

Bermuda 

Jersey 

1.  Unless otherwise stated, the Group owns 100% of the ordinary share capital and voting rights in its subsidiaries listed. 
2.  62.3% participation on the 2022 year of account and 69.3% participation on the 2023 year of account for Syndicate 2010. 
3.  The Group has an 16.7% holding through its interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL. 

186 
186

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

23. Related party disclosures  

The consolidated financial statements include LHL and the entities listed below: 

Principal Business

Domicile 

Name 

Subsidiaries1 

CCHL 

CCL 

CCL 19982 

CCL 1999 

CUL 

LAPL 

LBCL 

LCM 

LCMMSL 

LICL 

LIHL 

LIMSL 

LISL 

LHAPL 

LMSCL 

LSL 

LUAPL 

LUK 

Associate 

KHL3 

EBT 

Investment company 

Holding company 

Lloyd’s corporate member 

Non trading 

Non trading 

Non trading  

Holding company 

Insurance agent services 

Support services 

General insurance business 

Holding company 

Insurance mediation activities 

Support services 

Holding company 

Support services 

Lloyd’s managing agent 

Lloyd's service company 

General insurance business 

Holding company 

Trust 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Australia 

Cayman Islands 

Bermuda 

United Kingdom 

Bermuda 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

United Kingdom 

Australia 

Canada 

United Kingdom 

Australia 

United Kingdom 

Bermuda 

Jersey 

Other controlled entities 

1.  Unless otherwise stated, the Group owns 100% of the ordinary share capital and voting rights in its subsidiaries listed. 

2.  62.3% participation on the 2022 year of account and 69.3% participation on the 2023 year of account for Syndicate 2010. 

3.  The Group has an 16.7% holding through its interest in the preference shares of each segregated account of KHL. 

The EBT was established to assist in the administration of the Group’s employee equity based compensation schemes. While the Group does not 
have legal ownership of the EBT and the ability of the Group to influence the actions of the EBT is limited by the trust deed, the EBT was set up by 
the Group with the sole purpose of assisting in the administration of these schemes, and is in essence controlled by the Group, and is therefore 
consolidated. 

The Group has a Loan Facility Agreement (the ‘Facility’) with JTC PLC, the trustee of the EBT. The Facility is an interest free revolving credit facility 
under which the trustee can request advances on demand, within the terms of the Facility, up to a maximum aggregate amount of $80.0 million. 
The Facility may only be used by the trustee for the purpose of achieving the objectives of the EBT. During the year ended 31 December 2022, the 
Group had made advances of $0.5 million (31 December 2021 – $1.0 million) to the EBT under the terms of the Facility. 

During the year ended 31 December 2022, LHL donated 4,589,592 common shares (repurchased under its Repurchase Programmes) to the EBT for a 
total market value of $23.3 million at the prevailing rate. During the year ended 31 December 2021, LHL donated 1,000,000 common shares 
(repurchased under its Repurchase Programme) to the EBT for a total market value of $6.8 million at the prevailing rate. LHL did not issue any 
common shares to the EBT during either the year ended 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2021. 

LICL holds $203.8 million (31 December 2021 – $211.8 million) of cash and cash equivalents, fixed maturity securities and accrued interest in trust 
for the benefit of LUK relating to intra-group reinsurance agreements. In addition, LICL is required to provide 100% of the required FAL to support 
the underwriting activities of Syndicate 2010 and 3010 and in relation to intra-group reinsurance agreements. LICL holds $400.9 million (31 
December 2021 – $335.4 million) of cash and cash equivalents and fixed maturity securities in FAL with the remaining FAL requirement covered by 
an LOC facility, (refer to note 18). 

In September 2022, the senior management team sold their 6.5% shares in LCM to LHL for an amount of $1.1 million. LHL now owns 100% of the 
ordinary share capital of LCM (31 December 2021 – 93.5%). During the year ended 31 December 2022, dividends of $nil(31 December 2021 – $0.5 
million) were paid to minority interest holders in LCM. 

In September 2022, Mr Maloney, a Director of LHL, sold his 1.2% share in LCM to LHL for an amount of $0.2 million. During the year ended 31 
December 2021, Mr Maloney held a 1.2% share in LCM. 

Mr Maloney and his spouse acquired 100.0% of the shares in Nameco on 7 November 2016. Nameco provides capacity to a number of Lloyd’s 
syndicates including Syndicate 2010, which is managed by LSL. Nameco has provided $0.2 million of capacity to Syndicate 2010 for the 2023 year 
of account (2022 year of account – $0.2 million). Mr Maloney receives a proportionate share of the underwriting results of Syndicate 2010 to which 
he is contractually entitled through his participation. 

Key management compensation 
Remuneration for key management, the Group’s Executive and Non-Executive Directors, was as follows:  

For the year ended 31 December 
Short-term compensation 
Equity based compensation 
Directors’ fees and expenses 
Total 

2022
 $m 
2.7
0.8
2.3
5.8

2021
$m 
2.0
1.8
2.4

6.2

Non-Executive Directors do not receive any benefits in addition to their agreed fees and expenses and do not participate in any of the Group’s 
incentive, performance or pension plans. 

Transactions with associate and its subsidiary 
In 2013, LCM entered into an underwriting services agreement with KRL and KHL to provide various services relating to underwriting, actuarial, 
premium payments and relevant deductions, acquisition expenses and receipt of claims. For the year ended 31 December 2022, the Group 
recognised $4.0 million (2021 – $15.8 million) of service fees and profit commissions in other income (refer to note 5) in relation to this agreement.  

During 2022, the Group committed an additional $nil (31 December 2021 – $60.8 million) of capital to KHL. During 2022, KHL returned $55.0 
million (31 December 2021 – $65.4 million) of capital to the Group.  

Refer to note 16 for further details on the Group’s investment in associate. 

During 2021, the Group entered into reinsurance agreements with KRL. The following balances are included in the Group’s consolidated financial 
statements: 

Consolidated balance sheet 
Unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
Reinsurance recoveries 
Amounts payable to reinsurers 
Deferred acquisition cost ceded 

2022
$m
–
21.0
–
–

2021
$m
3.1
25.0
2.8
0.4

186 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

187 
187

Financial Statements 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial Statements 

Notes to the accounts continued 

23. Related party disclosures continued 

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income 
Outwards reinsurance premiums 
Change in unearned premiums on premiums ceded 
Insurance losses and loss adjustment expenses recoverable 
Insurance acquisition expenses ceded 

2022
 $m
–
(3.1)
(4.0)
0.4

2021
$m
(13.9)
(0.3)
25.0
0.9

24. Subsequent events 
Dividend 
On 9 February 2023, the Board of Directors declared the payment of an ordinary dividend of $0.10 per common share, subject to a shareholder vote 
of approval at the AGM on 26 April 2023, which will result in an aggregate payment of approximately $23.8 million. On the basis that the final 
dividend is so approved by the shareholders at the AGM, then the dividend will be paid on 2 June 2023 to shareholders of record on 5 May 2023. An 
amount equivalent to the dividend accrues on all RSS awards and is paid at the time of exercise, pro-rata according to the number of RSS options 
that vest. 

188 
188

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022 

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Shareholder Information

Annual General Meeting
The Company’s AGM is scheduled for 26 April 2023 and is to be held at 
the Company’s registered and head office at Power House, 7 Par-la-Ville 
Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. Notice of this year’s AGM and forms  
of proxy and direction shall be delivered to shareholders by electronic 
means. If you have any queries regarding the notice or AGM voting 
requirements please contact Chris Head, Company Secretary, using  
Tel: +44 (0) 20 7264 4000 and email: chris.head@lancashiregroup.com.

Further information
Lancashire Holdings Limited is registered in Bermuda under company 
number EC 37415 and has its registered office at Power House, 7 
Par-la-Ville Road, Hamilton HM 11, Bermuda. Further information  
about the Group including this Annual Report and Accounts, press 
releases and the Company’s share price is available on our website  
at www.lancashiregroup.com. Please address any enquiries to  
info@lancashiregroup.com.

Note regarding forward-looking statements
Some of the statements in this document include forward-looking 
statements which reflect the Directors’ current views with respect  
to financial performance, business strategy, plans and objectives of 
management for future operations (including development plans relating 
to the Group’s products and services). These statements include forward-
looking statements both with respect to the Group and the sectors and 
industries in which the Group operates. Statements containing the words 
‘believes’, ‘anticipates’, ‘aims’, ‘plans’, ‘projects’, ‘forecasts’, ‘guidance’, 
‘intends’, ‘expects’, ‘estimates’, ‘predicts’, ‘may’, ‘can’, ‘likely’, ‘will’, 
‘seeks’, ‘should’ or, in each case, their negative or comparable 
terminology and similar statements are of a future or forward-looking 
nature. All forward-looking statements address matters that involve 
known and unknown risks and uncertainties. Accordingly, there are  
or will be important factors that could cause the actual results, 
performance or achievements of the Group to be materially different 
from future results, performance or achievements expressed or implied 
by such forward-looking statements.

These factors include, but are not limited to: the impact of the ongoing 
conflict in Ukraine, including any escalation or expansion thereof, on the 
Group’s clients, reserves, the continued uncertainty of the situation in 
Russia, including issues relating to coverage and the impact of sanctions, 
the securities in our investment portfolio and on global financial markets 
generally, as well as any governmental or regulatory change arising 
therefrom; and a continuation in financial market volatility and other 
adverse market conditions generally; the actual development of losses 
and expenses impacting estimates for claims which arise as a result of 
the hurricane Ian, which occurred in the third quarter of 2022, COVID-19 
pandemic, the Kentucky tornadoes, hurricane Ida and the European 
storms which occurred in the second half of 2021, winter storm Uri 
which occurred during the first quarter of 2021, hurricanes Laura and 
Sally, the Midwest Derecho storm and the wildfires in California which 
occurred in 2020, the 2020 and 2021 large loss events across the 
Group’s specialty business lines, typhoon Hagibis in the fourth quarter  
of 2019, hurricane Dorian and typhoon Faxai in the third quarter of 2019, 

the Californian wildfires and hurricane Michael which occurred in the 
fourth quarter of 2018, hurricane Florence, the typhoons and marine 
losses that occurred in the third quarter of 2018, hurricanes Harvey,  
Irma and Maria and the earthquakes in Mexico, that occurred in the  
third quarter of 2017 and the wildfires which impacted parts of California 
during 2017; the impact of complex and unique causation and coverage 
issues associated with attribution of losses to wind or flood damage or 
other perils such as fire or business interruption relating to such events; 
potential uncertainties relating to reinsurance recoveries, reinstatement 
premiums and other factors inherent in loss estimations; the Group’s 
ability to integrate its business and personnel; the successful retention 
and motivation of the Group’s key management; the increased 
regulatory burden facing the Group; the number and type of insurance 
and reinsurance contracts that the Group writes or may write; the 
Group’s ability to successfully implement its business strategy during 
‘soft’ as well as ‘hard’ markets; the premium rates which may be 
available at the time of such renewals within its targeted business lines; 
potentially unusual loss frequency; the impact that the Group’s future 
operating results, capital position and rating agency and other 
considerations may have on the execution of any capital management 
initiatives or dividends; the possibility of greater frequency or severity  
of claims and loss activity than the Group’s underwriting, reserving or 
investment practices have anticipated; the reliability of, and changes in 
assumptions to, catastrophe pricing, accumulation and estimated loss 
models; increased competition from existing alternative capital providers 
and insurance-linked funds and collateralised special purpose insurers, 
and the related demand and supply dynamics as contracts come up for 
renewal; the effectiveness of its loss limitation methods; the potential 
loss of key personnel; a decline in the Group’s operating subsidiaries’ 
ratings with A.M. Best, S&P Global Ratings, Moody’s or other rating 
agencies; increased competition on the basis of pricing, capacity, 
coverage terms or other factors; cyclical downturns of the industry;  
the impact of a deteriorating credit environment for issuers of fixed 
maturity investments; the impact of swings in market interest rates, 
currency exchange rates and securities prices; changes by central banks 
regarding the level of interest rates; the impact of inflation or deflation  
in relevant economies in which the Group operates; the effect, timing 
and other uncertainties surrounding future business combinations within 
the insurance and reinsurance industries; the impact of terrorist activity 
in the countries in which the Group writes risks; a rating downgrade of,  
or a market decline in, securities in its investment portfolio; changes in 
governmental regulations or tax laws in jurisdictions where the Group 
conducts business; Lancashire or its Bermudian subsidiaries becoming 
subject to income taxes in the United States or in the United Kingdom; 
the impact of the change in tax residence on stakeholders of the Group; 
and the impact of the expiration of the transition period on 31 December 
2020 following the United Kingdom’s withdrawal from the European 
Union on the Group’s business, regulatory relationships, underwriting 
platforms or the industry generally, the focus and scrutiny on ESG-
related matters regarding the insurance industry from key stakeholders 
of the Group, and any adverse asset, credit, financing or debt or capital 
market conditions generally which may affect the ability of the Group  
to manage its liquidity.

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

189

Additional InformationShareholder Information continued

Any estimates relating to loss events involve the exercise of considerable 
judgement and reflect a combination of ground-up evaluations, 
information available to date from brokers and insureds, market 
intelligence, initial and/or tentative loss reports and other sources. 
Judgements in relation to loss arising from natural catastrophe and 
man-made events are influenced by complex factors. The Group cautions 
as to the preliminary nature of the information used to prepare such 
estimates as subsequently available information may contribute to an 
increase in these types of losses.

These forward-looking statements speak only as at the date of this 
document. The Company expressly disclaims any obligation or 
undertaking (save as required to comply with any legal or regulatory 
obligations including the rules of the LSE) to disseminate any updates  
or revisions to any forward-looking statement to reflect any changes in 
the Group’s expectations or circumstances on which any such statement 
is based. All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements 
attributable to the Group or individuals acting on behalf of the Group  
are expressly qualified in their entirety by this paragraph. Prospective 
investors should specifically consider the factors identified in this 
document which could cause actual results to differ before making  
an investment decision.

190

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Glossary

Accident year loss ratio

The accident year loss ratio is calculated using the accident year ultimate 
liability revalued at the current balance sheet date, divided by net 
premiums earned

Active Underwriter

The individual at a Lloyd’s syndicate with principal authority to accept 
insurance and reinsurance risk on behalf of the syndicate

Additional case reserves (ACR)

CCHL

Cathedral Capital Holdings Limited

CCL

Cathedral Capital Limited

CCL 1998

Cathedral Capital (1998) Limited

CCL 1999

Additional reserves deemed necessary by management

Cathedral Capital (1999) Limited

AFS

Available for sale

Aggregate

Accumulations of insurance loss exposures which result from 
underwriting multiple risks that are exposed to common causes of loss

CCWG

Climate Change Working Group

CDP

Carbon Disclosure Project

Ceded

AGM

Annual General Meeting

AIM

A sub-market of the LSE

A.M. Best Company (A.M. Best)

A.M. Best is a full-service credit rating organisation dedicated to serving 
the financial services industry, focusing on the insurance sector

APMs

Alternative performance measures

BCP

Business Continuity Plan

BMA

Bermuda Monetary Authority

Board of Directors; Board

Unless otherwise stated refers to the LHL Board of Directors

To transfer insurance risk from a direct insurer to a reinsurer and/or from 
a reinsurer to a retrocessionaire

CEND

Confiscation, Expropriation, Nationalisation and Deprivation

CEO

Chief Executive Officer

CFO

Chief Financial Officer

CGU

Cash generating unit

Change in FCBVS

The IRR of the change in FCBVS in the period plus accrued dividends

CIO

Chief Investment Officer

The Code

BREEAM

UK Corporate Governance Code published by the UK FRC (www.frc.org.uk)

Building Research Establishment Environmental Assessment Method

Combined ratio

BSCR

Bermuda Solvency Capital Requirement

BSX

Bermuda Stock Exchange

Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance losses, net acquisition 
expenses and other operating expenses to net premiums earned

Compound Annual Change in FCBVS adjusted for dividends

The calculation is the internal rate of return on the movement in Fully 
Converted Book Value since inception on an annualised basis plus 
dividends accrued

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

191

Additional InformationGlossary continued

Consolidated financial statements

Dividend yield

Includes the independent auditor’s report, consolidated primary 
statements, accounting policies, risk disclosures and related notes

Calculated by dividing the annual dividends per share by the share price 
on the last day of the given year

Consolidated primary statements

Duration

Includes the consolidated statement of comprehensive income, 
consolidated balance sheet, consolidated statement of changes in 
shareholders’ equity and the statement of consolidated cash flows

COO

Chief Operating Officer

CRO

Chief Risk Officer

CUL

Cathedral Underwriting Limited 

CUO

Chief Underwriting Officer

D&F

Direct and facultative (re)insurance

DE&I

Diversity, equity and inclusion

Deferred acquisition costs

Costs incurred for the acquisition or the renewal of insurance policies 
(e.g. brokerage and premium taxes) which are deferred and amortised 
over the term of the insurance contracts to which they relate

Delegated authorities

Arrangements under which a managing agent or (re)insurer delegates  
its authority to another to enter into contracts of insurance on its behalf

Diluted earnings per share

Calculated by dividing the net profit for the year attributable to 
shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares 
outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number of 
common shares that would be issued on the conversion of all  
potentially dilutive equity-based compensation awards into  
common shares under the treasury stock method

Directors’ fees and expenses

Unless otherwise stated includes fees and expenses of all Directors 
across the Group

Duration is the weighted average maturity of a security’s cash flows, 
where the present values of the cash flows serve as the weights. 

The effect of the convexity, or sensitivity, of the portfolio’s response  
to changes in interest rates is also factored into the calculation

Earnings per share (EPS)

Calculated by dividing net profit for the year attributable to shareholders 
by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during 
the year, excluding treasury shares and shares held by the EBT

EBT

Lancashire Holdings Employee Benefit Trust

ECA

Economic Capital Assessment

ERM

Enterprise Risk Management

ESG

Environmental, Social and Governance

EU

European Union

Excess of loss

Reinsurance or insurance that indemnifies the reinsured or insured 
against all or a specified portion of losses on an underlying insurance 
policy in excess of a specified amount

Facultative reinsurance

A reinsurance risk that is placed by means of a separately negotiated 
contract as opposed to one that is ceded under a reinsurance treaty

FAL

Funds at Lloyd’s

FCA

Financial Conduct Authority

FRC

Financial Reporting Council

192

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

FSMA

IFRS 17

The Financial Services and Markets Act 2000 (as amended from time to 
time)

FTE

Full-Time Employee

Fully converted book value per share (FCBVS)

Calculated based on the value of the total shareholders’ equity 
attributable to the Group and dilutive restricted stock units as calculated 
under the treasury method, divided by the sum of all shares and dilutive 
restricted stock units, assuming all are exercised

FVTPL

Fair value through profit or loss

G10

Belgium, Canada, Germany, France, Italy, Japan, the Netherlands, 
Sweden, the United Kingdom, and the United States

GDPR 

General Data Protection Regulation

GHG

Greenhouse gas emissions covers carbon dioxide (CO2), methane (CH4), 
nitrous oxide (N2O), hydrofluorocarbons (HFC), perfluorocarbons (PFC), 
nitrogen trifluoride (NF3) and sulphur hexafluoride (SF6)

The Group or the Lancashire Group

LHL and its subsidiaries

GMM

General Measurement Model

GSE

Government-Sponsored Enterprise

GWP

Gross premiums written. Amounts payable by the insured, excluding any 
taxes or duties levied on the premium, including any brokerage and 
commission deducted by intermediaries

ICM

International Care Ministries

IFRS

International Financial Reporting Standard(s)

IFRS 9

International Financial Reporting Standard on Financial Instruments

International Financial Reporting Standard on Insurance Contracts

ILS

Insurance Linked Securities

Incurred but not reported (IBNR)

These are anticipated or likely losses that may result from insured events 
which have taken place, but for which no losses have yet been reported. 
IBNR also includes a reserve for possible adverse development of 
previously reported losses

Industry loss warranty (ILW)

A type of reinsurance or derivative contract through which one party will 
purchase protection based on the total loss arising from an event to the 
entire insurance industry rather than their own losses

Internal Audit Charter

A formal written document that sets out the mission, scope, 
responsibilities, authority, professional standards and the relationship 
with the external auditors and regulatory bodies of the internal audit 
function with the Company and its subsidiaries

International Accounting Standard(s) (IAS)

Standards, created by the IASB, for the preparation and presentation of 
financial statements

International Accounting Standards Board (IASB)

An international panel of accounting experts responsible for developing 
IAS and IFRS

IRR

Internal rate of return

IRRC

Investment Risk and Return Committee

ISA

International Standards on Auditing (UK)

KHL

Kinesis Holdings I Limited

Kinesis

The Group’s third-party capital management division encompassing 
LCM, LCMMSL and the management of KHL and KRL

KPMG LLP

KPMG LLP, a UK limited liability partnership

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

193

Additional InformationGlossary continued

KPI

Key performance indicator

KRI

Key risk indicator

KRL (Kinesis Re)

Kinesis Reinsurance I Limited

Lancashire Foundation or Foundation

Lloyd’s

The Society of Lloyd’s

LMSCL

Lancashire Management Services (Canada) Limited

LOC

Letter of credit

Losses

The Lancashire Foundation is a charity registered in England and Wales

Demand by an insured for indemnity under an insurance contract

Lancashire Insurance Companies

LICL and LUK

LAPL

LSE

London Stock Exchange

LSL or Lancashire Syndicates

Lancashire Australia Pty Ltd

Lancashire Syndicates Limited. The managing agent of the syndicates

LBCL

LUAPL

Lancashire Blocker (Cayman) Limited

Lancashire Underwriting Australia Pty Ltd

LCM

LUK or Lancashire UK

Lancashire Capital Management Limited. 

Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited

LCMMSL

Managed cash

LCM Marketing Services Limited. Formerly KCM Marketing Services 
Limited

Managed cash includes both cash managed by external investment 
managers and non-operating cash managed internally

LHAPL

MBRT

Lancashire Holdings Australia Pty Limited

Multi-beneficiary reinsurance trust

LHL (The Company)

Lancashire Holdings Limited

LICL

Lancashire Insurance Company Limited

LIHL

Moody’s Investors Service (Moody’s)

Moody’s Corporation is the parent company of Moody’s Investors 
Service, which provides credit ratings and research covering debt 
instruments and securities, and Moody’s Analytics, which offers  
software, advisory services and research for credit and economic  
analysis and financial risk management

Lancashire Insurance Holdings (UK) Limited

MSCI

LIMSL

Lancashire Insurance Marketing Services Limited

LISL

Lancashire Insurance Services Limited

Listing Rules

The listing rules made by the FCA under part VI of FSMA (as amended 
from time to time)

A provider of tools and services for the global investment community

Nameco

Nameco (No. 801) Ltd

NAV

Net asset value

Net acquisition cost ratio

Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance acquisition expenses to net premiums 
earned

194

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Net expense ratio

Ratio, in per cent, of other operating expenses, excluding restricted  
stock expenses, to net premiums earned

Net loss ratio

Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net premiums earned

Net premiums earned

Net premiums earned is equal to net premiums written less the  
change in unearned premiums and change in unearned premiums  
on premiums ceded

Net premiums written

Net premiums written is equal to gross premiums written less  
outwards reinsurance premiums written

Official List

The official list of the UK Listing Authority

ORSA

Own Risk and Solvency Assessment

OTC

Over the counter

PAA

Premium Allocation Approach

PIPA

Personal Information Protection Act

PMI

Private Mortgage Insurance

PML

Probable maximum loss. The Group’s exposure to certain peak zone 
elemental losses

PRA

Prudential Regulation Authority

Pro-rata/proportional

and reflects management’s assessment of relative changes in price, terms, 
conditions and limits and is weighted by premium volume. The RPI does 
not include new business, to offer a consistent basis for analysis. The 
calculation involves a degree of judgement in relation to comparability of 
contracts and assessment noted above. To enhance the RPI methodology, 
management may revise the methodology assumptions underlying the 
RPI, so that the trends in premium rates reflected in the RPI may not be 
comparable over time. Consideration is only given to renewals of a 
comparable nature so it does not reflect every contract in the portfolio of 
contracts. The future profitability of the portfolio of contracts within the 
RPI is dependent upon many factors besides the trends in premium rates. 
RPIs are expressed as an approximate percentage of pricing achieved on 
similar contracts written in the corresponding year.

Retrocession

The insurance of a reinsurance account

Return on Equity (RoE)

The IRR of the change in FCBVS in the period plus accrued dividends

Risk Free Rate of Return (RFRoR)

Being the 13-week U.S. Treasury bill rate, unless otherwise stated

RMF

Risk Management Framework

RMS

Risk Management Solutions

RRC

Risk and Return Committee

RSC

Reinsurance Security Committee

RSS

Restricted share scheme

S&P Global Ratings (S&P)

S&P Global Ratings is a worldwide insurance rating and information 
agency whose ratings are recognised as a benchmark for assessing  
the financial strength of insurance-related organisations

Reinsurance or insurance where the reinsurer or insurer shares  
a proportional part of the original premiums and losses of the  
reinsured or insured

RCCC

SCR

Solvency Capital Requirement

SECR

Risk Capital and Compliance Committee

Streamlined Energy and Carbon Reporting

RDS

Realistic Disaster Scenarios

Renewal Price Index (RPI)

SGT

St Giles Trust 

Syndicate 2010

The RPI is an internal methodology that management uses to track trends 
in premium rates of a portfolio of insurance and reinsurance contracts. The 
RPI written in the respective segments is calculated on a per-contract basis 

Lloyd’s Syndicate 2010, managed by LSL. The Group provides capital  
to support 69.2% of the stamp for the 2023 underwriting year

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

195

Additional InformationGlossary continued

Syndicate 3010

U.S. GAAP

Accounting principles generally accepted in the United States

U.S.T

U.S. Treasury Bills

UURC

The Underwriting and Underwriting Risk Committee, a committee  
of the Board

Value at Risk (VaR)

A measure of the risk of loss of a specific portfolio of financial assets

Lloyd’s Syndicate 3010, managed by LSL. The Group provides capital  
to support 100.0% of the stamp for the 2023 underwriting year

TCFD

Task Force on Climate-related Financial Disclosures

The syndicates

Syndicates 2010 and 3010

TOBA

Terms of business agreement

Total Investment Return

Total investment return measures investment income and net realised 
and unrealised gains and losses produced by the Group’s managed 
investment portfolio

Total Shareholder Return (TSR)

The increase/(decrease) in share price in the period, measured on  
a total return basis, which assumes the reinvestment of dividends

Treaty reinsurance

A reinsurance contract under which the reinsurer agrees to offer and  
to accept all risks of a certain size within a defined class

UK

United Kingdom

ULAE

Unallocated loss adjustment expense

UMCC

Underwriting Marketing Conference Call

Unearned premiums

The portion of premium income that is attributable to periods after  
the balance sheet date that is deferred and amortised to future 
accounting periods

UNEP FI

The United Nations Environment Programme Finance Initiative

UNL

Ultimate net loss

UNPRI

UN-supported Principles for Responsible Investment

uSCR

Ultimate solvency capital requirement

U.S.

United States of America

196

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Alternative Performance Measures

Alternative Performance Measures (‘APMs’)

As is customary in the insurance industry, the Group utilises certain 
non-GAAP measures in order to evaluate, monitor and manage the 
business and to aid users’ understanding of the Group. Management 
believes that the APMs included in the Annual Report and Accounts are 
important for understanding the Group’s overall results of operations 
and may be helpful to investors and other interested parties who may 
benefit from having a consistent basis for comparison with other 
companies within the industry. However, these measures may not be 
comparable to similarly labelled measures used by companies inside or 
outside the insurance industry. In addition, the information contained 
herein should not be viewed as superior to, or a substitute for, the 
measures determined in accordance with the accounting principles  
used by the Group for its audited consolidated financial statements  
or in accordance with GAAP.

In compliance with the Guidelines on APMs of the European Securities 
and Markets Authority and as suggested by the FRC, as applied by the 
FCA, information on APMs which the Group uses is described below.  
This information has not been audited.

All amounts, excluding share data, percentages or where otherwise 
stated, are in millions of U.S. dollars.

Net loss ratio: Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance losses to net 
premiums earned. This ratio gives an indication of the amount of claims 
expected to be paid out per $1.00 of net premium earned in the financial 
year. The net loss ratio may also be presented with net insurance losses  
absent catastrophe and other large losses.

Net insurance losses
Divided by net premiums earned
Net loss ratio

31 December 2022
576.4 
988.4 
58.3% 

31 December 2021
470.5
696.5
67.6%

Net acquisition cost ratio: Ratio, in per cent, of net insurance 
acquisition expenses to net premiums earned. This ratio gives an 
indication of the amount expected to be paid out to insurance brokers 
and other insurance intermediaries per $1.00 of net premium earned in 
the financial year.

Net acquisition expenses
Divided by net premiums earned
Net acquisition cost ratio

31 December 2022
261.2 
988.4 
26.4% 

31 December 2021
157.0
696.5
22.5%

Net expense ratio: Ratio, in per cent, of other operating expenses, 
excluding restricted stock expenses, to net premiums earned. This ratio 
gives an indication of the amount of operating expenses expected to be 
paid out per $1.00 of net premium earned in the financial year.

Other operating expenses
Divided by net premiums earned
Net expense ratio

31 December 2022
128.7 
988.4 
13.0% 

31 December 2021
119.6
696.5
17.2%

Combined ratio (KPI): Ratio, in per cent, of the sum of net insurance 
losses, net acquisition expenses and other operating expenses to net 
premiums earned. The Group aims to price its business to ensure that  
the combined ratio across the cycle is less than 100%.

Net loss ratio
Net acquisition cost ratio
Net expense ratio
Combined ratio

31 December 2022
58.3% 
26.4% 
13.0% 
97.7% 

31 December 2021
67.6%
22.5%
17.2%
107.3%

Accident year loss ratio: The accident year loss ratio is calculated using 
the accident year ultimate liability revalued at the current balance sheet 
date, divided by net premiums earned. This ratio shows the amount of 
claims expected to be paid out per $1.00 of net premium earned in an 
accident year.

Current accident year ultimate 
liability
Divided by net premiums earned*
Accident year loss ratio

31 December 2022

31 December 2021

676.9 
968.6 
69.9% 

557.0
687.9
81.0%

 * For the accident year loss ratio, net premiums earned excludes inwards and outwards 

reinstatement premium from prior accident years.

Fully converted book value per share (‘FCBVS’) attributable to the  
Group: Calculated based on the value of the total shareholders’ equity 
attributable to the Group and dilutive restricted stock units as calculated 
under the treasury method, divided by the sum of all shares and dilutive 
restricted stock units, assuming all are exercised. Shows the Group net 
asset value on a diluted per share basis for comparison to the market 
value per share.

Shareholders’ equity attributable 
to the Group
Common voting shares 
outstanding*
Shares relating to dilutive 
restricted stock
Fully converted book value 
denominator
Fully converted book value per 
share

31 December 2022

31 December 2021

1,267,882,107 1,412,308,553

238,333,570

241,839,109

3,700,547 

2,805,365

242,034,117

244,644,474

$5.24 

$5.77

 * Common voting shares outstanding comprise issued share capital less amounts held 

in trust (see note 19).

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

197

Additional InformationAlternative Performance Measures continued

Change in FCBVS (KPI): The internal rate of return of the Change in 
FCBVS in the period plus accrued dividends. Sometimes referred to  
as ROE. The Group’s aim is to maximise risk-adjusted returns for 
shareholders across the cycle through a purposeful and sustainable 
business culture.

Opening FCBVS
Q1 dividend per share
Q2 dividend per share
Q3 dividend per share
Q4 dividend per share + closing 
FCBVS
Change in FCBVS*

31 December 2022
($5.77)
–
$0.10
$0.05

31 December 2021
($6.28)
–
$0.10 
$0.05

$5.24
(6.7%)

$5.77
(5.8%)

 * Calculated using the internal rate of return.
Total investment return (KPI): Total investment return, in percentage 
terms, is calculated by dividing the total investment return excluding 
foreign exchange by the investment portfolio net asset value, including 
managed cash on a daily basis. These daily returns are then annualised 
through geometric linking of daily returns. The return can be 
approximated by dividing the total investment return, excluding foreign 
exchange, by the average portfolio net asset value, including managed 
cash. The Group’s primary investment objectives are to preserve capital 
and provide adequate liquidity to support the Group’s payment of claims 
and other obligations. Within this framework we aim for a degree of 
investment portfolio return.

Total investment return
Average invested assets*
Approximate total investment 
return
Reported total investment return

31 December 2022
(76.7)
2,387.0

31 December 2021
1.3
2,167.5

(3.2%)
(3.5%)

0.1%
0.1%

 * Calculated as the average between the opening and closing investments as per note 

11 and externally managed cash as per note 10.

Total shareholder return (KPI): The increase/(decrease) in share price  
in the period, measured on a total return basis, which assumes the 
reinvestment of dividends. The Group’s aim is to maximise the Change  
in FCBVS over the longer term and we would expect that to be reflected 
in our share price and multiple. This is a long-term goal, recognising that 
the cyclicality and volatility of both the insurance market and the 
financial markets in general will impact management’s ability to 
maximise the Change in FCBVS in the immediate term. 

The total return measurement basis used will generally approximate the  
simple method of calculating the increase/(decrease) in share  
price adjusted for dividends as recalculated below.

Opening share price
Q1 dividend per share
Q2 dividend per share
Q3 dividend per share
Q4 dividend per share + closing 
share price
Total shareholder return

31 December 2022
($7.17)
–
$0.10
$0.05

31 December 2021
($9.88)
–
$0.10
$0.05

$7.86
11.7%

$7.17
(25.8%)

Comprehensive income returned to shareholders (KPI): The 
percentage of comprehensive income returned to shareholders  
equals the total capital returned to shareholders through dividends  
and share repurchases in a given year, divided by the Group’s 
comprehensive income. The Group aims to carry the right level  
of capital to match attractive underwriting opportunities, utilising an 
optimal mix of capital tools. Over time, through proactive and flexible 
capital management across the cycle, we aim to maximise risk-adjusted 
returns for shareholders.

Capital returned
Comprehensive income 
attributable to the Group
Comprehensive income returned 
to shareholders

31 December 2022
59.5 

31 December 2021
43.3

(92.6) 

(92.9)

n/a*

n/a*

 * The % comprehensive income returned to shareholders is n/a when reporting a 

comprehensive loss for the period.

Gross premiums written under management (KPI): The gross 
premiums written under management equals the total of the Group’s 
consolidated gross premiums written plus the external Names’ portion 
of the gross premiums written in Syndicate 2010 plus the gross 
premiums written in LCM on behalf of KRL. The Group aims to operate 
nimbly through the cycle. We will grow in existing and new classes where 
favourable and improving market conditions exist, whilst monitoring and 
managing our risk exposures and not seek top-line growth for the sake of 
it in markets where we do not believe the right opportunities exist.

Gross premiums written by the 
Group
LSL Syndicate 2010 – external 
Names’ portion of gross premiums 
written (unconsolidated)
LCM gross premiums written 
(unconsolidated)
Total gross premiums written 
under management

31 December 2022

31 December 2021

1,652.3

1,225.2

160.0

38.4

142.3

135.9

1,850.7

1,503.4

198

Lancashire Holdings Limited | Annual Report & Accounts 2022

Contact information

Registered and Head office
Lancashire Holdings Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950 
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951

Bermuda office
Lancashire Insurance Company Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950 
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951

UK office
Lancashire Insurance Company (UK) Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street 
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4000 
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7264 4077

Lancashire Syndicates Limited
Lancashire Syndicates Limited 
29th Floor 
20 Fenchurch Street 
London EC3M 3BY 
United Kingdom

Phone: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9000 
Fax: + 44 (0) 20 7170 9001

Lancashire Capital Management
Lancashire Capital Management Limited 
Power House 
7 Par-la-Ville Road 
Hamilton HM 11 
Bermuda

Phone: + 1 441 278 8950 
Fax: + 1 441 278 8951

Lancashire Underwriting Australia Pty Ltd
Registered Office – Level 20, 56 Pitt Street,  
Sydney, NSW 2000, Australia 
Trading Address – Suite 5.03, Level 5 
56, Pitt Street, Sydney,  
NSW 2000, Australia

Legal counsel to the Company
As to English and U.S. law: 
Willkie Farr & Gallagher (UK) LLP 
City Point 
1 Ropemaker Street 
London EC2Y 9AW 
United Kingdom

Auditors
KPMG LLP 
15 Canada Square 
London E14 5GL 
United Kingdom

Registrar
Link Market Services (Jersey) Limited 
P.O. Box 532 
St Helier 
Jersey JE4 5UW 
Channel Islands

Depositary
Link Market Services Trustees Limited 
10th floor 
Central Square 
29 Wellington Street 
Leeds LS1 4DL 
United Kingdom

This report is printed on Munken Lynx Rough  
and Arena Extra White Smooth both of which  
have been independently certified by the Forest 
Stewardship Council® and manufactured using 
materials from sustainable sources.

Designed and produced by Black Sun Plc.

Printed at Principal Colour Ltd. ISO 14001 certified,  
Alcohol Free and FSC® Chain of Custody certified. 

Holdings Limited

www.lancashiregroup.com